TM 9-2320-339-10
TM 9-2320-339-10
TM 9-2320-339-10
TECHNICAL MANUAL
OPERATOR'S MANUAL
FOR
TM 9-2320-339-10
WARNING SUMMARY
GENERAL SAFETY CAUTION/WARNING SUMMARY
This list summarizes critical warnings. They are repeated here to let you know how
important they are.
They can save your life and the lives of personnel you work with.
If there is any doubt about handling tools, materials, equipment, and procedures,
see TB 43-0216, Safety and Hazard Warnings for Operation and Maintenance of
TACOM Equipment.
Table 1. Warning Icons Used In This Manual.
WARNING ICON
DESCRIPTION
AIR PRESSURE - human hand blocking air gun shows the need
to reduce air pressure before use, or debris may injure user and/
or damage equipment.
TM 9-2320-339-10
DESCRIPTION
ELECTRICAL - electrical wire to arm with electricity symbol running through human body shows that shock hazard is present.
EYE PROTECTION - person with goggles shows that the material will injure the eyes.
FIRE - flame shows that material may ignite and cause burns.
TM 9-2320-339-10
DESCRIPTION
FIRE EXTINGUISHER - shows that material may ignite and a fire
extinguisher should be within easy reach.
HEAVY PARTS - hand with heavy object on top shows that heavy
parts can crush and harm.
HEAVY PARTS - foot with heavy object on top shows that heavy
parts can crush and harm.
TM 9-2320-339-10
DESCRIPTION
HEAVY PARTS - heavy object on human figure shows that heavy
parts present a danger to life or limb.
HOT AREA - hand over object radiating heats shows that part is
hot and can burn.
TM 9-2320-339-10
DESCRIPTION
RADIATION - three circular wedges show that the material emits
radioactive energy and can injure human tissue.
ROLLOVER HAZARD - vehicle indicating direction of human figure shows that vehicle may roll over if conditions are not avoided,
presenting a danger to life or limb.
TM 9-2320-339-10
DESCRIPTION
SLICK FLOOR - wavy line on floor with legs prone shows that
slick floor presents a danger of falling.
TIRE BLOWOUT - tire with hole shows that an over or under inflated tire may rupture, presenting a danger to life or limb.
TM 9-2320-339-10
DESCRIPTION
WIRE CABLE/ROPE - human hand with frayed wire cable/rope
running across shows injury to unprotected (bare) hands may result.
WARNING
MODIFICATION HAZARD
Unauthorized modifications to, alterations to, or installations on this
equipment are prohibited and are in violation of AR 750-10.
Failure to comply may result in injury or death to personnel or damage
to equipment.
WARNING
TM 9-2320-339-10
WARNING
ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
Remove all jewelry, such as rings, ID tags, bracelets, etc. If jewelry
or tools contact electrical circuits, a direct short may result. Failure to
comply may result in serious injury or death to personnel.
Do not smoke, use open flame, make sparks or other ignition sources
around batteries. A battery giving off gas could explode. Failure to
comply may result in serious injury or death to personnel.
Be careful when working on or with electrical equipment. Do not be
misled by the term low voltage. Voltages as low as 50 volts can
cause death. For artificial respiration, refer to FM 4-25.11.
When working inside the vehicle with power off, be sure to ground
every capacitor likely to hold a dangerous voltage potential.
Never work on electronic equipment unless there is another person
nearby who is familiar with the operation and hazards of the
equipment.
WARNING
TM 9-2320-339-10
may cause lung and central nervous system damage. Can be fatal if
swallowed. Inhalation of high/massive concentrations can cause
coma or be fatal. First aid for ingestion: do not induce vomiting. Seek
immediate medical attention. First aid of skin contact: remove
contaminated clothing. Wash skin thoroughly with soap and water. If
symptoms persist, seek medical attention. First aid for eye contact:
flush with water for 15 minutes or until irritation subsides. If symptoms
persist, seek medical attention. First aid for inhalation: move to fresh
air. If not breathing, provide artificial respiration. If symptoms persist,
seek medical attention. Keep away from open flames and other
sources of ignition. Failure to follow this warning may result in injury
or death to personnel.
The flashpoint for Type II solvent cleaning compound is 141-198F
(61-92C), and Type III is 200-241F (93-116C).
Improper cleaning methods and use of unauthorized cleaning
solvents may injure personnel and damage equipment.
Fire extinguishers should be placed nearby when using solvent
cleaning compound. Failure to follow this warning may result in injury
or death.
Cloths or rags saturated with solvent cleaning compound must be
disposed of IAW authorized facilities' procedures. Failure to follow
this warning may result in injury.
Eye shields must be worn when cleaning with a wire brush. Flying
rust and metal particles may cause injury.
WARNING
TM 9-2320-339-10
WARNING
ADHESIVE
Adhesive, solvents and sealing compounds can burn easily and are
harmful causing immediate bonding on contact with eyes, skin, or
clothing and gives off harmful vapors.
If adhesive, solvent, or sealing compound gets on skin or clothing,
wash immediately with soap and water.
If adhesive gets in your eyes, try to keep them open; flush them with
water for 15 minutes and get immediate medical attention.
Wear protective goggles and use in a well-ventilated area.
TM 9-2320-339-10
Keep away from open fire and use in well-ventilated area to avoid
injury or death.
WARNING
WARNING
TM 9-2320-339-10
WARNING
MOVING MACHINERY
Use extreme care when operating or working near moving machinery
including running engine, rotating shafts, and other moving parts.
Failure to comply may result in injury or death to personnel.
Use extreme care when measuring voltage while engine is running
around rotating fan blade and hot engine parts. Failure to comply may
result in injury or death to personnel.
TM 9-2320-339-10
WARNING
TANKER OPERATION
Equipment operation is allowable with minor leakages (Class I) or
(Class II). Consideration must be given to the field capacity in the
item/system being checked/inspected. When in doubt notify
supervisor. When operating with Class I or II leaks, continue to check
fluid levels as required in the PMCS.
or (Class III) leaks should be repaired per applicable procedure.
All winching performed in this procedure must be with engine at low
idle. Failure to comply may result in damage to equipment.
Use care when removing nozzles. Failure to comply may result in
damage to equipment.
WARNING
TM 9-2320-339-10
WARNING
HEAVY PARTS
Any part or component that weigh over 50 lbs (23 kg) must be removed
with the aid of an assistant and a lifting device. Failure to comply may
result in personal injury or death.
TM 9-2320-339-10
WARNING
CRANE SYSTEM
Always refer to the range diagram BEFORE making any lift. It is
extremely important that the crane is properly leveled to prevent
overstressing.
Do not operate crane unless outriggers are set up. Always chock front
wheels when using outriggers. Failure to comply may result in injury
or death to personnel.
When using crane on any vehicle, park vehicle clear of all overhead
powerlines. If operating crane under power lines, do not allow vehicle
to contact high-voltage connections. Failure to comply will result in
death to personnel.
Do not stand under crane. Failure to comply may result in injury or
death to personnel.
Refuse to work with worn, frayed, or damaged wire rope. Always wear
heavy gloves when handling winch cables; never let cable run
through hands. Frayed cables can cut. Never operate winch with less
than five wraps of cable on winch drum. Failure to comply may result
in injury or death to personnel.
When using crane on any vehicle, park vehicle clear of all overhead
power lines. Do not operate crane near overhead power lines. Failure
to comply may result in injury or death to personnel.
Boom has a 370 degree rotation and is mechanically stopped at five
degrees on either side of the left outrigger beam. Swing operations
must be slowed no later than 15 degrees prior to contacting the stop.
Keep boom clear of electrical powerlines and other obstacles. Do not
operate crane near overhead powerlines. Failure to comply will result
in death to personnel.
Avoid quick, jerking, winch operation. Keep other personnel well
away from vehicles involved in winching operations. A snapped cable
or shifting load can cause serious injury or death.
If possible, keep one hand away from equipment to reduce the hazard
of current flowing through vital organs of the body.
Keep fingers clear of top of lift-hook. Failure to comply could result in
personnel injury.
TM 9-2320-339-10
WARNING
TM 9-2320-339-10
WARNING
EXTREME HEAT
If required to remain inside the vehicle during extreme heat, occupants
should follow the water intake, work/rest cycle, and other heat stress
preventive medicine measures contained in FM 21-10, Field Hygiene and
Sanitation.
WARNING
CABLES
Always wear heavy gloves when handling winch cables; never let
cable run through hands. Frayed cables can cut. Failure to comply
may result in injury or death to personnel.
Never operate winch with less than five wraps of cable on winch
drum. Frayed cables can cut. Failure to comply may result in injury
or death to personnel.
WARNING
LEAD-ACID BATTERIES
Wear proper eye protection when working around batteries. Failure
to comply may result in injury or death to personnel.
Use extreme care not to short out battery terminals. Remove all
jewelry such as rings, ID tags, bracelets, etc. prior to working on or
TM 9-2320-339-10
WARNING
NBC
NBC-contaminated air filters must be handled and disposed of only
by authorized and trained personnel.
The unit commander or senior officer in charge of maintenance
personnel must ensure that prescribed protective clothing (FM
3-11.4) is used, and prescribed safety measures and
decontamination procedures (FM 3-11.5) are followed.
The local unit SOP is responsible for final disposal of contaminated
air filters. Failure to comply may cause severe injury or death to
personnel.
WARNING
TIRE OPERATION
Operating a vehicle with a tire in an overinflated or underinflated
condition, or with a questionable defect, may lead to premature tire
failure. Ensure tire has proper tire pressure. Failure to comply may
result in injury or death to personnel.
TM 9-2320-339-10
WARNING
VEHICLE OPERATION
Speed limits posted on curves reflect speeds that are considered safe
for automobiles. Heavy trucks with a high center of gravity can roll
over at these speed limits. Use caution and reduce your speed below
the posted limit before entering a curve. Failure to comply may result
in vehicle crash and injury to personnel.
TM 9-2320-339-10
Use caution and reduce your speed below the posted limit before
entering a curve. Failure to comply may result in vehicle crash and
injury to personnel.
Always use seatbelts when operating vehicle. Failure to use seatbelt
can result in serious injury or death in case of accident.
Operation at speeds over 15 mph (24 kph) on paved roads can be
achieved when the operator determines that the vehicle being towed
and the terrain allow safe operation.
Under no condition can speeds over 35 mph (55 kph) on paved road
and 15 mph (24 kph) off-road be allowed. Loss of control can cause
serious injury or death. Excessive speed can cause damage to
vehicle being towed.
WARNING
BRAKES
Ensure all personnel are clear from front of truck before performing
brake stall check. Be ready to apply service brake. Operator must
remain in cab while performing this check. Failure to comply could
result in personnel injury.
Never use parking brake for normal braking or wheels will lock up
causing severe skid. Skidding vehicle may result in serious personal
injury or death.
Engine must be shut OFF and parking brake set before performing
PMCS walkaround. Failure to comply may result in injury or death to
personnel.
WARNING
BURNS
The exhaust pipe and muffler can become very hot during vehicle
operation. Be careful not to touch these parts with bare hands, or allow
TM 9-2320-339-10
WARNING
HEARING PROTECTION
Excessive noise levels are present any time the heavy-duty winch or
crane is operating.
Wear single hearing protection (earplugs or equivalent) while working
around equipment while it is running. Failure to do so could result in
damage to your hearing.
Seek medical aid should you suspect a hearing problem.
WARNING
COMPRESSED AIR
Brake shoes may be coated with dust. Breathing this dust may be
harmful to your health.
Do not use compressed air to clean brake shoes. Wear a filter mask
approved for use against brake dust. Failure to comply may result in
injury or death to personnel.
Compressed air used for cleaning purposes will not exceed 30 psi
(207 kPa).
Use only with effective chip guarding and personal protective
equipment, goggles, shield, and gloves.
TM 9-2320-339-10
15 October 2008
TOTAL NUMBER OF PAGES FOR FRONT AND REAR
MATTER IS 76 AND TOTAL NUMBER OF WORK PACKAGES
IS 160, CONSISTING OF THE FOLLOWING.
Page/WP No.
Front Cover
Warning Summary
i-xliv
Chp 1 - General Information,
Equipment Description and
Theory of Operation
WP 0001 (10 pages)
WP 0002 (8 pages)
WP 0003 (2 pages)
WP 0004 (6 pages)
WP 0005 (4 pages)
WP 0006 (10 pages)
WP 0007 (2 pages)
WP 0008 (2 pages)
WP 0009 (4 pages)
WP 0010 (2 pages)
WP 0011 (2 pages)
WP 0012 (8 pages)
WP 0013 (8 pages)
WP 0014 (2 pages)
WP 0015 (2 pages)
WP 0016 (2 pages)
Chp 2 - Operator Instructions
WP 0017 (2 pages)
WP 0018 (4 pages)
WP 0019 (2 pages)
WP 0020 (16 pages)
WP 0021 (6 pages)
WP 0022 (2 pages)
Change
No.
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Page/WP No.
Change
No.
WP 0023 (2 pages)
WP 0024 (2 pages)
WP 0025 (2 pages)
WP 0026 (4 pages)
WP 0027 (2 pages)
WP 0028 (4 pages)
WP 0029 (4 pages)
WP 0030 (2 pages)
WP 0031 (4 pages)
WP 0032 (4 pages)
WP 0033 (4 pages)
WP 0034 (2 pages)
WP 0035 (6 pages)
WP 0036 (8 pages)
WP 0037 (4 pages)
WP 0038 (2 pages)
WP 0039 (6 pages)
WP 0040 (18 pages)
WP 0041 (10 pages)
WP 0042 (4 pages)
WP 0043 (8 pages)
WP 0044 (2 pages)
WP 0045 (2 pages)
WP 0046 (2 pages)
WP 0047 (4 pages)
WP 0048 (2 pages)
WP 0049 (2 pages)
WP 0050 (4 pages)
WP 0051 (6 pages)
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
TM 9-2320-339-10
Page/WP No.
Change
No.
Page/WP No.
WP 0052 (2 pages)
WP 0053 (2 pages)
WP 0054 (2 pages)
WP 0055 (2 pages)
WP 0056 (2 pages)
WP 0057 (4 pages)
WP 0058 (6 pages)
WP 0059 (4 pages)
WP 0060 (2 pages)
WP 0061 (2 pages)
WP 0062 (2 pages)
WP 0063 (4 pages)
WP 0064 (2 pages)
WP 0065 (4 pages)
WP 0066 (2 pages)
WP 0067 (2 pages)
WP 0068 (2 pages)
WP 0069 (2 pages)
WP 0070 (4 pages)
WP 0071 (4 pages)
WP 0072 (2 pages)
WP 0073 (2 pages)
WP 0074 (2 pages)
WP 0075 (2 pages)
WP 0076 (4 pages)
WP 0077 (2 pages)
WP 0078 (8 pages)
WP 0079 (6 pages)
WP 0080 (26 pages)
WP 0081 (14 pages)
WP 0082 (14 pages)
WP 0083 (26 pages)
WP 0084 (16 pages)
WP 0085 (2 pages)
WP 0086 (24 pages)
WP 0087 (4 pages)
WP 0088 (8 pages)
WP 0089 (4 pages)
WP 0090 (2 pages)
WP 0091 (16 pages)
WP 0092 (18 pages)
WP 0093 (54 pages)
WP 0094 (2 pages)
WP 0095 (6 pages)
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
WP 0096 (2 pages)
WP 0097 (14 pages)
WP 0098 (4 pages)
WP 0099 (2 pages)
WP 0100 (4 pages)
WP 0101 (2 pages)
WP 0102 (6 pages)
WP 0103 (4 pages)
WP 0104 (2 pages)
WP 0105 (2 pages)
WP 0106 (6 pages)
WP 0107 (4 pages)
WP 0108 (8 pages)
WP 0109 (2 pages)
WP 0110 (12 pages)
WP 0111 (4 pages)
WP 0112 (8 pages)
Chp 3 - Troubleshooting
Procedures
WP 0113 (8 pages)
WP 0114 (6 pages)
WP 0115 (4 pages)
WP 0116 (6 pages)
WP 0117 (4 pages)
WP 0118 (4 pages)
WP 0119 (4 pages)
WP 0120 (4 pages)
WP 0121 (4 pages)
WP 0122 (4 pages)
WP 0123 (4 pages)
WP 0124 (2 pages)
WP 0125 (4 pages)
WP 0126 (6 pages)
WP 0127 (6 pages)
WP 0128 (2 pages)
WP 0129 (4 pages)
WP 0130 (6 pages)
WP 0131 (2 pages)
WP 0132 (2 pages)
WP 0133 (2 pages)
WP 0134 (4 pages)
WP 0135 (2 pages)
WP 0136 (4 pages)
WP 0137 (2 pages)
Change
No.
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
TM 9-2320-339-10
Page/WP No.
Chp 4 - Preventive Maintenance
Checks and Services (PMCS)
WP 0138 (4 pages)
WP 0139 (48 pages)
WP 0140 (14 pages)
WP 0141 (20 pages)
WP 0142 (34 pages)
WP 0143 (16 pages)
WP 0144 (20 pages)
Chp 5 - Maintenance
Instructions
WP 0145 (14 pages)
WP 0146 (4 pages)
WP 0147 (6 pages)
Change
No.
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Page/WP No.
Change
No.
WP 0148 (2 pages)
WP 0149 (18 pages)
WP 0150 (2 pages)
WP 0151 (6 pages)
WP 0152 (8 pages)
WP 0153 (6 pages)
WP 0154 (8 pages)
WP 0155 (4 pages)
WP 0156 (2 pages)
Chp 6 - Supporting Information
WP 0157 (8 pages)
WP 0158 (16 pages)
WP 0159 (6 pages)
WP 0160 (8 pages)
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
TM 9-2320-339-10
HEADQUARTERS
DEPARTMENT OF THE ARMY
WASHINGTON D.C., 15 OCTOBER 2008
TECHNICAL MANUAL
OPERATOR'S MANUAL
TRUCK, TANK, 8X8
M978A4, W/WINCH
NSN 2320-01-534-1103
M978A4, W/O WINCH, 8X8
NSN 2320-01-534-1117
TM 9-2320-339-10
TABLE OF CONTENTS
WP Sequence No.
Page No.
Warning Summary
How to Use this Manual
Chapter 1 - General Information, Equipment Description and Theory of
Operation
INTRODUCTION..........................................................................................
Table 1. Overview..............................................................
0001-1
Figure 1. .............................................................................
0001-1
0001-3
0001-4
0001-9
WARRANTY PROGRAM.............................................................................
Table 1. Vehicle Information..............................................
0002-3
0002-3
WP 0001
WP 0002
WP 0003
WP 0004
0004-1
Figure 1. .............................................................................
0004-1
Figure 2. .............................................................................
0004-2
0004-4
Figure 3. .............................................................................
0004-4
iii
WP 0005
TM 9-2320-339-10
WP Sequence No.
Page No.
Table 1. Differences Between HEMTT A4 Models..............
0005-1
Table 2. Notes.....................................................................
0005-2
EQUIPMENT DATA......................................................................................
Table 1. Vehicle Operation..................................................
0006-1
0006-1
0006-1
0006-2
0006-2
0006-2
0006-2
0006-3
Table 9. Engine...................................................................
0006-3
0006-4
0006-4
0006-5
0006-5
0006-5
0006-5
0006-6
0006-6
0006-6
0006-6
0006-6
0006-7
iv
WP 0006
TM 9-2320-339-10
WP Sequence No.
Page No.
Table 22. Pintle Hook..........................................................
0006-7
0006-7
0006-7
0006-8
0006-8
0006-8
0006-9
SELF-RECOVERY WINCH..........................................................................
Figure 1. .............................................................................
0007-1
ELECTRICAL SYSTEM................................................................................
Figure 1. .............................................................................
Figure 1. .............................................................................
0010-1
Figure 2. .............................................................................
0010-2
STEERING SYSTEM...................................................................................
WP 0010
WP 0011
0011-1
POWER TRAIN............................................................................................
Figure 1. .............................................................................
0012-1
Figure 2. .............................................................................
0012-3
Figure 3. .............................................................................
0012-5
Figure 4. .............................................................................
0012-6
Figure 5. .............................................................................
0012-6
WP 0009
0009-2
Figure 1. .............................................................................
WP 0008
0008-1
AIR SYSTEM................................................................................................
Figure 1. .............................................................................
WP 0007
WP 0012
TM 9-2320-339-10
WP Sequence No.
Page No.
Figure 6. .............................................................................
0012-7
ENGINE SYSTEMS......................................................................................
Figure 1. .............................................................................
0013-1
Figure 2. .............................................................................
0013-2
Figure 3. .............................................................................
0013-3
Figure 4. .............................................................................
0013-4
Figure 5. .............................................................................
0013-6
CAB..............................................................................................................
Figure 1. .............................................................................
WP 0015
0015-1
TANKER MODULE.......................................................................................
Figure 1. .............................................................................
WP 0014
0014-1
WP 0013
WP 0016
0016-1
0017-1
Figure 1. .............................................................................
0017-1
0018-2
Figure 1. .............................................................................
0018-2
0019-1
Figure 1. .............................................................................
0019-1
vi
WP 0017
WP 0018
WP 0019
WP 0020
TM 9-2320-339-10
WP Sequence No.
Page No.
Table 1. Instrument Panel Controls and Indicators.............
0020-1
Figure 1. .............................................................................
0020-1
Figure 2. .............................................................................
0020-2
Figure 3. .............................................................................
0020-3
Figure 4. .............................................................................
0020-4
Figure 5. .............................................................................
0020-6
Figure 6. .............................................................................
0020-9
0021-1
Figure 1. .............................................................................
0021-1
Figure 2. .............................................................................
0021-4
Figure 3. .............................................................................
0021-5
0022-1
Figure 1. .............................................................................
0022-1
0023-1
Figure 1. .............................................................................
0023-1
0024-2
Figure 1. .............................................................................
0024-2
vii
WP 0021
WP 0022
WP 0023
WP 0024
WP 0025
TM 9-2320-339-10
WP Sequence No.
Page No.
Table 1. Hydraulic Selector Valve Control..........................
0025-2
Figure 1. .............................................................................
0025-2
0026-2
Figure 1. .............................................................................
0026-2
0027-1
Figure 1. .............................................................................
0027-1
0028-2
Figure 1. .............................................................................
0028-2
0029-2
Figure 1. .............................................................................
0029-2
0030-1
Figure 1. .............................................................................
0030-1
0031-2
Figure 1. .............................................................................
0031-2
0032-2
Figure 1. .............................................................................
0032-2
viii
WP 0026
WP 0027
WP 0028
WP 0029
WP 0030
WP 0031
WP 0032
TM 9-2320-339-10
WP Sequence No.
Page No.
RIFLE STOWAGE MOUNT..........................................................................
Table 1. Rifle Stowage Mount.............................................
0033-2
Figure 1. .............................................................................
0033-2
0034-1
Figure 2. .............................................................................
0034-2
0035-2
Figure 2. .............................................................................
0035-4
Figure 3. .............................................................................
0035-5
0036-1
Figure 2. .............................................................................
0036-2
Figure 3. .............................................................................
0036-3
Figure 4. .............................................................................
0036-4
Figure 5. .............................................................................
0036-5
Figure 6. .............................................................................
0036-6
Figure 7. .............................................................................
0036-6
Figure 8. .............................................................................
0036-7
0037-1
Figure 2. .............................................................................
0037-2
Figure 3. .............................................................................
0037-3
ix
WP 0033
WP 0034
WP 0035
WP 0036
WP 0037
WP 0038
TM 9-2320-339-10
WP Sequence No.
Page No.
Figure 1. .............................................................................
0038-1
Figure 2. .............................................................................
0038-2
0039-2
Figure 2. .............................................................................
0039-3
Figure 3. .............................................................................
0039-4
Figure 4. .............................................................................
0039-5
Figure 5. .............................................................................
0039-6
0040-2
Figure 2. .............................................................................
0040-3
Figure 3. .............................................................................
0040-3
Figure 4. .............................................................................
0040-4
Figure 5. .............................................................................
0040-5
Figure 6. .............................................................................
0040-6
Figure 7. .............................................................................
0040-8
Figure 8. .............................................................................
0040-9
WP 0039
WP 0040
TM 9-2320-339-10
WP Sequence No.
Page No.
Figure 16. ........................................................................... 0040-17
OPERATE INSTRUMENT PANEL...............................................................
Figure 1. .............................................................................
0041-1
Figure 2. .............................................................................
0041-2
Figure 3. .............................................................................
0041-3
Figure 4. .............................................................................
0041-4
Figure 5. .............................................................................
0041-4
Figure 6. .............................................................................
0041-5
Figure 7. .............................................................................
0041-5
Figure 8. .............................................................................
0041-6
Figure 9. .............................................................................
0041-6
0041-7
0041-7
0041-8
0041-8
0041-9
0041-9
WP 0041
0042-2
Figure 2. .............................................................................
0042-4
START ENGINE...........................................................................................
Figure 1. .............................................................................
0043-2
Figure 2. .............................................................................
0043-3
xi
WP 0042
WP 0043
TM 9-2320-339-10
WP Sequence No.
Page No.
Figure 3. .............................................................................
0043-4
Figure 4. .............................................................................
0043-6
Figure 5. .............................................................................
0043-7
0044-1
Figure 1. .............................................................................
0047-2
Figure 2. .............................................................................
0047-3
Figure 1. .............................................................................
0051-2
Figure 2. .............................................................................
0051-3
Figure 3. .............................................................................
0051-4
xii
WP 0049
WP 0050
0050-2
Figure 1. .............................................................................
WP 0048
0049-2
WP 0047
0048-2
WP 0046
0046-2
Figure 1. .............................................................................
WP 0045
0045-2
WP 0044
0052-1
WP 0051
WP 0052
TM 9-2320-339-10
WP Sequence No.
Page No.
DRIVE VEHICLE UP/DOWN STEEP GRADE.............................................
Figure 1. .............................................................................
0053-1
Figure 2. .............................................................................
0053-2
WP 0056
0056-1
0057-2
Figure 2. .............................................................................
0057-3
0058-1
Figure 2. .............................................................................
0058-2
Figure 3. .............................................................................
0058-3
Figure 4. .............................................................................
0058-4
Figure 5. .............................................................................
0058-4
Figure 6. .............................................................................
0058-5
Figure 7. .............................................................................
0058-6
0059-1
Figure 2. .............................................................................
0059-2
Figure 3. .............................................................................
0059-3
xiii
WP 0055
0055-1
WP 0054
0054-2
PARK VEHICLE...........................................................................................
Figure 1. .............................................................................
WP 0053
WP 0057
WP 0058
WP 0059
TM 9-2320-339-10
WP Sequence No.
Page No.
OPERATE DOME LIGHT.............................................................................
Figure 1. .............................................................................
0060-2
Figure 1. .............................................................................
0063-2
Figure 2. .............................................................................
0063-2
Figure 3. .............................................................................
0063-3
Figure 4. .............................................................................
0063-4
OPERATE STOPLIGHTS.............................................................................
WP 0065
WP 0066
0066-2
WP 0064
0065-2
WP 0063
0064-1
WP 0062
0062-2
Figure 1. .............................................................................
WP 0061
0061-1
WP 0060
WP 0067
0067-2
WP 0068
WP 0069
Figure 1. .............................................................................
0069-1
Figure 2. .............................................................................
0069-2
Figure 3. .............................................................................
0069-2
xiv
TM 9-2320-339-10
WP Sequence No.
Page No.
PORTABLE BEACON LIGHT OPERATION................................................
Figure 1. .............................................................................
0070-1
Figure 2. .............................................................................
0070-2
Figure 3. .............................................................................
0070-2
Figure 4. .............................................................................
0070-3
Figure 5. .............................................................................
0070-4
Figure 1. .............................................................................
0073-1
Figure 2. .............................................................................
0073-2
WP 0076
WP 0077
0077-1
0078-2
Figure 2. .............................................................................
0078-3
xv
WP 0075
0076-2
WP 0074
0075-2
WP 0073
0074-1
WP 0072
0072-2
Figure 1. .............................................................................
WP 0071
0071-2
WP 0070
WP 0078
TM 9-2320-339-10
WP Sequence No.
Page No.
Figure 3. .............................................................................
0078-4
Figure 4. .............................................................................
0078-5
Figure 5. .............................................................................
0078-6
Figure 6. .............................................................................
0078-7
0079-2
Figure 2. .............................................................................
0079-3
Figure 3. .............................................................................
0079-4
Figure 4. .............................................................................
0079-5
0080-2
Figure 2. .............................................................................
0080-3
Figure 3. .............................................................................
0080-4
Figure 4. .............................................................................
0080-4
Figure 5. .............................................................................
0080-5
Figure 6. .............................................................................
0080-6
Figure 7. .............................................................................
0080-7
Figure 8. .............................................................................
0080-8
Figure 9. .............................................................................
0080-9
0080-9
xvi
WP 0079
WP 0080
TM 9-2320-339-10
WP Sequence No.
Page No.
Figure 15. ........................................................................... 0080-14
Figure 16. ........................................................................... 0080-15
Figure 17. ........................................................................... 0080-16
Figure 18. ........................................................................... 0080-17
Figure 19. ........................................................................... 0080-18
Figure 20. ........................................................................... 0080-19
Figure 21. ........................................................................... 0080-20
Figure 22. ........................................................................... 0080-22
Figure 23. ........................................................................... 0080-23
Figure 24. ........................................................................... 0080-24
Figure 25. ........................................................................... 0080-25
SERVICE LAND VEHICLE OR AIRCRAFT (OVER-WING) WITH FUEL....
Figure 1. .............................................................................
0081-2
Figure 2. .............................................................................
0081-3
Figure 3. .............................................................................
0081-3
Figure 4. .............................................................................
0081-4
Figure 5. .............................................................................
0081-5
Figure 6. .............................................................................
0081-6
0081-7
Figure 7. .............................................................................
0081-8
Figure 8. .............................................................................
0081-9
xvii
WP 0081
TM 9-2320-339-10
WP Sequence No.
Page No.
Figure 12. ........................................................................... 0081-13
RE-CIRCULATE FUEL.................................................................................
Figure 1. .............................................................................
0082-2
Figure 2. .............................................................................
0082-3
Figure 3. .............................................................................
0082-3
Figure 4. .............................................................................
0082-4
Figure 5. .............................................................................
0082-5
Figure 6. .............................................................................
0082-6
Figure 7. .............................................................................
0082-7
Figure 8. .............................................................................
0082-8
WP 0082
0083-2
Figure 2. .............................................................................
0083-3
Figure 3. .............................................................................
0083-3
Figure 4. .............................................................................
0083-4
Figure 5. .............................................................................
0083-5
Figure 6. .............................................................................
0083-6
Figure 7. .............................................................................
0083-7
Figure 8. .............................................................................
0083-8
Figure 9. .............................................................................
0083-9
xviii
WP 0083
TM 9-2320-339-10
WP Sequence No.
Page No.
Figure 10. ........................................................................... 0083-10
Figure 11. ........................................................................... 0083-11
Figure 12. ........................................................................... 0083-12
Figure 13. ........................................................................... 0083-13
Figure 14. ........................................................................... 0083-13
Figure 15. ........................................................................... 0083-14
Figure 16. ........................................................................... 0083-15
Figure 17. ........................................................................... 0083-16
Figure 18. ........................................................................... 0083-17
Figure 19. ........................................................................... 0083-18
Figure 20. ........................................................................... 0083-19
Figure 21. ........................................................................... 0083-20
Figure 22. ........................................................................... 0083-21
Figure 23. ........................................................................... 0083-22
Figure 24. ........................................................................... 0083-23
Figure 25. ........................................................................... 0083-24
Figure 26. ........................................................................... 0083-25
CHANGING TO DIFFERENT FUEL OR FUEL GRADE..............................
Figure 1. .............................................................................
0084-2
Figure 2. .............................................................................
0084-3
Figure 3. .............................................................................
0084-3
Figure 4. .............................................................................
0084-4
Figure 5. .............................................................................
0084-6
Figure 6. .............................................................................
0084-7
xix
WP 0084
TM 9-2320-339-10
WP Sequence No.
Page No.
Figure 7. .............................................................................
0084-8
Figure 8. .............................................................................
0084-9
WP 0085
WP 0086
Figure 1. .............................................................................
0086-2
Figure 2. .............................................................................
0086-3
Figure 3. .............................................................................
0086-4
Figure 4. .............................................................................
0086-5
Figure 5. .............................................................................
0086-5
Figure 6. .............................................................................
0086-6
Figure 7. .............................................................................
0086-6
Figure 8. .............................................................................
0086-7
Figure 9. .............................................................................
0086-7
0086-8
0086-8
0086-9
xx
TM 9-2320-339-10
WP Sequence No.
Page No.
Figure 14. ........................................................................... 0086-11
Figure 15. ........................................................................... 0086-12
Figure 16. ........................................................................... 0086-13
Figure 17. ........................................................................... 0086-14
Figure 18. ........................................................................... 0086-14
Figure 19. ........................................................................... 0086-15
Figure 20. ........................................................................... 0086-16
Figure 21. ........................................................................... 0086-16
Figure 22. ........................................................................... 0086-17
Figure 23. ........................................................................... 0086-17
Figure 24. ........................................................................... 0086-18
Figure 25. ........................................................................... 0086-19
Figure 26. ........................................................................... 0086-19
Figure 27. ........................................................................... 0086-20
Figure 28. ........................................................................... 0086-21
Figure 29. ........................................................................... 0086-21
Figure 30. ........................................................................... 0086-22
Figure 31. ........................................................................... 0086-23
Figure 32. ........................................................................... 0086-24
PERFORM IMMEDIATE ACTION FOR LOSS OF AIR SUPPLY
SYSTEM PRESSURE..................................................................................
Figure 1. .............................................................................
0087-1
xxi
WP 0087
0088-2
WP 0088
TM 9-2320-339-10
WP Sequence No.
Page No.
Figure 2. .............................................................................
0088-2
Figure 3. .............................................................................
0088-3
Figure 4. .............................................................................
0088-4
Figure 5. .............................................................................
0088-5
Figure 6. .............................................................................
0088-5
Figure 7. .............................................................................
0088-6
Figure 8. .............................................................................
0088-6
WP 0089
0089-2
WP 0090
WP 0091
Figure 1. .............................................................................
0091-2
Figure 2. .............................................................................
0091-3
Figure 3. .............................................................................
0091-3
Figure 4. .............................................................................
0091-4
Figure 5. .............................................................................
0091-5
Figure 6. .............................................................................
0091-6
Figure 7. .............................................................................
0091-7
Figure 8. .............................................................................
0091-8
Figure 9. .............................................................................
0091-9
xxii
TM 9-2320-339-10
WP Sequence No.
Page No.
Figure 13. ........................................................................... 0091-13
Figure 14. ........................................................................... 0091-14
Figure 15. ........................................................................... 0091-15
Figure 16. ........................................................................... 0091-16
OPERATE TIRE CARRIER USING OUTSIDE AIR SOURCE.....................
Figure 1. .............................................................................
0092-2
Figure 2. .............................................................................
0092-3
Figure 3. .............................................................................
0092-3
Figure 4. .............................................................................
0092-4
Figure 5. .............................................................................
0092-5
Figure 6. .............................................................................
0092-7
Figure 7. .............................................................................
0092-8
Figure 8. .............................................................................
0092-9
WP 0092
0093-1
Figure 2. .............................................................................
0093-2
xxiii
WP 0093
TM 9-2320-339-10
WP Sequence No.
Page No.
Figure 3. .............................................................................
0093-2
Figure 4. .............................................................................
0093-3
Figure 5. .............................................................................
0093-4
Figure 6. .............................................................................
0093-5
Figure 7. .............................................................................
0093-5
Figure 8. .............................................................................
0093-6
Figure 9. .............................................................................
0093-7
0093-8
0093-9
xxiv
TM 9-2320-339-10
WP Sequence No.
Page No.
Figure 26. ........................................................................... 0093-28
Figure 27. ........................................................................... 0093-29
Figure 28. ........................................................................... 0093-29
Figure 29. ........................................................................... 0093-30
Figure 30. ........................................................................... 0093-30
Figure 31. ........................................................................... 0093-31
Figure 32. ........................................................................... 0093-32
Figure 33. ........................................................................... 0093-33
Figure 34. ........................................................................... 0093-33
Figure 35. ........................................................................... 0093-34
Figure 36. ........................................................................... 0093-36
Figure 37. ........................................................................... 0093-37
Figure 38. ........................................................................... 0093-38
Figure 39. ........................................................................... 0093-39
Table 2. Self-Recovery Winch Pull Capacity....................... 0093-40
Figure 40. ........................................................................... 0093-41
Figure 41. ........................................................................... 0093-42
Figure 42. ........................................................................... 0093-45
Figure 43. ........................................................................... 0093-46
Figure 44. ........................................................................... 0093-47
Figure 45. ........................................................................... 0093-48
Figure 46. ........................................................................... 0093-49
Figure 47. ........................................................................... 0093-51
Figure 48. ........................................................................... 0093-52
xxv
TM 9-2320-339-10
WP Sequence No.
Page No.
Figure 49. ........................................................................... 0093-52
Figure 50. ........................................................................... 0093-53
SNATCH BLOCK INSTALLATION/REMOVAL............................................
Figure 1. .............................................................................
0094-1
Figure 2. .............................................................................
0094-2
0095-1
Figure 2. .............................................................................
0095-2
Figure 3. .............................................................................
0095-3
Figure 4. .............................................................................
0095-4
Figure 5. .............................................................................
0095-5
Figure 6. .............................................................................
0095-6
WP 0095
WP 0096
0096-2
0097-2
Figure 2. .............................................................................
0097-3
Figure 3. .............................................................................
0097-3
Figure 4. .............................................................................
0097-5
Figure 5. .............................................................................
0097-6
Figure 6. .............................................................................
0097-7
Figure 7. .............................................................................
0097-8
Figure 8. .............................................................................
0097-9
xxvi
WP 0094
WP 0097
TM 9-2320-339-10
WP Sequence No.
Page No.
Figure 9. ............................................................................. 0097-10
Figure 10. ........................................................................... 0097-10
Figure 11. ........................................................................... 0097-11
Figure 12. ........................................................................... 0097-12
Figure 13. ........................................................................... 0097-13
Figure 14. ........................................................................... 0097-13
OPERATE VEHICLE IN EXTREME HEAT..................................................
Figure 1. .............................................................................
0098-2
0099-1
Figure 2. .............................................................................
0099-2
WP 0098
WP 0099
WP 0100
0100-2
WP 0101
WP 0102
Figure 1. .............................................................................
0102-2
WP 0103
0103-3
WP 0104
WP 0105
WP 0106
Figure 1. .............................................................................
0106-1
Figure 2. .............................................................................
0106-2
xxvii
TM 9-2320-339-10
WP Sequence No.
Page No.
Figure 3. .............................................................................
0106-2
Figure 4. .............................................................................
0106-2
Figure 5. .............................................................................
0106-3
Figure 6. .............................................................................
0106-3
Figure 7. .............................................................................
0106-4
Figure 8. .............................................................................
0106-4
Figure 9. .............................................................................
0106-5
0106-5
0106-6
0107-1
Figure 2. .............................................................................
0107-2
Figure 3. .............................................................................
0107-3
Figure 4. .............................................................................
0107-4
Figure 5. .............................................................................
0107-4
0108-2
Figure 2. .............................................................................
0108-2
Figure 3. .............................................................................
0108-3
Figure 4. .............................................................................
0108-4
Figure 5. .............................................................................
0108-4
Figure 6. .............................................................................
0108-5
Figure 7. .............................................................................
0108-7
Figure 8. .............................................................................
0108-7
xxviii
WP 0107
WP 0108
TM 9-2320-339-10
WP Sequence No.
Page No.
Figure 9. .............................................................................
0108-8
WP 0109
WP 0110
Figure 1. .............................................................................
0110-2
Figure 2. .............................................................................
0110-3
Figure 3. .............................................................................
0110-4
Figure 4. .............................................................................
0110-5
Figure 5. .............................................................................
0110-6
Figure 6. .............................................................................
0110-7
Figure 7. .............................................................................
0110-8
Figure 8. .............................................................................
0110-9
0111-2
0112-1
0112-2
0112-3
0112-4
0112-5
0112-6
0112-7
xxix
WP 0111
WP 0112
TM 9-2320-339-10
WP Sequence No.
Page No.
Chapter 3 - Troubleshooting Procedures
BUZZER SOUNDS AND AIR INDICATOR IS LIT........................................
Figure 1. .............................................................................
0113-2
Figure 2. .............................................................................
0113-3
Figure 3. .............................................................................
0113-4
Figure 4. .............................................................................
0113-5
Figure 5. .............................................................................
0113-6
Figure 6. .............................................................................
0113-7
0114-2
Figure 2. .............................................................................
0114-3
Figure 3. .............................................................................
0114-4
Figure 4. .............................................................................
0114-5
0115-2
Figure 2. .............................................................................
0115-3
0116-1
Figure 2. .............................................................................
0116-2
Figure 3. .............................................................................
0116-3
Figure 4. .............................................................................
0116-4
Figure 5. .............................................................................
0116-4
Figure 6. .............................................................................
0116-5
xxx
WP 0113
WP 0114
WP 0115
WP 0116
TM 9-2320-339-10
WP Sequence No.
Page No.
AIR HORN WILL NOT OPERATE................................................................
Figure 1. .............................................................................
0117-2
Figure 2. .............................................................................
0117-3
Figure 3. .............................................................................
0117-4
0118-2
Figure 2. .............................................................................
0118-4
0119-2
Figure 2. .............................................................................
0119-3
0120-1
Figure 2. .............................................................................
0120-2
0121-1
Figure 2. .............................................................................
0121-2
Figure 3. .............................................................................
0121-3
0122-2
Figure 2. .............................................................................
0122-3
Figure 3. .............................................................................
0122-4
ENGINE OVERHEATS.................................................................................
xxxi
WP 0117
WP 0118
WP 0119
WP 0120
WP 0121
WP 0122
WP 0123
TM 9-2320-339-10
WP Sequence No.
Page No.
Figure 1. .............................................................................
0123-2
Figure 2. .............................................................................
0123-3
0124-1
WP 0125
0125-2
0126-2
Figure 2. .............................................................................
0126-4
0127-2
Figure 2. .............................................................................
0127-3
Figure 3. .............................................................................
0127-4
0128-1
Figure 2. .............................................................................
0128-2
0129-2
Figure 2. .............................................................................
0129-3
0130-2
Figure 2. .............................................................................
0130-4
xxxii
WP 0124
WP 0126
WP 0127
WP 0128
WP 0129
WP 0130
TM 9-2320-339-10
WP Sequence No.
Page No.
WATER IS DISPENSED WITH FUEL..........................................................
Figure 1. .............................................................................
0131-1
WP 0133
0133-1
0134-1
Figure 2. .............................................................................
0134-2
Figure 3. .............................................................................
0134-3
Figure 4. .............................................................................
0134-4
0135-1
Figure 2. .............................................................................
0135-2
WHEEL WOBBLES......................................................................................
Figure 1. .............................................................................
0136-2
Figure 2. .............................................................................
0136-3
WP 0132
0132-1
WP 0131
WP 0134
WP 0135
WP 0136
WP 0137
0137-2
0138-3
xxxiii
WP 0138
WP 0139
TM 9-2320-339-10
WP Sequence No.
Page No.
Table 1. PMCS - BEFORE..................................................
0139-1
Figure 1. .............................................................................
0139-4
Figure 2. .............................................................................
0139-6
Figure 3. .............................................................................
0139-7
xxxiv
TM 9-2320-339-10
WP Sequence No.
Page No.
Figure 24. ........................................................................... 0139-46
DURING - PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE..................................................
Table 1. PMCS - DURING..................................................
0140-1
Figure 1. .............................................................................
0140-2
Figure 2. .............................................................................
0140-4
Figure 3. .............................................................................
0140-5
Figure 4. .............................................................................
0140-6
Figure 5. .............................................................................
0140-8
Figure 6. .............................................................................
0140-9
WP 0140
0141-1
Figure 1. .............................................................................
0141-5
Figure 2. .............................................................................
0141-8
Figure 3. .............................................................................
0141-9
xxxv
WP 0141
TM 9-2320-339-10
WP Sequence No.
Page No.
Figure 10. ........................................................................... 0141-17
Figure 11. ........................................................................... 0141-18
WEEKLY - PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE.................................................
Table 1. PMCS - WEEKLY..................................................
0142-1
Figure 1. .............................................................................
0142-4
Figure 2. .............................................................................
0142-6
Figure 3. .............................................................................
0142-7
Figure 4. .............................................................................
0142-8
Figure 5. .............................................................................
0142-9
xxxvi
WP 0142
TM 9-2320-339-10
WP Sequence No.
Page No.
SEMIANNUAL - PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE.........................................
Table 1. PMCS- SEMIANNUAL..........................................
0143-1
Figure 1. .............................................................................
0143-3
Figure 2. .............................................................................
0143-6
Figure 3. .............................................................................
0143-8
Figure 4. .............................................................................
0143-9
WP 0143
0144-1
Figure 1. .............................................................................
0144-4
Figure 2. .............................................................................
0144-5
Figure 3. .............................................................................
0144-6
Figure 4. .............................................................................
0144-7
Figure 5. .............................................................................
0144-8
Figure 6. .............................................................................
0144-9
xxxvii
WP 0144
TM 9-2320-339-10
WP Sequence No.
Page No.
Figure 10. ........................................................................... 0144-13
Figure 11. ........................................................................... 0144-15
Figure 12. ........................................................................... 0144-17
Figure 13. ........................................................................... 0144-18
Chapter 5 - Maintenance Instructions
LUBRICATION INSTRUCTIONS.................................................................
Table 1. Engine Lubrication................................................
0145-2
0145-3
0145-4
0145-7
0145-7
0145-9
WP 0145
0146-1
Figure 2. .............................................................................
0146-2
Figure 3. .............................................................................
0146-3
Figure 4. .............................................................................
0146-3
0147-2
Figure 2. .............................................................................
0147-3
xxxviii
WP 0146
WP 0147
TM 9-2320-339-10
WP Sequence No.
Page No.
Figure 3. .............................................................................
0147-4
Figure 4. .............................................................................
0147-5
CLEAN VEHICLE.........................................................................................
Figure 1. .............................................................................
0148-1
Figure 2. .............................................................................
0148-2
0149-2
Figure 2. .............................................................................
0149-3
Figure 3. .............................................................................
0149-4
Figure 4. .............................................................................
0149-5
Figure 5. .............................................................................
0149-6
Figure 6. .............................................................................
0149-6
Figure 7. .............................................................................
0149-7
Figure 8. .............................................................................
0149-8
Figure 9. .............................................................................
0149-9
xxxix
WP 0148
WP 0149
TM 9-2320-339-10
WP Sequence No.
Page No.
CLEAN FUEL TANK STRAINER..................................................................
Figure 1. .............................................................................
0150-1
Figure 2. .............................................................................
0150-2
0151-1
Figure 2. .............................................................................
0151-2
Figure 3. .............................................................................
0151-3
Figure 4. .............................................................................
0151-4
Figure 5. .............................................................................
0151-4
Figure 6. .............................................................................
0151-5
SERVICE TIRES..........................................................................................
Figure 1. .............................................................................
0152-3
Figure 2. .............................................................................
0152-4
Figure 3. .............................................................................
0152-5
Figure 4. .............................................................................
0152-6
Figure 5. .............................................................................
0152-7
0153-3
Figure 2. .............................................................................
0153-5
0154-1
Figure 2. .............................................................................
0154-2
Figure 3. .............................................................................
0154-3
xl
WP 0150
WP 0151
WP 0152
WP 0153
WP 0154
TM 9-2320-339-10
WP Sequence No.
Page No.
Figure 4. .............................................................................
0154-4
Figure 5. .............................................................................
0154-5
Figure 6. .............................................................................
0154-5
Figure 7. .............................................................................
0154-6
Figure 8. .............................................................................
0154-7
WP 0155
0155-2
0156-1
Figure 2. .............................................................................
0156-2
WP 0156
WP 0157
WP 0158
0158-2
0158-2
0158-3
0159-1
0159-2
xli
0160-1
WP 0159
WP 0160
TM 9-2320-339-10
Chapter 3 of this manual provides operator troubleshooting procedures for both the
HEMTT series vehicle, and its accompanying operating systems.
xliii
TM 9-2320-339-10
CHAPTER 1
GENERAL
INFORMATION,
EQUIPMENT
DESCRIPTION AND
THEORY OF
OPERATION
TM 9-2320-339-10
0001
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
INTRODUCTION
SCOPE
This manual is used for operation and operator-performed maintenance of HEMTT series
vehicles which consist of a number of different models all built on similar chassis, but
specially equipped to perform different missions.
Table 1. Overview.
M978A4 TANKER
FLAMMABLE
NO SMOKING WITHIN 50 FEET
DESCRIPTION
Tanker vehicle with 66,000 lbs (29 964 kg) GVWR and
109,000 lbs (49 486 kg) GCWR. Tanker module has a 2500
gal (9 463 L) capacity and two fuel resupply stations.
FLAMMABLE
NO SMOKING WITHIN 50 FEET
Figure 1.
0001-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
0001
Publications), and advance information on proposed changes that may affect this manual.
Refer to the TB 43-0001-62 (series) Equipment Improvement Report and Maintenance
Digest (WP 0157) periodically for the most current and authoritative information on the
equipment. The information will help to do a better job and will advise of the latest changes
to this manual. Also refer to DA PAM 25-30, (WP 0157) Consolidated Index of Army
Publications and Blank Forms at http://www.army.mil/usapa/2530.html, and reference
section (WP 0157) of this manual. If you have a change recommendation to this manual,
submit a DA Form 2028's (WP 0157) (Recommended Changes to Publications) via e-mail
to: [email protected].
You can help improve this publication. If you find any mistakes or if you know of a way to
improve the procedures, please let us know. Submit your DA Form 2028 (WP 0157)
(Recommended Changes to Equipment Technical Publications) through the Internet, on
the Army Electronic Product Support (AEPS) website. The Internet address is https://
aeps.ria.army.mil. The DA Form 2028 (WP 0157) is located under the Public Applications
section in the AEPS Public Home Page. Fill out the form and click on SUBMIT. Using this
form on the AEPS will enable us to respond quicker to your comments and better manage
the DA Form 2028 program. You may also mail, fax or e-mail your letter or DA Form 2028
(WP 0157) direct to: TACOM Life Cycle Management Command, ATTN: AMSTA-LCLMPP / TECH PUBS, TACOMRI, 1 Rock Island Arsenal, Rock Island, IL 61299-7630. The
e-mail address is [email protected]. The fax number is DSN
793-0726 or Commercial (309) 782-0726.
HAND RECEIPT (HR) INFORMATION
The is a companion document to this manual which consists of preprinted hand receipts
(DA Form 2062) (WP 0157) that list end item related equipment (COEI, BII, (WP 0158) and
AAL (WP 0159)) which must be accounted for. As an aid to property accountability,
additional Hand Receipt (-HR) Manuals may be requisitioned from the following source in
accordance with procedures in DA PAM 25-30, (WP 0157) Consolidated Index of Army
Publications and Blank Forms; Commander US Army Distribution Operation Facility, 1655
Woodson Road, St Louis, MO 63114-6181.
CORROSION PREVENTION AND CONTROL
Corrosion prevention and control (CPC) of Army material is a continuing concern. It is
important that any corrosion problems be reported so they can be corrected and
improvements can be made to prevent problems in the future. While corrosion is typically
associated with the rusting of metals, it can also include deterioration of other materials,
such as rubber and plastic. Unusual cracking, softening, swelling, or breaking of these
materials may be a corrosion problem.
If a corrosion problem is identified, it can be reported using SF 368 (WP 0157). The use of
key words, such as corrosion, rust, deterioration, and cracking will ensure that the
information is identified as a CPC problem.
0001-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
0001
OFFICIAL NOMENCLATURE
Brake Pedal
Cable/Hoist Cable
Wire Rope
Junction Box
Engine Coolant
Glad Hand
Manual Controls
O-Ring
Preformed Packing
Snap Ring
Retaining Ring
0001-3
TM 9-2320-339-10
LIST OF ABBREVIATIONS
Table 3. Common Abbreviations.
ABBREVIATION
OFFICIAL NOMENCLATURE
AAL
AMDF
amp
Ampere
BAP
bar
Barometric Pressure
BII
BL
Bottom Load
BOI
Basis of Issue
Celsius
CAGEC
CARC
CBR
CBT
CCA
CHU
CID
CKT
Circuit
cm
Centimeter
COEI
CPC
0001-4
0001
TM 9-2320-339-10
OFFICIAL NOMENCLATURE
CROP
CTA
DA
dia.
Diameter
DS
Direct Support
EIR
Fahrenheit
FHTV
FLA
fl. oz.
Fluid Ounce
FR
Flatrack
FRS
ft.
Foot
GAA
gal
Gallon
GCWR
GMT
GPFU
gpm
GS
General Support
GVWR
0001-5
0001
TM 9-2320-339-10
OFFICIAL NOMENCLATURE
HDI
Hexamethylene Diisocyanate
HEMTT
hp
Horsepower
HVAC
IBC
I.D.
Inside Diameter
in.
Inch
ISO
JTA
kg
Kilogram
km
Kilometer
Kmh or km/h
kPa
Kilopascals
kw
Kilowatt
Liter
lbs
Pound
lb-ft
Pound-Foot
lb-in
Pound-Inch
LCD
LED
LH
Left-Hand
0001-6
0001
TM 9-2320-339-10
OFFICIAL NOMENCLATURE
LHS
Meter
MAC
mi
Mile
ml
Milliliter
MLC
mm
Millimeter
Mph
MTOE
NBC
NIIN
Nm
Newton Meter
NOC
NSN
O.D.
Outside Diameter
OEA
OE/HDO
O/R
Outrigger
OTC
Oz
Ounce
PLS
0001-7
0001
TM 9-2320-339-10
OFFICIAL NOMENCLATURE
PMCS
psi
pt.
Pint
PTO
Power Take-Off
qt.
Quart
Qty. Recm.
Quantity Recommended
Qty. Rqr.
Quantity Required
RCU
RFI
Radio-Frequency Interference
RH
Right-Hand
rpm
RPSTL
SAE
SMR
SRA
SRW
Self-Recovery Winch
TAMMS
TDA
TM
Technical Manual
TMDE
TOE
0001-8
0001
TM 9-2320-339-10
OFFICIAL NOMENCLATURE
u/m
Unit of Measure
UOC
Usable-On Code
Vdc
XHD
Extra Heavy-Duty
HAZARD
SAFETY
RECOMMENDATIO OPERATING CONDITION
N OR PRECAUTION
Do not go between
Normal
vehicles until vehicles are stopped and
brakes are set.
0001-9
0001
TM 9-2320-339-10
0001
HAZARD
Refueling vehicle.
SAFETY
RECOMMENDATIO OPERATING CONDITION
N OR PRECAUTION
Shut off engine and
Normal
no smoking when filling tank.
NOTE
Category of hazards as to whether or not they may be expected under
normal or abnormal operating conditions.
METRIC SYSTEM
The equipment described herein contains metric components and requires metric, common,
and special tools. Therefore, metric units and English units will be used throughout this
publication. An English-to-metric conversion table is included as the last page of this manual
inside the back cover.
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0001-10
TM 9-2320-339-10
0002
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
WARRANTY PROGRAM
GENERAL
This work package provides implementation instructions for the warranty on the HEMTT. It
contains instructions for obtaining services and/or supplies covered under warranty. This
work package also describes methods of processing warranty claims. For additional
warranty information on the HEMTT or any U.S. Army Tank-Automotive and Armaments
Command (TACOM) equipment, contact your local Warranty Control Office/Officer
(WARCO) or TACOM Logistics Assistance Representative (LAR). If your WARCO or
TACOM LAR is not available or if additional information is required, contact TACOM.
EXPLANATION OF TERMS
Abuse
The improper use, maintenance, repair or handling of warranted items that may cause the
warranty of those items to become void (for example, not following service intervals, using
the vehicle for other than what is intended).
Acceptance
The execution of the acceptance block and signing of DD Form 250 (WP 0157), by the
authorized Government representative, unless end items are placed in storage in which
case acceptance shall mean date of shipment from storage facility as reflected on DD Form
1149 (WP 0157) or DD Form 1348-1. (WP 0157)
Acceptance Date
The date an item of equipment is accepted into the Army's inventory by the execution of
the acceptance block and signing of a DD Form 250 (WP 0157) or approved acceptance
document, by an authorized representative of the Government.
Contractor
The supplier of equipment who enters into an agreement directly with the Government to
furnish supplies.
Correction
The elimination of a defect.
0002-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
0002
Defect
Any condition or characteristic in any supplies furnished by the contractor that does not
otherwise function or threatens not to function as intended.
Failure
A part, component, or end item that fails to perform its intended use.
Manufacturer's Recall
Safety Recall An item is recalled to repair or replace a defective part or assembly which
may affect safety.
Service Recall An item is recalled to repair or replace a defective part(s) or assembly which
does not affect the safe use of this item.
Owning Unit
The Army Unit authorized to operate, maintain, and use the equipment.
Reimbursement
A written provision in this warranty in which the Using/Support Unit may make the necessary
repairs, with or without prior approval from the contractor, and the Government will be
reimbursed for the repair parts and labor costs.
Repair
A maintenance action required to restore an item to serviceable condition without affecting
the warranty.
Supplies
The end item and all assemblies/parts furnished by the contractor.
Supporting Repair Facility
The repair activity authorized to accomplish warrantable repairs at the appropriate level of
maintenance identified in the Maintenance Allocation Chart.
WARCO
Serves as the intermediary between the troops owning the equipment and the local dealer,
contractor or manufacturer. All warranty claim actions will be processed through the
WARCO.
0002-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
0002
Warranty
A written agreement between a contractor and the Government which outlines the rights
and obligations of both parties for defective supplies.
Warranty Claim
Action started by the equipment user for authorized warranty repair reimbursement.
Warranty Expiration Date
The date the warranty is no longer valid. This date will be 13 months from the contractor
shipment date. This warranty period covers the basic 12 months plus on additional month
for shipping time.
Warranty Period
Time during which the warranty is in effect; normally measured as the maximum number of
years, months, days, miles, or hours used.
Warranty Start Date
The day shipment is put into effect (Contractor Shipment Date).
COVERAGE-SPECIFIC
This work package applies to:
Table 1. Vehicle Information
Model
Noun
Truck, Cargo
NSN
M985A4
(with winch)
2320-01-543-1860
Cage
45152
NOTE
The item is manufactured by Oshkosh Truck Corporation (OTC), under
contract #W56HZV-07-C-0248. Inquiries to OTC can be made by calling
(920) 235-9151.
Model
Truck, Cargo
NSN
M985A4
0002-3
2320-01-543-1877
Cage
45152
TM 9-2320-339-10
0002
Model
NSN
Cage
(without winch)
NOTE
The item is manufactured by Oshkosh Truck Corporation (OTC), under
contract #W56HZV-07-C-0248. Inquiries to OTC can be made by calling
(920) 235-9151.
The contractor warrants the supplies are free from defects in design, material, and
workmanship for a period of thirteen (13) months from warranty start date.
If a Safety recall defect occurs during the vehicle warranty period, the contractor agrees to
extend the terms of the warranty to the time required to make necessary safety defect
corrections. Also, if the contractor or his supplier(s) provide a greater warranty for the
supplies furnished, the contractor will provide the greater warranty to the Government.
If a defect/failure is caused by or falls within any of the following categories, it is not
considered warrantable and a claim should not be initiated:
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
Misuse or negligence
Accidents
Improper operation
Improper storage
Improper transport
Improper or insufficient maintenance
Improper alterations or repairs
Defect/failure discovered or occurring after warranty expiration date.
Fair wear and tear items (brake shoes, pads, armatures, brushes, etc.).
In addition to the 13 month warranty, the vehicles will be warranted for a total service life of
10 years including extended periods in a corrosion hazard military environment. During this
10 year service life, there will be no damage caused by corrosion requiring repair or
replacement of parts. No actions beyond normal washing or replacement of accidentdamaged paint shall be necessary to maintain the corrosive protection in place.
This 13 month warranty is extended up to nine (9) months from date of acceptance if the
vehicle is put into government storage before use. In this case, the warranty starts when
the vehicle is either taken out of storage or until nine (9) months from the warranty start date
shown on the warranty data plate, whichever occurs first. Refer to preparation for storage.
0002-4
TM 9-2320-339-10
0002
CONTRACTOR RESPONSIBILITIES
When the owning unit has directed the contractor to correct the supplies, the contractor will
furnish all material required to correct the defective supplies. Repairs and parts shall be
initiated/provided within ten (10) working days after receipt of written claim notification.
Furthermore, the contractor will provide a copy of the work order to owning unit upon
completion of repair.
When the contractor receives written notification requiring contractor repair, they will have
the option:
1. Correct the supplies in the field.
2. Return the vehicle or parts to the contractor's designated facility for correction.
When the contractor corrects the supplies, all labor involved shall be borne by the
contractor. Additionally, the contractor shall arrange and bear all transportation costs of the
supplies to its facility and return to user.
The contractor, within five (5) working days of receiving such notice, shall notify the warranty
claimant by telephone as to the method of correction, date(s) work is to be performed and
by whom.
GOVERNMENT RESPONSIBILITIES
The Major Subordinate Command for the HEMTT is the U.S. Army Tank-Automotive and
Armaments Command (TACOM), Warren, MI 48397-5000. TACOM is responsible for
managing and implementing the warranty.
TACOM will:
Insure the contractor performs in accordance to the terms of the contract.
Equipment owning unit will:
1. Identify defects/failures and verify the defects/failures are warrantable.
2. Submit warranty claims, using DA Form 2407 (WP 0157) or DA Form 2407-1 (WP
0157) to your local Warranty Coordinator.
3. Tag and retain (IAW DA PAM 750-8 and this work package) (WP 0157) parts,
pieces of parts and/or assemblies removed at the owning unit level and as a result
of a warrantable defect/failure and/or correction.
Supporting repair facility will:
1. Identify defects/failures as warrantable (if owning unit has not already identified
them). Verify defects/failures are warrantable.
2. Review, process, and submit valid warranty claims to the local WARCO if the DA
Form 2407 (WP 0157) is complete and correctly filled out.
3. Reject invalid warranty claims or request additional information for incomplete and
incorrect claims.
0002-5
TM 9-2320-339-10
0002
4. Coordinate with the owning unit and decide which option for repair is desired to
correct the warrantable defect/failure.
5. Depending on which repair option was chosen (Government or contract repair)
provide labor/parts required to accomplish the warrantable repairs.
6. Tag and retain (IAW DA PAM 750-8 and this work package) (WP 0157) all parts,
pieces, or parts and/or assemblies removed as a result of warrantable defect/failure
and/or correction.
Local WARCO will:
1. Verify, review, process, and if valid and complete, submit claims (reimbursable and/
or disputes) to the contractor.
2. Reject claims that are not valid, and send them back to the local Unit with a short
explanation of why the claim is rejected.
3. Request additional information for incomplete claims.
4. Provide warranty claim acknowledgment closeout and/or parts/assemblies
disposition instructions to the local Unit.
5. Insure the contractor performs in accordance to the terms of the contract.
6. Verify, administer and process warranty claims.
7. Act as a liaison between owning unit, the contractor, supporting repair facility and
TACOM.
8. Notify the owning units of all warranty claim acknowledgments/close-outs,
information and/or instructions received from TACOM or the contractor.
9. Act as a liaison between local dealers and the Army.
10. Enter all open and closed WCAs into the Army Electronics Product Support (AEPS),
Electronic Deficiency Reporting System.
11. The information/data provided on the DA Form 2407 (WP 0157) are placed into the
AEPS Deficiency Reporting System (DRS) at the installation WARCO office to
facilitate MSC management and tracking of warranties.
Alterations/Modifications
Alterations/modifications shall not be applied unless authorized by TACOM.
WARRANTY DATA PLATE
All vehicles will have a warranty data plate. The contractor is required to mount his data
plate within clear view of the operator.
When the vehicle is received, the owning unit should locate the warranty data plate and
check the warranty start date with date shown on the applicable DD Form 250 (WP 0157)
or DD Form 1149. (WP 0157) If these dates differ, disregard the data plate. The date shown
on the DD Form 250 (WP 0157) or DD Form 1149. (WP 0157) is the date to be used as a
warranty start date.
0002-6
TM 9-2320-339-10
0002
CLAIM PROCEDURES
The procedures for reporting warranty claims are found in DA PAM 750-8 (WP 0157) and
this work package. Responsibilities of the MACOM are found in AR 700-139. (WP 0157)
All Warranty Claim Actions are processed on DA Form 2407 (WP 0157) and DA Form
2407-1. (WP 0157) It is very important to fill in the blocks on the forms as accurately as
possible.
The contractor shall be notified in writing within 30 days, utilizing DA Form 2407 (WP
0157) by the local Warranty Control Office/Officer (WARCO) following the discovery of a
defect in supplies which requires contractor repair and/or replacement parts. This shall
constitute formal notification of a warranty claim, and initiate the time period for contractor
responsibilities and action under the warranty. This notification shall include, but not be
limited to furnishing of the equipment serial number, operating hours, part number or NSN
of the defective part and circumstances surrounding the defect(s). At this time, the
contractor will further be informed whether the owning unit has elected:
1. To correct the defect themselves.
2. To direct the contractor to correct the defect.
Upon completion of contractor repair, forward completed warranty claims (Information Only)
electronically to AEPS (Army Electronic Product Support) http://aeps.ria.army.mil.
The contractor shall reimburse the government for the cost of labor and/or replacement
parts involved in the government correction of the defect. The government's Maintenance
Allocation Chart (MAC) determines the times. Additionally, the cost of replacement parts
obtained through the Government's supply channels will be determined by the amount
identified in the contractor's current commercial dealer net price or Army Master Data File
(AMDF) price, whichever is less. Furthermore, the owning unit may direct the contractor to
provide the replacement parts that prove to be defective within the warranty period, without
costs to the government, directly to their location or F.O.B., U.S. Port of Embarkation for
OCONUS. The contractor shall furnish replacement parts within 10 working days after
receipt of written claim notification. DO NOT submit warranty claims for reimbursement
where repair labor costs and replacement parts costs combined do not exceed $150.00 for
any one failure.
Identification Of Failed Items. Failed warranty items shall be tagged/identified to prevent
improper repair or use. Documents that describe the use of DA Form 2402 Maintenance
Tag (WP 0157) and DA Form 2407 Maintenance Request (WP 0157) shall be referenced.
Items requiring special handling, storage, or shipment during the processing of claims shall
be identified.
Disposition. The repair activity shall retain defective supplies for thirty (30) days following
receipt of acknowledgment of warranty claim from WARCO or contractor. If receipt of
acknowledgment is not received, inquiries should be made to your local WARCO. If receipt
of acknowledgment is received but no instructions are forthcoming within thirty (30) days of
receipt, supplies may be disposed.
0002-7
TM 9-2320-339-10
0002
Invalid Warranty Claims. When supplies are inspected by the contractor and found to be
non-warrantable due to abuse or improper maintenance, or the supplies are found to be
serviceable, the repair activity submitting the claim will be required to make reimbursement
for contractor services. All failed items returned for warranty claim action will be monitored
by the WARCO. Additionally, regarding contractor repair, the local WARCO must stipulate
at the time of request for services that either no non-warranty work be done or be prepared
to pay for such work.
REIMBURSEMENT FOR ARMY REPAIR
In the event that the repair activity should receive any reimbursement from the contractor,
the monies must be forwarded to the following address: Defense Accounting Office,
DAOTACOM, ATTN: DFAS-IN/EM-BED, TACOM, Warren, Michigan 48397-5000.
CLAIM DENIAL/DISPUTES
All denials or disputes will be handled by TACOM.
REPORTING
Reporting or recording action on a failed item shall be specified in DA PAM 750-8. (WP
0157) Contractor or repair activity unique forms shall not be used.
STORAGE/SHIPMENT/HANDLING
Storage
See coverage-specific data above (last paragraph) and preparation for storage for further
information.
Shipment
See contractor responsibilities data above (second paragraph), claim procedures (third
paragraph), and preparation of equipment for transportation/shipment for further
information.
Handling
See contractor responsibilities data above (second paragraph), claim procedures (third
paragraph), and safety, care, and handling for further information.
0002-8
TM 9-2320-339-10
0003
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
EQUIPMENT CHARACTERISTICS, CAPABILITIES, AND FEATURES
EQUIPMENT CHARACTERISTICS
The M978A4 tanker is used in refueling missions.
EQUIPMENT CAPABILITIES
1. All models are capable of operating in temperatures from -25 to 120F (-32 to 49
C) and to -50 to 120F (-46 to 49C) with arctic kit installed.
2. All models can ford water up to 48 in. (1 219 mm) deep for 5 minutes without
damage or without requiring maintenance before operation can continue.
3. Normal operating range of all models is 300 miles (483 km), based upon 154 gallons
(583 L) of fuel and 109,000 lbs (49 486 kg) GCWR, traveling over mixed terrain.
Varying loads, prolonged idle, use of power takeoff (PTO), off-road driving, and
climatic conditions affect operating range.
4. All models are provided with sufficient tiedown points located so vehicles can be
restrained in all directions during air transport in C-130, C-5A, and C-17 type
aircraft.
5. All models are also capable of being transported by highway, rail, and sea.
EQUIPMENT FEATURES
1. Caterpillar C15 (on-highway) electronically controlled, in-line six-cylinder, 4-cycle,
fuel injected, turbocharged diesel engine.
2. Push button automatic transmission with one reverse speed and five forward
speeds.
3. Anti-Lock Braking System (ABS) to all eight wheels which can be disabled by the
operator for off-road operation.
4. Operator controlled 4-wheel/8-wheel drive and high and low range transfer case
for positive traction in areas of unimproved road surfaces.
5. Power steering system consists of basic manual steering system with hydraulic
boost. Mechanical linkage also provides operator control in event of hydraulic oil
pressure loss.
6. Fuel system includes one fuel tank, fuel lines, fuel/water separator, fuel pump,
secondary filter, fuel pipes, and fuel injectors.
7. Two front and two rear towing eyes.
8. Manual-release-type rear pintle hook which will allow towing of a trailer.
9. Radio frequency interference suppression to permit voice radio communications
during all phases of operation.
0003-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
0003-2
0003
TM 9-2320-339-10
0004
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
LOCATION AND DESCRIPTION OF MAJOR COMPONENTS
1
3
Figure 1.
Personnel Cab. Provides protection from weather for crew and vehicle controls,
gauges, and indicators.
Engine Compartment. Engine supplies power to move vehicle and operate equipment and accessories.
0004-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
0004
No. 1 Driving Axle. Controls direction of vehicle when in motion. When needed,
transmits power to hubs to turn wheels.
No. 2 Driving Axle. Controls direction of vehicle when in motion. When needed,
transmits power to hubs to turn wheels.
No. 3 Driving Axle. Supports weight of vehicle, and transmits power to hubs to turn
rear wheels.
No. 4 Driving Axle. Supports weight of vehicle, and transmits power to hubs to turn
rear wheels.
Fuel Tank. Stores fuel used to operate engine. Receives excess fuel not used by
engines fuel injection system.
Tow Eyes. Attachment points for safety chains, towing shackles, and towing.
14
12
15
10
17
16
11
Figure 2.
0004-2
13
TM 9-2320-339-10
0004
Charge Air Cooler. Intake of air is used to cool engine inlet air temperature, transmission oil, and hydraulic system fluid.
10 Fuel/Water Separator. Acts as primary fuel filter and removes any water from fuel
before entering engine.
Ether Canister. Located next to fuel/water separator, the ether canister contains
ether for use as cold weather starting aid.
11 Hydraulic Reservoir. Stores, cools, and filters oil used in hydraulic and power steering systems.
12 Radiator. Intake of air is used to cool engine coolant and cabin air conditioning system.
13 Tire Carrier (shown raised). Used to raise and lower spare tire.
14 Air Cleaner. Filters out dust and debris from air entering air induction system.
15 Battery Box. Houses and protects four storage batteries.
16 Air Reservoirs. Used to store air system air.
17 Self-Recovery Winch (not used on all vehicles). Used to help vehicle pull itself
free of obstructions.
0004-3
TM 9-2320-339-10
0004
10
9
2
FLAMMABLE
FLAMMABLE
NO SMOKING WITHIN
50 FEET
3
Figure 3.
Stowage Boxes. Used to stow COEI, BII, (WP 0158)AAL, (WP 0159) and other mission essential items.
Tank Access Ladder (shown in stowed position). Provides access to top of tank.
0004-4
TM 9-2320-339-10
0004
Access Ladder. Used by crew to clean window, check oil, or perform other task
requiring access to parts of vehicle out of normal reach.
0004-5
TM 9-2320-339-10
0005
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
DIFFERENCES BETWEEN MODELS
M985
GMT
(Note
2)
18 ft. (5.49
m)
Cargo Body
Cargo Cover
Kit
M977
(Note
1)
M983
M978 M983
LET
(Note (Note
(Note
1)
2)
3)
10 ft. (3.05
m)
Equipment
Body
M1120
LHS
(Note
1)
M1977
CBT
(Note
1)
Heavy-Duty
Winch
Rear Beacon
Lights
(Note 4)
Work Lights
(Note 5)
MHC977
Grove
Crane
M984
(Note
2)
0005-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
0005
M983
M978 M983
LET
(Note (Note
(Note
1)
2)
3)
M984
(Note
2)
MHC985
Grove
Crane
M985
(Note
1)
M985
GMT
(Note
2)
M1120
LHS
(Note
1)
M1977
CBT
(Note
1)
MHC984
Grove
Crane
8108-2/2C
D
HIAB Crane
(Note 6)
Fifth Wheel
3.5 inch
(89 mm)
Kingpin
Semitrailer
Spare Tire
Carrier
Load Handling
System
Table 2. Notes.
Note:
1. Vehicle can be equipped in either of two configurations: with or without optional
self-recovery winch.
2. Vehicle equipped with self-recovery winch.
3. Self-recovery winch not available for this model.
4. All HEMTT series vehicles are authorized to carry portable beacon light as an
optional accessory.
0005-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
0005
0005-3
TM 9-2320-339-10
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
EQUIPMENT DATA
EQUIPMENT DATA
Table 1. Vehicle Operation.
Operating Mode: On and off-road
Operating Temperature w/o Arctic Kit: -25 to 120F (-32 to 49C)
Operating Temperature w/Arctic Kit: -50 to 120F (-46 to 49C)
Table 2. M978A4 Tanker Vehicle Dimensions.
Width (overall): 96 in. (2 438 mm)
Height (overall): 119 in. (3 022 mm)
Height (reduced for shipping): 102 in. (2 590 mm)
Length Overall: 409 in. (10 389 mm)
Wheelbase: 210 in. (5 334 mm)
Turn Circle (curb to curb): 110 ft. (33.5 m)
Ground Clearance: 24 in. (610 mm)
Center of Gravity:See shipping data plate on inside of driver side door.
Table 3. M978A4 Tanker Vehicle Weight.
Curb Weight: 42,150 lbs (19 136 kg)
Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR): 66,000 lbs (29 964 kg)
Gross Combination Weight Rating (GCWR): 109,000 lbs (49 486 kg)
0006-1
0006
TM 9-2320-339-10
0006
0006-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
0006
0006-3
TM 9-2320-339-10
0006-4
0006
TM 9-2320-339-10
0006-5
0006
TM 9-2320-339-10
0006-6
0006
TM 9-2320-339-10
0006-7
0006
TM 9-2320-339-10
0006
FULL LOAD
(TONS)
15
25
TIRE PRESSURES
Table 27. Tire Pressures.
TIRE
HIGHWAY
CROSSCOUNTRY
(DRY)
CROSSCOUNTRY
(WET)
SANDY
TERRAIN
0006-8
20 psi (138
kPa)
TM 9-2320-339-10
0006
TIRE
HIGHWAY
CROSSCOUNTRY
(DRY)
CROSSCOUNTRY
(WET)
SAND TIRE
NA
NA
25 psi (172
kPa)
SANDY
TERRAIN
20 psi (138
kPa)
SAND TIRE
NA
NA
30 psi (207
kPa)
100 psi (690 kPa) 100 psi (690 kPa) 100 psi (690
kPa)
100 psi
(690 kPa)
SAND TIRE
100 psi
(690 kPa)
NA
OPERATING SPEEDS
Table 28. Operating Speeds.
HIGHWAY
STANDARD
(XZL) TIRE
(maximum
Speed)
62 mph (100 km/ 40 mph (64 km/h) 20 mph (32 km/h) 20 mph (32
h)
km/h)
SAND TIRE
(maximum
Speed)
0006-9
NA
20 mph (32
km/h)
TM 9-2320-339-10
0007
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
SELF-RECOVERY WINCH
SELF-RECOVERY WINCH
The self-recovery winch (1), where used, is mounted on the passenger side chassis frame
rail between the second and third axles.
INTERAXLE
8X8
EXHAUST
ER
TRAILSUPPLYING
AIR PARK
S U PP
FOR AND
NOT MIDL
LY
PULL TO
B.O.
LIGHTS
B.O.
SELECT
PU S H T O
CHEM
ALARM
GPPU
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
M
M
12
ASS
HIGH
IDLE
n
AllTransisomission
1
Figure 1.
0007-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
0007
The self-recovery winch (1) is powered by a reversible hydraulic motor which drives the
winch drum through a planetary gearbox.
It is equipped with an automatic brake that is applied whenever the cab control lever (2) is
in center position.
NOTE
The M984A4 wrecker equipped with a self-recovery winch does not employ an operator controlled, two-position hydraulic selector valve to activate the reversible winch motor.
All vehicles (except the M984A4 wrecker) equipped with a self-recovery winch (1) have an
operator controlled, two-position hydraulic selector valve (WP 0025) to activate the
reversible winch motor.
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0007-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
0008
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
NOTE
Wiring harnesses are used to carry current to operate equipment and
accessories.
The electrical system is a 24 VDC system.
Four 12 VDC storage batteries (1) are connected in series-parallel with the negative terminal
grounded.
4
2
1
6
7
CHEM
ALARM
INTER
AXLE
25
22
15
11
8
8X8
6.2
5.5
3.7
2.7
2.0
IN H20 kPa
FILTER MINDER
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
B.O
SELECT
GPFU
B.O
LIGHTS
PARKING
BRAKE
HIGH
IDLE
1
2
TRAILER
AIR SUPPLY
0
1
2
AIR BRAKE
5
Figure 1.
A belt-driven 24 VDC alternator (2) having a capacity of 260 amps maintains the charge on
the batteries.
0008-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
0008
The voltage regulator (3) is mounted on the belt-driven 24 VDC alternator (2) and maintains
a 24-volt level for battery charging.
The heavy-duty starting motor (4) operates directly from the 24 VDC source through the
engine start switch (5).
NOTE
The battery readout is located in the top right corner of the instrument
panel liquid crystal display (LCD).
The battery readout (6) shows the state of charge of the batteries and alternator voltage
output.
The vehicle electrical circuits are protected against overloads by automatic reset circuit
breakers (7) located below the cab engine access panel along the aft bulkhead between
the operator and crew seats.
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0008-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
0009
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
AIR SYSTEM
AIR SYSTEM
NOTE
The call out number for the air reservoirs below matches the actual air
reservoir number.
The air system consists of five air reservoirs (1, 2, 3, 4, and 5) and an engine-driven air
compressor (6).
0009-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
0009
FRONT
13
INTERAXLE
8X8
FOR
NOT MIDLA
LY
ILER
TRA SUPPLYNG
AIR PARKIND
11
PU S H T O
CHEM
ALARM
GPPU
AUX
HYD
11
EXHAUST
SU PP
PULL TO
B.O.
LIGHTS
B.O.
SELECT
HYD
ENABLE
M
M
12
ASS
HIGH
IDLE
ission
AlliTransmson
7
2
5
15
8
12
10
14
Figure 1.
0009-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
0009
NOTE
The air system includes the necessary valves and air lines to control
the vehicle's air-operated parts.
On the M983A4 LET tractor vehicle, air from reservoir is controlled
by the winch tensioner and winch declutch manual valves, which in
turn operate the heavy-duty winch kickout and cable hold down
systems.
Pressurized air from the air compressor (6) is passed through the air dryer (7) to the
reservoir (1) - also called the wet tank. The air dryer (7) removes dirt and moisture from
the pressurized air.
Once air pressure in reservoir (1) rises above 65 to 75 psi (4.5 to 5.2 bar), a valve opens
and allows reservoirs (2, 3, 4, and 5) to be pressurized up to 133 psi (9.2 bar).
Air from reservoir (4 and 5) goes to the brake treadle valve (8). This air controls the rear
axle service parking brakes (9). Air pressure for reservoirs (4 and 5) is displayed by REAR
air pressure gauge (10).
Air from reservoir (2 and 3) goes to the brake treadle valve (8). This air controls the front
axle service brakes (11). Air pressure for reservoirs (2 and 3) is displayed by FRONT air
pressure gauge (12).
The PARKING BRAKE valve (13) controls air from reservoirs (4 and 5) and applies or
releases the rear axle service parking brakes (9).
Reservoirs (2 and 3 or 4 and 5) are interconnected so that if one reservoir fails, air is supplied
to release the rear axle service parking brakes (9) from whichever reservoir is functioning.
A buzzer will sound and the brake system failure (low air) indicator (14) will illuminate if air
pressure falls below 65 to 75 psi (4.5 to 5.2 bars).
NOTE
There is a SPNSN LOW AIR indicator that warns when the
suspension system is low with air and it will not dump.
A SPNSN LOW AIR indicator will illuminate if one or more zones of
air springs are deflated.
Specific to the M984A4, the front brake actuator valve (15) is used to apply the front axle
service brakes when using heavy-duty winch.
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0009-3
TM 9-2320-339-10
0010
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
MAIN HYDRAULIC SYSTEM
1
2
Figure 1.
0010-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
0010
NOTE
The M983A4 LET is not equipped with a self-recovery winch, but is
equipped with a manually-operated hydraulic selector valve to supply
hydraulic power to the heavy-duty winch.
The M984A4 is equipped with a self-recovery winch, but does not
have a manually-operated hydraulic selector valve.
Any vehicle (see notes above) may also be equipped with a self-recovery winch (3) and a
manually operated hydraulic selector valve (4).
The main hydraulic system includes the material handling cranes (5) on the M977A4
(shown), M985A4, and M985A4 GMT as well as the main fuel pump on the M978A4, and
load handling system on both the M1120A4 LHS and M1977A4 CBT.
FLUID SYSTEM
Pump (1) mounted on the rear of engine provides the fluid power to operate the power
steering (2).
1
10
6
4
11
2
12
7
9
Figure 2.
Fluid power for operating the self-recovery winch (3) and crane (4) is provided by a hydraulic
pump (5) driven by the power take-off (PTO) mounted on the transmission.
A manually-operated selector valve (6) is used to activate either the self-recovery winch (3),
crane (4), fuel tanker dispensing components (M978 only), or load handling system (LHS)
on M1120 LHS and M1977 CBT.
Operation on the crane (4) is controlled from the control panel (7) at the rear of the vehicle.
Both hydraulic pumps (1 and 5) share the same reservoir (8).
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0010-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
0011
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
STEERING SYSTEM
2
1
Figure 1.
The fluid reservoir (2) is shared with the main hydraulic system.
The steering wheel (3), which is mechanically linked to the main steering gear, rotates a
gear that positions a spool in the main steering gear.
This motion is hydraulically transmitted to a piston in the slave gear causing it to follow the
rotation of the main gear.
The main gear pitman arm (4) is mechanically connected to the slave gear pitman arm.
0011-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
0011
These pitman arms move the steering mechanism on the front axles (5) left or right causing
the vehicle to steer left or right.
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0011-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
0012
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
POWER TRAIN
POWER TRAIN
The drivetrain control system consists of the engine and transmission systems.
The vehicle drivetrain is enhanced through the use of an engine electrical control system
and 4500SP electronic transmission controller.
The engine electrical control and 4500SP transmission systems perform self-diagnostics,
engine/transmission system diagnostics, and vehicle performance diagnostics.
Self-diagnostics includes personnel-initiated checks of main electronic components such
as solenoids, wiring, sensor, and control modules.
System-diagnostics monitor critical engine and transmission parameters such as oil
temperature, oil pressure, coolant temperature, voltage, and gear range attained.
Vehicle performance diagnostic capabilities aid the mechanic in isolating problems outside
of the electronic control system.
Operating data is stored in the engine electrical control system and 4500SP electronic
transmission controller memory for display at a later time.
Power Train
Power for the vehicle is provided by a diesel engine (1), which is coupled directly to an
automatic transmission (2).
Figure 1.
0012-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
0012
Power from the transmission is transferred to the transfer case (3) and on to front and rear
axles (4) through a series of drive shafts and universal joints (5).
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
HEMTT series vehicles use an Allison HD4000 series transmission model 4500SP.
This hydrokinetic type transmission has an integral-locking torque converter, lock-up clutch,
constant mesh planetary gearing, the GEN IV, a speedometer, and control valve module
assembly.
The primary components of the GEN IV system are the Transmission Control Module
(TCM), transmission range selector in the vehicle cab, a control valve module beneath the
transmission gearing section which contains solenoid valves for clutch control, an engine
speed sensor, a turbine speed sensor, and an output speed sensor that relays the
transmission output speed to the TCM for shifting and control functions.
0012-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
0012
2
AXLE
8X8
B.O.
LIGHTS
SUPP
PULL TO
EXHAUST
ER
LY
TRAILSUPPKING
AIRNOT FORMIDLPARAND
LY
B.O.
SELECT
PUSH TO
CHEM
ALARM
GPPU
HYD
ENABLE
M
M
12
ASS
HIGH
IDLE
AlTranslismissonion
OUTPUT
SPEED
SENSOR
TURBINE SPEED
SENSOR
CONTROL VALVE
MODULE
TCM
ENGINE SPEED
SENSOR
Figure 2.
The TCM also protects the transmission from cold weather startups by inhibiting normal
shifting functions until a minimum sump temperature of 20F (-7C) is attained.
A check transmission indicator (2) located on the instrument panel alerts the operator,
momentarily, every time the system is activated as a lamp check, and when the TCM finds
a problem in the system.
If check transmission indicator (2) comes on during vehicle operation, the transmission will
continue to operate normally, in most cases. However, in some cases, the TCM will take
0012-3
TM 9-2320-339-10
0012
action to reduce the possibility of damage to the vehicle or the transmission (refer to limp
home/transmission fault (WP 0111) for more information. The transmission should be
serviced at the next opportunity.
The transmission range selector (1) allows the operator to select a vehicle drive range.
Operate transmission and transfer case (WP 0047) provides full operating instructions for
the transmission.
The TCM contains the microprocessor based electronics and is located in a protected area
within the vehicle cab.
The TCM receives information in the form of signals from switches and sensor, processes
the information, and sends electrical signals to the appropriate components, which control
the operation.
The TCM features diagnostics, which can sense electronic system malfunctions and identify
them with a displayed code.
Diagnostic codes can be accessed by two methods: a diagnostic data reader connected to
the vehicle at the electronic diagnostic receptacle or through the transmission range
selector (1) push buttons.
0012-4
TM 9-2320-339-10
0012
ELECTRONIC
DIAGNOSTIC
RECEPTACLE
Figure 3.
All lubricating and clutch-applied oil is provided by an engine-driven pump (in the
transmission).
The transmission includes an electrically-controlled power take-off (PTO).
The PTO provides power to a hydraulic pump, which powers the vehicle's hydraulic system.
The hydraulic system operates the self-recovery winch, the material handling crane, the
heavy-duty recovery winch, and the pumping equipment, depending on how the vehicle is
equipped.
0012-5
TM 9-2320-339-10
0012
TRANSFER CASE
The transfer case (1) connects the drivetrain to the No.1 and No. 2 axles (2) when 8-wheel
drive is needed.
1
Figure 4.
The transfer case has two gear ratios (high and low) and neutral. The vehicle must be
stopped before the transfer case can be shifted between ranges because the gears are not
synchronized.
Engagement of the transfer case in low range will automatically engage the drivetrain to the
front axles.
TANDEM AXLES AND SUSPENSION
Front and rear axles (1) are single reduction, full floating axle shaft type.
Figure 5.
The front two axles provide vehicle steering
The rear two axles are non-steering.
0012-6
TM 9-2320-339-10
0012
Both front and rear axles are equipped with wheel differentials and inter-axle differentials.
The inter-axle differential have driver-controlled lockouts for positive drive to all axles in low
range.
The rear axles are equipped with permanently engaged controller traction differentials.
The front and rear suspensions are air spring, transverse beam type.
PROPELLER SHAFTS AND UNIVERSAL JOINTS
The propeller shafts and universal joints (1) transmit engine power to the axles.
1
1
Figure 6.
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0012-7
TM 9-2320-339-10
0013
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
ENGINE SYSTEMS
ENGINE
NOTE
The Caterpillar C15 (on-highway) engine and is controlled electronically.
The primary components of electronic control system are electronic unit injector (EUI),
electronic control module (ECM), and engine sensors.
The ECM (1) contains:
1
Figure 1.
1. A microprocessor that continuously monitors and analyzes the engine and
accompanying systems with electronic sensors during engine operation.
2. A programmable read only memory (PROM) provides basic engine control function
instructions.
3. An electronically erasable, programmable, read only memory (EEPROM) stores
engine calibration values.
0013-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
0013
25
22
15
11
8
6.2
5.5
3.7
2.7
2.0
IN H20 kPa
FILTER MINDER
PARKING
BRAKE
TRAILER
AIR SUPPLY
CHEM
ALARM
INTER
AXLE
8X8
25
22
15
11
8
6.2
5.5
3.7
2.7
2.0
IN H20 kPa
FILTER MINDER
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
B.O
SELECT
GPFU
B.O
LIGHTS
PARKING
BRAKE
HIGH
IDLE
1
2
TRAILER
AIR SUPPLY
0
1
2
AIR BRAKE
Figure 2.
The EUI allows precise metering and injection timing.
The engine sensors monitor key parts of the engine for performance and environmental
variables.
The ECM (1) features diagnostics which can sense electronic system malfunctions and
identify them by displaying a code.
A check engine indicator (3) on instrument panel will illuminate when a noncritical fault
occurs, but the vehicle can still be operated.
Diagnostic codes can be accessed by a PC based software program or a diagnostic data
reader connected to the vehicle at the electronic diagnostic receptacle (4).
0013-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
0013
Figure 3.
Engine exhaust gases flow through the turbocharger (2) driving a turbine wheel.
0013-3
TM 9-2320-339-10
0013
A compressor wheel on the opposite end of the turbine wheel shaft rotates and draws in
fresh air through the air cleaner (1), compresses the air, and delivers it to the engine blower
(3).
Air from the engine blower (3) flows through the aftercooler (4) which cools the air before it
is delivered to the engine cylinders.
FUEL SYSTEM
NOTE
The fuel circuit is a conventional design for electronic unit injector diesel
engines.
The fuel transfer pump (1) draws fuel from fuel tank (2).
4
10
11
7
6
8
5
Figure 4.
The fuel passes through primary filter/water separator (3).
The fuel passes into the fuel transfer pump (1) and the fuel is then pressurized.
The fuel transfer pump (1) incorporates a check valve in order to permit a fuel flow around
the gears for hand priming.
The fuel transfer pump (1) also incorporates a relief valve in order to protect the system
from extreme pressure.
0013-4
TM 9-2320-339-10
0013
NOTE
The excess fuel flow also purges the air from the fuel system.
The excess fuel flow that is provided by the transfer pump (1) is used in order to cool the
electronic unit injectors (4).
The fuel from the transfer pump (1) flows through two micron fuel filters (5) at fuel filter base
(6).
Fuel temperature sensor (7) is mounted in the fuel filter base (6).
NOTE
The engine control module (ECM) uses the sensor to monitor the
temperature of the fuel that is entering the engine.
The information is used by the ECM to calculate a fuel correction
factor during engine operation.
Fuel priming pump (8) is positioned on the fuel filter base (6) in order to prime the system
when air has been introduced into the fuel system.
NOTE
The fuel enters the cylinder head at the front of the engine.
The fuel leaves the fuel filter base (6) and flows through fuel supply line (9) to the cylinder
head.
Fuel is delivered to electronic unit injectors (4) through fuel manifold (10) that is drilled into
the cylinder head during the manufacturing process.
NOTE
Excess fuel exits the cylinder head at the rear.
The fuel returns to the fuel filter base (6) through fuel return line (11) to the pressure
regulating valve that maintains a sufficient amount of back pressure in the system in order
to fill the electron unit injectors (4).
NOTE
After the fuel passes through the pressure regulating valve, the fuel returns to the fuel tank.
The fuel flows continuously from the fuel supply through the electronic unit injectors (4) in
the head and back of the tank.
COOLING SYSTEM
Air is pulled through the air cleaner, and into the air inlet (1) by the low pressure turbocharger
(2).
0013-5
TM 9-2320-339-10
10
0013
13
11
5
12
15
14
16
3
2
1
Figure 5.
NOTE
Pressurizing the inlet air causes the air to heat up.
The low pressure turbocharger (2) compresses the air.
NOTE
The high pressure turbocharger is used to compress the air to a
higher pressure.
This increase in pressure continues to cause the inlet air's
temperature to increase.
Pressurized air exits the low pressure turbocharger (2) through an outlet (3) and the air is
forced into the inlet (4) of high pressure turbocharger (5).
NOTE
The precooler uses engine coolant to cool the air.
Without the precooler, the inlet air would be too hot in order to be
cooled sufficiently by the aftercooler
As the air is compressed, the air is forced through the high pressure turbocharger's outlet
(6) and into the precooler (7).
0013-6
TM 9-2320-339-10
0013
NOTE
The inlet air is cooled further by transferring heat to the ambient air.
The combustion efficiency increases as the temperature of the inlet
air decreases.
Combustion efficiency helps to provide increased fuel efficiency and
increased horsepower output.
The aftercooler core is a separate cooler core that is mounted in front
of the engine radiator.
The engine fan and the ram effect of the forward motion of the vehicle
causes ambient air to move across the core.
The pressurized inlet air is cooled by the precooler (7) prior to being sent to the aftercooler
(8).
Inlet air is forced from the aftercooler (7) into the engine's intake manifold.
NOTE
The airflow from the intake manifold into the cylinders and out of the
cylinders is controlled by engine's valve mechanisms.
The inlet valves open when the piston moves downward on the inlet
stroke.
When the inlet valves open, cooled, compressed air from the intake
manifold is pulled into the cylinder.
The inlet valves close when the piston begins to move upward on the
compression stroke.
The air in the cylinder is compressed by the piston.
As the air is compressed by the piston, the temperature of the air in
the cylinder is heated.
Fuel is injected into the cylinder when the piston is near the top of the
compression stroke.
Combustion begins when the fuel mixes with the hot, pressurized air.
The force of the combustion pushes the piston downward on the
power stroke.
The exhaust valves are opened as the piston travels upward to the
top of the cylinder.
The exhaust gases are pushed through the exhaust port into the
exhaust manifold.
After the piston completes the exhaust stroke, the exhaust valves
close and the cycle begins again.
0013-7
TM 9-2320-339-10
0013
Each cylinder has two inlet valves (9) and two exhaust valves (10) that are mounted in the
cylinder head.
Exhaust gases from the exhaust manifold flow into the high pressure turbocharger's exhaust
inlet (11).
NOTE
The hot gases that are expelled from the engine are used to turn the
turbine wheel of the turbocharger.
The turbine wheel drives the compressor wheel that is used in order
to compress the inlet air that enters the inlet side of the turbocharger.
The exhaust gas exits from the high pressure turbocharger through the high pressure
turbocharger's exhaust outlet (12).
NOTE
The wastegate also prevents excessive boost of the engine during acceleration.
Wastegate (13) is used by the high pressure turbocharger (5) to prevent an overspeed
condition of the turbocharger turbine wheel during engine acceleration.
The wastegate (13) is controlled by the boost pressure that is felt in the air hose assembly
that connects the inlet side of the two turbochargers.
NOTE
As the diaphragm reacts to high boost pressure, a valve is activated.
The valve allows exhaust gas to bypass the high pressure
turbocharger's turbine, which effectively controls the speed of the
turbine.
Wastegate pressure line (14) provides the air pressure to the wastegate's diaphragm.
NOTE
The exhaust gases drive the turbocharger's turbine.
This energy is used in order to compress the inlet air in the same
manner as the high pressure turbocharger.
The exhaust gases then enter the exhaust inlet (15) for the low pressure turbocharger (2).
The exhaust gases then exit the low pressure turbocharger (2) through the exhaust outlet
(16) into the vehicle's exhaust system.
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0013-8
TM 9-2320-339-10
0014
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
CAB
CAB
The cab (1) contains all of the driving controls and gauges, operating controls for some of
the mounted equipment, and adjustable seats for a crew of two. For explanation of cab
controls, refer to vehicle controls and indicators.
1
Figure 1.
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0014-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
0015
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
WHEELS AND TIRES
Figure 1.
One spare tire (2) is mounted on top of vehicle.
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0015-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
0016
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
TANKER MODULE
The tanker may be loaded through the manhole (1) in the top or by using the loading valve
(2) in the bottom of the tank.
2
5
Figure 1.
A hydraulic motor driven pump (3) is used to deliver fuel during all fueling operations.
0016-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
0016
An electric motor driven pump (4) serves as a backup pumping unit in case the tanker loses
hydraulic power.
Fuel delivery hoses are stored on retracting reels (5) located on each side of the fueling
station.
Two reel-mounted static grounding cables (6) are provided for grounding whatever is being
fueled or defueled.
An emergency shutoff valve and a hand-actuated deadman control are included for
maximum safety.
Hand-operated valves attached to the delivery hoses control fuel flow during refueling.
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0016-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
CHAPTER 2
OPERATOR
INSTRUCTIONS
TM 9-2320-339-10
0017
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
CAB-MOUNTED FOOT CONTROLS
Key
Control/
Indicator
Function
CHEM
ALARM
INTER
AXLE
8X8
25
22
15
11
8
6.2
5.5
3.7
2.7
2.0
IN H20 kPa
FILTER MINDER
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
B.O
SELECT
GPFU
B.O
LIGHTS
PARKING
BRAKE
HIGH
IDLE
1
2
0
1
2
TRAILER
AIR SUPPLY
AIR BRAKE
1
Figure 1.
0017-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
0017
Key
Control/
Indicator
Function
Service Brake
Pedal
Throttle Pedal
0017-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
0018
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
CAB-MOUNTED HAND CONTROLS
0018-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
0018
Key
Control/
Indicator
Function
Figure 1.
1
Pull chain to sound air horn. Release chain to silence air horn.
0018-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
0018
Key
Control/
Indicator
Function
(one on each
door)
4
0018-3
TM 9-2320-339-10
0019
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
STEERING COLUMN MOUNTED CONTROLS
Key
Control/
Indicator
Function
6
1
Figure 1.
1
Emergency
Flasher Control
0019-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
0019
Key
Control/
Indicator
Function
Steering Wheel
Horn Button
Turn Signal
Lever
Push up to signal right turn. Pull down to signal left turn. When
turn is complete, return lever to center position.
Used to test the trailer brakes. Pull control lever down to apply
trailer brakes. Push control lever up to release trailer brakes.
0019-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
0020
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
INSTRUMENT PANEL CONTROLS AND INDICATORS
Key
Control/
Indicator
Function
25.2V
93.5 mi
Trip
6.7 mi
Figure 1.
1
Speedometer
0020-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
0020
Key
Control/
Indicator
Function
Liquid Crystal
Display (LCD)
7
8
6
93.5 mi
6.7 mi
25.2V
Trip
Figure 2.
5
Odometer
0020-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
0020
Key
Control/
Indicator
Function
Battery Voltage
Drive Mode
Display
Operator may choose between either drive mode display option by momentarily pressing and releasing (T) button.
Displays Trip or Hrs dependent on drive mode selected.
10
14
11
13
12
Figure 3.
9
Tachometer
10
High Engine
Coolant Temperature Indicator
0020-3
TM 9-2320-339-10
0020
Key
Control/
Indicator
Function
11
Engine Coolant
Temperature
Gauge
12
Check Engine
Indicator
13
Engine Oil
Pressure
Gauge
14
22
15
16
17
21
18
20
19
Figure 4.
15
0020-4
TM 9-2320-339-10
0020
Key
Control/
Indicator
Function
16
Transmission
Oil Temperature Gauge
17
18
19
Brake System
Failure (LOW
AIR) Indicator
20
FRONT Air
Pressure
Gauge
21
0020-5
TM 9-2320-339-10
0020
Key
Control/
Indicator
Function
22
Fuel Gauge
26
25
27
28
29
30 31
32
34
33
36
35
24
CHEM
ALARM
INTER
AXLE
25
23
6.2
22
15
11
8
8X8
5.5
3.7
2.7
2.0
IN H20 kPa
FILTER MINDER
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
B.O
SELECT
GPFU
B.O
LIGHTS
PARKING
BRAKE
HIGH
IDLE
1
2
3
0
1
2
TRAILER
AIR SUPPLY
37
38
Figure 5.
23
Beacon Light
Switch
24
Work Light
Switch
25
CHEM ALARM
Switch
26
27
Beacon Light
Indicator
0020-6
TM 9-2320-339-10
0020
Function
28
Clearance
Light Indicator
29
30
PARKING
BRAKE Indicator
31
Vehicle ABS
Indicator
32
33
34
Dimmer Switch
(Two-Position
Momentary)
35
Key
0020-7
TM 9-2320-339-10
0020
Key
Control/
Indicator
Function
37
PARKING
BRAKE Control
38
TRAILER AIR
SUPPLY Control
Supplies air to (push in) and shuts off (pull out) air to trailer
brake system. When TRAILER AIR SUPPLY control is applied (pushed in), vehicle PARKING BRAKE Control acti-
0020-8
TM 9-2320-339-10
0020
Key
Function
vates/deactivates the trailer parking brakes in concert with the
vehicle parking brakes.
42
41
40
39
43
45
44
46
47
48
CHEM
ALARM
49
INTER
AXLE
8X8
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
HIGH
IDLE
50
1
2
3
B.O
SELECT
GPFU
B.O
LIGHTS
0
1
2
51
53
52
54
Figure 6.
39
AUX HYD
Switch
40
HYD ENABLE
Switch
41
GPFU
42
0020-9
TM 9-2320-339-10
0020
Key
Control/
Indicator
Function
43
OVER SPEED
Indicator
44
STOP ENGINE
Indicator
Illuminates (red) when engine oil pressure, manifold air temperature, and/or engine coolant temperature/fluid level is outside safe operating limits.
45
Automatic
Traction Control Indicator
(ATC)
Flashes (amber) when traction control system is automatically activated during vehicle operation. Illuminates steady
(amber) when traction control is experiencing a fault and/or
ABS Disable Switch (50) is set to on position.
46
ABS Disabled
Indicator
47
SPARE TIRE
LOOSE Indicator
48
B.O. SELECT
Switch
Setting the blackout service select switch to on position disables the master lighting switch (all functions including brake
lights, turn signals, and emergency flashers), work light
switch, beacon light switch, dome light switch, electric horn,
and reverse alarm.
49
B.O. LIGHTS
Switch (ThreePosition)
DOWN - off.
0020-10
TM 9-2320-339-10
0020
Key
Control/
Indicator
Function
Anti-Lock
Brake System
(ABS) Disable
Switch
Disables vehicle anti-lock brake system. The automatic traction control (ATC) indicator (45) will also illuminate steady
(amber) when ABS is disabled.
51
Engine Brake
High/Medium/
Low Switch
(Three-Position)
Engine Brake
On/Off Switch
Turns the engine retarder on/off which provides engine braking to the vehicle. The amount of engine braking provided is
dependant on the position of the Engine Brake High/Medium/
Low Switch.
0020-11
TM 9-2320-339-10
0020
Key
53
Control/
Indicator
Master Lighting
Switch (ThreePosition)
Function
DOWN - off
CENTER (middle) - clearance lights and parking lights illuminate.
UP - clearance lights, parking lights, and headlights illuminate.
0020-12
TM 9-2320-339-10
0020
Key
54
Control/
Indicator
Function
Dome Light
Switch
56
55
57
58
59
61
60
62
CHEM
ALARM
INTER
AXLE
8X8
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
HIGH
IDLE
63
1
2
3
B.O
SELECT
GPFU
B.O
LIGHTS
0
1
2
64
66
65
67
68
69
Figure 7.
55
56
57
ENGINE
BRAKE ENABLE Indicator
0020-13
TM 9-2320-339-10
0020
Key
Control/
Indicator
58
LHS Indicator
59
8X8 Indicator
Illuminates (green) when Traction Control Switch (Three-Position) is set to 8x8 position and/or TRANSFER CASE shift
lever is positioned to LO.
60
Inter-Axle Indicator
Illuminates (green) when Traction Control Switch (Three-Position) is set to INTER AXLE position.
61
SPNSN AIR
LOW Indicator
62
63
HIGH IDLE
Switch
64
Windshield
Wiper Switch
(Three-Position)
Function
DOWN - off.
CENTER (middle) - low speed.
UP - high speed.
0020-14
TM 9-2320-339-10
0020
Key
Control/
Indicator
Function
65
Windshield
Washer Switch
(Two-Position
Momentary)
66
LHS NO
TRANSIT Indicator
67
LHS OVER
LOAD Indicator
68
Ignition Switch
69
Engine Start
Switch (TwoPosition Momentary)
0020-15
TM 9-2320-339-10
0021
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
HEATER COMPARTMENT CONTROLS AND INDICATORS
Function
INTERAXLE
8X8
PULL TO
B.O.
LIGHTS
B.O.
SELECT
EXHAUST
LER
TRAI SUPPKINLYG
AIR PAR D
FOR
NOT MIDLAN
SUPPLY
Key
PUS O
HT
CHEM
ALARM
GPPU
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
M
M
1
2
ASS
HIGH
IDLE
nn
smissio
ATranlliso
4
1
Figure 1.
0021-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
0021
Key
Control/
Indicator
Transmission
Range Selector
Function
Cabin Floor
Vent Control
0021-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
0021
Key
Control/
Indicator
Function
Vent Control
Fan Control
0021-3
TM 9-2320-339-10
0021
Key
Control/
Indicator
Function
Figure 2.
8
EPLRS Power
Outlet
0021-4
TM 9-2320-339-10
0021
Key
Control/
Indicator
Function
SINCGARS
Power Outlet
Supplies electrical power to Single Channel Ground and Airborne Radio System (SINCGARS).
INTERAXLE
8X8
B.O.
LIGHTS
S U P PL
PULL TO
EXHAUST
LER LY
TRAI SUPPKING
AINOTR FORMIDPARLAND
B.O.
SELECT
10
PUSH T O
CHEM
ALARM
11
GPPU
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
M
M
1
2
ASS
HIGH
IDLE
AlTranlissmisonsion
Figure 3.
10
TRANSFER
CASE Shift
Lever
11
Self-Recovery
Winch (SRW)
Lever
Used to pay out (push lever forward) and take up (pull lever
aft) winch cable. Lever will return to neutral (center) position
when released. Lever not included in vehicles without SRW.
0021-5
TM 9-2320-339-10
0022
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
CENTER DASH PANEL CONTROLS
Key
Control/
Indicator
Function
25
22
15
11
8
6.2
5.5
3.7
2.7
2.0
IN H20 kPa
FILTER MINDER
PARKING
BRAKE
TRAILER
AIR SUPPLY
Figure 1.
1
Operator/Crew
Air Vents
0022-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
0022
Key
Control/
Indicator
Function
24 Volt Receptacle
STE/ICE Receptacle
0022-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
0023
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
OPERATOR AND CREW FOUR-POINT SEATBELT/AIR-RIDE SEAT ADJUSTMENT
CONTROLS
Function
HEIGHT
ADJ.
Key
5
3
2
6
2
4
Figure 1.
0023-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
0023
Key
Control/
Indicator
Function
Seatbelt
Retractor
0023-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
0024
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
24V BATTERY DISCONNECT SWITCH
0024-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
0024
Key
Control/
Indicator
Function
1
Figure 1.
1
24V BATTERY
DISCONNECT
Switch
When in the ON position, power is available to control modules and electrical system. When in OFF position, battery
does not run down due to control module load.
0024-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
0025
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
HYDRAULIC SELECTOR VALVE CONTROL
0025-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
0025
Key
Control/
Indicator
Function
Figure 1.
0025-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
0026
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
TIRE CARRIER PUMP CONTROLS
0026-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
0026
Key
Control/
Indicator
1
Function
2
3
Figure 1.
1
Hand Pump
Receptacle
Receiver for handle which is used in conjunction with directional control lever (2) to manually raise and lower tire carrier.
Directional
Control Lever
Outboard - LOWER
0026-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
0026
Key
Control/
Indicator
Function
Inboard - RAISE
3
Power Control
(momentary)
Auxiliary Air
Fitting
0026-3
TM 9-2320-339-10
0027
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
SUSPENSION DUMP VALVE CONTROL
Key
Control/
Indicator
Function
Figure 1.
0027-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
Key
Control/
Indicator
Suspension
Dump Valve
Control
Function
0027-2
0027
TM 9-2320-339-10
0028
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
TANKER MODULE CONTROLS - FAR RIGHT AND FAR LEFT
0028-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
0028
Key
Control/
Indicator
Function
1
1
7
60
40
20
80
500 600
60
100
800
300
40
120
20
140
1000
1100
160
100
0
0
80
500 600
100
800
300
120
140
1000
1100
160
100
0
0
MARSH
MARSH
D
E
F
U
E
L
OUT
F
U
E
L
IN
VALVE
L L O N S
3
FLOW METER
7
4
6
FLAMMABLE
Figure 1.
1
Hose Reel
Tension Knob
MC MANUAL
CONTROL EM
VALVE Lever
Opens and closes valve (V1) which allows fuel flow out of
tank. Valve is pulled back to open in all operations except top
load or bottom load.
0028-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
0028
Table 1. Tanker Module Controls - Far Right and Far Left. - Continued
Control/
Indicator
Function
SR1 STATIC
REEL/SR2
STATIC REEL
Hand Crank
Handle
Connects to hand crank and allows operator to rewind servicing hose onto reel.
Engages main pump when lever is pushed forward. Disengages pump when lever is pulled back. Allows use of remote
hydraulics when latch is lifted and lever is pulled full back.
Hand Actuated
Valve (HAV)
Control
Hand Crank
Shaft
Key
0028-3
TM 9-2320-339-10
0029
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
TANKER MODULE CONTROLS - CENTER
0029-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
0029
Key
Control/
Indicator
Function
60
40
20
80
500 600
60
100
800
300
40
120
20
140
1000
1100
160
100
0
0
80
500 600
60
40
80
500 600
300
120
140
1000
1100
160
MARSH
20
100
800
300
100
0
MARSH
3
4
100
800 120
140
1000
1100
160
100
0
MARSH
L L O N S
5
FLOW METER
12
11
10
9
8
Figure 1.
1
Discharge Line
Pressure
Gauge (DLPG)
0029-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
0029
Key
Control/
Indicator
Function
Venturi-Nozzle
Pressure
Gauge (VNPG)
Differential
Pressure
Gauge (DPG)
Indicates whether filter-separator is clean or dirty by measuring pressure drop as fuel flows through separator.
Flowmeter
(FM)
LIQUID TANK
LEVEL Gauge
AUXILIARY
PUMP CONTROL (APC)/
APS AUXILIARY PUMP
Switch
THROTTLE
CONTROL
(TC) Switch
0029-3
TM 9-2320-339-10
0029
Key
Control/
Indicator
Function
10
TANK LEVEL
INDICATOR
(TLI) Switch
11
V15 DRAIN
VALVE
12
SAMPLING
PROBE Shutoff Valve
0029-4
TM 9-2320-339-10
0030
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
TANKER MODULE CONTROLS - NEAR RIGHT
Key
Control/
Indicator
Function
60
40
20
80
500 600
100
800
300
120
140
1000
1100
160
100
0
0
MARSH
D
E
F
U
E
L
F
U
E
L
OUT
IN
6
VALVE
L L O N S
FLOW METER
4
Figure 1.
0030-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
0030
Key
Control/
Indicator
Function
V6 FUEL/DEFUEL VALVE
V11 FLOW
VALVE (REG)
Controls rate of fuel flow though bulk unload connector. Varies rate of flow from 50 to 300 gpm. Each notch in control
equals approximately 25 gpm.
V8 REEL
VALVE (H2)
0030-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
0031
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
TANKER MODULE CONTROLS - NEAR LEFT
0031-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
0031
Key
Control/
Indicator
Function
60
40
20
80
500 600
60
100
800
300
40
120
20
140
1000
1100
160
100
0
0
80
500 600
100
800
300
120
140
1000
1100
160
100
0
0
MARSH
MARSH
D
E
F
U
E
L
F
U
E
L
OUT
IN
VALVE
L L O N S
FLOW METER
Figure 1.
1
V7 REEL
VALVE (H1)
0031-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
0031
Key
Control/
Indicator
Function
Valve is used during bulk loading operations to be sure bottom load valve (V10) will close when tank is full.
THROTTLE
CONTROL
Switch (TC)
V17 GRAVITY
VALVE
0031-3
TM 9-2320-339-10
0032
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
TANKER MODULE CONTROLS - DRIVER SIDE OF VEHICLE
0032-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
0032
Key
Control/
Indicator
Function
FLAMMABLE
NO SMOKING WITHIN 50 FEET
Figure 1.
1
Emergency
Fuel Shutoff
(Manual Emergency Control)
When pulled, valve (V1) closes, stopping fuel flow from tank.
Valve (V1) can only be reopened by using the MC MANUAL
CONTROL EM VALVE (WP 0028) lever at the rear of vehicle.
0032-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
0032
Key
Control/
Indicator
V3 SUCTION
LINE VALVE
Function
Diverts fuel from main pump to auxiliary pump. Valve is located inside driver side frame in front of No. 3 axle. Shown in
open position.
0032-3
TM 9-2320-339-10
0033
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
RIFLE STOWAGE MOUNT
0033-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
0033
Key
Control/
Indicator
Function
1
Figure 1.
1
Lower Rifle
Mount
0033-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
Key
Control/
Indicator
Function
Rifle Mount
Handle
Top Rifle
Mount
0033-3
0033
TM 9-2320-339-10
0034
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
OPERATE WINDSHIELD WIPERS/WASHER
INITIAL SETUP:
Not Applicable
NOTE
24V battery disconnect switch must be positioned to ON (WP 0075) to
operate windshield wipers.
1. Ensure ignition switch (1) is set to on position.
CHEM
ALARM
INTER
AXLE
8X8
25
22
15
11
8
6.2
5.5
3.7
2.7
2.0
IN H20 kPa
FILTER MINDER
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
B.O
SELECT
GPFU
B.O
LIGHTS
PARKING
BRAKE
HIGH
IDLE
1
2
TRAILER
AIR SUPPLY
0
1
2
AIR BRAKE
Figure 1.
2. Press three-position windshield wiper switch (2) up one position for low speed, or up
two positions for high speed as desired.
3. Press three-position windshield wiper switch (2) all the way down to stop wipers.
OPERATE WINDSHIELD WASHER
NOTE
24V battery disconnect switch must be positioned to ON (WP 0075) to
operate windshield wipers.
0034-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
0034
CHEM
ALARM
INTER
AXLE
8X8
25
22
15
11
8
6.2
5.5
3.7
2.7
2.0
IN H20 kPa
FILTER MINDER
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
B.O
SELECT
GPFU
B.O
LIGHTS
PARKING
BRAKE
HIGH
IDLE
1
2
TRAILER
AIR SUPPLY
0
1
2
AIR BRAKE
Figure 2.
2. Push in and hold windshield washer switch (2) to spray cleaning fluid on windshield.
3. Release windshield washer switch (2) to stop spray.
END OF TASK
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0034-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
OPERATE CAB TEMPERATURE CONTROLS
INITIAL SETUP:
Not Applicable
NOTE
If heater does not blow hot air, ensure heater valves are open.
Air temperature is controlled by position of temperature control
switch.
Turn temperature control switch CW to increase temperature.
Turn temperature control switch CCW to decrease temperature.
1. Position temperature control switch (1) to desired setting.
0035-1
0035
TM 9-2320-339-10
0035
INTERAXLE
8X8
B.O.
LIGHTS
PULL TO
EXHAUST
LER
TRAI SUPPKINLYG
AIR PAR D
FOR
NOT MIDLAN
S UPPLY
B.O.
SELECT
PUS O
HT
CHEM
ALARM
GPPU
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
M
M
1
2
ASS
HIGH
IDLE
nn
smissio
ATranlliso
Figure 1.
2. Set fan switch (2) to desired position:
Off - full CCW.
Low - one position CW from off.
Medium - two positions CW from off.
High - full CW.
3. Position vent control switch (3) as desired to control outside airflow for cab ventilation.
Full CCW shuts outside air ventilation off.
4. Position mid-level/defrost vent control switch (4) as desired to control airflow direction:
a. Turning the mid-level/defrost vent control switch (4) full CCW position turns
maximum airflow to defrost vent, and shuts off all airflow to mid-level vents.
b. Turning the mid-level/defrost vent control switch (4) CW causes a relative
distribution of airflow between defrost and mid-level vents.
0035-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
c.
0035
Turning the mid-level/defrost vent control switch (4) full CW turns maximum airflow
to mid-level vents and shuts off all airflow to defrost vents.
5. Position floor vent control switch (5) as desired to control airflow to the floor vents:
a. Turning the floor vent control switch (5) full CCW directs maximum airflow to floor
vents.
b. Turning the floor vent control switch (5) CCW causes a relative decrease in airflow.
c.
Turning the floor vent control switch (5) full CW shuts airflow to foot vents off.
NOTE
If windshield defrost does not blow hot air, ensure heater valves are open.
1. Turn mid-level/defrost vent control switch (4) to full CCW position.
0035-3
TM 9-2320-339-10
0035
INTERAXLE
8X8
B.O.
LIGHTS
PULL TO
EXHAUST
LER
TRAI SUPPKINLYG
AIR PAR D
FOR
NOT MIDLAN
S UPPLY
B.O.
SELECT
PUS O
HT
CHEM
ALARM
GPPU
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
M
M
1
2
ASS
HIGH
IDLE
nn
smissio
ATranlliso
Figure 2.
2. Position temperature control switch (1) to desired setting.
3. Set fan switch (2) to desired setting:
a. Off - full CCW.
b. Low - one position CW from off.
c.
0035-4
TM 9-2320-339-10
0035
NOTE
Close heater valves to improve the efficiency of cabin air
conditioning.
Closing the heater valves disables cabin heat.
1. Set air conditioning control switch (6) to on (full CW).
4
1
6
3
INTERAXLE
8X8
B.O.
LIGHTS
PULL TO
EXHAUST
LER
TRAI SUPPKINLYG
AIR FOR PARLAND
NOT MID
S UPPLY
B.O.
SELECT
PUS O
HT
CHEM
ALARM
GPPU
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
M
M
1
2
ASS
HIGH
IDLE
nn
smissio
ATranlliso
Figure 3.
2. Set fan switch (2) to desired setting:
a. Off - full CCW.
b. Low - one position CW from off.
c.
0035-5
TM 9-2320-339-10
0035
Turning the mid-level/defrost vent control switch (4) full CW turns maximum airflow
to mid-level vents and shuts off all airflow to defrost vents.
5. Position floor vent control switch (5) as desired to control airflow to the floor vents:
a. Turning the floor vent control switch (5) full CCW directs maximum airflow to floor
vents.
b. Turning the floor vent control switch (5) CW causes a relative decrease in airflow.
c.
Turning the floor vent control switch (5) full CW shuts airflow to foot vents off.
0035-6
TM 9-2320-339-10
0036
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
OPERATE FIRE EXTINGUISHER
INITIAL SETUP:
Not Applicable
NOTE
Fire extinguisher is located on rear of heater compartment between driver
and passenger seats.
1. Pull up top clamp (1) and disengage from top hook (2).
1
3
Figure 1.
2. Pull up bottom clamp (3) and disengage from bottom hook (4).
3. Remove fire extinguisher (5) from bracket (6).
0036-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
0036
NOTE
Fire extinguisher is located on driver side just between No. 2 axle wheel
and fuel tank, on top of tool box.
1. Pull up clamp (1) and unhook from strap (2).
4
Figure 2.
2. Remove fire extinguisher (3) from bracket (4).
REMOVE FIRE EXTINGUISHER FROM BATTERY BOX
NOTE
Fire extinguisher is located on passenger side, affixed on rear side of the
shelf where the battery box is mounted.
1. Pull up clamp (1) and unhook strap (2).
0036-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
0036
1
3
Figure 3.
2. Remove fire extinguisher (3) from bracket (4).
EXTINGUISH FIRE
NOTE
Fire extinguisher is a dry chemical type. Refer to MSDS for specific
extinguisher warnings and cautions for use.
Remember the word PASS to operate fire extinguisher:
.
1. Hold fire extinguisher (1) upright and pull safety pin (2) to break plastic tie (3).
0036-3
TM 9-2320-339-10
0036
Figure 4.
2. Point nozzle (4) at base of fire.
3. Press down on stop lever (5) and spray discharge in a side-to-side motion at base of
fire.
4. Let go of stop lever (5) when fire is out.
5. Notify field level maintenance to replace fire extinguisher.
INSTALL FIRE EXTINGUISHER IN CAB
1. Put neck of fire extinguisher (1) on bracket (2).
0036-4
TM 9-2320-339-10
0036
3
5
Figure 5.
2. Hook top clamp (3) on top hook (4) and push top clamp (3) down, tightening strap.
3. Hook bottom clamp (5) on bottom hook (6) and push bottom clamp (5) down, tightening
strap.
INSTALL FIRE EXTINGUISHER ON DRIVER SIDE TOOL BOX
NOTE
Fire extinguisher is located on driver side just between No. 3 axle wheel
and fuel tank, on top of stowage box.
1. Place fire extinguisher (1) on bracket (2).
0036-5
TM 9-2320-339-10
Figure 6.
2. Hook strap (3) onto clamp (4).
3
4
Figure 7.
3. Push clamp (4) down, securing strap (3).
0036-6
0036
TM 9-2320-339-10
0036
4
1
2
Figure 8.
2. Hook strap (3) onto clamp (4).
3. Push clamp (4) down, securing strap (3).
END OF TASK
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0036-7
TM 9-2320-339-10
0037
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
OPERATE ACCESS LADDER
INITIAL SETUP:
Not Applicable
2
4
Figure 1.
2. Remove access ladder (3) from over battery box (4).
NOTE
Front skid plate has two sets of mounting holes centered on both driver
side and passenger side windshield.
3. Install access ladder (3) hooks (5) in front (driver or passenger side) skid plate mounting
holes (6), driver side charge air cooler mounting holes (8), or passenger side radiator
grill mounting holes (7), as required.
0037-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
0037
8
5
3
Figure 2.
STOW ACCESS LADDER
1. Secure access ladder (1) above battery box (2).
0037-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
0037
4
3
Figure 3.
2. Hook stowage rod (3) around access ladder (1) and attach spring (4).
END OF TASK
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0037-3
TM 9-2320-339-10
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
OPERATE DRAIN PLUG
INITIAL SETUP:
Not Applicable
NOTE
There are two drain plugs. One located on each side of cab floor, just
below operator/crew seats.
1. Pull up on lever (1).
Figure 1.
2. Remove drain plug (2) to drain any liquid from floor of cab.
INSTALL DRAIN PLUG
1. Push drain plug (2) in opening on cab floor.
0038-1
0038
TM 9-2320-339-10
Figure 2.
2. Press down on lever (1) to secure drain plug (2).
END OF TASK
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0038-2
0038
TM 9-2320-339-10
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
OPERATE AIR SUSPENSION DUMP VALVE
INITIAL SETUP:
Not Applicable
CAUTION
Ensure all tools and equipment are removed from 'pinch points' in
suspension as vehicle will lower to suspension stops. Failure to
comply may result in damage to equipment.
Never operate vehicle with suspension dumped (deflated) during
normal driving operations. Failure to comply may result in damage to
equipment.
Do not dump (deflate) vehicle air suspension system when spare tire
is attached to tire carrier and in contact with the ground. Failure to
comply may result in damage to equipment.
NOTE
Refer to operate air suspension ball valves (WP 0042) for further information on ball valve operation.
1. Position all required (air springs to be dumped) ball valves to ON. (WP 0042)
NOTE
Suspension dump valve requires 70 psi (4.8 bar) of air in vehicle rear air
system to function. If rear air system has less than 70 psi (4.8 bar) reading
on rear air pressure gauge, suspension dump valve will not dump (deflate) the vehicle air suspension system.
2. Ensure rear air pressure gauge (1) reads at least 70 psi (4.8 bar).
0039-1
0039
TM 9-2320-339-10
CHEM
ALARM
INTER
AXLE
8X8
0039
25
22
15
11
8
6.2
5.5
3.7
2.7
2.0
IN H20 kPa
FILTER MINDER
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
B.O
SELECT
GPFU
B.O
LIGHTS
PARKING
BRAKE
HIGH
IDLE
1
2
TRAILER
AIR SUPPLY
0
1
2
AIR BRAKE
Figure 1.
3. If rear air pressure gauge (1) reads less that 70 psi (4.8 bar), start engine (WP 0043)
and allow air system to recharge.
NOTE
The operator can choose to dump (deflate) one to all four zones of
air springs by positioning appropriate ball valves to OFF (on air
springs desired to remain inflated) prior to pushing in suspension
dump valve button.
Suspension dump valve will not dump (deflate) any suspension air
springs that have ball valves positioned OFF.
4. Remove pin (2) from suspension dump valve, and push suspension dump valve button
(3) in.
0039-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
0039
Figure 2.
NOTE
All air springs with ball valves positioned ON will dump (deflate).
Suspension dump valve button will remain in PUSH TO DUMP
position.
5. (If required) tag suspension dump valve to ensure no personnel service (inflate) air
suspension.
SERVICE (INFLATE) AIR SUSPENSION
CAUTION
Ensure vehicle has adequate overhead clearance prior to servicing
(inflating) air suspension bags. Vehicle will raise approximately 4 in.
(10 cm) when air springs transition from deflated to fully inflated.
Failure to comply may result in damage to equipment.
Never operate vehicle with suspension dumped (deflated) during
normal driving operations. Failure to comply may result in damage to
equipment.
0039-3
TM 9-2320-339-10
0039
NOTE
If possible, start engine (WP 0043) and idle during air suspension
servicing.
Refer to operate air suspension ball valves (WP 0042) for further
information on ball valve operation.
1. Ensure all (air springs to be serviced) ball valves are positioned ON. (WP 0042)
NOTE
Servicing (inflating) a dumped (deflated) suspension system requires approximately 70 psi (4.8 bar) of air from vehicle rear air system. If rear air
system has less than 70 psi (4.8 bar) reading on rear air pressure gauge,
suspension may not fully inflate.
2. Ensure rear air pressure gauge (1) reads at least 70 psi (4.8 bar).
CHEM
ALARM
INTER
AXLE
8X8
25
22
15
11
8
6.2
5.5
3.7
2.7
2.0
IN H20 kPa
FILTER MINDER
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
B.O
SELECT
GPFU
B.O
LIGHTS
PARKING
BRAKE
HIGH
IDLE
1
2
TRAILER
AIR SUPPLY
0
1
2
AIR BRAKE
Figure 3.
3. If rear air pressure gauge (1) reads less that 70 psi (4.8 bar), start vehicle and allow air
system to recharge.
NOTE
The operator can choose to service (inflate) one to all four zones of
air springs by positioning appropriate ball valves to OFF (on air
springs desired to remain deflated) prior to pushing in suspension
dump valve button.
Suspension dump valve will not service (inflate) any suspension air
springs that have ball valves positioned OFF.
0039-4
TM 9-2320-339-10
0039
4. Pull suspension dump valve button (3) out. All air springs with ball valves (1) positioned
ON will service (inflate). Insert pin (2) in suspension dump valve to lock suspension
dump valve button (3) in OUT FOR SERVICE position.
Figure 4.
CAUTION
Vehicle should never be operated with any zone of vehicle air suspension
dumped (deflated). Failure to comply may result in damage to equipment.
5. Ensure that SPSN LOW AIR indicator (4) has gone out prior to resuming normal vehicle
operation. If SPSN LOW AIR indicator (4) is illuminated, there may be at least one zone
of air suspension system that has a ball valve in OFF position:
0039-5
TM 9-2320-339-10
0039
4
CHEM
ALARM
INTER
AXLE
8X8
25
22
15
11
8
6.2
5.5
3.7
2.7
2.0
IN H20 kPa
FILTER MINDER
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
B.O
SELECT
GPFU
B.O
LIGHTS
PARKING
BRAKE
HIGH
IDLE
1
2
TRAILER
AIR SUPPLY
0
1
2
AIR BRAKE
Figure 5.
a. Complete Steps (1) and (2) of this procedure again.
b. If SPSN LOW AIR indicator (4) remains illuminated, notify field level maintenance.
END OF TASK
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0039-6
TM 9-2320-339-10
0040
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
OPERATE TIRE CARRIER
INITIAL SETUP:
Not Applicable
CAUTION
Ensure the passenger side of the vehicle has 6 ft. (1.83 m) of
clearance from the battery box forward to accommodate the tire
carrier lowering or damage to equipment may occur.
Do not dump (deflate) vehicle air suspension system (WP 0039)
when spare tire is attached to tire carrier and in contact with the
ground. Failure to comply may result in damage to equipment.
Do not add a significant amount of weight to the vehicle when spare
tire is attached to tire carrier and in contact with the ground. Failure
to comply may result in damage to equipment.
NOTE
This procedure is a two soldier task.
Lowering the tire carrier requires approximately 10 psi (1 bar) of air
from the vehicle rear air system.
1. Remove access ladder from stowage and connect to passenger side front fender. (WP
0037)
2. Disconnect safety pin (1) from right lock rod (2). Leave safety pin (1) hang from its
lanyard (3).
0040-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
0040
Figure 1.
CAUTION
The tire carrier lock rods are a snag hazard to the movement of the tire
carrier and must be properly stowed in stowage brackets prior to lowering
the tire carrier. Failure to properly stow tire carrier lock rods prior to lowering operation may result in damage to equipment.
3. Turn left lock rod (4) CCW until enough slack is made to push left lock rod (4) up and
into its stowage bracket (5).
0040-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
0040
Figure 2.
4. Turn right lock rod (6) CCW until enough slack is made to push right lock rod (6) up and
into its stowage bracket (7).
Figure 3.
0040-3
TM 9-2320-339-10
0040
WARNING
If tire carrier is in any position other than full up and locked (tire carrier
latch engaged) or resting on ground, only tire carrier pump operator
should be within six feet (1.83 m) of passenger side of vehicle from battery
box forward. Failure to comply may result in personnel being struck by
tire carrier/spare tire, causing injury or death to personnel.
5. Ensure safety area clear of personnel and equipment. Assistant will stand outside the
safety area and ensure no personnel wander into safety area while lowering operation
is taking place.
SAFETY
AREA
6 FT (1.83m)
SAFETY AREA
Figure 4.
6. Set directional control lever (8) to LOWER (pointing outboard) position.
0040-4
TM 9-2320-339-10
0040
8
9
Figure 5.
NOTE
The operator will notice a small amount of oil being expelled with the air
from the tire carrier pump each time it cycles, this is a normal condition.
7. Press and hold power control (9). The tire carrier pump cyclic rate will be rapid at first,
and then slow noticeably. As cyclic rate slows, the operator should notice the tire carrier
begin to move.
CAUTION
Once tire is in contact with the ground, do not press power control with
directional control lever in LOWER (pointing outboard) position. This may
put undue stress on tire carrier. Failure to comply may result in damage
to equipment.
0040-5
TM 9-2320-339-10
0040
NOTE
The tire carrier can be stopped at any time during lowering operations by
releasing the power control and moving the directional control lever to
RAISE (pointing inboard) position.
8. Once tire carrier has passed vertical (approximately 6 in. [15.24 cm] of movement),
release power control (9) and allow the tire carrier to lower on its own until tire contacts
ground.
9. Set directional control lever (8) to RAISE (pointing inboard) position.
RAISE TIRE CARRIER
CAUTION
Ensure the passenger side of the vehicle has 6 ft. (1.83 m) of clearance
from the battery box forward to accommodate the tire carrier raising or
damage to equipment may occur.
NOTE
This procedure is a two soldier task.
Raising the tire carrier requires approximately 70 psi (5 bar) of air
from the vehicle rear air system. If possible, the operator should start
engine (WP 0043) and let idle during raise operation to ensure adequate supply of air.
1. If vehicle is not idling, set ignition switch (1) to on position , and check the following:
2
CHEM
ALARM
INTER
AXLE
25
22
15
11
8
8X8
6.2
5.5
3.7
2.7
2.0
IN H20 kPa
FILTER MINDER
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
B.O
SELECT
GPFU
B.O
LIGHTS
PARKING
BRAKE
HIGH
IDLE
1
2
TRAILER
AIR SUPPLY
0
1
2
AIR BRAKE
Figure 6.
0040-6
TM 9-2320-339-10
0040
CAUTION
Ensure the passenger side top engine access cover is closed and secured prior to raising the tire carrier with spare tire installed. If access
cover is braced open, spare tire will contact it and cause damage to the
cover as well as prevent the tire carrier from locking in full up position.
NOTE
If passenger side top engine access cover is open and laying flat, the tire
(in the full up position) will not allow the access cover to be closed.
3. Ensure passenger side top engine access cover is secured closed.
CAUTION
The tire carrier lock rods are a snag hazard to the movement of the tire
carrier and must be properly stowed in stowage brackets prior to lowering
the tire carrier. Failure to properly stow tire carrier lock rods prior to lowering operation may result in damage to equipment.
4. Ensure left lock rod (4) is properly stowed in stowage bracket (5).
0040-7
TM 9-2320-339-10
0040
Figure 7.
5. Ensure right lock rod (6) is properly stowed in stowage bracket (7).
WARNING
If tire carrier is in any position other than full up and locked (tire carrier
latch engaged) or resting on ground, only tire carrier pump operator
should be within six feet (1.83 m) of passenger side of vehicle from battery
box forward. Failure to comply may result in personnel being struck by
tire carrier/spare tire, causing injury or death to personnel.
6. Ensure safety area is clear of personnel and equipment. Assistant will stand outside
the safety area and ensure no personnel wander into safety area while raising operation
is taking place.
0040-8
TM 9-2320-339-10
SAFETY
AREA
6 FT (1.83m)
SAFETY AREA
Figure 8.
7. Set directional control lever (8) to RAISE (pointing inboard) position.
0040-9
0040
TM 9-2320-339-10
0040
8
9
Figure 9.
NOTE
The operator will notice a small amount of oil being expelled with the
air from the tire carrier pump each time it cycles, this is a normal
condition.
When the power control is pressed, the tire carrier pump cyclic rate
will be rapid at first, and then slow noticeably. As cyclic rate slows,
the operator should notice the tire carrier begin to move.
8. Press and hold power control (9).
NOTE
The tire carrier can be stopped at any time during raising operations
by releasing power control.
0040-10
TM 9-2320-339-10
0040
As the tire carrier is raised, the tire carrier pump will begin to cycle at
an increased rate.
9. Continue to raise tire carrier until it is in the full up position. The operator will notice a
significant slow down in the tire carrier pump cyclic rate. Release power control (9).
WARNING
Always maintain a distance of six feet (1.83 m) until confirmation that tire
carrier latch is engaged. Failure to comply may result in personnel being
struck by tire carrier/spare tire causing severe injury or death to personnel.
10. Maintaining a safe distance of 6 ft. (1.83 m), the assistant will check the tire carrier latch
(10), ensuring it has fully engaged the tire carrier arm bar (11).
11
10
Figure 10.
11. With the assistant maintaining the safety area, the operator will proceed to the driver
side cabin and check to ensure the SPARE TIRE LOOSE indicator (2) has gone out.
0040-11
TM 9-2320-339-10
0040
2
CHEM
ALARM
INTER
AXLE
8X8
25
22
15
11
8
6.2
5.5
3.7
2.7
2.0
IN H20 kPa
FILTER MINDER
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
B.O
SELECT
GPFU
B.O
LIGHTS
PARKING
BRAKE
HIGH
IDLE
1
2
TRAILER
AIR SUPPLY
0
1
2
AIR BRAKE
Figure 11.
NOTE
If tire carrier latch is fully engaged, and SPARE TIRE LOOSE indicator light has gone out, skip to Step (15).
If tire carrier latch fails to fully engage tire carrier bar, or SPARE TIRE
LOOSE indicator fails to go out, perform Steps (12) through (14).
12. Set directional control lever (8) to LOWER (pointing outboard) position.
0040-12
TM 9-2320-339-10
0040
8
9
Figure 12.
13. Press power control (9) until tire carrier lowers approximately 1 ft. (30 cm).
14. Repeat Steps (7) through (11).
NOTE
If tire carrier latch is fully engaged, and SPARE TIRE LOOSE indicator
light has gone out, complete Steps (15) through (20).
15. Remove right lock rod (6) from stowage bracket (7) and pull down to end of groove (12)
until it stops. Turn right lock rod (6) CW until it is hand tight, with jointed end (13) across
tire carrier arm (14).
0040-13
TM 9-2320-339-10
15
0040
17
13
7
16
12
14
Figure 13.
16. Remove left lock rod (4) from stowage bracket (5), locate washer (15) and pull towards
left lock rod (4) until it stops. Pull both left lock rod (4) and washer (15) down to end of
groove (16). Turn left lock rod (4) CW until it is hand tight, with jointed end (17) pointed
towards tire carrier arm (14).
17. Insert safety pin (18) through hole located on right lock rod jointed end (13).
0040-14
TM 9-2320-339-10
0040
18
13
Figure 14.
NOTE
Tire carrier directional control lever should always be in LOWER position
for vehicle operation.
18. Set directional control lever (8) to LOWER (pointing outboard) position.
0040-15
TM 9-2320-339-10
0040
Figure 15.
19. Shut off engine (WP 0056) or set ignition switch (1) to off position (as applicable).
0040-16
TM 9-2320-339-10
CHEM
ALARM
0040
INTER
AXLE
25
22
15
11
8
8X8
6.2
5.5
3.7
2.7
2.0
IN H20 kPa
FILTER MINDER
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
B.O
SELECT
GPFU
B.O
LIGHTS
PARKING
BRAKE
HIGH
IDLE
1
2
TRAILER
AIR SUPPLY
0
1
2
AIR BRAKE
Figure 16.
20. Stow access ladder. (WP 0037)
END OF TASK
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0040-17
TM 9-2320-339-10
0041
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
OPERATE INSTRUMENT PANEL
INITIAL SETUP:
Not Applicable
GENERAL
Instrument panel on HEMTT A4 series vehicle incorporates electronic gauges, indicator
lights, and liquid crystal display LCD to communicate information to operator. LCD has
multiple modes and functions.
LCD can display odometer reading as well as testing gauges and indicator lights. LCD can
also be set to display measured units in English or Metric.
INSTRUMENT PANEL MODES
Sleep Mode: Instrument panel is normally in sleep mode when ignition switch (1) is turned
off. No gauges, indicator lights, or LCD screen (2) will operate in this mode.
2
CHEM
ALARM
INTER
AXLE
25
22
15
11
8
8X8
6.2
5.5
3.7
2.7
2.0
IN H20 kPa
FILTER MINDER
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
B.O
SELECT
GPFU
B.O
LIGHTS
PARKING
BRAKE
HIGH
IDLE
1
2
3
TRAILER
AIR SUPPLY
0
1
2
3
AIR BRAKE
Figure 1.
0041-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
0041
Limited Mode: If turn signal lever (3) or panel dimmer switch (4) is actuated, instrument
panel goes into limited mode. In limited mode, turn signals, odometer on LCD (2), and fuel
gauge (5) are active. Remaining gauges will go to zero.
Start-up Mode: Instrument panel enters start-up mode when ignition switch (1) is positioned
on. After key-on, an optional gauge start-up self test (SST) may be performed. Operator
can enable or disable SST by pressing and holding both M (mode) button (6) and trip T (trip)
button (7) while setting ignition switch (1) to on position. A screen will be displayed that
allows operator to enable SST (Yes) or disable SST (No).
6
CHEM
ALARM
INTER
AXLE
8X8
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
HIGH
IDLE
1
2
3
B.O
SELECT
GPFU
B.O
LIGHTS
0
1
2
Figure 2.
During start-up mode:
With SST disabled, gauges will go to zero and move to current status positions.
With SST enabled, gauges move upscale, pausing at half scale before going to full
scale. Gauges will go to zero before moving to current status positions.
LCD (2) will display any warning messages and will then display odometer, trip
odometer, engine hour meter, and battery voltage readings. LCD (2) will revert to
normal drive mode screen. If SST is enabled, LCD (2) will also turn on and off,
followed by OSHKOSH logo, and finally, software information before going to
normal drive mode screen.
Warning lights will turn on and off followed by active warning lights (if any) coming
back on.
With SST disabled, there is no alarm at start-up. With SST enabled, a one second
alarm will sound at start-up.
Ignition Mode: Instrument panel will be in ignition mode whenever ignition switch (1) is
positioned on. Instrument Panel is fully active in this mode.
Diagnostic Mode: From ignition mode with vehicle speed at zero, pressing M button (6)
for more that two seconds allows instrument panel to enter diagnostic mode. This mode
provides following functions.
0041-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
Set units.
Adjust contrast.
Instrument diagnostics.
0041
NOTE
LCD will display warning as dictated by various control systems on vehicle. Warning will remain on screen until warning is no longer valid or, until
operator pushes T (trip) button.
Drive Mode Screen. This is normal display screen when operating vehicle. In drive mode,
LCD (1) will display odometer reading, system voltage reading, and either operating hours
or trip odometer reading. To toggle back and forth between these two options, operator
must press and release M (mode) button (2) in less than two seconds.
2
CHEM
ALARM
INTER
AXLE
8X8
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
HIGH
IDLE
1
2
3
B.O
SELECT
GPFU
B.O
LIGHTS
0
1
2
Figure 3.
Settings and diagnostics. Operator can enter settings and diagnostics menu from drive
mode screen when engine is running and vehicle speed is zero. To enter settings and
diagnostics menu, operator must push M button (2) for more than two seconds. Item
highlighted will be item selected when both M button (2) and T button (3) are pressed
together. Pressing M button (2) or T button (3) separately will scroll through various
selections.
1. To change measurement units.
a. Enter LCD (1) settings and diagnostics screen.
0041-3
TM 9-2320-339-10
0041
CHEM
ALARM
INTER
AXLE
8X8
0-Set Units
1-Contrast
2-Instrument Diagnostics
\/ Select /\
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
HIGH
IDLE
1
2
3
B.O
SELECT
GPFU
B.O
LIGHTS
0
1
2
Figure 4.
b. Scroll down using M button (2) or up using T button (3) until '0-Set Units' is selected
(shown).
c.
Press M button (2) and T button (3) at same time. Current Units screen will appear.
2
CHEM
ALARM
Current Units
ENGLISH
INTER
AXLE
8X8
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
HIGH
IDLE
1
2
3
GPFU
B.O
SELECT
0
1
2
Figure 5.
d. Press T button (3) to change measurement units to English or Metric.
e. Press M button (2) to return LCD (1) to drive mode screen.
2. To change LCD screen contrast setting.
a. Enter LCD (1) settings and diagnostics screen.
0041-4
B.O
LIGHTS
TM 9-2320-339-10
0041
CHEM
ALARM
0-Set Units
1-Contrast
2-Instrument Diagnostics
\/ Select /\
INTER
AXLE
8X8
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
HIGH
IDLE
1
2
B.O
SELECT
GPFU
B.O
LIGHTS
0
1
2
Figure 6.
b. Scroll down using M button (2) or up using T button (3) until '1-Contrast' is selected
(shown).
c.
Press M button (2) and T button (3) at same time. CONTRAST ADJUST screen will
appear.
2
CHEM
ALARM
INTER
AXLE
8X8
CONTRAST ADJUST
+
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
GPFU
HIGH
IDLE
1
2
3
0
1
2
Figure 7.
d. Press M button (2) to increase LCD (1) contrast.
e. Press T button (3) to decrease LCD (1) contrast.
f.
0041-5
B.O
SELECT
B.O
LIGHTS
TM 9-2320-339-10
0041
CHEM
ALARM
0-Set Units
1-Contrast
2-Instrument Diagnostics
\/ Select /\
INTER
AXLE
8X8
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
HIGH
IDLE
1
2
3
B.O
SELECT
GPFU
B.O
LIGHTS
0
1
2
Figure 8.
b. Scroll down using M button (2) or up using T button (3) until '2-Instrument
Diagnostics' is selected (shown).
c.
Press M button (2) and T button (3) at same time. Instrument diagnostic screen will
appear.
2
CHEM
ALARM
INTER
AXLE
8X8
0-Gauge Test
1-Lamp Test
2-LCD Test
\/ Select /\
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
HIGH
IDLE
1
2
3
GPFU
B.O
SELECT
B.O
LIGHTS
0
1
2
Figure 9.
d. Scroll down using M button (2) or up using T button (3) until '0-Gauge Test' is
selected (shown).
e. Press M button (2) and T button (3) together to begin testing gauges (fuel gauge
test shown). Each gauge is tested in turn at 0%, 50%, and 100%. LCD (1) displays
corresponding percentage.
0041-6
TM 9-2320-339-10
0041
Fuel Level
CHEM
ALARM
INTER
AXLE
8X8
EXIT
0%
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
B.O
SELECT
GPFU
B.O
LIGHTS
Fuel Level
M
EXIT
1
2
3
50%
HIGH
IDLE
0
1
2
Fuel Level
EXIT
100%
Figure 10.
f.
Press M button (2) to end test and return LCD (1) to drive mode screen.
CHEM
ALARM
0-Set Units
1-Contrast
2-Instrument Diagnostics
\/ Select /\
INTER
AXLE
8X8
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
HIGH
IDLE
1
2
3
GPFU
B.O
SELECT
B.O
LIGHTS
0
1
2
Figure 11.
b. Scroll down using M button (2) or up using T button (3) until '2-Instrument
Diagnostics' is selected (shown).
c.
Press M button (2) and T button (3) at same time. Instrument diagnostic screen will
appear.
0041-7
TM 9-2320-339-10
0041
CHEM
ALARM
0-Gauge Test
1-Lamp Test
2-LCD Test
\/ Select /\
INTER
AXLE
8X8
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
HIGH
IDLE
1
2
3
B.O
SELECT
GPFU
B.O
LIGHTS
0
1
2
Figure 12.
d. Scroll down using M button (2) or up using T button (3) until '1-Lamp Test' is selected
(shown).
e. Press M button (2) and T button (3) together to begin testing warning and indicator
lamps. Each warning and indicator lamp on main gauge/instrument panel is turned
on and off in turn. LCD (1) displays corresponding warning or indicator lamp under
test (high beam indicator test shown).
CHEM
ALARM
INTER
AXLE
8X8
High Beam
AUX
HYD
EXIT
HYD
ENABLE
B.O
SELECT
B.O
LIGHTS
ON
M
High Beam
EXIT
GPFU
HIGH
IDLE
1
2
3
0
1
2
OFF
Figure 13.
f.
Press M button (2) to end test and return LCD (1) to drive mode screen.
NOTE
Instrument panel LCD is used as part of test procedure. If LCD is unreadable during any part of test, it should be considered defective and
replaced.
5. Instrument Panel Liquid Crystal Display (LCD) Testing.
0041-8
TM 9-2320-339-10
0041
CHEM
ALARM
0-Set Units
1-Contrast
2-Instrument Diagnostics
\/ Select /\
INTER
AXLE
8X8
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
HIGH
IDLE
1
2
3
B.O
SELECT
GPFU
B.O
LIGHTS
0
1
2
Figure 14.
b. Scroll down using M button (2) or up using T button (3) until '2-Instrument
Diagnostics' is selected (shown).
c.
Press M button (2) and T button (3) at same time. Instrument diagnostic screen will
appear.
2
CHEM
ALARM
INTER
AXLE
8X8
0-Gauge Test
1-Lamp Test
2-LCD Test
\/ Select /\
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
HIGH
IDLE
1
2
3
GPFU
B.O
SELECT
B.O
LIGHTS
0
1
2
Figure 15.
d. Scroll down using M button (2) or up using T button (3) until '2-LCD Test' is selected
(shown).
e. Press M button (2) and T button (3) together to begin testing LCD (1). Display should
alternate between normal (shown-top) and negative (shown-bottom) mode three
times before returning to drive mode screen.
0041-9
TM 9-2320-339-10
0041
CHEM
ALARM
INTER
AXLE
8X8
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
HIGH
IDLE
1
2
3
GPFU
B.O
SELECT
B.O
LIGHTS
0
1
2
Figure 16.
f.
Contact field level maintenance to replace main gauge/instrument panel if LCD (1)
fails to illuminate as shown and described in Step (f).
END OF TASK
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0041-10
TM 9-2320-339-10
0042
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
OPERATE AIR SUSPENSION BALL VALVES
INITIAL SETUP:
Not Applicable
CAUTION
Never operate vehicle with suspension dumped (deflated) during
normal driving operations. Failure to comply may result in damage to
equipment.
Never operate vehicle with one or more ball valves positioned OFF.
Failure to comply may result in damage to equipment.
NOTE
Vehicle is equipped with four ball valves, one on top of each air spring
on No. 1 and No. 4 axles. Each ball valve controls two air springs
(zone).
No. 1 axle driver side ball valve controls both No. 1 and No. 2 axle
air springs (zone) for that side of vehicle.
No. 1 axle passenger side ball valve controls both No. 1 and No. 2
axle air springs (zone) for that side of vehicle.
No. 4 axle driver side ball valve controls both No. 4 and No. 3 axle
air springs (zone) for that side of vehicle.
No. 4 axle passenger side ball valve controls both No. 4 and No. 3
axle air springs (zone) for that side of vehicle.
1. Position ball valve (1) ON (shown):
a. Pull lock (2) towards handle (3) and push handle (3) in until parallel with ball valve
(1).
0042-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
0042
Figure 1.
b. Release lock (2), and gently move handle (3) back and forth until lock is engaged.
NOTE
Refer to operate air suspension dump valve (WP 0039) for more information on air suspension servicing/dumping procedures.
2. Repeat Step (1) as necessary on remaining ball valves (1).
TURN BALL VALVES OFF
CAUTION
Never operate vehicle with suspension dumped (deflated) during
normal driving operations. Failure to comply may result in damage to
equipment.
0042-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
0042
Never operate vehicle with one or more ball valves positioned OFF.
Failure to comply may result in damage to equipment.
NOTE
Vehicle is equipped with four ball valves, one on top of each air spring
on No. 1 and No. 4 axles. Each ball valve controls two air springs
(zone).
No. 1 axle driver side ball valve controls both No. 1 and No. 2 axle
air springs (zone) for that side of vehicle.
No. 1 axle passenger side ball valve controls both No. 1 and No. 2
axle air springs (zone) for that side of vehicle.
No. 4 axle driver side ball valve controls both No. 4 and No. 3 axle
air springs (zone) for that side of vehicle.
No. 4 axle passenger side ball valve controls both No. 4 and No. 3
axle air springs (zone) for that side of vehicle.
1. Position ball valve (1) OFF (shown):
a. Pull lock (2) towards handle (3) and push handle (3) until at 90 degree angle with
ball valve (1).
0042-3
TM 9-2320-339-10
0042
Figure 2.
b. Release lock (2), and gently move handle (3) back and forth until lock is engaged.
NOTE
Refer to operate air suspension dump valve (WP 0039) for more information on air suspension servicing/dumping procedures.
2. Repeat Step (1) as necessary on remaining ball valves (1).
END OF TASK
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0042-4
TM 9-2320-339-10
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
START ENGINE
INITIAL SETUP:
Not Applicable
WARNING
Do not start, crank engine, or move vehicle when anyone is near, working
on, or working under vehicle. Failure to comply may result in injury or
death to personnel.
WARNING
Keep away from moving engine parts, alternator belts, and pulleys while
engine is running. Failure to comply may result in injury or death to personnel.
NOTE
Ensure that 24V battery disconnect switch is set to ON position (WP
0075) before attempting to start engine.
Dashboard parking brake indicator will illuminate when PARKING
BRAKE control is applied.
1. Pull out PARKING BRAKE control (1).
0043-1
0043
TM 9-2320-339-10
0043
2
INTERAXLE
8X8
B.O.
LIGHTS
PULL TO
B.O.
SELECT
EXHAUST
ER
LY
TRAILSUPPKING
AIR PAR
SUPPLY
FOR AND
NOT MIDL
PU S H T O
CHEM
ALARM
GPPU
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
M
M
12
ASS
HIGH
IDLE
AlTranlissmisonsion
Figure 1.
2. Set ignition switch (2) to ON position.
3. Set transmission range selector (3) to N (neutral).
NOTE
Perform Step (4) up to seven times. If engine does not start after eight
attempts, notify field level maintenance.
4. Push engine start switch (4) for no longer than 15 seconds, or until engine starts.
NOTE
Engine start switch will spring back to off position when released.
Brake system failure (LOW AIR) indicator may illuminate and buzzer
may sound upon engine start.
5. Release engine start switch (4) immediately after engine starts.
CAUTION
Do not position engine start switch to start position while motor is
running. Failure to comply may result in damage to equipment.
If engine fails to start, repeat Step (4) up to seven times. If engine
doesn't start after eight starting attempts, notify field level
maintenance.
If oil pressure gauge does not show engine oil pressure within 10 to
15 seconds after starting engine, immediately shut off engine (WP
0056) and notify field level maintenance. Failure to comply may result
in damage to equipment.
0043-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
0043
6. With engine at idle (625-725 rpm), check that engine oil pressure gauge (5) reads 15-88
psi (1.03-6.07 bar).
11
CHEM
ALARM
INTER
AXLE
25
22
15
11
8
8X8
6.2
5.5
3.7
2.7
2.0
IN H20 kPa
FILTER MINDER
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
B.O
SELECT
GPFU
B.O
LIGHTS
PARKING
BRAKE
HIGH
IDLE
1
2
TRAILER
AIR SUPPLY
0
1
2
10
AIR BRAKE
6
Figure 2.
7. Press throttle pedal (6) until tachometer (7) reads 800-1000 rpm.
8. Run engine at 800-1000 rpm for about 5 minutes.
CAUTION
If FRONT and REAR air pressure gauges do not read 60 to 120 psi (4 to
8 bar) after warm-up, shut off engine (WP 0056) and notify field level
maintenance. Failure to comply may result in damage to equipment.
9. Check that FRONT (8) and REAR (9) air pressure gauges read 60 to 120 psi (4 to 8
bar). Brake system failure (LOW AIR) indicator (10) will illuminate and buzzer may
sound until both gauges reach 60 to 75 psi (4 to 5 bar).
10. Check that fuel gauge (11) shows enough fuel to complete mission.
NOTE
Engine coolant temperature gauge may not show reading at engine idle.
11. Check that engine coolant temperature gauge (12) does not read over 219F (104C).
0043-3
TM 9-2320-339-10
0043
13
14
CHEM
ALARM
INTER
AXLE
8X8
25
22
15
11
8
6.2
5.5
3.7
2.7
2.0
IN H20 kPa
FILTER MINDER
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
B.O
SELECT
GPFU
B.O
LIGHTS
243v
PARKING
BRAKE
HIGH
IDLE
1
2
15
TRAILER
AIR SUPPLY
0
1
2
12
AIR BRAKE
Figure 3.
NOTE
Battery voltage readout is located in the top right corner of the LCD.
12. Check that battery voltage readout (13) reads between 24 and 28 volts.
13. Check that air filter restriction indicator (14) shows yellow.
14. If air filter restriction indicator (14) shows red, press and release RESET button (15).
WARNING
NOTE
Bouncing or jarring of indicator may put indicator in red zone while air
cleaner elements are still good. Turn engine off and press reset button to
recheck indicator.
15. If air filter restriction indicator (14) still shows red and/or VACUUM INCHES H2O
window shows 18, shut off engine (WP 0056) and clean air filter elements. (WP 0151)
0043-4
TM 9-2320-339-10
WARNING
Do not start, crank engine, or move vehicle when anyone is near, working
on, or working under vehicle. Failure to comply may result in injury or
death to personnel.
WARNING
Keep away from moving engine parts, alternator belts, and pulleys while
engine is running. Failure to comply may result in injury or death to personnel.
NOTE
Ensure that 24V battery disconnect switch is set to ON position (WP
0075) before attempting to start engine.
Dashboard parking brake indicator will illuminate when PARKING
BRAKE control is applied.
1. Pull out PARKING BRAKE control (1).
0043-5
0043
TM 9-2320-339-10
0043
2
INTERAXLE
8X8
B.O.
LIGHTS
PULL TO
B.O.
SELECT
EXHAUST
ER
LY
TRAILSUPPKING
AIR PAR
SUPPLY
FOR AND
NOT MIDL
PU S H T O
CHEM
ALARM
GPPU
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
M
M
12
ASS
HIGH
IDLE
AlTranlissmisonsion
Figure 4.
2. Set ignition switch (2) to ON position.
3. Set transmission range selector (3) to N (neutral).
NOTE
Perform Step (4) up to seven times. If engine does not start after eight
attempts, notify field level maintenance.
4. Push engine start switch (4) for no longer than 10 seconds, or until engine starts.
NOTE
Engine start switch will spring back to off position when released.
Brake system failure (LOW AIR) indicator may illuminate and buzzer
may sound upon engine start.
5. Release engine start switch (4) immediately after engine starts.
CAUTION
If engine oil pressure gauge does not show engine oil pressure within 10
to 15 seconds after starting engine, shut off engine (WP 0056) immediately and notify field level maintenance. Failure to comply may result in
damage to equipment.
NOTE
Minimum engine oil pressure for safe operation (vehicle moving) is
30 psi (2 bar).
0043-6
TM 9-2320-339-10
0043
At idle, engine oil pressure can drop as low as 5 psi (0.34 bar), this
is a normal condition.
6. Check that engine oil pressure gauge (5) indicates normal operating range of 40 to 70
psi (2.76 to 4.83 bar) at 1800 to 2100 rpm.
11
12
CHEM
ALARM
INTER
AXLE
25
22
15
11
8
8X8
6.2
5.5
3.7
2.7
2.0
IN H20 kPa
FILTER MINDER
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
B.O
SELECT
GPFU
B.O
LIGHTS
243v
PARKING
BRAKE
HIGH
IDLE
1
2
13
TRAILER
AIR SUPPLY
0
1
2
10
AIR BRAKE
Figure 5.
7. Check that FRONT (6) and REAR (7) air pressure gauges read 60 to 120 psi (4 to 8
bar). Brake system failure (LOW AIR) indicator (8) will illuminate and buzzer may sound
until both gauges reach 60 to 75 psi (4 to 5 bar).
8. Check that fuel gauge (9) shows enough fuel to complete mission.
NOTE
Engine coolant temperature gauge may not show reading at engine idle.
9. Check that engine coolant temperature gauge (10) does not read over 219F (104C).
NOTE
Battery voltage readout is located in the top right corner of the LCD.
10. Check that battery voltage readout (11) reads between 24 and 28 volts.
11. If air filter restriction indicator (12) shows red, press and release RESET button (13).
12. If air filter restriction indicator (12) still shows red and/or VACUUM INCHES H2O
window shows 18, shut off engine (WP 0056) and clean air filter elements. (WP 0151)
END OF TASK
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0043-7
TM 9-2320-339-10
0044
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
OPERATE PARKING BRAKES
INITIAL SETUP:
Not Applicable
NOTE
Vehicle is equipped with automatic parking brake valve (square/yellow knob).
Automatic parking brake valve will apply parking brakes when air
pressure is approximately 30 psi (2 bar) or less.
1. Pull out PARKING BRAKE control (1) to apply, parking brake indicator (2) will illuminate.
INTERAXLE
8X8
B.O.
LIGHTS
EXHAUST
LER
TRAI SUPPKINLYG
AINOTR FORMIDPARLAND
S UPPLY
PULL TO
B.O.
SELECT
PUS O
HT
CHEM
ALARM
GPPU
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
M
M
1
2
ASS
HIGH
IDLE
nn
smissio
ATranlliso
Figure 1.
0044-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
0044
2. Push in PARKING BRAKE control (1) to release, parking brake indicator (2) will go out.
END OF TASK
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0044-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
0045
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
OPERATE SERVICE BRAKES
INITIAL SETUP:
Not Applicable
WARNING
Do not press service brake treadle hard three or four times in a row. Air
supply will be used up and service brakes will not work until air is built up
again. Failure to comply may result in injury or death to personnel.
1. Make sure FRONT (1) and REAR (2) air pressure gauges both read at least 100 psi (7
bar) before operating vehicle.
2. Push down and hold service brake pedal (3) as needed to slow or stop vehicle.
0045-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
CHEM
ALARM
INTER
AXLE
8X8
0045
25
22
15
11
8
6.2
5.5
3.7
2.7
2.0
IN H20 kPa
FILTER MINDER
HYD
ENABLE
AUX
HYD
B.O
SELECT
GPFU
B.O
LIGHTS
PARKING
BRAKE
HIGH
IDLE
1
2
TRAILER
AIR SUPPLY
0
1
2
AIR BRAKE
2
1
Figure 1.
END OF TASK
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0045-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
OPERATE TRAILER BRAKES
INITIAL SETUP:
Not Applicable
WARNING
Trailer handbrake control is used only when testing trailer brakes. Do not
use trailer handbrake control while driving or the trailer may skid and
jackknife, causing an accident. Failure to comply may result in injury or
death to personnel.
1. Slowly pull trailer handbrake control (1) down to test application of trailer brakes.
2. Push trailer handbrake control (1) up to test release of trailer brakes.
0046-1
0046
TM 9-2320-339-10
CHEM
ALARM
0046
INTER
AXLE
25
22
15
11
8
8X8
6.2
5.5
3.7
2.7
2.0
IN H20 kPa
FILTER MINDER
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
B.O
SELECT
GPFU
B.O
LIGHTS
PARKING
BRAKE
HIGH
IDLE
1
2
TRAILER
AIR SUPPLY
0
1
2
AIR BRAKE
Figure 1.
END OF TASK
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0046-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
OPERATE TRANSMISSION AND TRANSFER CASE
INITIAL SETUP:
Not Applicable
OPERATE TRANSMISSION
CAUTION
If transmission range selector flashes current range selection while operating vehicle (shift selection is inhibited), DO NOT shut off engine or
attempt to change range selection. Shutting off engine may result in the
inability to select a drive range at startup, and diagnostic data may be
lost. Move vehicle to safe place and notify field level maintenance as soon
as possible (refer to limp home/transmission fault for more information).
(WP 0111)
NOTE
When transmission oil is below 19F (-7 C), the only gears available
are R (reverse), N (Neutral), and 3 (third gear range) when D (drive)
is selected. The remaining gears in D (drive) will not be available until
transmission oil in sump warms above 19F (-7 C).
The transmission range selector has six buttons and digital display
window. The six buttons are: R (reverse), N (neutral), D (drive), up
arrow, down arrow, and MODE. The transmission has five forward
gears.
The MODE button located on the transmission range selector does
not perform any operator function.
The digital display window on the transmission range selector will
display R (reverse), N (neutral), or the number 1 through 5,
depending on gear range selected.
The lowest gear of any gear range is always first gear.
When transmission is set to D (drive), 5 (fifth gear range) is
automatically chosen and displayed in the digital display window.
When engine brake is activated and vehicle is decelerating, 2
(second gear range) will be displayed in the digital display window.
0047-1
0047
TM 9-2320-339-10
0047
EXHAUST
ER
TRAILSUPPLYING
AIR PARK
SU PP
FOR AND
NOT MIDL
LY
PULL TO
B.O.
LIGHTS
B.O.
SELECT
PU S H T O
CHEM
ALARM
GPPU
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
M
M
12
ASS
HIGH
IDLE
n
AllTransisomission
Figure 1.
b. Park vehicle. (WP 0055)
c.
NOTE
When setting a new transmission operating range, the top gear of the
desired operating range must be chosen and displayed on the transmission range selector digital display.
3. Complete the following if a lower gear range is required:
a. Using the up arrow button (4) or down arrow button (5), adjust the digital display
window (6) until top gear of desired transmission operating range is displayed:
0047-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
0047
NOTE
Once the arrow buttons are used, the transmission will not
upshift past the gear range displayed in the transmission range
selector digital display, but will downshift normally.
4
1
INTERAXLE
8X8
B.O.
LIGHTS
PULL TO
EXHAUST
ER
LY
TRAILSUPPKING
AIR PAR
S U PP
FOR AND
NOT MIDL
LY
B.O.
SELECT
PUSH TO
CHEM
ALARM
GPPU
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
M
M
12
ASS
HIGH
IDLE
AlTranslismissonion
Figure 2.
0047-3
TM 9-2320-339-10
0047
NOTE
Dashboard parking brake indicator will go out when PARKING BRAKE
control is released.
2. Push in PARKING BRAKE control (1).
3. Set transmission range selector (2) to N (neutral).
CAUTION
Do not force TRANSFER CASE shift lever. Lever may work hard if
there is drive line windup. Using excessive force on shift lever may
cause damage to shift linkage or change linkage adjustment.
Do not move TRANSFER CASE shift lever when vehicle is moving,
or when transmission is in gear. Severe damage to drive line may
result.
4. Select transfer case position.
NOTE
If TRANSFER CASE shift lever is hard to move, set transmission range
selector to D, then back to N. If transfer case will not shift, refer to troubleshooting procedures. (WP 0134)
5. Set TRANSFER CASE shift lever (3) to H (HI) for highway driving.
NOTE
Selecting L (LO) position automatically selects 8X8 drive in the vehicle
traction control system.
6. Set TRANSFER CASE shift lever (3) to L (LO) for off-road driving, 8X8 indicator (4) will
illuminate.
END OF TASK
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0047-4
TM 9-2320-339-10
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
OPERATE ENGINE BRAKE
INITIAL SETUP:
Not Applicable
WARNING
NOTE
Service brakes must be used in addition to engine brake for optimum
braking capability.
1. Set engine brake high/medium/low switch (1) to low (full down) position.
0048-1
0048
TM 9-2320-339-10
0048
6
INTERAXLE
8X8
B.O.
LIGHTS
PULL TO
B.O.
SELECT
EXHAUST
ER
LY
TRAILSUPPKING
AIR PAR
SUPPLY
FOR AND
NOT MIDL
PU S H T O
CHEM
ALARM
GPPU
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
M
M
12
3
ASS
HIGH
IDLE
AlTranlissmisonsion
5
4
Figure 1.
2. Set engine brake on/off switch (2) to on (up) position, ENGINE BRAKE ENABLE
indicator (3) will illuminate.
3. Lift foot off throttle pedal (4). Engine brake will automatically slow vehicle.
4. If too much braking occurs, set transmission range selector (5) to a higher range.
5. If more braking is required, set engine brake high/medium/low switch (1) to medium
(center) position, and then high (full up) position (as required).
NOTE
Engine brake operates best when engine speed is between 1650 and
2100 rpm.
6. Check that tachometer (6) reads between 1650 and 2100 rpm whenever engine brake
is used.
END OF TASK
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0048-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
0049
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
DRIVE VEHICLE FORWARD
INITIAL SETUP:
Not Applicable
PREPARE VEHICLE
NOTE
If vehicle has less than 500 miles (805 km), check controls and indicators
often during operation and listen for unusual noises or vibrations. Notify
field level maintenance of any problems.
1. Remove and stow wheel chocks. (WP 0073)
2. Ensure manhole cover is closed and latched.
3. Ensure pump module doors are closed and latched. (WP 0080)
4. Ensure tank module access ladder is secure in stowed position. (WP 0079)
5. Adjust air-ride seat and mirrors as needed. (WP 0076)
6. Adjust four-point seatbelt as needed. (WP 0077)
7. Ensure air suspension dump valve control is pinned in service position. (WP 0027)
8. Ensure all four suspension ball valves are open. (WP 0042)
9. Ensure tire carrier is secure in raised position.
10. Start engine. (WP 0043)
11. Turn on lights as required.
WARNING
Do not press service brake treadle hard three or four times in a row. Air
supply will be used up and service brakes will not work until air is built up
again. Failure to comply may result in injury or death to personnel.
0049-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
0049
12. Ensure both (FRONT and REAR) air pressure gauges (1) read at least 100 psi (7 bar)
before driving vehicle.
CHEM
ALARM
INTER
AXLE
8X8
25
22
15
11
8
6.2
5.5
3.7
2.7
2.0
IN H20 kPa
FILTER MINDER
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
B.O
SELECT
GPFU
B.O
LIGHTS
PARKING
BRAKE
HIGH
IDLE
1
2
TRAILER
AIR SUPPLY
0
1
2
AIR BRAKE
Figure 1.
DRIVE VEHICLE FORWARD
1. Drive vehicle in city traffic and on highway. (WP 0051)
2. Drive vehicle in off-road conditions. (WP 0052)
3. Drive vehicle in slippery conditions. (WP 0054)
4. Drive vehicle up/down steep grade. (WP 0053)
END OF TASK
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0049-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
0050
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
DRIVE VEHICLE IN REVERSE
INITIAL SETUP:
Not Applicable
PREPARE VEHICLE
1. Remove and stow wheel chocks.
2. Adjust air-ride seat and mirrors as needed. (WP 0076)
3. Adjust four-point seatbelt as needed. (WP 0077)
4. Start engine. (WP 0043)
5. Turn on lights as required.
DRIVE VEHICLE IN REVERSE
WARNING
Do not press service brake treadle hard three or four times in a row. Air
supply will be used up and service brakes will not work until air is built up
again. Failure to comply may result in injury or death to personnel.
1. Make sure both (FRONT and REAR) air pressure gauges (1) read at least 100 psi (7
bar) before driving vehicle.
0050-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
0050
1
INTERAXLE
8X8
B.O.
LIGHTS
PULL TO
EXHAUST
LER
TRAI SUPPKINLYG
AIR PAR D
FOR
NOT MIDLAN
S UPPLY
B.O.
SELECT
PUS O
HT
CHEM
ALARM
GPPU
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
M
M
1
2
ASS
HIGH
IDLE
LOA MU
D H LTI
SYST ANDLI LIFT
EM NG
UN
LOA
D
LOA
D
MA
N
TRAN
S
CR
AN
SW E
H.A
.
AN
OFF
nn
smissio
ATranlliso
Figure 1.
WARNING
Driver has limited vision to rear. Ground guide is required when driving
vehicle in reverse. Failure to comply may result in injury or death to personnel.
CAUTION
Do not move TRANSFER CASE shift lever when vehicle is moving or
when transmission is in gear. Severe damage to drive line may result.
2. Set TRANSFER CASE shift lever (2) to HI.
NOTE
Reverse alarm will not sound if blackout lighting is selected.
3. Set transmission range selector (3) to R (reverse).
0050-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
NOTE
Dashboard parking brake indicator will go out when PARKING BRAKE
control is released.
4. Push in PARKING BRAKE control (4).
5. Slowly apply throttle pedal (5).
6. Follow direction from ground guide (as required).
CAUTION
Do not hold steering wheel at full left or full right position for longer than
10 seconds. Oil overheating and pump damage may result.
7. Accelerate, brake, and steer as required.
END OF TASK
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0050-3
0050
TM 9-2320-339-10
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
DRIVE VEHICLE IN CITY TRAFFIC AND ON HIGHWAY
INITIAL SETUP:
Not Applicable
OPERATE VEHICLE
WARNING
Speed limits posted on curves reflect speeds that are considered safe for
automobiles. Heavy vehicles with a high center of gravity can roll over at
these speed limits. Use care and reduce your speed below the posted
limit prior to entering a curve. Failure to comply may result in injury or
death to personnel.
CAUTION
Do not move TRANSFER CASE shift lever when vehicle is moving or
when transmission is in gear. Severe damage to drive line will result.
1. Set TRANSFER CASE shift lever (1) to HI.
0051-1
0051
TM 9-2320-339-10
0051
3
5
INTERAXLE
8X8
B.O.
LIGHTS
EXHAUST
ER
LY
TRAILSUPPKING
AIRNOT FORMIDLPARAND
SUPPLY
PULL TO
B.O.
SELECT
PU S H T O
CHEM
ALARM
GPPU
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
M
M
1
2
ASS
HIGH
IDLE
AlTranlissmisonsion
4
Figure 1.
2. Set transmission range selector (2) to D (drive).
NOTE
Dashboard parking brake indicator will go out when PARKING BRAKE
control is released.
3. Push in PARKING BRAKE control (3).
CAUTION
Never let engine exceed maximum no-load governed engine speed (approximately 2170 rpm) or maximum governed engine speed under load
(approximately 2150 rpm). If engine is allowed to go over governed engine speeds, serious engine damage may result.
4. Slowly depress throttle pedal (4) until vehicle reaches desired speed. Tachometer (5)
should read 1650 to 2100 rpm.
CAUTION
Do not hold steering wheel at full left or full right position for longer than
10 seconds. Power steering oil can overheat and pump can be damaged.
5. Accelerate, brake, and steer as required.
0051-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
0051
NOTE
Check system gauges often during vehicle operation. If gauges read other than normal, stop engine and troubleshoot problem.
6. Check that fuel gauge (6) shows enough fuel to complete mission.
8
11
CHEM
ALARM
INTER
AXLE
8X8
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
HIGH
IDLE
1
2
B.O
SELECT
GPFU
B.O
LIGHTS
10
0
1
2
Figure 2.
CAUTION
Minimum safe operating engine oil pressure is 40 psi (2.76 bar) at 1200
rpm. If engine oil pressure gauge reads over 88 psi (6.06 bar) or lower
than 40 psi (2.76 bar) at any engine speed of 1200 rpm or higher, shut
off engine (WP 0056), and notify field level maintenance.
NOTE
With engine at idle (625-725 rpm), engine oil pressure can go as low as
15 psi (1.03 bar) or as high as 88 psi (6.06 bar).
7. Check that engine oil pressure gauge (7) reads 40 to 88 psi (2.76 to 6.06 bar) between
1200-2100 rpm.
8. If engine oil pressure gauge indicator (8) illuminates (red), this indicates that an engine
oil pressure fault code has been logged. Shut off engine (WP 0056), and notify field
level maintenance.
9. Check that transmission temperature gauge (9) reads 160 to 220F (71 to 104C).
10. If transmission temperature indicator (10) illuminates (red), this indicates that the
transmission temperature is above 250F (121C), or torque converter temperature is
above 350 (177C); park vehicle (WP 0055) and allow transmission to cool. Notify field
level maintenance upon completion of mission.
0051-3
TM 9-2320-339-10
0051
CAUTION
If transmission range selector flashes current range selection while operating vehicle (shift selection is inhibited), DO NOT SHUT DOWN ENGINE OR FURTHER ATTEMPT TO CHANGE TRANSMISSION RANGE
SELECTION. Shutting down engine may result in inability of selecting a
drive range at engine startup (vehicle will be unable to move), and diagnostic data will be lost. Move vehicle to safe place for maintenance or
perform limp home/transmission fault emergency procedures. (WP
0111)
11. If check transmission indicator (11) illuminates (amber), there is a potential problem
with the transmission and/or the transmission may need to be serviced. Check for
correct oil level and/or high transmission oil temperature. If indicators are normal,
continue mission and notify field level maintenance as soon as possible.
12. Check that engine coolant temperature gauge (12) reads 180 to 200F (82 to 93C).
13
15
CHEM
ALARM
INTER
AXLE
8X8
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
HIGH
IDLE
1
2
B.O
SELECT
GPFU
B.O
LIGHTS
0
1
2
14
12
16
18
17
Figure 3.
13. If engine coolant temperature gauge (12) reads over 219F (104C), idle engine until
water temperature cools. If coolant does not cool, shut off engine (WP 0056) and notify
field level maintenance.
14. If high engine coolant temperature indicator (13) illuminates (red), this indicates the
engine monitoring system has logged a high engine coolant fault code and will cause
the check engine indicator (14) to illuminate (amber). Check engine coolant
temperature gauge (12) and allow engine to cool as necessary. Notify field level
maintenance as soon as possible.
15. If check engine indicator (14) illuminates (amber), engine must be serviced by field level
maintenance as soon as possible.
0051-4
TM 9-2320-339-10
0051
NOTE
Battery voltage readout is in the top right corner of LCD. (WP 0020)
16. Check that battery voltage readout (15) reads 24 to 28 volts.
17. Check that front air pressure gauge (16) and rear air pressure gauge (17) both read
100 to 130 psi (7 to 9 bar).
18. If low air indicator (18) illuminates (red), perform immediate action for loss of air supply
system pressure emergency procedures. (WP 0087)
END OF TASK
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0051-5
TM 9-2320-339-10
0052
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
DRIVE VEHICLE IN OFF-ROAD CONDITIONS
INITIAL SETUP:
Not Applicable
NOTE
Vehicle Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) should always be disabled when
driving vehicle in off-road conditions.
1. Set ABS disable switch (1) to on position, ABS disabled indicator (2) will illuminate.
2
7
INTERAXLE
8X8
B.O.
LIGHTS
S U P PL
PULL TO
EXHAUST
LER LY
TRAI SUPPKING
AINOTR FORMIDPARLAND
B.O.
SELECT
PU S H T O
CHEM
ALARM
GPPU
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
M
M
1
2
ASS
HIGH
IDLE
AlTranlissmisonsion
4
6
Figure 1.
CAUTION
Do not move TRANSFER CASE shift lever when vehicle is moving or
when transmission is in gear. Severe damage to drive line may result.
0052-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
0052
NOTE
8x8 indicator (WP 0020) will illuminate when TRANSFER CASE shift lever is positioned to L (LO).
2. Set TRANSFER CASE shift lever (3) to L (LO).
3. Set transmission range selector (4) to 2 (2nd gear range) or 1 (1st gear range), (WP
0047) depending on ground condition.
NOTE
Dashboard parking brake indicator will go out when PARKING BRAKE
control is released.
4. Push in PARKING BRAKE control (5).
CAUTION
Never let engine exceed maximum no-load governed engine speed (approximately 2170 rpm) or maximum governed engine speed under load
(approximately 2150 rpm). If engine is allowed to go over governed engine speeds, serious engine damage may result.
5. Slowly depress throttle pedal (6) until vehicle reaches desired speed. Tachometer (7)
should read 1650 to 2100 rpm.
CAUTION
Do not hold steering wheel at full left or full right position for longer than
10 seconds. Power steering oil can overheat and pump can be damaged.
6. Accelerate, brake, and steer as required.
NOTE
When off-road driving is completed, enable vehicle Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS).
7. Set ABS disable switch (1) to off position, ABS disabled indicator (2) will go out.
END OF TASK
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0052-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
0053
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
DRIVE VEHICLE UP/DOWN STEEP GRADE
INITIAL SETUP:
Not Applicable
CHEM
ALARM
INTER
AXLE
8X8
25
22
15
11
8
6.2
5.5
3.7
2.7
2.0
IN H20 kPa
FILTER MINDER
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
B.O
SELECT
GPFU
B.O
LIGHTS
PARKING
BRAKE
HIGH
IDLE
1
2
TRAILER
AIR SUPPLY
0
1
2
AIR BRAKE
1
Figure 1.
DRIVE VEHICLE DOWN STEEP GRADE
CAUTION
Do not allow speed to go above 2100 RPM when driving downhill, or
damage to engine can result.
Engine brake operates best when engine speed is between 1650 and
2100 RPM. Transmission torque converter lockup valve may
disengage below 1650 RPM resulting in loss of engine power.
1. Set transmission range selector (1) to lower range as needed to keep engine speed on
tachometer (2) between 1650 and 2100 RPM.
0053-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
2
INTERAXLE
8X8
B.O.
LIGHTS
EXHAUST
ER
LY
TRAILSUPPKING
AIRNOT FORMIDLPARAND
S U P P LY
PULL TO
B.O.
SELECT
PU S H T O
CHEM
ALARM
GPPU
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
M
M
12
ASS
HIGH
IDLE
AlTranlissmisonsion
1
3
Figure 2.
WARNING
Do not press service brake treadle hard three or four times in a row. Air
supply will be used up and service brakes will not work until air is built up
again. Failure to comply may result in injury or death to personnel.
2. Use service brake pedal (3) as needed to control vehicle speed.
3. Operate engine brake (WP 0048) as required.
END OF TASK
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0053-2
0053
TM 9-2320-339-10
0054
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
DRIVE VEHICLE IN SLIPPERY CONDITIONS
INITIAL SETUP:
Not Applicable
OPERATE VEHICLE
CAUTION
Do not move traction control switch while vehicle is moving. Damage to
drive line may result.
NOTE
The traction control switch has three positions:
.
After traction control switch is positioned on, let vehicle creep forward
several feet to allow shift collars to fully engage.
1. If TRANSFER CASE shift lever (1) is set to LO, 8X8 is automatically engaged and
indicator light (4) will illuminate. Set traction control switch (2) to INTER AXLE. Indicator
light (3) will come on.
0054-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
0054
3
INTERAXLE
8X8
B.O.
LIGHTS
EXHAUST
LER
TRAI SUPPKINLYG
AINOTR FORMIDPARLAND
S U P P LY
PULL TO
B.O.
SELECT
PUS O
HT
CHEM
ALARM
GPPU
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
M
M
1
2
ASS
HIGH
IDLE
LOA MU
D H LTI
SYST ANDLI LIFT
EM NG
UN
LOA
D
LOA
D
MA
N
TRAN
S
CR
AN
SW E
H.A
.
AN
OFF
nn
smissio
ATranlliso
Figure 1.
2. If TRANSFER CASE shift lever (1) is set to HI, set traction control switch (2) to 8X8.
Indicator light (4) will come on.
CAUTION
Do not move traction control switch while vehicle is moving. Damage to
drive line may result.
NOTE
After traction control switch is positioned off, let vehicle creep forward
several feet to allow shift collars to fully disengage.
3. When vehicle gets good traction again, stop vehicle and set traction control switch (2)
to off (center) position. Indicator light (3 or 4 as applicable) will go out.
END OF TASK
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0054-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
0055
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
PARK VEHICLE
INITIAL SETUP:
Not Applicable
OPERATE VEHICLE
1. Lift foot off throttle pedal (1). Let automatic downshifting of transmission slow vehicle.
3
INTERAXLE
8X8
B.O.
LIGHTS
PULL TO
EXHAUST
ER
LY
TRAILSUPPKING
AIR PAR D
FOR
NOT MIDLAN
SUPPLY
B.O.
SELECT
PU S H T O
CHEM
ALARM
GPPU
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
M
M
1
2
ASS
HIGH
IDLE
AlTranlissmisonsion
4
1
Figure 1.
WARNING
Do not press service brake treadle hard three or four times in a row. Air
supply will be used up and service brakes will not work until air is built up
again. Failure to comply may result in injury or death to personnel.
0055-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
2. Push down on service brake pedal (2) until vehicle comes to complete stop.
NOTE
Dashboard parking brake indicator illuminates when PARKING BRAKE
control is applied.
3. Pull out PARKING BRAKE control (3).
4. Set transmission range selector (4) to N (neutral).
5. Leave TRANSFER CASE shift lever (5) set to HI or LO.
6. Align front tires in straight-ahead position.
7. Install wheel chocks (WP 0073) as required.
END OF TASK
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0055-2
0055
TM 9-2320-339-10
0056
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
SHUT OFF ENGINE
INITIAL SETUP:
Not Applicable
CAUTION
Before shutting down engine, run at reduced speed (800 to 1000 rpm) at
no-load for three to five minutes to allow turbocharger to slow down and
cool off. Turbocharger may be damaged if not allowed to cool off.
2. Push down and hold throttle pedal (1) until tachometer (2) reads 800 to 1000 rpm for
three to five minutes.
2
CHEM
ALARM
INTER
AXLE
25
22
15
11
8
8X8
6.2
5.5
3.7
2.7
2.0
IN H20 kPa
FILTER MINDER
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
B.O
SELECT
GPFU
B.O
LIGHTS
PARKING
BRAKE
HIGH
IDLE
1
2
TRAILER
AIR SUPPLY
0
1
2
AIR BRAKE
Figure 1.
3. Lift foot off throttle pedal (1).
0056-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
CAUTION
Failure to place light switches in OFF position when vehicle is not in use
may cause battery and/or vehicle damage.
4. Turn off lights as required.
5. Set ignition switch (3) to off (down) position.
6. Turn 24V battery disconnect switch (4) to OFF position. (WP 0075)
END OF TASK
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0056-2
0056
TM 9-2320-339-10
0057
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
OPERATE RIFLE STOWAGE MOUNT
INITIAL SETUP:
Not Applicable
0057-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
Figure 1.
2. Pull handle (5) of top mount (6) toward middle of cab.
3. Place heat guard (7) of M-16 rifle (2) in top mount (6).
4. Push handle (5) across heat guard (7).
5. Check that M-16 rifle (2) is held tightly.
REMOVE RIFLE FROM STOWAGE MOUNT
1. Pull handle (1) of top mount (2) down and toward middle of cab.
0057-2
0057
TM 9-2320-339-10
0057
2
4
Figure 2.
2. Remove heat guard (3) of M-16 rifle (4) from top mount (2).
3. Remove butt (5) of M-16 rifle (4) from lower mount (6).
END OF TASK
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0057-3
TM 9-2320-339-10
0058
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
CONNECT/DISCONNECT AUXILIARY HYDRAULIC EQUIPMENT
INITIAL SETUP:
Not Applicable
2
1
INTERAXLE
8X8
B.O.
LIGHTS
PULL TO
EXHAUST
LER
TRAI SUPPKINLYG
AIR PAR D
FOR
NOT MIDLAN
S U P PL
Y
B.O.
SELECT
PU S H T O
CHEM
ALARM
GPPU
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
M
M
1
2
ASS
HIGH
IDLE
AlTranlissmionssion
Figure 1.
CAUTION
Do not move SELECTOR VALVE while PTO is engaged or vehicle hydraulic equipment may be damaged.
4. Push in hydraulic selector valve control for tanker pump operation.
0058-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
0058
HYDRAULIC SELECTOR
VALVE CONTROL
FLAMMABLE
NO SMOKING WITHIN 50 FEET
Figure 2.
5. Set HYD ENABLE switch (1) to on position. MAIN HYD ENABLE indicator (2) will
illuminate.
WARNING
Stand clear to avoid injury when operating pump module rear doors.
When each door is about halfway open, gas pistons push doors open
quickly and with much force. Failure to comply may result in injury or
death to personnel.
6. Open driver side pump module rear door (3).
0058-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
0058
3
6
Figure 3.
NOTE
Small amount of hydraulic fluid may leak out when caps are removed.
7. Remove return line cap (4) and supply line cap (5).
8. Connect hydraulic lines from auxiliary hydraulic equipment to return fitting (6) and
supply fitting (7).
9. Start engine (WP 0043).
10. Lift latch (8) and pull pump engagement lever (9) completely back.
0058-3
TM 9-2320-339-10
0058
Figure 4.
11. Continue operation of auxiliary hydraulic equipment.
DISCONNECT AUXILIARY HYDRAULIC EQUIPMENT
1. Shutdown auxiliary hydraulic equipment.
2. Lift latch (1) and push pump engagement lever (2) to off (center position).
Figure 5.
3. Shut off engine (WP 0056).
0058-4
TM 9-2320-339-10
0058
4. Disconnect hydraulic lines from auxiliary hydraulic equipment from return fitting (5) and
supply fitting (6).
9
5
7
Figure 6.
5. Install return line cap (7) and supply line cap (8).
6. Close left-side pump module rear door (9).
7. Pull out hydraulic selector valve control for tanker pump operation.
0058-5
TM 9-2320-339-10
HYDRAULIC SELECTOR
VALVE CONTROL
FLAMMABLE
NO SMOKING WITHIN 50 FEET
Figure 7.
END OF TASK
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0058-6
0058
TM 9-2320-339-10
0059
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
PORTABLE WORK LAMP OPERATION
INITIAL SETUP:
Not Applicable
NOTE
Ensure that 24V battery disconnect switch is ON (WP 0075) before operating work lamp.
1. Remove work lamp (1) and work lamp harness (2) from stowage.
1
2
3
5
4
Figure 1.
2. Mount work lamp (1) on vehicle using magnet (3).
3. Install work lamp harness plug (4) on work lamp terminal (5).
4. Route work lamp harness (2) through driver side door opening (6), between inside of
cab roof (7) and air horn valve hoses (8).
0059-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
0059
Figure 2.
5. Route work lamp harness (2) across driver side defroster (9) and across center dash
panel (10) to utility outlet (11).
0059-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
25
22
15
11
8
0059
10
6.2
5.5
3.7
2.7
2.0
IN H20 kPa
FILTER MINDER
PARKING
BRAKE
13
TRAILER
AIR SUPPLY
11
8
12
14
3
5
4
2
Figure 3.
6. Remove utility outlet cover (12). Insert work lamp harness plug (13) into utility outlet
(11).
NOTE
Ignition switch must be positioned to on for portable work lamp to operate.
7. Turn on work lamp (1) using toggle switch (14).
NOTE
Perform Steps (8) through (13) when use of the portable work lamp is no
longer required.
0059-3
TM 9-2320-339-10
0059
0059-4
TM 9-2320-339-10
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
OPERATE DOME LIGHT
INITIAL SETUP:
Not Applicable
CAUTION
Failure to place light switches in off position when vehicle is not in use
may cause battery and/or vehicle damage.
NOTE
Dome light is located on very rear of cabin overhead centered
between operator and crew seats.
Dome light switch is a 2-position switch; down is off, up is on.
Dome light is disabled when B.O. SELECT switch is positioned on.
Ensure that the 24V battery disconnect switch is set to ON position
(WP 0075) before operating lights.
1. Set DOME switch (1) to on/off position as required.
0060-1
0060
TM 9-2320-339-10
0060
1
CHEM
ALARM
INTER
AXLE
8X8
25
22
15
11
8
6.2
5.5
3.7
2.7
2.0
IN H20 kPa
FILTER MINDER
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
B.O
SELECT
GPFU
B.O
LIGHTS
PARKING
BRAKE
HIGH
IDLE
1
2
TRAILER
AIR SUPPLY
0
1
2
AIR BRAKE
Figure 1.
END OF TASK
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0060-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
0061
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
OPERATE PANEL LIGHTS
INITIAL SETUP:
Not Applicable
CAUTION
Failure to place light switches in the off position when vehicle is not in use
may cause battery and/or vehicle damage.
NOTE
Ensure that the 24V battery disconnect switch is set to ON position (WP
0075) before operating lights.
1. Set ignition switch (1) to on position.
2
CHEM
ALARM
INTER
AXLE
25
22
15
11
8
8X8
6.2
5.5
3.7
2.7
2.0
IN H20 kPa
FILTER MINDER
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
B.O
SELECT
GPFU
B.O
LIGHTS
PARKING
BRAKE
HIGH
IDLE
1
2
TRAILER
AIR SUPPLY
0
1
2
AIR BRAKE
1
Figure 1.
0061-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
NOTE
The dimmer switch is a two-position momentary switch. Each
upward/downward momentary depression of the switch will increase/
decrease panel light intensity by 5%.
Pressing and holding dimmer switch up for 3+ seconds will increase
panel light intensity to 100%.
Pressing and holding dimmer switch down for 3+ seconds will
decrease panel light intensity to 10%.
2. Adjust panel light brightness using dimmer switch (2).
NOTE
Complete Step (3) when panel lights are no longer required.
3. Set ignition switch (1) to off position.
END OF TASK
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0061-2
0061
TM 9-2320-339-10
0062
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
OPERATE PARKING LIGHTS
INITIAL SETUP:
Not Applicable
CAUTION
Failure to place light switches in the off position when vehicle is not in use
may cause battery and/or vehicle damage.
NOTE
The master lighting switch is a three-position switch:
.
Ensure that the 24V battery disconnect switch is set to ON position
(WP 0075) before operating lights.
Clearance lights indicator will illuminate whenever master light switch
is moved out of off position.
1. Set master lighting switch (1) up one click to center position, clearance light indicator
(2) will illuminate.
0062-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
0062
CHEM
ALARM
INTER
AXLE
25
22
15
11
8
8X8
6.2
5.5
3.7
2.7
2.0
IN H20 kPa
FILTER MINDER
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
B.O
SELECT
GPFU
B.O
LIGHTS
PARKING
BRAKE
HIGH
IDLE
1
2
TRAILER
AIR SUPPLY
0
1
2
AIR BRAKE
Figure 1.
NOTE
Complete Step (2) when parking lights are no longer required.
2. Position master lighting switch (1) down one click to off position, clearance light indicator
(2) will go out.
END OF TASK
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0062-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
0063
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
OPERATE SERVICE DRIVE LIGHTS
INITIAL SETUP:
Not Applicable
CAUTION
Failure to place light switches in the off position when vehicle is not in use
may cause battery and/or vehicle damage.
NOTE
The master lighting switch is a three-position switch:
.
Ensure that the 24V battery disconnect switch is set to ON position
(WP 0075) before operating lights.
For full explanation of clearance lights, go to operate clearance
lights . (WP 0065)
Clearance lights indicator will illuminate whenever master light switch
is moved out of off position.
1. Position master lighting switch (1) up two clicks to full up position, clearance light
indicator (2) will illuminate. Service headlights (3), composite lights (4), taillights (5),
and clearance lights (6) will illuminate.
0063-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
0063
CHEM
ALARM
INTER
AXLE
25
22
15
11
8
8X8
6.2
5.5
3.7
2.7
2.0
IN H20 kPa
FILTER MINDER
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
B.O
SELECT
GPFU
B.O
LIGHTS
PARKING
BRAKE
HIGH
IDLE
1
2
TRAILER
AIR SUPPLY
0
1
2
AIR BRAKE
Figure 1.
5
Figure 2.
NOTE
Service stop lights (incorporated in taillights) will illuminate when service
brake pedal is applied.
2. Press dimmer switch (7) to cycle between high and low headlight beams. High beam
indicator (8) will illuminate (blue) when high beams are selected.
0063-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
0063
8
CHEM
ALARM
INTER
AXLE
8X8
25
22
15
11
8
6.2
5.5
3.7
2.7
2.0
IN H20 kPa
FILTER MINDER
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
B.O
SELECT
GPFU
B.O
LIGHTS
PARKING
BRAKE
HIGH
IDLE
1
2
TRAILER
AIR SUPPLY
0
1
2
AIR BRAKE
Figure 3.
NOTE
Complete Step (3) when service drive lights are no longer required.
3. Position master lighting switch (1) down two clicks to off position, clearance light
indicator (2) will go out.
0063-3
TM 9-2320-339-10
0063
CHEM
ALARM
INTER
AXLE
25
22
15
11
8
8X8
6.2
5.5
3.7
2.7
2.0
IN H20 kPa
FILTER MINDER
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
B.O
SELECT
GPFU
B.O
LIGHTS
PARKING
BRAKE
HIGH
IDLE
1
2
TRAILER
AIR SUPPLY
0
1
2
AIR BRAKE
Figure 4.
END OF TASK
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0063-4
TM 9-2320-339-10
0064
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
OPERATE STOPLIGHTS
INITIAL SETUP:
Not Applicable
NOTE
Ensure that the 24V battery disconnect switch is set to ON position (WP
0075) before operating lights.
1. Stoplights (1) will illuminate when service brake pedal (2) is applied.
CHEM
ALARM
INTER
AXLE
8X8
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
HIGH
IDLE
1
2
B.O
SELECT
GPFU
B.O
LIGHTS
0
1
2
AIR BRAKE
Figure 1.
END OF TASK
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0064-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
0065
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
OPERATE CLEARANCE LIGHTS
INITIAL SETUP:
Not Applicable
CAUTION
Failure to place light switches in the OFF position when vehicle is not in
use may cause battery and/or vehicle damage.
NOTE
The master lighting switch is a three-position switch:
.
Ensure that the 24V battery disconnect switch is set to ON position
(WP 0075) before operating lights.
Clearance lights indicator will illuminate whenever master light switch
is moved out of off position.
1. Set master lighting switch (1) up one or two clicks; clearance light indicator (2) and
clearance lights (3) will illuminate.
0065-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
0065
CHEM
ALARM
INTER
AXLE
8X8
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
HIGH
IDLE
1
2
B.O
SELECT
GPFU
B.O
LIGHTS
0
1
2
3
3
Figure 1.
NOTE
Complete Step (2) when clearance lights are no longer required.
0065-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
0065
2. Set master lighting switch (1) full down to off position; clearance light indicator (2) and
clearance lights (3) will go out.
END OF TASK
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0065-3
TM 9-2320-339-10
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
OPERATE BLACKOUT DRIVE LIGHT
INITIAL SETUP:
Not Applicable
CAUTION
Failure to place light switches in the OFF position when vehicle is not in
use may cause battery and/or vehicle damage.
NOTE
The B.O. LIGHTS switch is a three-position switch:
.
Ensure that the 24V battery disconnect switch is set to ON position
(WP 0075) before operating lights.
Use blackout drive light for night driving under blackout conditions.
Master lighting switch, dome light switch, work light switch, beacon
light switch, electric horn (on steering column), and reverse alarm are
disabled when B.O. SELECT switch is positioned on.
1. Set B.O. SELECT switch (1) to on position.
0066-1
0066
TM 9-2320-339-10
0066
CHEM
ALARM
INTER
AXLE
8X8
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
HIGH
IDLE
1
2
B.O
SELECT
GPFU
B.O
LIGHTS
0
1
2
AIR BRAKE
6
4
5
3
Figure 1.
2. Set B.O. LIGHTS switch (2) up two clicks. Blackout drive light (3) and blackout markers
(4) will illuminate.
3. Blackout stoplights (5) will illuminate when service brake pedal (6) is applied.
NOTE
Complete Steps (4) and (5) when blackout lights are no longer required.
4. Set B.O. LIGHTS switch (2) down two clicks to off position. Blackout drive light (3) and
blackout markers (4) will go out.
5. Lift switch lock and set B.O. SELECT switch (1) off position.
END OF TASK
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0066-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
OPERATE BLACKOUT MARKERS
INITIAL SETUP:
Not Applicable
CAUTION
Failure to place light switches in the OFF position when vehicle is not in
use may cause battery and/or vehicle damage.
NOTE
The B.O. LIGHTS switch is a three-position switch:
.
Ensure that the 24V battery disconnect switch is set to ON position
(WP 0075) before operating lights.
Master lighting switch, dome light switch, work light switch, beacon
light switch, electric horn (on steering column), and reverse alarm are
disabled when B.O. SELECT switch is positioned on.
1. Set B.O. SELECT switch (1) to on position.
0067-1
0067
TM 9-2320-339-10
0067
CHEM
ALARM
INTER
AXLE
8X8
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
HIGH
IDLE
1
2
B.O
SELECT
GPFU
B.O
LIGHTS
0
1
2
AIR BRAKE
5
3
3
Figure 1.
2. Set B.O. LIGHTS switch (2) up one click to center position. Blackout markers (3) will
illuminate.
3. Blackout stoplight markers (4), which are located on vehicle taillights, will illuminate
when service brake pedal (5) is applied.
NOTE
Complete Steps (4) and (5) when blackout markers are no longer required.
4. Set B.O. LIGHTS switch (2) one click to off position. Blackout markers (3) will go out.
5. Lift switch lock and set B.O. SELECT switch (1) to off position.
END OF TASK
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0067-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
OPERATE WORK LIGHTS
INITIAL SETUP:
Not Applicable
END OF TASK
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0068-1
0068
TM 9-2320-339-10
0069
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
OPERATE TANKER MODULE LIGHTS
INITIAL SETUP:
Not Applicable
CAUTION
Failure to place light switches in the off position when vehicle is not in use
may cause battery and/or vehicle damage.
NOTE
Ensure that the 24V battery disconnect switch is set to ON position
(WP 0075) before operating lights.
Tanker module has one light on each side, operated in the same
fashion.
Ignition switch is a two-position switch; up is on, down is off.
1. Set ignition switch (1) to on position.
CHEM
ALARM
INTER
AXLE
25
22
15
11
8
8X8
6.2
5.5
3.7
2.7
2.0
IN H20 kPa
FILTER MINDER
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
B.O
SELECT
GPFU
B.O
LIGHTS
PARKING
BRAKE
HIGH
IDLE
1
2
TRAILER
AIR SUPPLY
0
1
2
AIR BRAKE
Figure 1.
2. Open pump module rear doors (2).
0069-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
0069
Figure 2.
3. Pull switch (3) to down position to turn desired tanker module light (4) on.
NOTE
Perform Steps (4) through (6) when use of tanker module light(s) are no
longer needed.
4. Push switch (3) to up position to turn desired tanker module light (4) off.
5. Close pump module rear doors (2).
6. Set ignition switch (1) to off position.
CHEM
ALARM
INTER
AXLE
25
22
15
11
8
8X8
6.2
5.5
3.7
2.7
2.0
IN H20 kPa
FILTER MINDER
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
B.O
SELECT
GPFU
B.O
LIGHTS
PARKING
BRAKE
HIGH
IDLE
1
2
TRAILER
AIR SUPPLY
0
1
2
AIR BRAKE
Figure 3.
END OF TASK
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0069-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
0070
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
PORTABLE BEACON LIGHT OPERATION
INITIAL SETUP:
Not Applicable
NOTE
Ensure that the 24V battery disconnect switch is set to ON position (WP
0075) before operating lights.
1. Remove beacon light (1) from stowage and unwind cord (2).
Figure 1.
2. Place beacon light (1) on driver side front corner of cab roof (3) approximately 12 in.
(30 cm) from driver side cab, and approximately 2 in. (5 cm) from front edge of cab roof.
0070-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
0070
Figure 2.
3. Route beacon cord (2) through driver side door opening (4) and between inside of cab
roof (3) and air horn valve hoses (5).
Figure 3.
0070-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
0070
4. Route beacon cord (2) down left side of driver's windshield (6), across driver side
defroster (7), and across center dash panel (8) to utility outlet (9).
25
22
15
11
8
6.2
5.5
3.7
2.7
2.0
IN H20 kPa
FILTER MINDER
PARKING
BRAKE
11
TRAILER
AIR SUPPLY
9
10
Figure 4.
5. Remove utility outlet cover (10).
NOTE
Ignition switch must be positioned to on for portable beacon light to operate.
6. Insert beacon cord plug (11) into utility outlet (9).
NOTE
Perform Steps (7) through (11) when use of portable beacon light is no
longer required.
7. Remove beacon cord plug (11) from utility outlet (9).
8. Install utility outlet cover (10).
9. Remove beacon cord (2) from interior of cab.
10. Remove beacon light from cab roof (3).
11. Rewind cord (2) and return beacon light (1) to appropriate stowage.
0070-3
TM 9-2320-339-10
Figure 5.
END OF TASK
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0070-4
0070
TM 9-2320-339-10
0071
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
OPERATE TURN SIGNALS
INITIAL SETUP:
Not Applicable
NOTE
Ensure that the 24V battery disconnect switch is set to ON position
(WP 0075) before operating turn signals.
If left turn is desired, complete Step (1). If right turn is desired, skip
to Step (2).
1. Set turn signal lever (1) down to left turn position. Left turn indicator (2), and driver side
front (3) and rear (4) composite lights will flash (approximately once per second)
simultaneously.
0071-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
0071
CHEM
ALARM
INTER
AXLE
25
22
15
11
8
8X8
6.2
5.5
3.7
2.7
2.0
IN H20 kPa
FILTER MINDER
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
B.O
SELECT
GPFU
B.O
LIGHTS
PARKING
BRAKE
HIGH
IDLE
1
2
TRAILER
AIR SUPPLY
0
1
2
AIR BRAKE
Figure 1.
NOTE
If right turn is desired, complete Step (2).
2. Set turn signal lever (1) up to right turn position. Right turn indicator (5), and passenger
side front (6) and rear (7) composite lights will flash (approximately once per second)
simultaneously.
NOTE
Turn signal level may return to off (center) position automatically once
turn is complete, if this is not the case and/or turn signal is no longer
desired, complete Step (3).
0071-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
0071
3. Set turn signal control lever (1) to off (center) position. Appropriate turn indicator and
composite lights will go out.
END OF TASK
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0071-3
TM 9-2320-339-10
0072
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
OPERATE EMERGENCY FLASHERS
INITIAL SETUP:
Not Applicable
NOTE
Ensure that the 24V battery disconnect switch is set to ON position
(WP 0075) before operating emergency flashers.
Highway Emergency Marker Kit (WP 0106) should be used to mark
location and caution oncoming traffic whenever vehicle is disabled or
must park in areas where there is other traffic.
1. Push emergency flasher switch (1) in. Both left (2) and right (3) turn indicators, and front
(4) and rear (5) composite lights will flash simultaneously at approximately once per
second.
0072-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
0072
CHEM
ALARM
INTER
AXLE
25
22
15
11
8
8X8
6.2
5.5
3.7
2.7
2.0
IN H20 kPa
FILTER MINDER
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
B.O
SELECT
GPFU
B.O
LIGHTS
PARKING
BRAKE
HIGH
IDLE
1
2
TRAILER
AIR SUPPLY
0
1
2
AIR BRAKE
Figure 1.
NOTE
Perform Step (2) when emergency flashers are no longer desired.
2. Pull emergency flasher switch (1) out.
END OF TASK
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0072-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
0073
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
INSTALL/REMOVE WHEEL CHOCKS
INITIAL SETUP:
Not Applicable
NOTE
Vehicle is equipped with four wheel chocks.
Always chock tires if vehicle is shut down on uneven terrain.
Always chock tires if vehicle parking brake is inoperative.
Ensure local policy for chocking vehicle tires is followed.
1. Remove two wheel chocks (1) from stowage.
Figure 1.
2. Place one wheel chock (1) snugly against both front and rear of tire (No. 1 axle driver
side tire shown).
REMOVE WHEEL CHOCKS
NOTE
Vehicle is equipped with four wheel chocks.
0073-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
0073
Figure 2.
2. Return wheel chocks (1) to stowage.
3. Repeat Steps (1) and (2) if more than one wheel is chocked.
END OF TASK
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0073-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
0074
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
CHANGE VEHICLE WEIGHT INDICATOR
INITIAL SETUP:
Not Applicable
NOTE
Refer to load classification table for appropriate vehicle weight.
1. Press in bottom of lockplate (1).
1
2
2
3
3
4
Figure 1.
2. Push lockplate (1) up and off one lockpin (2).
3. Remove number plates (3).
4. Place new number on top of number plates (3).
5. Install number plates (3) on lockpin (4).
0074-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
6. Push down number plates (3). Slide lockplate (1) on lockpin (2).
7. Repeat Steps (1) through (7) to change other number.
END OF TASK
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0074-2
0074
TM 9-2320-339-10
0075
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
OPERATE 24V BATTERY DISCONNECT SWITCH
INITIAL SETUP:
Not Applicable
NOTE
All electrical power to the cab is turned ON/OFF by the 24V disconnect
switch.
Turn switch (1) full clockwise (CW) to ON position or full counterclockwise (CCW) to OFF
position as desired.
0075-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
Figure 1.
END OF TASK
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0075-2
0075
TM 9-2320-339-10
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
ADJUST AIR-RIDE SEAT
INITIAL SETUP:
Not Applicable
WARNING
When adjusting seat ride firmness, keep fingers out from under seat.
Failure to comply may result in injury or death to personnel.
NOTE
Sit in seat and perform Steps (1) through (6) as necessary.
Driver and crew (passenger side) side seats are adjusted the same
way.
1. Pull out (increase) or push in (decrease) knob (1) to adjust seat ride firmness.
0076-1
0076
TM 9-2320-339-10
0076
6
4
5
2
Figure 1.
2. Move lever (2) away from seat (3) and slide seat (3) forward or backwards.
3. Move lever (2) towards seat (3) to lock seat (3) in place.
4. Pull up lever (4) and lift self off seat (3) to raise, or pull up lever (4) and push down on
seat (3) to lower.
5. Release lever (4) to lock seat (3) in place.
6. Adjust all vehicle mirrors as necessary once driver's seat is properly adjusted.
NOTE
If vehicle is bounced too hard, seat tether may lock seat in down position.
Park vehicle (WP 0055) and perform Steps (7) through (10) to free seat.
7. Push in knob (1) to decrease seat ride firmness.
0076-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
0076
8. Move lever (2) away from seat (3), and slide seat (3) backwards to relieve tension on
retractor (5).
9. Feed some seat tether (6) into retractor (5) until it releases.
10. Perform Steps (1) through (5) as required to reset seat (3) to desired position.
END OF TASK
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0076-3
TM 9-2320-339-10
0077
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
OPERATE FOUR-POINT SEATBELT
INITIAL SETUP:
Not Applicable
3
4
2
1
Figure 1.
0077-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
0077-2
0077
TM 9-2320-339-10
0078
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
PREPARE TANKER FOR OPERATION
INITIAL SETUP:
Not Applicable
PREPARE VEHICLE
WARNING
To prevent fire or explosion, do not allow smoking, flame, sparks, and hot
or glowing objects within 50 ft. (15 m) of vehicle. Read and follow all safety
precautions in FM 10-67-1. Failure to comply may result in injury or death
to personnel.
NOTE
This procedure should be performed to prepare tanker before all fuel
loading, fuel servicing, defueling, fuel recirculation and fuel unloading
operations.
1. Start engine (WP 0043), position vehicle for operation, and park vehicle. (WP 0055)
2. Shut OFF engine. (WP 0056)
NOTE
Perform all before-operation PMCS procedures (WP 0139).
3. Remove and stow lock (1) (if so equipped).
0078-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
60
80
500
40
20
60
100
800
1000
80
500
600
300
100
40
120
20
140
100
600
800
300
100
1000
1100
120
140
1100
160
160
0078
MARSH
MARSH
D
E
F
U
E
L
F
U
E
L
OUT
IN
VALVE
L L O N S
FLOW METER
Figure 1.
WARNING
Stand clear to avoid injury when operating pump module rear doors.
When each door is about halfway open, gas pistons push doors open
quickly and with much force. Failure to comply may result in injury or
death to personnel.
4. Open pump module rear doors (2).
0078-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
0078
80
500
40
20
60
100
800
1000
80
500
600
300
100
40
120
20
140
100
600
800
300
100
1000
1100
120
140
1100
160
160
MARSH
MARSH
D
E
F
F
U
E
OUT
L
L
IN
VALVE
L L O N S
FLOW METER
2
60
80
500
40
20
100
600
800
300
100
1000
120
140
1100
160
0
MARSH
D
E
F
U
E
L
F
U
E
L
OUT
IN
VALVE
L L O N S
FLOW METER
1
Figure 2.
2. Push in V6 FUEL/DEFUEL VALVE (2) to fueling position.
3. Close Vll FLOW VALVE (REG) (3).
4. Push V8 REEL VALVE (H2) (4) straight up to close.
5. Close V18 BULK DEL VALVE (5).
6. Close V15 DRAIN VALVE (6).
7. Turn flowmeter reset knob (7) to zero scale (8).
0078-3
TM 9-2320-339-10
0078
8
60
80
500
40
20
60
100
800
1000
80
500
600
300
100
40
120
20
140
100
600
800
300
100
1000
1100
120
140
1100
160
160
MARSH
MARSH
D
E
F
U
E
L
F
U
E
L
OUT
IN
VALVE
L L O N S
FLOW METER
11
10
Figure 3.
8. Set TC/THROTTLE CONTROL switch (9) down to OFF position.
9. Set TLI/TANK LEVEL INDICATOR switch (10) down to OFF position.
10. Set APC/AUXILIARY PUMP CONTROL switch (11) APC to shut off.
11. Pull back on PUMP ENGAGEMENT LEVER (12) until locked.
0078-4
TM 9-2320-339-10
0078
60
80
500
40
20
60
100
800
1000
80
500
600
300
100
40
120
20
140
100
600
800
300
100
1000
1100
120
140
1100
160
160
MARSH
MARSH
D
E
F
U
E
OUT
F
U
E
L
IN
VALVE
L L O N S
FLOW METER
15
60
80
500
40
20
100
600
800
300
100
1000
120
140
1100
160
0
MARSH
14
12
13
Figure 4.
NOTE
V3 SUCTION LINE VALVE is located inside driver side frame rail
above rear end of air tank in front of No. 3 axle.
V3 SUCTION LINE VALVE is shown in open position. Valve is closed
when lever is straight down.
15. Move V3 SUCTION LINE VALVE handle (16) to OPEN position (shown).
0078-5
TM 9-2320-339-10
0078
FLAMMABLE
NO SMOKING WITHIN 50 FEET
16
Figure 5.
BONDING AND GROUNDING
NOTE
Bonding is the process of electrically connecting two units to equalize
and form a path for any static potential that might develop during
fueling process. Grounding is the process of electrically connecting
single or bonded units to ground rods. This discharges into the earth
any static potential that might exist at the beginning of operation or
that might develop during the operation.
Both vehicles and equipment involved must be bonded and grounded
before performing fueling procedures.
If you use only one ground rod to ground both vehicles, you do not
need to bond.
1. Connect SR1 and SR2 static cables (1) to grounding devices and vehicle being
serviced.
0078-6
TM 9-2320-339-10
BONDING
CABLE
GROUNDING
CABLE
Figure 6.
END OF TASK
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0078-7
0078
TM 9-2320-339-10
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
CHECK TANKER FUEL LEVEL
INITIAL SETUP:
Not Applicable
WARNING
To prevent fire or explosion, do not allow smoking, flame, sparks, and hot
or glowing objects within 50 ft. (15 m) of vehicle. Read and follow all safety
precautions in FM 10-67-1. Failure to comply may result in injury or death
to personnel.
WARNING
Stand clear to avoid injury when operating pump module rear doors.
When each door is about halfway open, gas pistons push doors open
quickly and with much force. Failure to comply may result in injury or
death to personnel.
1. Open passenger side pump module rear door (1).
0079-1
0079
TM 9-2320-339-10
0079
1
60
80
500
40
20
100
600
800
300
100
1000
120
140
1100
160
0
MARSH
D
E
F
U
E
L
F
U
E
L
OUT
IN
VALVE
L L O N S
FLOW METER
Figure 1.
2. Set TLI/TANK LEVEL INDICATOR switch (2) to ON.
3. Read tank fuel level on indicator gauge (3).
NOTE
If TLI/TANK LEVEL INDICATOR gauge does not show fuel level, check
with dipstick.
4. Set TLI/TANK LEVEL INDICATOR switch (2) to OFF.
5. Close passenger side pump module rear door (1).
0079-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
WARNING
Keep hands clear of ladder hinge. Failure to comply may result in injury
or death to personnel.
1. Remove safety pin (1) and pin (2). Lower ladder (3).
1
2
Figure 2.
2. Install pin (2) and safety pin (1) in ladder (3).
3. Climb on top of tank (4).
WARNING
0079-3
0079
TM 9-2320-339-10
0079
5
8
10
9
8
Figure 3.
5. Remove pin (7) from end of sheath (8) and remove dipstick (9).
6. Lower dipstick (9) into manhole fill opening (10) until it touches bottom of tank.
7. Remove dipstick (9) and check marking for fuel level in tank.
8. Wipe off dipstick (9).
9. Push dipstick (9) in sheath (8) and install pin (7).
CLOSE MANHOLE COVER AND SECURE TANKER MODULE
1. Close manhole cover (6) and secure latch (5).
0079-4
TM 9-2320-339-10
0079
5
6
1
2
Figure 4.
2. Climb down from top of tank (4).
3. Remove safety pin (1) and pin (2).
WARNING
Keep hands clear of ladder hinge. Failure to comply may result in injury
or death to personnel.
4. Raise ladder (3).
0079-5
TM 9-2320-339-10
0079-6
0079
TM 9-2320-339-10
0080
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
LOAD TANKER WITH FUEL
INITIAL SETUP:
Not Applicable
WARNING
To prevent fire or explosion, do not allow smoking, flame, sparks, and hot
or glowing objects within 50 ft. (15 m) of vehicle. Read and follow all safety
precautions in FM 10-67-1. Failure to comply may result in injury or death
to personnel.
CAUTION
Drain and flush tank (WP 0084) compartment, filter/separator and piping
system with new product when changing to fuel or grade different from
last one carried. Notify field level maintenance to change all filter elements. Failure to do so may result in equipment damage.
NOTE
Refer to FM 10-67-1 for general operating instructions for tanker
vehicles.
If equipment malfunctions, check that all steps of procedure have
been performed in proper order. If equipment still malfunctions, do
troubleshooting.
1. Prepare tanker for operation. (WP 0078)
2. Connect SR1 and SR2 static cables (1) to source of fuel and to grounding devices.
0080-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
60
80
800
80
100
500
600
300
600
40
120
800
300
20
140
100
0
60
100
500
40
20
1000
1100
160
160
120
140
100
1000
1100
0080
MARSH
MARSH
D
E
F
U
E
L
F
U
E
L
OUT IN
VALVE
L L O N S
FLOW METER
Figure 1.
3. Remove dust cap (2) from A B/L RECEPTACLE (3).
4. Remove D1 adapter (4) from stowage.
0080-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
Figure 2.
5. Place end of D1 adapter (4) on A B/L RECEPTACLE (3) and align keyways.
6. Push in and turn D1 adapter (4) clockwise until locked in place.
7. Check that D1 adapter valve lever (5) is in CLOSE position.
8. Open stowage tube cover (6) and remove suction hose (7).
0080-3
0080
TM 9-2320-339-10
0080
Figure 3.
9. Remove 3 in. adapter coupling (8) from stowage and connect to one end of suction
hose (7).
Figure 4.
0080-4
TM 9-2320-339-10
0080
Figure 5.
CAUTION
Fuel loading must be discontinued if fuel flow does not stop within 15
seconds after V12 B/L PRECHECK VALVE is opened. Failure to comply
may result in damage to equipment.
13. As soon as fuel starts flowing, open V12 B/L PRECHECK VALVE (9). If fuel flow stops
within approximately 15 seconds, close V12 B/L PRECHECK VALVE and continue fuel
loading. If fuel flow does not stop within approximately 15 seconds, stop fuel loading
and notify field level maintenance.
14. When tank is full and fuel flow stops automatically, move D1 adapter valve lever (5) to
CLOSE position.
0080-5
TM 9-2320-339-10
0080
Figure 6.
15. After fuel station operator shuts off fuel, disconnect 3 in. adapter coupling (8) from D1
adapter (4).
16. Remove D1 adapter (4).
17. Drain fuel from suction hose (7) and dispose of fuel in accordance with unit SOP.
18. Disconnect suction hose (7) from fuel supply.
19. Remove 3 in. adapter coupling (8) from suction hose (7).
20. Stow suction hose (7), 3 in. adapter coupling (8), and D1 adapter (4).
21. Install dust cap (2) on A B/L RECEPTACLE (3).
0080-6
TM 9-2320-339-10
0080
10
60
80
800
80
100
500
600
300
600
40
120
800
300
20
140
100
0
60
100
500
40
20
1000
1100
160
160
120
140
100
1000
1100
MARSH
MARSH
D
E
F
U
E
L
F
U
E
L
OUT IN
VALVE
L L
O N S
FLOW METER
3
1
Figure 7.
22. Disconnect and rewind SR1 and SR2 static cables (1).
23. Close pump module rear doors (10).
BOTTOM LOAD TANK WITH TANKER FUEL PUMP
WARNING
To prevent fire or explosion, do not allow smoking, flame, sparks, and hot
or glowing objects within 50 ft. (15 m) of vehicle. Read and follow all safety
precautions in FM 10-67-1. Failure to comply may result in injury or death
to personnel.
CAUTION
Do not run tanker pump without fuel in system or damage to fuel
pump and hydraulic motor may result.
Do not press accelerator during tanker primary fuel pump operation.
Engine speeds higher than 1500 rpm may cause damage to hydraulic
motor and primary pump.
0080-7
TM 9-2320-339-10
0080
Drain and flush tank compartment, filter separator, and piping system
with new product when changing to fuel or grade different from last
one carried WP 0084. Notify field level maintenance to change all
filter elements. Failure to comply may result in damage to equipment.
NOTE
Refer to FM 10-67-1 for general operating instructions for tanker
vehicles.
If equipment malfunctions, check that all steps of procedure have
been performed in proper order. If equipment still malfunctions, do
troubleshooting.
1. Start engine (WP 0043) and position vehicle to load fuel.
2. Park vehicle. (WP 0056)
3. Set HYD ENABLE switch (1) to off position. MAIN HYD ENABLE indicator (2) will go
out.
2
1
INTERAXLE
8X8
B.O.
LIGHTS
PULL TO
EXHAUST
LER
TRAI SUPPKINLYG
AIR PAR D
FOR
NOT MIDLAN
S U P PL
Y
B.O.
SELECT
PU S H T O
CHEM
ALARM
GPPU
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
M
M
1
2
ASS
HIGH
IDLE
AlTranlissmionssion
Figure 8.
CAUTION
Do not move hydraulic selector valve control while HYD ENABLE switch
is positioned on, or vehicle hydraulic equipment may be damaged.
4. Push in hydraulic selector valve control for tanker pump operation.
0080-8
TM 9-2320-339-10
0080
HYDRAULIC SELECTOR
VALVE CONTROL
FLAMMABLE
NO SMOKING WITHIN 50 FEET
Figure 9.
5. Set HYD ENABLE switch (1) to on position. MAIN HYD ENABLE indicator (2) will
illuminate.
2
1
INTERAXLE
8X8
B.O.
LIGHTS
PULL TO
EXHAUST
LER
TRAI SUPPKINLYG
AIR PAR D
FOR
NOT MIDLAN
S U P PL
Y
B.O.
SELECT
PU S H T O
CHEM
ALARM
GPPU
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
M
M
1
2
ASS
HIGH
IDLE
AlTranlissmionssion
Figure 10.
0080-9
TM 9-2320-339-10
0080
WARNING
Stand clear to avoid injury when operating pump module rear doors.
When each door is about halfway open, gas pistons push doors open
quickly and with much force. Failure to comply may result in injury or
death to personnel.
6. Open pump module rear doors (3).
7. Position tanker controls. (WP 0078)
8. Connect SR1 and SR2 static cables (4) to source of fuel and to grounding devices.
60
80
500
40
20
60
100
800
1000
80
500
600
300
100
40
120
20
140
100
600
800
300
100
1000
1100
120
140
1100
160
160
MARSH
MARSH
D
E
F
U
E
L
F
U
E
L
OUT
IN
VALVE
L L O N S
FLOW METER
6
8
10
3
7
Figure 11.
0080-10
TM 9-2320-339-10
11
0080
12
Figure 12.
13. Remove 3 in. adapter coupling (13) and D1 adapter (14) from stowage.
0080-11
TM 9-2320-339-10
0080
14
13
10
15
12
Figure 13.
14. Place end of D1 adapter (14) on A B/L RECEPTACLE (6) and align keyways.
15. Push in and turn D1 adapter (14) clockwise until locked in place.
16. Check that D1 adapter valve lever (15) is in CLOSE position.
17. Connect 3 in. adapter coupling (13) to end of suction hose (12).
18. Connect 3 in. adapter coupling (13) to D1 adapter (14).
19. Connect other end of suction hose (12) to C BULK RECEPTACLE (UNFIL) (10).
20. Connect one end of fuel station suction hose (16) to B GRAVITY RECEPTACLE (8).
0080-12
TM 9-2320-339-10
16
15
0080
Figure 14.
21. Connect other end of fuel station suction hose (16) to fuel supply.
22. After fuel flow control valve on fuel supply is opened by fuel station operator, set D1
adapter valve lever (15) to OPEN position.
23. Open V17 GRAVITY VALVE (17).
0080-13
TM 9-2320-339-10
0080
17
60
80
800
80
100
500
600
300
600
40
120
800
300
20
140
100
0
60
100
500
40
20
1000
1100
160
160
120
140
100
1000
1100
MARSH
MARSH
D
E
F
U
E
L
F
U
E
L
OUT IN
VALVE
L L O N S
FLOW METER
22
18
19
23
20
21
Figure 15.
24. Open V18 BULK DEL VALVE (18).
25. Push PUMP ENGAGEMENT LEVER (19) forward.
26. Set TC/THROTTLE CONTROL switch (20) up to ON position.
27. Press HI/HIGH IDLE switch (21).
28. Pull out HAV HAND ACTUATED CONTROL valve (22).
NOTE
HAV HAND ACTUATED CONTROL valve must be open for fuel to flow.
29. Squeeze and hold lever (23) to open HAV HAND ACTUATED CONTROL valve (22).
CAUTION
Fuel loading must be discontinued if fuel flow does not stop within 15
seconds after V12 B/L PRECHECK VALVE is opened. Failure to comply
may result in damage to equipment.
0080-14
TM 9-2320-339-10
0080
30. As soon as fuel starts flowing, open V12 B/L PRECHECK VALVE (24). If fuel flow stops
within approximately 15 seconds, close V12 B/L PRECHECK VALVE and continue fuel
loading. If fuel flow does not stop within 15 seconds, stop fueling and notify field level
maintenance.
24
Figure 16.
31. When tank is full and fuel flow stops automatically, let go of HAV HAND ACTUATED
CONTROL valve lever (23).
0080-15
TM 9-2320-339-10
26
0080
17
60
80
800
80
100
500
600
300
600
40
120
800
300
20
140
100
0
60
100
500
40
20
1000
1100
160
160
120
140
100
1000
1100
MARSH
MARSH
D
E
F
U
E
L
F
U
E
L
OUT IN
VALVE
L L O N S
FLOW METER
22
25
18
19
23
20
Figure 17.
32. Pull back on PUMP ENGAGEMENT LEVER (19) until locked.
CAUTION
Carefully guide HAV hand actuated control valve hoses through access
hole onto reel. Failure to comply may result in damage to equipment.
33. Rewind HAV HAND ACTUATED CONTROL valve hoses (25) onto reel (26).
34. Set TC/THROTTLE CONTROL switch (20) down to OFF position.
35. After fuel station operator shuts off fuel flow from fuel supply, close V18 BULK DEL
VALVE (18).
36. Close V17 GRAVITY VALVE (17).
37. Disconnect fuel station suction hose (16) from B GRAVITY RECEPTACLE (8).
0080-16
TM 9-2320-339-10
16
0080
Figure 18.
NOTE
Remove remaining fuel in fuel station suction hose by walking out hose.
38. Drain fuel from fuel station suction hose (16) and dispose of fuel in accordance with unit
SOP.
39. Disconnect fuel station suction hose (16) from fuel supply.
40. Set D1 adapter valve lever (15) to CLOSE position.
41. Remove D1 adapter (14) from A B/L RECEPTACLE (6).
0080-17
TM 9-2320-339-10
0080
14
13
10
15
12
Figure 19.
NOTE
Remove remaining fuel in suction hose by walking out suction hose.
42. Drain fuel from suction hose (12) and dispose of fuel in accordance with unit SOP.
43. Disconnect 3 in. adapter coupling (13) from D1 adapter (14).
44. Disconnect suction hose (12) from C BULK RECEPTACLE (UNFIL) (10).
45. Remove 3 in. adapter coupling (13) from suction hose (12).
46. Return 3 in. adapter coupling (13) and D1 adapter (14) to vehicle stowage.
NOTE
Return fuel station suction hose to fuel station operator.
47. Stow suction hose (12).
48. Install dust caps (5, 7, and 9) on A B/L RECEPTACLE (6), B GRAVITY RECEPTACLE
(8), and C BULK RECEPTACLE (UNFIL) (10).
0080-18
TM 9-2320-339-10
0080
60
80
800
80
100
500
600
300
600
40
120
800
300
20
140
100
0
60
100
500
40
20
1000
1100
160
160
120
140
100
1000
1100
MARSH
MARSH
D
E
F
U
E
L
F
U
E
L
OUT IN
VALVE
L L O N S
FLOW METER
10
4
Figure 20.
49. Disconnect and rewind SR1 and SR2 static cables (4).
50. Close pump module rear doors (3).
51. Set HYD ENABLE switch (1) to off position. MAIN HYD ENABLE indicator (2) will go
out.
0080-19
TM 9-2320-339-10
0080
2
1
INTERAXLE
8X8
B.O.
LIGHTS
EXHAUST
LER
TRAI SUPPKINLYG
AINOTR FORMIDPARLAND
S U P PL
Y
PULL TO
B.O.
SELECT
PU S H T O
CHEM
ALARM
GPPU
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
M
M
1
2
ASS
HIGH
IDLE
AlTranlissmionssion
Figure 21.
52. Shut off engine. (WP 0056)
TOP LOADING FUEL
WARNING
CAUTION
Drain and flush tank compartment, filter/separator, and piping system
with new product when changing to fuel or grade different from last
one carried WP 0084. Notify field level maintenance to change all
filter elements. Failure to do so may result in equipment damage.
0080-20
TM 9-2320-339-10
NOTE
Fuel should only be loaded through manhole when bottom loading
cannot be done. Tank should be bottom loaded with either exterior
pump or tanker fuel pump whenever possible.
Refer to FM 10-67-1 for general operating instructions for tanker
vehicles.
If equipment malfunctions, check that all steps of procedure have
been performed in proper order. If equipment still malfunctions, do
troubleshooting.
When top loading, slowly begin the flow of product and continue at a
reduced rate until the lower end of the drop tube or discharge hose
is covered with product and then gradually increase the flow rate and
fill the tank.
1. Prepare tanker for operation (WP 0078).
2. Close pump module rear doors (1).
0080-21
0080
TM 9-2320-339-10
60
80
500
40
20
60
100
800
1000
80
500
600
300
100
40
120
20
140
100
600
800
300
100
1000
1100
120
140
1100
160
160
0080
MARSH
MARSH
D
E
F
U
E
L
F
U
E
L
OUT
IN
VALVE
L L O N S
FLOW METER
Figure 22.
3. Connect SR1 and SR2 static cables (2) to the fuel source and to grounding devices.
WARNING
Keep hands clear of ladder hinge. Failure to comply may result in injury
or death to personnel.
4. Remove vehicle fire extinguishers (WP 0036) and bring them to the point of operation.
5. Remove safety pin (3) and pin (4). Lower ladder (5).
0080-22
TM 9-2320-339-10
Figure 23.
6. Install pin (4) and safety pin (3) in ladder.
7. Climb on top of tank (6).
WARNING
0080-23
0080
TM 9-2320-339-10
0080
Figure 24.
10. After fuel station operator fills tank to desired level and stops fuel flow, remove fillstand
downspout from manhole fill opening (9).
11. Close manhole cover (8) and secure latch (7).
12. Climb down from top of tank (6).
0080-24
TM 9-2320-339-10
Figure 25.
13. Remove safety pin (3) and pin (4) from ladder (5).
14. Raise ladder (5).
15. Install pin (4) and safety pin (3).
16. Disconnect and rewind SR1 and SR2 static cables (2).
17. Install vehicle fire extinguishers. (WP 0036)
END OF TASK
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0080-25
0080
TM 9-2320-339-10
0081
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
SERVICE LAND VEHICLE OR AIRCRAFT (OVER-WING) WITH FUEL
INITIAL SETUP:
Not Applicable
WARNING
To prevent fire or explosion, do not allow smoking, flame, sparks, and hot
or glowing objects within 50 ft. (15 m) of vehicle. Read and follow all safety
precautions in FM 10-67-1. Failure to comply may result in injury or death
to personnel.
CAUTION
Do not run tanker pump without fuel in system or damage to fuel
pump and hydraulic motor may result.
Do not press accelerator during tanker primary fuel pump operation.
Engine speeds higher than 1500 rpm may cause damage to hydraulic
motor and primary pump.
NOTE
Refer to FM 10-67-1 for general operating instructions for tank
vehicles and information on aircraft fueling.
If equipment malfunctions, check that all steps of procedure have
been performed in proper order. If equipment still malfunctions, do
troubleshooting.
1. Start engine (WP 0043) and position vehicle for fuel servicing.
2. Park vehicle. (WP 0055)
3. Set HYD ENABLE switch (1) to off position. MAIN HYD ENABLE indicator (2) will go
out.
0081-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
0081
2
1
INTERAXLE
8X8
B.O.
LIGHTS
EXHAUST
LER
TRAI SUPPKINLYG
AINOTR FORMIDPARLAND
S U P PL
Y
PULL TO
B.O.
SELECT
PU S H T O
CHEM
ALARM
GPPU
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
M
M
1
2
ASS
HIGH
IDLE
AlTranlissmionssion
Figure 1.
CAUTION
Do not move hydraulic selector valve control while HYD ENABLE switch
is set to on position or vehicle hydraulic equipment may be damaged.
4. Push in hydraulic selector valve control for tanker pump operation.
0081-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
0081
HYDRAULIC SELECTOR
VALVE CONTROL
FLAMMABLE
NO SMOKING WITHIN 50 FEET
Figure 2.
5. Set HYD ENABLE switch (1) to on position. MAIN HYD ENABLE indicator (2) will
illuminate.
2
1
INTERAXLE
8X8
B.O.
LIGHTS
PULL TO
EXHAUST
LER
TRAI SUPPKINLYG
AIR PAR D
FOR
NOT MIDLAN
S U P PL
Y
B.O.
SELECT
PU S H T O
CHEM
ALARM
GPPU
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
M
M
1
2
ASS
HIGH
IDLE
AlTranlissmionssion
Figure 3.
0081-3
TM 9-2320-339-10
0081
WARNING
Stand clear to avoid injury when operating pump module rear doors.
When each door is about halfway open, gas pistons push doors open
quickly and with much force. Failure to comply may result in injury or
death to personnel.
6. Open tanker module doors (3).
60
80
500
40
20
60
100
800
1000
80
500
600
300
100
40
120
20
140
100
600
800
300
100
1000
1100
120
140
1100
160
160
MARSH
MARSH
D
E
F
U
E
L
F
U
E
L
OUT
IN
VALVE
L L O N S
FLOW METER
Figure 4.
7. Position tanker controls. (WP 0078)
0081-4
TM 9-2320-339-10
0081
8. Connect SR1 and SR2 static cables (4) to vehicle being serviced and grounding
devices.
FUEL SERVICING
WARNING
To prevent fire or explosion, do not allow smoking, flame, sparks, and hot
or glowing objects within 50 ft. (15 m) of vehicle. Read and follow all safety
precautions in FM 10-67-1. Failure to comply may result in injury or death
to personnel.
NOTE
Driver side servicing hose is shown. Procedure for using passenger side
servicing hose is same.
1. Disengage hose reel tension knob (1).
60
80
800
120
140
100
80
100
500
600
300
20
0
60
100
500
40
600
40
800
300
20
0
160
120
140
100
1000
1000
1100
1100
160
0
MARSH
MARSH
D
E
F
F
U
OUT
L
IN
VALVE
L L O N S
FLOW METER
60
80
100
500
600
40
800
300
20
0
120
140
100
1000
1100
160
0
MARSH
Figure 5.
2. Remove rubber tie down strap (2) to release fuel service nozzle (5) from stowage
position.
0081-5
TM 9-2320-339-10
0081
NOTE
Use fuel service nozzle for fueling land vehicles. Use over-wing
nozzle for over-wing fueling of aircraft.
Reducer adapter is used with over-wing nozzle only. If not fueling an
aircraft and/or using the over-wing fueling, skip to Step (8).
5. Remove fuel service nozzle (5) from servicing hose (3).
10
80
80
60
60
100
500
40
100
40
120
100
140
1100
160
160
120
1000
1100
600
800
300
20
140
1000
0
0
100
500
600
800
300
20
MARSH
MARSH
D
E
F
U
E
F
U
E
L
OUT
IN
VALVE
L L O N S
FLOW METER
9
5
7
Figure 6.
6. Stow fuel service nozzle (5). Remove over-wing nozzle (6) and reducer adapter (7) from
stowage.
7. Install reducer adapter (7) on servicing hose (3). Install over-wing nozzle (6) on reducer
adapter (7).
0081-6
TM 9-2320-339-10
0081
NOTE
Refer to tanker module controls-center (WP 0029) for information about
discharge line pressure gauge (DLPG) and venturi-nozzle pressure
gauge (VNPG).
10. Determine required rate of delivery for servicing hose being used.
NOTE
V8 REEL VALVE controls rate of fuel delivery when passenger side servicing hose is used for fueling.
11. Adjust V7 REEL VALVE (10) to control rate of fuel delivery through servicing hose (3).
Table 1. V7 and V8 Reel Valve
Fueling Delivery Rates
Position
1, 2, 3, 4
105 5
90 5
75 5
50 5
15 5
0081-7
TM 9-2320-339-10
60
80
500
40
20
60
100
800
1000
80
500
600
300
100
40
120
20
140
100
600
800
300
100
1000
1100
120
140
1100
160
160
0081
MARSH
MARSH
D
E
F
U
E
L
F
U
E
L
OUT
IN
VALVE
L L O N S
FLOW METER
14
11
12
13
Figure 7.
13. Set TC/THROTTLE CONTROL switch (12) to ON.
14. Press HI/HIGH IDLE switch (13).
15. Pull out HAV HAND ACTUATED CONTROL valve (14).
16. Remove fuel filter cover from receiving vehicle or aircraft.
17. Insert fuel service nozzle (5) or over-wing nozzle (6) through fuel filler of receiving
vehicle or aircraft.
0081-8
TM 9-2320-339-10
0081
8
80
80
60
60
100
500
40
100
40
120
100
140
1100
160
160
120
1000
1100
600
800
300
20
140
1000
0
0
100
500
600
800
300
20
MARSH
MARSH
D
E
F
U
E
F
U
E
L
OUT
IN
VALVE
L L O N S
FLOW METER
15
14
16
3
17
Figure 8.
NOTE
HAV HAND ACTUATED CONTROL valve must be open for fuel to flow.
18. Squeeze and hold lever (15) to open HAV HAND ACTUATED CONTROL valve (14).
19. Squeeze and hold lever (16) on fuel service nozzle (5) or lever (17) on over-wing nozzle
(6) to start fuel flow.
20. When receiving vehicle or aircraft tank is filled to desired level, release lever (16 or 17)
and HAV HAND ACTUATED CONTROL valve lever (15).
21. Remove fuel service nozzle (5) or over-wing nozzle (6) from receiving vehicle or aircraft
fuel filler.
22. Install fuel filler cover on receiving vehicle or aircraft.
0081-9
TM 9-2320-339-10
0081
NOTE
Tanker must have at least 300 gal (1136 liters) of fuel remaining in order
to perform fuel hose evacuation.
23. Pull out V6 FUEL/DEFUEL VALVE control rod (8).
24. Squeeze and hold lever (15) to open HAV HAND ACTUATED CONTROL valve (14).
25. Squeeze and hold lever (16) on fuel service nozzle (5) or level (17) on over-wing nozzle
(6) to evacuate fuel from servicing hose (3).
26. When all fuel is evacuated from servicing hose (3), release lever (16 or 17) and lever
(15) on HAV HAND ACTUATED CONTROL valve (14). Dispose of fuel in accordance
with unit SOP.
27. Let HAV HAND ACTUATED CONTROL valve hoses (18) rewind onto reel (19) and
stow inside pump module (20).
20
10
60
80
500
40
20
60
100
800
1000
80
500
600
300
100
40
120
20
140
100
600
800
300
100
1000
1100
120
140
1100
160
160
MARSH
MARSH
D
E
F
U
E
L
F
U
E
L
OUT
IN
VALVE
L L O N S
FLOW METER
19
11
18
12
Figure 9.
0081-10
TM 9-2320-339-10
0081
60
80
500
40
20
60
100
800
1000
80
500
600
300
100
40
120
20
140
100
600
800
300
100
1000
1100
120
140
1100
160
160
MARSH
MARSH
D
E
F
U
E
L
F
U
E
L
OUT
IN
VALVE
L L O N S
FLOW METER
3
7
Figure 10.
NOTE
Reducer adapter is used with over-wing nozzle only. If over-wing nozzle
was not used, skip to Step (35).
33. Remove reducer adapter (7) from servicing hose (3).
34. Return over-wing nozzle (6) and reducer adapter (7) to stowage.
35. Remove hand crank handle (21) from stowage.
0081-11
TM 9-2320-339-10
0081
24
60
80
500
40
20
60
100
800
1000
80
500
600
300
100
40
120
20
140
100
600
140
1000
1100
160
160
120
800
300
100
0
1100
MARSH
MARSH
D
E
F
U
E
L
F
U
E
L
OUT
IN
VALVE
L L O N S
FLOW METER
S
23
22
21
Figure 11.
36. Release hose reel tension knob (1).
37. Insert hand crank handle (21) onto crankshaft (22).
38. Turn hand crank handle (21) to rewind servicing hose (3) onto reel (4).
39. Place fuel service nozzle (5) in stowage position and secure with rubber tiedown strap
(2).
40. Engage hose reel tension knob (1).
41. Return hand crank handle (21) to stowage.
42. Disconnect and rewind SR1 and SR2 static cables (23).
43. Close tanker module doors (24).
44. Set HYD ENABLE switch (25) to off position. MAIN HYD ENABLE indicator (26) will go
out.
0081-12
TM 9-2320-339-10
25
0081
26
CHEM
ALARM
INTER
AXLE
8X8
25
22
15
11
8
6.2
5.5
3.7
2.7
2.0
IN H20 kPa
FILTER MINDER
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
B.O
SELECT
GPFU
B.O
LIGHTS
PARKING
BRAKE
HIGH
IDLE
1
2
TRAILER
AIR SUPPLY
0
1
2
AIR BRAKE
Figure 12.
45. Shut off engine. (WP 0056)
END OF TASK
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0081-13
TM 9-2320-339-10
0082
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
RE-CIRCULATE FUEL
INITIAL SETUP:
Not Applicable
WARNING
To prevent fire or explosion, do not allow smoking, flame, sparks, and hot
or glowing objects within 50 ft. (15 m) of vehicle. Read and follow all safety
precautions in FM 10-67-1. Failure to comply may result in injury or death
to personnel.
CAUTION
Do not run tanker pump without fuel in system or damage to fuel
pump and hydraulic motor may result.
Do not press accelerator during tanker primary fuel pump operation.
Engine speeds higher than 1500 rpm may cause damage to hydraulic
motor and primary pump.
NOTE
If equipment malfunctions, check that all steps of procedure have been
performed in proper order. If equipment still malfunctions, do troubleshooting.
1. Start engine. (WP 0043)
2. Park vehicle. (WP 0055)
3. Set HYD ENABLE switch (1) to off position. MAIN HYD ENABLE indicator (2) will go
out.
0082-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
0082
2
1
INTERAXLE
8X8
B.O.
LIGHTS
EXHAUST
LER
TRAI SUPPKINLYG
AINOTR FORMIDPARLAND
S U P PL
Y
PULL TO
B.O.
SELECT
PU S H T O
CHEM
ALARM
GPPU
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
M
M
1
2
ASS
HIGH
IDLE
AlTranlissmionssion
Figure 1.
CAUTION
Do not move hydraulic selector valve control while HYD ENABLE switch
is set to on position or vehicle hydraulic equipment may be damaged.
4. Push in hydraulic selector valve control for tanker pump operation.
0082-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
0082
HYDRAULIC SELECTOR
VALVE CONTROL
FLAMMABLE
NO SMOKING WITHIN 50 FEET
Figure 2.
5. Set HYD ENABLE switch (1) to on position. MAIN HYD ENABLE indicator (2) will
illuminate.
2
1
INTERAXLE
8X8
B.O.
LIGHTS
PULL TO
EXHAUST
LER
TRAI SUPPKINLYG
AIR PAR D
FOR
NOT MIDLAN
S U P PL
Y
B.O.
SELECT
PU S H T O
CHEM
ALARM
GPPU
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
M
M
1
2
ASS
HIGH
IDLE
AlTranlissmionssion
Figure 3.
0082-3
TM 9-2320-339-10
0082
WARNING
Stand clear to avoid injury when operating pump module rear doors.
When each door is about halfway open, gas pistons push doors open
quickly and with much force. Failure to comply may result in injury or
death to personnel.
6. Open pump module rear doors (3).
10
11
60
80
800
80
100
500
600
300
600
40
120
800
300
20
140
100
0
60
100
500
40
20
1000
1100
160
160
120
140
100
1000
1100
MARSH
MARSH
D
E
F
U
E
L
F
U
E
L
OUT IN
VALVE
L L O N S
FLOW METER
3
4
Figure 4.
0082-4
TM 9-2320-339-10
0082
NOTE
Driver side servicing hose is shown. Procedure for using passenger side
servicing hose is same.
10. Remove rubber tie-down strap (7) to release fuel service nozzle (8) from stowed
position.
11. Disengage hose reel tension knob (9).
12. Pull out about 15 ft. (5 m) of servicing hose (10) from reel (11).
13. Engage hose reel tension knob (9).
14. Remove fuel service nozzle (8) from servicing hose (10). Place fuel service nozzle (8)
in stowage.
15. Remove D1 adapter (12) from stowage.
12
10
6
Figure 5.
0082-5
TM 9-2320-339-10
0082
WARNING
To prevent fire or explosion, do not allow smoking, flame, sparks, and hot
or glowing objects within 50 ft. (15 m) of vehicle. Read and follow all safety
precautions in FM 10-67-1. Failure to comply may result in injury or death
to personnel.
1. Push in V6 FUEL/DEFUEL valve control rod (1).
60
80
800
80
100
500
600
300
600
40
120
800
300
20
140
100
0
60
100
500
40
20
1000
1100
160
160
120
140
100
1000
1100
MARSH
MARSH
D
E
F
U
E
L
F
U
E
L
OUT IN
VALVE
L L O N S
FLOW METER
1
4
5
Figure 6.
0082-6
TM 9-2320-339-10
0082
NOTE
Refer to tanker module controls-center (WP 0029) for information
about discharge line pressure gauge (DLPG) and venturi-nozzle
pressure gauge (VNPG).
V8 REEL VALVE is used to control flow rate when right side servicing
hose is used.
6. Open V7 REEL VALVE (6).
60
80
800
80
100
500
600
300
600
40
120
800
300
20
140
100
0
60
100
500
40
20
1000
1100
160
160
120
140
100
1000
1100
MARSH
MARSH
D
E
F
U
E
L
F
U
E
L
OUT IN
VALVE
L L O N S
FLOW METER
8
7
Figure 7.
7. Pull out HAV HAND ACTUATED CONTROL valve (7).
8. Move D1 adapter valve lever (8) to OPEN position.
NOTE
HAV HAND ACTUATED CONTROL valve must be open for fuel to flow.
9. Squeeze and hold HAV HAND ACTUATED CONTROL valve lever (9) to recirculate
fuel.
0082-7
TM 9-2320-339-10
0082
60
80
800
80
100
500
600
300
600
40
120
800
300
20
140
100
0
60
100
500
40
20
1000
1100
160
160
120
140
100
1000
1100
MARSH
MARSH
D
E
F
U
E
L
F
U
E
L
OUT IN
VALVE
L L O N S
FLOW METER
8
9
10
10
Figure 8.
10. When recirculation is completed, release HAV HAND ACTUATED CONTROL valve
lever (9).
11. Move D1 adapter valve lever (8) to CLOSE position.
NOTE
Tanker must be holding at least 300 gal (1136 liters) of fuel in order to
perform fuel hose evacuation.
12. Pull out V6 FUEL/DEFUEL VALVE control rod (1).
0082-8
TM 9-2320-339-10
0082
13. Squeeze and hold HAV HAND ACTUTATED CONTROL valve lever (9) to aid in
evacuating fuel from servicing hose (10).
14. Close V7 REEL VALVE (6) and release HAV HAND ACTUATED CONTROL valve lever
(9).
SHUT DOWN RE-CIRCULATION OF FUEL
WARNING
To prevent fire or explosion, do not allow smoking, flame, sparks, and hot
or glowing objects within 50 ft. (15 m) of vehicle. Read and follow all safety
precautions in FM 10-67-1. Failure to comply may result in injury or death
to personnel.
NOTE
A small amount of fuel will remain in servicing hose. Keep servicing hose
opening pointed up to prevent fuel spillage while installing fuel service
nozzle.
1. Disconnect D1 adapter (1) from A B/L RECEPTACLE (2).
0082-9
TM 9-2320-339-10
8
1
0082
3
7
Figure 9.
2. Disconnect servicing hose (3) from D1 adapter (1).
3. Stow D1 adapter (1).
4. Remove fuel service nozzle (4) from stowage and install on servicing hose (3).
5. Squeeze and hold HAV HAND ACTUATED CONTROL valve lever (5) and open V7
REEL VALVE (6).
6. Squeeze and hold lever (7) on fuel service nozzle (4) to complete servicing hose (3)
evacuation.
7. When all fuel is emptied from servicing hose (3), release HAV HAND ACTUATED
CONTROL valve lever (5) and fuel service nozzle lever (7).
8. Close V7 REEL VALVE (6).
9. Install dust cap (8) on A B/L RECEPTACLE (2).
10. Set TC/THROTTLE CONTROL switch (9) to OFF position.
0082-10
TM 9-2320-339-10
0082
14
13
60
80
500
40
20
60
100
800
1000
80
500
600
300
100
40
120
20
140
100
600
800
300
100
1000
1100
120
140
1100
160
160
MARSH
MARSH
D
E
F
U
E
L
F
U
E
L
OUT
IN
VALVE
L L O N S
FLOW METER
12
10
11
9
Figure 10.
11. Pull back on PUMP ENGAGEMENT LEVER (10) until locked.
12. Push MC MANUAL CONTROL EM VALVE lever (11) forward.
CAUTION
Carefully guide control valve hoses through access hole onto reel. Failure
to comply may result in equipment damage.
13. Rewind HAV HAND ACTUATED CONTROL valve hoses (12) onto reel (13) and stow
inside pump module (14).
14. Remove hand crank handle (15) from stowage on pump module (14).
0082-11
TM 9-2320-339-10
18
0082
14
21
16
60
80
800
80
100
500
600
300
600
40
120
800
300
20
140
100
0
60
100
500
40
20
1000
1100
160
160
120
140
100
1000
1100
MARSH
MARSH
D
E
F
U
E
L
F
U
E
L
OUT IN
VALVE
L L OS
N
FLOW METER
19
17
20
15
Figure 11.
15. Disengage hose reel tension knob (16).
16. Insert hand crank handle (15) onto crankshaft (17).
17. Turn hand crank handle (15) to rewind servicing hose (3) onto reel (18).
18. Return fuel service nozzle (4) to stowed position and connect rubber tie-down strap (19)
to hold fuel service nozzle (4) in place.
19. Engage hose reel tension knob (16).
20. Return hand crank handle (15) to stowage.
21. Disconnect and rewind SR1 and SR2 static cables (20).
22. Close pump module rear doors (21).
23. Set HYD ENABLE switch (22) to off position. MAIN HYD ENABLE indicator (23) will go
out.
0082-12
TM 9-2320-339-10
22
0082
23
CHEM
ALARM
INTER
AXLE
8X8
25
22
15
11
8
6.2
5.5
3.7
2.7
2.0
IN H20 kPa
FILTER MINDER
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
B.O
SELECT
GPFU
B.O
LIGHTS
PARKING
BRAKE
HIGH
IDLE
1
2
TRAILER
AIR SUPPLY
0
1
2
AIR BRAKE
Figure 12.
24. Shut off engine. (WP 0056)
END OF TASK
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0082-13
TM 9-2320-339-10
0083
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
UNLOAD FUEL FROM TANKER
INITIAL SETUP:
Not Applicable
WARNING
To prevent fire or explosion, do not allow smoking, flame, sparks, and hot
or glowing objects within 50 ft. (15 m) of vehicle. Read and follow all safety
precautions in FM 10-67-1. Failure to comply may result in injury or death
to personnel.
CAUTION
Do not run tanker pump without fuel in system or damage to fuel
pump and hydraulic motor may result.
Do not press accelerator during tanker primary fuel pump operation.
Engine speeds higher than 1500 rpm may cause damage to hydraulic
motor and primary pump.
NOTE
Dispose of unloaded/drained fuel in accordance with unit SOP.
If equipment malfunctions, check that all steps of procedure have
been performed in proper order. If equipment still malfunctions,
complete troubleshooting procedures.
1. Start engine (WP 0043) and position fuel for bulk unloading.
2. Park vehicle. (WP 0055)
3. Set HYD ENABLE switch (1) to off position. MAIN HYD ENABLE indicator (2) will go
out.
0083-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
0083
2
1
INTERAXLE
8X8
B.O.
LIGHTS
EXHAUST
LER
TRAI SUPPKINLYG
AINOTR FORMIDPARLAND
S U P PL
Y
PULL TO
B.O.
SELECT
PU S H T O
CHEM
ALARM
GPPU
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
M
M
1
2
ASS
HIGH
IDLE
AlTranlissmionssion
Figure 1.
CAUTION
Do not move hydraulic selector valve control while HYD ENABLE switch
is set to on position or vehicle hydraulic equipment may be damaged.
4. Push in hydraulic selector valve control for tanker pump operation.
0083-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
0083
HYDRAULIC SELECTOR
VALVE CONTROL
FLAMMABLE
NO SMOKING WITHIN 50 FEET
Figure 2.
5. Set HYD ENABLE switch (1) to on position. MAIN HYD ENABLE indicator (2) will
illuminate.
2
1
INTERAXLE
8X8
B.O.
LIGHTS
PULL TO
EXHAUST
LER
TRAI SUPPKINLYG
AIR PAR D
FOR
NOT MIDLAN
S U P PL
Y
B.O.
SELECT
PU S H T O
CHEM
ALARM
GPPU
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
M
M
1
2
ASS
HIGH
IDLE
AlTranlissmionssion
Figure 3.
0083-3
TM 9-2320-339-10
0083
WARNING
Stand clear to avoid injury when operating pump module rear doors.
When each door is about halfway open, gas pistons push doors open
quickly and with much force. Failure to comply may result in injury or
death to personnel.
6. Open pump module rear doors (3).
60
80
800
80
100
500
600
300
600
40
120
800
300
20
140
100
0
60
100
500
40
20
1000
1100
160
160
120
140
100
1000
1100
MARSH
MARSH
D
E
F
U
E
L
F
U
E
L
OUT IN
VALVE
L L O N S
FLOW METER
3
4
Figure 4.
7. Position tanker controls. (WP 0078)
8. Connect SR1 and SR2 static cables (4) to equipment receiving fuel and to grounding
devices.
9. Remove dust cap (5) from D BULK RECEPTACLE (METERED) (6).
0083-4
TM 9-2320-339-10
60
80
800
80
100
500
600
300
600
40
120
800
300
20
140
100
0
60
100
500
40
20
1000
1100
160
160
120
140
100
1000
1100
0083
MARSH
MARSH
D
E
F
U
E
L
F
U
E
L
OUT IN
VALVE
L L O N S
FLOW METER
5
6
Figure 5.
10. Open stowage tube cover (7) and remove suction hose (8).
0083-5
TM 9-2320-339-10
0083
Figure 6.
11. Connect one end of suction hose (8) to D BULK RECEPTACLE (METERED) (6) and
other end to receiving receptacle.
0083-6
TM 9-2320-339-10
60
80
100
500
600
40
800
300
20
120
140
100
0
0083
1000
1100
160
0
MARSH
D
F
E
U
F
E
U
L
E
L
OUT IN
11
10
VALVE
L L O N S
6
FLOW METER
9
8
Figure 7.
12. Pull back MC MANUAL CONTROL EM VALVE lever (9).
13. Set V11 FLOW VALVE (REG) (10) to desired flow rate.
14. Push V6 FUEL/DEFUEL VALVE control rod (11) in.
15. Push PUMP ENGAGEMENT LEVER (12) forward.
0083-7
TM 9-2320-339-10
0083
11
60
80
60
100
500
800
300
20
120
140
100
80
100
500
600
40
600
40
800
300
20
140
100
1000
1000
0
1100
1100
160
160
120
MARSH
MARSH
D
E
F
U
E
L
F
U
E
L
OUT IN
VALVE
L L O N S
18
FLOW METER
17
13
12
10
16
15
14
Figure 8.
16. Pull out HAV HAND ACTUATED CONTROL valve (13).
17. Set TC/THROTTLE CONTROL switch (14) up to ON.
18. Press HI/HIGH IDLE switch (15).
NOTE
HAV HAND ACTUATED CONTROL valve must be open for fuel to flow.
19. Squeeze and hold HAV HAND ACTUATED CONTROL valve lever (16) to unload fuel.
20. When unloading is finished, release HAV HAND ACTUATED CONTROL valve lever
(16).
21. Set TC/THROTTLE CONTROL switch (14) down to OFF.
22. Pull back on PUMP ENGAGEMENT LEVER (12) until locked.
23. Push MC MANUAL CONTROL EM VALVE lever (9) forward.
24. Push V6 FUEL/DEFUEL VALVE control rod (11) in.
0083-8
TM 9-2320-339-10
0083
Figure 9.
30. Install dust cap (5) on D BULK RECEPTACLE (METERED) (6).
0083-9
TM 9-2320-339-10
0083
60
80
800
80
100
500
600
300
600
40
120
800
300
20
140
100
0
60
100
500
40
20
1000
1100
160
160
120
140
100
1000
1100
MARSH
MARSH
D
E
F
U
E
L
F
U
E
L
OUT IN
VALVE
L L O N S
FLOW METER
6
4
Figure 10.
31. Disconnect and rewind SR1 and SR2 static cables (4).
32. Close pump module rear doors (3).
33. Set HYD ENABLE switch (1) to off position. MAIN HYD ENABLE indicator (2) will go
out.
0083-10
TM 9-2320-339-10
0083
2
1
INTERAXLE
8X8
B.O.
LIGHTS
EXHAUST
LER
TRAI SUPPKINLYG
AINOTR FORMIDPARLAND
S U P PL
Y
PULL TO
B.O.
SELECT
PU S H T O
CHEM
ALARM
GPPU
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
M
M
1
2
ASS
HIGH
IDLE
AlTranlissmionssion
Figure 11.
34. Shut off engine. (WP 0056)
UNFILTERED BULK UNLOADING
WARNING
To prevent fire or explosion, do not allow smoking, flame, sparks, and hot
or glowing objects within 50 ft. (15 m) of vehicle. Read and follow all safety
precautions in FM 10-67-1. Failure to comply may result in injury or death
to personnel.
CAUTION
Do not run tanker pump without fuel in system or damage to fuel
pump and hydraulic motor may result.
Do not press accelerator during tanker primary fuel pump operation.
Engine speeds higher than 1500 rpm may cause damage to hydraulic
motor and primary pump.
NOTE
Dispose of unloaded/drained fuel in accordance with unit SOP.
0083-11
TM 9-2320-339-10
0083
2
1
INTERAXLE
8X8
B.O.
LIGHTS
PULL TO
EXHAUST
LER
TRAI SUPPKINLYG
AIR PAR D
FOR
NOT MIDLAN
S U P PL
Y
B.O.
SELECT
PU S H T O
CHEM
ALARM
GPPU
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
M
M
1
2
ASS
HIGH
IDLE
AlTranlissmionssion
Figure 12.
CAUTION
Do not move hydraulic selector valve control while HYD ENABLE switch
is positioned on, or vehicle hydraulic equipment may be damaged.
4. Push in hydraulic selector valve control for tanker pump operation.
0083-12
TM 9-2320-339-10
0083
HYDRAULIC SELECTOR
VALVE CONTROL
FLAMMABLE
NO SMOKING WITHIN 50 FEET
Figure 13.
5. Set HYD ENABLE switch (1) to on position. MAIN HYD ENABLE indicator (2) will
illuminate.
2
1
INTERAXLE
8X8
B.O.
LIGHTS
PULL TO
EXHAUST
LER
TRAI SUPPKINLYG
AIR PAR D
FOR
NOT MIDLAN
S U P PL
Y
B.O.
SELECT
PU S H T O
CHEM
ALARM
GPPU
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
M
M
1
2
ASS
HIGH
IDLE
AlTranlissmionssion
Figure 14.
0083-13
TM 9-2320-339-10
0083
WARNING
Stand clear to avoid injury when operating pump module rear doors.
When each door is about halfway open, gas pistons push doors open
quickly and with much force. Failure to comply may result in injury or
death to personnel.
6. Open pump module rear doors (3).
60
80
800
80
100
500
600
300
600
40
120
800
300
20
140
100
0
60
100
500
40
20
1000
1100
160
160
120
140
100
1000
1100
MARSH
MARSH
D
E
F
U
E
L
F
U
E
L
OUT IN
VALVE
L L O N S
FLOW METER
5
4
Figure 15.
7. Position tanker controls. (WP 0078)
8. Connect SR1 and SR2 static cables (4) to equipment receiving fuel and to grounding
devices.
0083-14
TM 9-2320-339-10
0083
Figure 16.
11. Connect one end of suction hose (8) to C BULK RECEPTACLE (UNFIL) (6) and other
end to receiving receptacle.
0083-15
TM 9-2320-339-10
60
80
100
500
600
40
800
300
20
120
140
100
0
0083
1000
1100
160
0
MARSH
D
F
E
U
F
E
U
L
E
L
OUT IN
VALVE
L L O N S
10
FLOW METER
Figure 17.
12. Pull back MC MANUAL CONTROL EM VALVE lever (9).
13. Open V18 BULK DELIVERY VALVE (10).
14. Push PUMP ENGAGEMENT LEVER (11) forward.
0083-16
TM 9-2320-339-10
60
80
60
100
500
800
300
120
140
100
80
100
500
600
40
20
600
40
800
300
20
0
1100
1000
1100
160
160
120
140
100
1000
0083
MARSH
MARSH
D
E
F
U
E
L
F
U
E
L
OUT IN
VALVE
L L O N S
17
FLOW METER
16
12
11
10
15
14
3
Figure 18.
15. Pull out HAV HAND ACTUATED CONTROL valve (12).
16. Set TC/THROTTLE CONTROL switch (13) up to ON position.
17. Press HI/HIGH IDLE switch (14).
NOTE
HAV HAND ACTUATED CONTROL valve must be open for fuel to flow.
18. Squeeze and hold HAV HAND ACTUATED CONTROL valve lever (15) to unload fuel.
19. When unloading is finished; release HAV HAND ACTUATED CONTROL valve lever
(15).
20. Set TC/THROTTLE CONTROL switch (13) down to OFF.
21. Pull back on PUMP ENGAGEMENT LEVER (11) until locked.
22. Push MC MANUAL CONTROL EM VALVE lever (9) forward.
23. Close V18 BULK DELIVERY VALVE (10).
0083-17
TM 9-2320-339-10
0083
CAUTION
Carefully guide control valve hoses through access hole onto reel. Failure
to comply may result in damage to equipment.
24. Rewind HAV HAND ACTUATED CONTROL valve hoses (16) on to reel (17).
NOTE
Remove remaining fuel in suction hose by walking out suction hose.
25. Remove suction hose (8), drain fuel, and dispose of fuel in accordance with unit SOP.
26. Return suction hose (8) to stowage tube and close cover (7).
Figure 19.
27. Disconnect and rewind SR1 and SR2 static cables (4).
0083-18
TM 9-2320-339-10
0083
60
80
800
80
100
500
600
300
600
40
120
800
300
20
140
100
0
60
100
500
40
20
1000
1100
160
160
120
140
100
1000
1100
MARSH
MARSH
D
E
F
U
E
L
F
U
E
L
OUT IN
VALVE
L L O N S
FLOW METER
5
4
Figure 20.
28. Install dust cap (5) on C BULK RECEPTACLE (UNFIL) (6).
29. Close pump module rear doors (3).
30. Set HYD ENABLE switch (1) to off position. MAIN HYD ENABLE indicator (2) will go
out.
0083-19
TM 9-2320-339-10
0083
2
1
INTERAXLE
8X8
B.O.
LIGHTS
EXHAUST
LER
TRAI SUPPKINLYG
AINOTR FORMIDPARLAND
S U P PL
Y
PULL TO
B.O.
SELECT
PU S H T O
CHEM
ALARM
GPPU
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
M
M
1
2
ASS
HIGH
IDLE
AlTranlissmionssion
Figure 21.
31. Shut off engine. (WP 0056)
UNFILTERED GRAVITY BULK UNLOADING
WARNING
To prevent fire or explosion, do not allow smoking, flame, sparks, and hot
or glowing objects within 50 ft. (15 m) of vehicle. Read and follow all safety
precautions in FM 10-67-1. Failure to comply may result in injury or death
to personnel.
NOTE
Dispose of unloaded/drained fuel in accordance with unit SOP.
If equipment malfunctions, check that all steps of procedure have
been performed in proper order. If equipment still malfunctions,
complete troubleshooting procedures.
1. Prepare tanker for operation. (WP 0078)
2. Connect SR1 and SR2 static cables (1) to equipment receiving fuel and to grounding
devices.
0083-20
TM 9-2320-339-10
60
80
800
80
100
500
600
300
600
40
120
140
100
0
60
100
500
40
20
800
300
20
0
1000
1100
160
160
120
140
100
1000
1100
0083
MARSH
MARSH
D
E
F
U
E
L
F
U
E
L
OUT IN
VALVE
L L O N S
FLOW METER
Figure 22.
3. Remove dust cap (2) from B GRAVITY RECEPTACLE (3).
4. Open stowage tube cover (4) and remove suction hose (5).
0083-21
TM 9-2320-339-10
0083
Figure 23.
NOTE
B GRAVITY RECEPTACLE is designed for a 4 in. (101.6 mm) hose. Use
an army supplied hose for gravity discharge of fuel.
5. Connect one end of suction hose (5) to B GRAVITY RECEPTACLE (3) and other end
to receiving receptacle.
0083-22
TM 9-2320-339-10
0083
60
80
800
80
100
500
600
300
120
140
100
0
60
100
500
40
20
600
40
800
300
20
1000
1100
160
160
120
140
100
1000
1100
MARSH
MARSH
D
E
F
U
E
L
F
U
E
L
OUT IN
VALVE
L L O N S
FLOW METER
Figure 24.
6. Pull back MC MANUAL CONTROL EM VALVE lever (6).
7. Open V17 GRAVITY VALVE (7) to unload fuel.
8. When unloading is finished, close V17 GRAVITY VALVE (7).
9. Push MC MANUAL CONTROL EM VALVE lever (6) forward.
10. Remove remaining fuel in suction hose by walking out suction hose.
11. Remove suction hose (5), drain fuel, and dispose of fuel in accordance with unit SOP.
Stow suction hose.
12. Return suction hose (5) to stowage tube and close cover (4).
0083-23
TM 9-2320-339-10
0083
Figure 25.
13. Install dust cap (2) on B GRAVITY RECEPTACLE (3).
0083-24
TM 9-2320-339-10
0083
60
80
800
80
100
500
600
300
600
40
120
800
300
20
140
100
0
60
100
500
40
20
1000
1100
160
160
120
140
100
1000
1100
MARSH
MARSH
D
E
F
U
E
L
F
U
E
L
OUT IN
VALVE
L L O N S
FLOW METER
Figure 26.
14. Disconnect and rewind SR1 and SR2 static cables (1).
0083-25
TM 9-2320-339-10
0083-26
0083
TM 9-2320-339-10
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
CHANGING TO DIFFERENT FUEL OR FUEL GRADE
INITIAL SETUP:
Not Applicable
WARNING
To prevent fire or explosion, do not allow smoking, flame, sparks, and hot
or glowing objects within 50 ft. (15 m) of vehicle. Read and follow all safety
precautions in FM 10-67-1. Failure to comply may result in injury or death
to personnel.
CAUTION
Do not run tanker pump without fuel in system or damage to fuel
pump and hydraulic motor may result.
Do not press accelerator during tanker primary fuel pump operation.
Engine speeds higher than 1500 rpm may cause damage to hydraulic
motor and primary pump.
NOTE
Refer to FM 10-67-1 for general operating instructions for tank
vehicles.
If equipment malfunctions, check that all steps of procedure have
been performed in proper order. If equipment still malfunctions, do
troubleshooting.
Tanker must be holding at least 300 gal (1136 liters) of fuel in order
to perform fuel hose evacuation.
1. Start engine (WP 0043) and position vehicle for bulk unloading.
2. Park vehicle. (WP 0055)
0084-1
0084
TM 9-2320-339-10
0084
3. Set HYD ENABLE switch (1) to off position. MAIN HYD ENABLE indicator (2) will go
out.
2
1
INTERAXLE
8X8
B.O.
LIGHTS
PULL TO
EXHAUST
LER
TRAI SUPPKINLYG
AIR PAR D
FOR
NOT MIDLAN
S U P PL
Y
B.O.
SELECT
PU S H T O
CHEM
ALARM
GPPU
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
M
M
1
2
ASS
HIGH
IDLE
AlTranlissmionssion
Figure 1.
CAUTION
Do not move hydraulic selector valve control while HYD ENABLE switch
is set to on position or vehicle hydraulic equipment may be damaged.
4. Push in hydraulic selector valve control for tanker pump operation.
0084-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
0084
HYDRAULIC SELECTOR
VALVE CONTROL
FLAMMABLE
NO SMOKING WITHIN 50 FEET
Figure 2.
5. Set HYD ENABLE switch (1) to on position. MAIN HYD ENABLE indicator (2) will
illuminate.
2
1
INTERAXLE
8X8
B.O.
LIGHTS
PULL TO
EXHAUST
LER
TRAI SUPPKINLYG
AIR PAR D
FOR
NOT MIDLAN
S U P PL
Y
B.O.
SELECT
PU S H T O
CHEM
ALARM
GPPU
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
M
M
1
2
ASS
HIGH
IDLE
AlTranlissmionssion
Figure 3.
0084-3
TM 9-2320-339-10
0084
WARNING
Stand clear to avoid injury when operating pump module rear doors.
When each door is about halfway open, gas pistons push doors open
quickly and with much force. Failure to comply may result in injury or
death to personnel.
6. Open tanker module doors (3).
60
80
500
40
20
60
100
800
1000
80
500
600
300
100
40
120
20
140
100
600
800
300
100
1000
1100
120
140
1100
160
160
MARSH
MARSH
D
E
F
U
E
L
F
U
E
L
OUT
IN
VALVE
L L O N S
FLOW METER
Figure 4.
7. Position tanker controls. (WP 0078)
0084-4
TM 9-2320-339-10
8. Connect SR1 and SR2 static cables (4) to vehicle being serviced and grounding
devices.
DRAIN EXISTING FUEL
WARNING
To prevent fire or explosion, do not allow smoking, flame, sparks, and hot
or glowing objects within 50 ft. (15 m) of vehicle. Read and follow all safety
precautions in FM 10-67-1. Failure to comply may result in injury or death
to personnel.
CAUTION
Do not run tanker pump without fuel in system or damage to fuel
pump and hydraulic motor may result.
Do not press accelerator during tanker primary fuel pump operation.
Engine speeds higher than 1500 rpm may cause damage to hydraulic
motor and primary pump.
NOTE
Refer to FM 10-67-1 for general operating instructions for tank
vehicles.
If equipment malfunctions, check that all steps of procedure have
been performed in proper order. If equipment still malfunctions, do
troubleshooting.
Tanker must be holding at least 300 gal (1136 liters) of fuel in order
to perform fuel hose evacuation.
1. Disengage hose reel tension knob (1).
0084-5
0084
TM 9-2320-339-10
0084
60
80
800
80
100
500
600
300
600
40
120
800
300
20
140
100
0
60
100
500
40
20
1000
1100
160
160
120
140
100
1000
1100
MARSH
MARSH
D
E
F
U
E
L
F
U
E
L
OUT IN
VALVE
L L O N S
FLOW METER
Figure 5.
2. Remove rubber tiedown strap, remove service nozzle (4) from stowage position, and
pull out 2 ft. (61 cm) of servicing hose (2) from reel (3).
3. Engage hose reel tension knob (1).
4. Repeat Steps (1) through (3) to set up servicing hose (5) on passenger side of pump
module (6).
5. Pull out V6 FUEL/DEFUEL VALVE control rod (7).
0084-6
TM 9-2320-339-10
0084
60
80
500
40
20
60
100
800
1000
80
500
600
300
100
40
120
20
140
100
600
800
300
100
1000
1100
120
140
1100
160
160
MARSH
MARSH
10
D
E
F
U
E
L
F
U
E
L
OUT
IN
VALVE
L L O N S
FLOW METER
11
8
12
13
Figure 6.
6. Pull back MC MANUAL CONTROL EM VALVE lever (8).
7. Open V7 (9) and V8 (10) REEL VALVES all the way.
8. Push PUMP ENGAGEMENT LEVER (11) forward.
9. Set TC/THROTTLE CONTROL switch (12) to ON position.
10. Press HI/HIGH IDLE switch (13).
11. Pull out HAV HAND ACTUATED CONTROL valve (14); squeeze and hold lever (15).
0084-7
TM 9-2320-339-10
0084
60
80
500
40
20
60
100
800
1000
80
500
600
300
100
40
120
20
140
100
600
800
300
100
1000
1100
120
140
1100
160
160
MARSH
MARSH
D
E
F
U
E
L
F
U
E
L
OUT
IN
VALVE
L L O N S
FLOW METER
11
15
14
16
12
17
18
Figure 7.
12. Squeeze and hold lever (16) on fuel service nozzle (4) to empty fuel from servicing hose
(2). Dispose of fuel in accordance with unit SOP.
13. When all fuel is emptied from servicing hose (2), release nozzle lever (16).
14. Squeeze and hold lever (17) on fuel service nozzle (18) to empty fuel from servicing
hose (5). Dispose of fuel in accordance with unit SOP.
15. When all fuel is emptied from hose (5), release nozzle lever (17) and HAV HAND
ACTUATED CONTROL valve lever (15).
16. Set TC/THROTTLE CONTROL switch (12) to OFF position.
17. Pull back on PUMP ENGAGEMENT LEVER (11) until locked.
18. Push MC MANUAL CONTROL EM VALVE lever (8) forward.
19. Close V7 (9) and V8 (10) REEL VALVES.
0084-8
TM 9-2320-339-10
0084
9
20
60
80
500
40
20
10
60
100
800
1000
80
500
600
300
100
40
120
20
140
100
600
800
300
100
1000
1100
120
140
1100
160
160
MARSH
MARSH
D
E
F
U
E
L
F
U
E
L
OUT
IN
VALVE
L L O N S
FLOW METER
19
Figure 8.
20. Rewind HAV HAND ACTUATED CONTROL valve hoses (19) onto reel (20) inside
pump module (6).
21. Remove hand crank handle (21) from stowage in pump module (6).
0084-9
TM 9-2320-339-10
22
0084
7
6
60
80
500
40
20
60
100
800
1000
80
500
600
300
100
40
120
20
140
100
600
800
300
100
1000
1100
120
140
1100
160
160
MARSH
MARSH
D
E
F
U
E
L
F
U
E
L
OUT
IN
VALVE
L L O N S
FLOW METER
23
4
21
Figure 9.
22. Release hose reel tension knobs (1).
23. Insert hand crank handle (21) onto crankshaft (22) and turn to rewind servicing hose
(2) onto reel (3).
24. Return fuel service nozzle (4) to stowage and install rubber tiedown strap (23).
25. Engage hose reel tension knob (1).
26. Repeat Steps (22) through (25) to stow servicing hose (7) on passenger side of pump
module (6).
27. Stow hand crank handle (21).
28. Perform gravity bulk unload of tank. (WP 0083)
29. Put suitable non-spark producing container under V15 DRAIN VALVE TUBE (24).
0084-10
TM 9-2320-339-10
60
80
500
40
20
60
100
800
1000
80
500
600
300
100
40
120
20
140
100
600
800
300
100
1000
1100
120
140
1100
160
160
0084
MARSH
MARSH
D
E
F
U
E
L
F
U
E
L
OUT
IN
VALVE
L L O N S
FLOW METER
26
27
25
24
Figure 10.
30. Open V15 DRAIN VALVE (25) to drain all fuel from filter/separator.
31. Close V15 DRAIN VALVE (25) when fuel is completely drained.
32. Dispose of fuel in accordance with unit SOP.
33. Remove dust cap (26) from C BULK RECEPTACLE (UNFIL) (27).
34. Open stowage tube cover (28) and remove suction hose (29).
0084-11
TM 9-2320-339-10
29
0084
28
Figure 11.
35. Connect one end of suction hose (29) to C BULK RECEPTACLE (UNFIL) (27) and other
end to receiving receptacle or suitable container.
0084-12
TM 9-2320-339-10
60
80
500
40
20
60
100
800
1000
80
500
600
300
100
40
120
20
140
100
600
800
300
100
1000
1100
120
140
1100
160
160
0084
MARSH
MARSH
D
E
F
U
E
L
F
U
E
L
OUT
IN
VALVE
L L O N S
FLOW METER
30
27
29
Figure 12.
36. Open V18 BULK DEL VALVE (30) to drain fuel from piping.
37. Close V18 BULK DEL VALVE (30) when fuel is completely drained.
38. Remove and completely drain fuel from suction hose (29). Dispose of fuel in accordance
with unit SOP.
39. Return suction hose (29) to stowage tube and close cover (28).
0084-13
TM 9-2320-339-10
29
0084
28
Figure 13.
40. Install dust cap (26) on C BULK RECEPTACLE (UNFIL) (27).
0084-14
TM 9-2320-339-10
0084
32
60
80
500
40
20
100
600
800
300
100
1000
120
140
1100
160
0
MARSH
D
E
F
U
E
L
F
U
E
L
OUT
IN
VALVE
L L O N S
FLOW METER
27
26
31
33
Figure 14.
41. Disconnect and rewind SR1 and SR2 static cables (31).
42. Close pump module rear doors (32).
43. Install lock (33).
44. Set HYD ENABLE switch (34) to off position. MAIN HYD ENABLE indicator (35) will go
out.
0084-15
TM 9-2320-339-10
34
0084
35
CHEM
ALARM
INTER
AXLE
8X8
25
22
15
11
8
6.2
5.5
3.7
2.7
2.0
IN H20 kPa
FILTER MINDER
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
B.O
SELECT
GPFU
B.O
LIGHTS
PARKING
BRAKE
HIGH
IDLE
1
2
TRAILER
AIR SUPPLY
0
1
2
AIR BRAKE
Figure 15.
45. Shut OFF engine. (WP 0056)
LOAD TANKER WITH NEW FUEL
1. Load tank with 300 gal (1136 liters) of fuel or fuel grade to be carried. (WP 0080)
2. Circulate fuel through complete piping system and both fuel servicing hoses. (WP
0082)
3. Repeat Drain existing fuel section of this procedure.
4. Notify field level maintenance to replace filter elements in filter/separator.
5. Load tank with fuel or fuel grade to be carried. (WP 0080)
6. Shut OFF engine. (WP 0056)
END OF TASK
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0084-16
TM 9-2320-339-10
0085
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
TRANSFER FUEL BETWEEN DIFFERENT TANKER VEHICLES
INITIAL SETUP:
Not Applicable
NOTE
Top loading through the manhole will only be done in emergency situations, when bottom loading is not possible, and only by order of the
Unit Commander.
When transferring fuel between tanker vehicles, the pump on only
one vehicle is required. Procedures for transfer fuel shall be coordinated between the two vehicle operators so that only one pump is in
operation.
1. When transferring fuel to a HEMTT M978 tanker from another tanker truck or trailer,
follow instructions including all WARNINGS, CAUTIONS, and NOTES, for loading
tanker with fuel (WP 0080) with the following changes:
a. Bond and ground M978. Connect the M978 SR1 and SR2 static cables to vehicle
from which fuel is to be transferred and to grounding devices.
b. If transferring through bottom loading, connect enough suction hoses together to
keep at least 25 ft. (8 m) between vehicles. The end of the suction hose which is
connected to the fuel supply will be connected in accordance with the applicable
tanker truck or trailer technical manuals.
c.
During fuel transfer between tankers, the M978 fuel station operator is replaced by
the operator of the tanker truck or trailer from which fuel is being transferred.
d. The transferring tanker may be emptied before the receiving M978 is full. In this
case, the fuel flow WILL NOT shut off automatically. Care should be taken when
transferring fuel using the receiving M978 pump to avoid running the pump when
there is no more fuel to be transferred.
e. The preferred method for loading transferred fuel is bottom loading with exterior
pump (WP 0080).
f.
0085-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
0085
and NOTES. The operator of the fuel tank truck or trailer supplying the fuel will
follow requirements in paragraph for transferring fuel through the manhole (WP
0080) regarding hose placement within the HEMTT and adjustment of product flow
rates.
TRANSFER FUEL FROM M978 TANKER TO ANOTHER TYPE TANKER TRUCK OR
TRAILER
1. When transferring fuel from a HEMTT M978 tanker to another tank truck or trailer, follow
instructions including all WARNINGS, CAUTIONS, and NOTES for unloading fuel (WP
0083) with the following changes:
a. Connect SR1 and SR2 static cables to vehicle to which fuel is being transferred
and to grounding devices.
b. The end of the suction hose which is connected to the receiving receptacle shall
be connected in accordance with the applicable tanker truck or trailer technical
manuals.
c.
The preferred method for unloading fuel to another tanker is filtered bulk unloading
(WP 0083).
d. If fuel is transferred to another tanker using the servicing hose, follow procedures
forLand Vehicle or Aircraft Overwing Fuel Servicing (WP 0081), except that the fuel
service nozzle is not attached. Follow instructions in the receiving tankers technical
manuals and FM 10-67-1 (WP 0157) regarding positioning of the hose in the
receiving tanker and adjustment of product flow rates.
END OF TASK
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0085-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
LIMP HOME/FLAT TIRE WITH NO SPARE
INITIAL SETUP:
Not Applicable
CAUTION
Do not use this procedure on fully loaded M983A4 or M983A4 LET
vehicle with trailer in tow. Limp home setup will not support extra
weight and equipment may be damaged.
Vehicle must not be driven faster than 10 mph (16 km/h) or farther
than 30 miles (48 km) in limp home condition.
NOTE
Use limp home procedure for emergency only in case of wheel
bearing failure, wheel damage, or when unable to change wheel and
tire.
Limp home setup for passenger side No. 1 axle is shown. All limp
home setups for No.1 and No.2 axle are done in same manner.
1. Drive flat/shredded tire onto two wheel chocks (1).
0086-1
0086
TM 9-2320-339-10
1
Figure 1.
2. Dump (deflate) air suspension.
NOTE
The distance between the axle and axle stop should be no greater than
2 in. (5 cm) or the limp home setup will not work as intended.
3. Check axle (2) proximity to axle stop (3).
0086-2
0086
TM 9-2320-339-10
Figure 2.
NOTE
If axle is too far from axle stop (more than 2 in. [5 cm]) to effectively
install limp home setup, discontinue procedure and arrange for
vehicle recovery.
If axle and axle stop are close enough (2 in. [5 cm] or less) to
effectively install limp home setup, continue with Step (4).
4. Remove two wheel chocks (4) and 7 ft. (2.1 m) chain (5) from stowage.
0086-3
0086
TM 9-2320-339-10
0086
Figure 3.
5. Install two wheel chocks (WP 0073) (4) in front of and behind tire across (on same axle)
from tire in which limp home setup is being installed.
CAUTION
Wrap 7 ft. (2.1 m) chain around frame rail and axle only. Do not wrap 7
ft. (2.1 m) chain around lateral torque rod, shock absorber, etc., as they
could be crushed. Route 7 ft. (2.1 m) chain so hoses or lines are not
between frame and 7 ft. (2.1 m) chain or axle and 7 ft. (2.1 m) chain.
Failure to comply may result in damage to equipment.
6. Route 7 ft. (2.1 m) chain (5) around frame rail (6) and axle (2).
0086-4
TM 9-2320-339-10
0086
5
6
Figure 4.
7. Route end of 7 ft. (2.1 m) chain (5) to chain grab hook (7) and fasten 7 ft. (2.1 m) chain
(5) back into itself as tight as possible.
NOTE
Axle will drop slightly when air suspension is serviced (inflated).
8. Service (inflate) air suspension.
9. Remove and stow two wheel chocks (4) from tire opposite of limp home setup.
Figure 5.
10. Drive vehicle off two wheel chocks (1) and return wheel chocks (1) to vehicle stowage.
0086-5
TM 9-2320-339-10
0086
1
Figure 6.
REMOVE LIMP HOME FROM NO. 1 AND NO. 2 AXLE TIRES
1. Dump (deflate) air suspension.
2. Check to see if 7 ft. (2.1 m) chain (1) can be disconnected from grab hook (2).
1
2
Figure 7.
0086-6
TM 9-2320-339-10
0086
NOTE
If 7 ft. (2.1 m) chain can be disconnected, skip to Step (5).
If 7 ft. (2.1 m) chain is too tight to disconnect, continue with Step (3).
Removal of limp home setup No. 1 axle is shown. Removal of limp
home setup for No. 2 axle is done in same manner.
3. Drive flat/shredded tire onto two wheel chocks (3).
3
Figure 8.
4. Install two wheel chocks (WP 0073) (4) in front of and behind tire across (on same axle)
from tire in which limp home setup is being removed.
Figure 9.
5. Unhook 7 ft. (2.1 m) chain (1) and remove from around frame rail (5) and axle (6).
0086-7
TM 9-2320-339-10
0086
Figure 10.
6. Return 7 ft. (2.1 m) chain (1) to stowage.
Figure 11.
7. Service (inflate) air suspension.
8. Drive vehicle off two wheel chocks (3) and return wheel chocks (3) to vehicle stowage.
0086-8
TM 9-2320-339-10
3
Figure 12.
INSTALL LIMP HOME SETUP ON NO. 3 AND NO. 4 AXLE TIRES
CAUTION
Do not use this procedure on fully loaded M983A4 or M983A4 LET
vehicle with trailer in tow. Limp home setup will not support extra
weight and equipment may be damaged.
Vehicle must not be driven faster than 10 mph (16 km/h) or farther
than 30 miles (48 km) in limp home condition. Failure to comply may
result in damage to equipment.
NOTE
Use limp home procedure for emergency only in case of wheel
bearing failure, wheel damage, or when unable to change wheel and
tire.
Limp home setup for passenger side No. 4 axle is shown. All limp
home setups for No. 3 and No. 4 axle are done in same manner.
If possible, place wheel chock under flat/shredded tire to assist in
axle/axle stop proximity before vehicle air suspension is dumped.
1. Drive flat/shredded tire onto two wheel chocks (1).
0086-9
0086
TM 9-2320-339-10
1
Figure 13.
2. Dump (deflate) air suspension.
NOTE
The distance between the axle and axle stop should be no greater than
2 in. (5 cm) or the limp home setup will not work as intended.
3. Check axle (2) proximity to axle stop (3).
0086-10
0086
TM 9-2320-339-10
0086
Figure 14.
NOTE
If axle and axle stop are close enough (2 in. [5 cm] or less) to
effectively install limp home setup, skip to Step (9).
If axle is too far from axle stop (more than 2 in. [5 cm]) to effectively
install limp home setup, continue with Step (4).
4. Remove two wheel chocks (4), jack base plate (5), jack (6), 7 ft. (2.1 m) chain (7), and
shackle (8) from stowage.
0086-11
TM 9-2320-339-10
0086
5
7
8
Figure 15.
5. Install two wheel chocks (WP 0073) (4) in front of and behind tire across (on same axle)
from tire in which limp home setup is being installed.
CAUTION
Jack placement is critical to avoid damaging vehicle suspension components. Follow jack placement notes and procedures carefully. Failure to
comply may result in damage to equipment.
NOTE
Center jack on flat spot in center of transverse beam casting.
6. Place jack base plate (5) and jack (6) under transverse beam casting (9).
0086-12
TM 9-2320-339-10
0086
9
10
Figure 16.
7. Unscrew jack ram (10) until it contacts transverse beam end casting (9), or is at full
extension.
NOTE
If axle cannot be jacked close enough to axle stop (2 in. [5 cm] or less)
to effectively install limp home setup, discontinue procedure and arrange
for vehicle recovery.
8. Raise vehicle until axle (2) is as close as it will go to axle stop (3).
0086-13
TM 9-2320-339-10
0086
Figure 17.
9. Install shackle (8) on axle stop (3) with pin (11).
3
11
Figure 18.
CAUTION
Wrap 7 ft. (2.1 m) chain around axle only. Do not wrap 7 ft. (2.1 m) chain
around shock absorber or brake chamber bracket. Route 7 ft. (2.1 m)
chain so hoses or lines are not between axle and 7 ft. (2.1 m) chain.
Failure to comply may result in damage to equipment.
0086-14
TM 9-2320-339-10
0086
12
8
Figure 19.
11. Route end of 7 ft. (2.1 m) chain (7) around axle (2).
12. Bring end of 7 ft. (2.1 m) chain (7) up to chain grab hook (12) and fasten 7 ft. (2.1 m)
chain (7) back into itself as tight as possible.
WARNING
Keep hands away from chain when lowering jack. Hands and fingers
could be crushed. Failure to comply may result in injury or death to personnel.
NOTE
If vehicle DID NOT require jacking, skip to Step (15).
If vehicle DID require jacking, continue with Step (13).
Axle will drop slightly when jack is lowered.
13. Lower jack (6) and remove jack base plate (5) and jack (6) from under transverse beam
casting (9).
0086-15
TM 9-2320-339-10
0086
Figure 20.
14. Return jack base plate (5) and jack (6) to stowage.
15. Service (inflate) air suspension.
16. Remove two wheel chocks (WP 0073) (4) from in front of and behind tire across (on
same axle) from tire in which limp home setup was installed.
Figure 21.
17. Drive vehicle off two wheel chocks (1) and return wheel chocks (1) to vehicle stowage.
0086-16
TM 9-2320-339-10
0086
1
Figure 22.
REMOVE LIMP HOME SETUP FROM NO. 3 AND NO. 4 AXLE TIRES
1. Dump (deflate) air suspension.
2. Check to see if 7 ft. (2.1 m) chain (1) can be disconnected from grab hook (2).
Figure 23.
0086-17
TM 9-2320-339-10
NOTE
If 7 ft. (2.1 m) chain can be disconnected, skip to Step (9).
If 7 ft. (2.1 m) chain is too tight to disconnect, continue with Step (3).
Removal of limp home setup No. 4 axle is shown. Removal of limp
home setup for No. 3 axle is done in same manner.
3. Drive flat/shredded tire onto two wheel chocks (3).
3
Figure 24.
4. Check to see if 7 ft. (2.1 m) chain (1) can be disconnected from grab hook (2).
0086-18
0086
TM 9-2320-339-10
0086
Figure 25.
NOTE
If 7 ft. (2.1 m) chain can be disconnected, skip to Step (9).
If 7 ft. (2.1 m) chain is too tight to disconnect, continue with Step (5).
Removal of limp home setup No. 4 axle is shown. Removal of limp
home setup for No. 3 axle is done in same manner.
5. Remove two wheel chocks (4), jack base plate (5), and jack (6) from stowage.
Figure 26.
6. Install two wheel chocks (WP 0073) (4) in front of and behind tire across (on same axle)
from tire in which limp home setup is being installed.
0086-19
TM 9-2320-339-10
CAUTION
Jack placement is critical to avoid damaging vehicle suspension components. Follow jack placement notes and procedures carefully. Failure to
comply may result in damage to equipment.
NOTE
Jack ram should be fully screwed down (making jack as short as
possible) for Step (7).
Center jack on flat spot in center of transverse beam casting.
7. Place jack base plate (5), and jack (6) under transverse beam casting (7).
Figure 27.
NOTE
If possible, unscrew jack ram until it contacts jacking point on equalizing
beam.
8. Raise vehicle until axle (8) is as close as it will go to axle stop (9).
0086-20
0086
TM 9-2320-339-10
0086
2
10
9
Figure 28.
9. Unhook 7 ft. (2.1 m) chain (1) from grab hook (2) and remove 7 ft. (2.1 m) chain (1) from
shackle (10) and axle (8).
10. Remove pin (11) from shackle (10) and axle stop (9).
9
11
10
Figure 29.
NOTE
If vehicle DID NOT require jacking, skip to Step (13).
0086-21
TM 9-2320-339-10
Figure 30.
12. Return jack base plate (5) and jack (6) to stowage.
0086-22
0086
TM 9-2320-339-10
0086
6
1
5
10
Figure 31.
13. Return 7 ft. (2.1 m) chain (1), and shackle (10) to stowage.
14. Service (inflate) air suspension.
NOTE
Complete Step (15) if vehicle was driven onto two wheel chocks to facilitate 7 ft. (2.1 m) chain removal.
15. Drive vehicle off two wheel chocks (3) and return wheel chocks (3) to vehicle stowage.
0086-23
TM 9-2320-339-10
3
Figure 32.
END OF TASK
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0086-24
0086
TM 9-2320-339-10
0087
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
PERFORM IMMEDIATE ACTION FOR LOSS OF AIR SUPPLY SYSTEM PRESSURE
INITIAL SETUP:
Not Applicable
PERFORM PROCEDURE
1. If brake system failure (LOW AIR) indicator (1) illuminates and warning buzzer sounds
while driving vehicle, check both FRONT (2) and REAR (3) air pressure gauges.
7
CHEM
ALARM
INTER
AXLE
25
22
15
11
8
8X8
6.2
5.5
3.7
2.7
2.0
IN H20 kPa
FILTER MINDER
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
B.O
SELECT
GPFU
B.O
LIGHTS
PARKING
BRAKE
HIGH
IDLE
1
2
3
TRAILER
AIR SUPPLY
0
1
2
AIR BRAKE
3
1
Figure 1.
NOTE
If both FRONT and REAR air pressure gauges read zero, skip to Step
(4).
2. If REAR air pressure gauge (3) reads zero and FRONT air pressure gauge (2) reads
normal air pressure of 100 to 130 psi (7 to 9 bar), complete the following:
a. Continue operation of vehicle. Brakes on all eight wheels and trailer (if applicable)
will operate.
b. Notify field level maintenance as soon as possible.
0087-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
0087
WARNING
When REAR air pressure gauge reads zero, vehicle braking capability is
greatly reduced. Extra care must be taken to avoid collision. Failure to
comply may result in injury or death to personnel.
NOTE
If both FRONT and REAR air pressure gauges read zero, skip to Step
(4).
3. If FRONT air pressure gauge (2) is at zero and REAR air pressure gauge (3) shows
normal air pressure of 100 to 130 psi (7 to 9 bar), complete the following:
a. Continue operation of vehicle. Brakes on No. 3 and No. 4 axles and trailer (if
applicable) will operate. Use caution, and comply with the following:
(1) Leave additional distance between vehicles.
(2) Apply service brake pedal (4) earlier than usual when slowing vehicle.
(3) Downshift as necessary when slowing vehicle.
WARNING
0087-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
0087
WARNING
Use of service brake pedal will not slow or stop vehicle when both
FRONT and REAR air pressure gauges read zero. Use the following
procedure to safely stop vehicle after loss of air pressure. Failure to
comply may result in injury or death to personnel.
NOTE
c.
When spring brakes are applied, vehicle will stop quickly. Vehicle
cannot be driven again until malfunction is repaired and there is
enough air supply for operation of service brakes.
When suitable area is found to stop vehicle, pull out PARKING BRAKE control (8)
to apply spring brakes on four rear wheels.
0087-3
TM 9-2320-339-10
0088
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
INSTALL/REMOVE TIRE CHAINS
INITIAL SETUP:
Not Applicable
CAUTION
When tire chains are used, they must be used on all four rear wheels.
Chains must not be used when driving on hard surfaces where there is
no wheel slippage. Improper use of tire chains may result in equipment
damage.
NOTE
This procedure is a two soldier task.
Tire chains on No. 3 and No. 4 axle tires are all installed the same.
Passenger side No. 4 axle shown.
Maximum speed limit for vehicles driving with chains in city or on
highway is 10 mph (16 km/h).
Maximum speed limit for vehicles driving with chains off-road is 15
mph (24 km/h).
1. With aid of an assistant, place tire chain (1) on ground with cross chain connecting links
(2) facing down.
0088-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
0088
Figure 1.
NOTE
Assistant shall ensure vehicle is stopped when only tire in contact with
tire chains is tire being equipped.
2. Move vehicle onto tire chain (1) while assistant guides vehicle so tire (3) is about onethird of way on tire chain.
Figure 2.
NOTE
Ensure only tire in contact with tire chains is tire being equipped.
3. Park vehicle. (WP 0055)
4. With aid of an assistant, wrap tire chain (1) around tire (3).
0088-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
0088
Figure 3.
5. With aid of an assistant, connect and secure inside and outside clamps (4) so tire chain
(1) is as tight as possible.
6. With aid of an assistant, repeat Steps (1) through (5) on remaining tires of No. 3 and
No. 4 axles.
7. Drive vehicle forward (WP 0049) about 15 ft. (4.6 m) and then drive vehicle in reverse
(WP 0050) about 15 ft. (4.6 m) as guided by assistant.
8. Park vehicle. (WP 0055)
NOTE
Tire chains on No. 3 and No. 4 axle tires are all tightened up the same.
Passenger side No. 4 axle shown.
9. With aid of an assistant, disconnect inside clamp (4) of tire chain (1) on tire (3).
0088-3
TM 9-2320-339-10
0088
Figure 4.
10. With aid of an assistant, take up slack in tire chain (1).
11. With aid of an assistant, connect inside clamp (4).
12. With aid of an assistant, disconnect outside clamp (4) of tire chain (1) on tire (3).
13. With aid of an assistant, take up slack in tire chain (1).
14. With aid of an assistant, connect outside clamp (4).
15. With aid of an assistant, take up slack in tire chains on other three rear tires by repeating
Steps (10) through (15).
REMOVE TIRE CHAINS
NOTE
This procedure is a two soldier task.
Tire chains on No. 4 axle tires are both removed the same. Passenger
side shown.
1. Move vehicle into position so tire chain (1) and clamps (2) on tire (3) are at 4 oclock
position while assistant guides vehicle.
0088-4
TM 9-2320-339-10
0088
Figure 5.
2. Park vehicle. (WP 0055)
3. With aid of an assistant, disconnect inside and outside clamps (2) of tire chain (1).
Figure 6.
4. With aid of an assistant, unwrap tire chain (1) from tire (3) and spread tire chain out on
ground behind vehicle.
5. Drive vehicle forward (WP 0049) off tire chain (1) while assistant guides vehicle.
6. With aid of an assistant, repeat Steps (2) through (5) for opposite side tire.
0088-5
TM 9-2320-339-10
0088
NOTE
Tire chains on No. 3 axle tires are both removed the same. Passenger
side shown.
7. Move vehicle into position so tire chain (4) and clamps (5) on tire (6) are at 8 oclock
position while assistant guides vehicle.
Figure 7.
8. Park vehicle. (WP 0055)
9. With aid of an assistant, disconnect inside and outside clamps (5) of tire chain (4).
10. With aid of an assistant, unwrap tire chain (4) from tire (6) and spread tire chain out on
ground in front of tire.
Figure 8.
11. Drive vehicle forward (WP 0049) off tire chain (4) while assistant guides vehicle.
0088-6
TM 9-2320-339-10
12. With aid of an assistant, repeat Steps (7) through (11) for opposite side tire.
END OF TASK
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0088-7
0088
TM 9-2320-339-10
0089
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
FORD WATER OBSTACLE
INITIAL SETUP:
Not Applicable
WARNING
Do not ford water unless depth is known. Water deeper than 4 ft. (1.2 m)
may enter vehicle. Failure to comply may result in injury or death to personnel.
NOTE
After vehicle fords water obstacle, service all lubrication points below
fording depth and check submerged gearboxes for presence of water
upon return from mission (refer to lubrication instructions (WP 0145) for
more information).
CAUTION
Towing a trailer may affect maximum fording depth (refer to applicable
trailer operators manual). Do not ford water obstacle deeper than maximum depth allowed by either vehicle or trailer (whichever depth is less).
Failure to comply may result in damage to equipment.
1. Ensure depth of fording site is not more than 4 ft. (1.2 m).
2. Ensure bottom at fording site is firm enough that 4 ft. (1.2 m) maximum fording depth
will not be exceeded and vehicle will not become mired.
3. Stop vehicle at edge of water.
4. If brakes have been used heavily and are hot, allow drums and shoes to cool before
entering water if possible.
5. Ensure engine is operating correctly before entering water.
6. Set TRANSFER CASE shift lever (1) to LO, 8X8 drive indicator (2) will illuminate.
0089-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
0089
7
INTERAXLE
8X8
B.O.
LIGHTS
PULL TO
EXHAUST
ER
LY
TRAILSUPPKING
AIR PAR
FOR AND
NOT MIDL
SUPPLY
B.O.
SELECT
PU S H T O
CHEM
ALARM
GPPU
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
M
M
12
ASS
HIGH
IDLE
AlTranlissmisonsion
5
6
CHEM
ALARM
INTER
AXLE
8X8
25
22
15
11
8
6.2
5.5
3.7
2.7
2.0
IN H20 kPa
FILTER MINDER
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
B.O
SELECT
GPFU
B.O
LIGHTS
PARKING
BRAKE
HIGH
IDLE
1
2
TRAILER
AIR SUPPLY
0
1
2
AIR BRAKE
6
Figure 1.
7. Position traction control switch (3) to INTER AXLE for added traction, indicator (4) will
come on.
8. Set transmission range selector (5) to 1 (1st gear range).
9. Drive vehicle slowly into water.
10. If engine stops, immediately attempt to restart engine. If engine will not start, tow or
winch vehicle from water with another vehicle as soon as possible.
11. Drive vehicle at 3 to 4 mph (5 to 6 km/h) or less, through water.
12. Unless absolutely necessary, do not stop while in water.
13. If vehicle accidentally enters water deeper than 4 ft. (1.2 m), do the following:
0089-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
0089
0089-3
TM 9-2320-339-10
0090
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
INTERIM NUCLEAR, BIOLOGICAL, AND CHEMICAL (NBC) DECONTAMINATION
PROCEDURES
INITIAL SETUP:
Not Applicable
NOTE
To reduce the effects of contamination in an NBC-contaminated environment, the HEMTT series vehicle should be operated with all windows,
doors, and stowage boxes closed.
1. The HEMTT series vehicle is capable of being operated by personnel wearing nuclear,
biological, or chemical (NBC) protective clothing without special tools or supporting
equipment. Refer to FM 3-11.5 (WP 0157) for information on decontamination
procedures. Specific procedures for the HEMTT series vehicle are as follows:
a. Rubber sleeves and other rubber items, rope, and gaskets will absorb and retain
chemical agents. Replacement of these items is the recommended method of
decontamination.
b. Lubricants or fluids may be present on the external surfaces of the HEMTT series
vehicle or its components due to leaks or normal operation. These fluids will absorb
NBC agents. The preferred method of decontamination is removal of these fluids
using conventional decontamination methods in accordance with FM 3-11.5. (WP
0157)
c.
d. External surfaces of the HEMTT series vehicle and related equipment such as the
remote control units that are marked with painted or stamped lettering will not
withstand repeated decontamination with STB or DS2 without degradation of this
lettering. Therefore, the recommended method of decontamination for these areas
is washing with warm, soapy water.
0090-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
0090
NOTE
Replacement of hardware, as well as conventional methods of decontamination, are the preferred methods of decontamination for the areas
listed below.
2. Areas that will entrap contaminants, making efficient decontamination extremely difficult
include the following:
a. Exposed heads of screws.
b. Areas adjacent to and behind exposed hydraulic lines.
c.
0090-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
0091
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
OPERATE TIRE CARRIER USING HAND PUMP
INITIAL SETUP:
Not Applicable
CAUTION
Ensure the passenger side of the vehicle has 6 ft. (1.83 m) of
clearance from the battery box forward to accommodate the tire
carrier lowering or damage to equipment may occur.
Do not dump (deflate) vehicle air suspension system (WP 0039)
when spare tire is attached to tire carrier and in contact with the
ground. Failure to comply may result in damage to equipment.
Do not add a significant amount of weight to the vehicle when spare
tire is attached to tire carrier and in contact with the ground. Failure
to comply may result in damage to equipment.
NOTE
This procedure is a two soldier task.
1. Remove access ladder from stowage and connect to passenger side front fender. (WP
0037)
2. Disconnect safety pin (1) from right lock rod (2). Leave safety pin (1) hang from its
lanyard (3).
0091-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
0091
Figure 1.
CAUTION
The tire carrier lock rods are a snag hazard to the movement of the tire
carrier and must be properly stowed in stowage brackets prior to lowering
the tire carrier. Failure to properly stow tire carrier lock rods prior to lowering operation may result in damage to equipment.
3. Turn left lock rod (4) CCW until enough slack is made to push left lock rod (4) up and
into its stowage bracket (5).
0091-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
0091
Figure 2.
4. Turn right lock rod (6) CCW until enough slack is made to push right lock rod (6) up and
into its stowage bracket (7).
Figure 3.
0091-3
TM 9-2320-339-10
0091
WARNING
If tire carrier is in any position other than full up and locked (tire carrier
latch engaged) or resting on ground, only tire carrier pump operator
should be within six feet (1.83 m) of passenger side of vehicle from battery
box forward. Failure to comply may result in personnel being struck by
tire carrier/spare tire, causing injury or death to personnel.
5. Ensure safety area is clear of personnel and equipment. Assistant will stand outside
the safety area and ensure no personnel wander into safety area while lowering
operation is taking place.
SAFETY
AREA
6 FT (1.83m)
SAFETY AREA
Figure 4.
6. Set directional control lever (8) to LOWER position.
0091-4
TM 9-2320-339-10
0091
9
10
Figure 5.
7. Remove hand pump handle (9) from stowage, insert into hand pump receptacle (10).
Move hand pump handle (9) up and down rapidly, tire carrier should begin to move.
CAUTION
Once tire is in contact with the ground, do not pump hand pump handle
with directional control lever in LOWER position. This could put undue
stress on tire carrier and may cause damage to equipment.
NOTE
The tire carrier can be stopped at any time during lowering operations by
stopping use of hand pump and moving the directional control lever to
RAISE position.
8. Once tire carrier has passed vertical (approximately 6 in. [15.24 cm] of movement), stop
pumping hand pump handle (9) and allow the tire carrier to lower on its own until spare
tire contacts ground.
0091-5
TM 9-2320-339-10
0091
CAUTION
Ensure the passenger side of the vehicle has 6 ft. (1.83 m) of clearance
from the battery box forward to accommodate the tire carrier lowering or
damage to equipment may occur.
NOTE
This procedure is a two soldier task.
1. If vehicle is not idling, set ignition switch (1) to on position , and check that SPARE TIRE
LOOSE indicator (2) is illuminated.
CHEM
ALARM
INTER
AXLE
8X8
25
22
15
11
8
6.2
5.5
3.7
2.7
2.0
IN H20 kPa
FILTER MINDER
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
B.O
SELECT
GPFU
B.O
LIGHTS
PARKING
BRAKE
HIGH
IDLE
1
2
0
1
2
TRAILER
AIR SUPPLY
AIR BRAKE
Figure 6.
2. Ensure spare tire is securely fastened to the tire carrier.
CAUTION
Ensure the passenger side top engine access cover is closed and secured prior to raising the tire carrier with spare tire installed. If access
cover is braced open, spare tire will contact it and cause damage to the
cover as well as prevent the tire carrier from locking in full up position.
NOTE
If passenger side top engine access cover is open and laying flat, the tire
(in the full up position) will not allow the access cover to be closed.
0091-6
TM 9-2320-339-10
0091
CAUTION
The tire carrier lock rods are a snag hazard to the movement of the tire
carrier and must be properly stowed in stowage brackets prior to lowering
the tire carrier. Failure to properly stow tire carrier lock rods prior to lowering operation may result in damage to equipment.
4. Ensure left lock rod (3) is properly stowed in stowage bracket (4).
Figure 7.
5. Ensure right lock rod (5) is properly stowed in stowage bracket (6).
WARNING
If tire carrier is in any position other than full up and locked (tire carrier
latch engaged) or resting on ground, only tire carrier pump operator
should be within six feet (1.83 m) of passenger side of vehicle from battery
0091-7
TM 9-2320-339-10
0091
6 FT (1.83m)
SAFETY AREA
Figure 8.
7. Set directional control lever (7) to RAISE position.
0091-8
TM 9-2320-339-10
0091
8
9
Figure 9.
8. Remove hand pump handle (8) from stowage, insert into hand pump receptacle (9).
Move hand pump handle (8) up and down rapidly, tire carrier should begin to move.
NOTE
The tire carrier can be stopped at any time during raising operations.
9. Continue to raise tire carrier until it is in the full up position. Stop use of hand pump.
WARNING
Always maintain a distance of six feet (1.83 m) until confirmation that tire
carrier latch is engaged. Failure to comply may result in personnel being
0091-9
TM 9-2320-339-10
0091
11
10
Figure 10.
11. With the assistant maintaining the safety area, the operator will proceed to the driver
side cabin and check to ensure the SPARE TIRE LOOSE indicator (2) has gone out.
0091-10
TM 9-2320-339-10
0091
2
CHEM
ALARM
INTER
AXLE
8X8
25
22
15
11
8
6.2
5.5
3.7
2.7
2.0
IN H20 kPa
FILTER MINDER
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
B.O
SELECT
GPFU
B.O
LIGHTS
PARKING
BRAKE
HIGH
IDLE
1
2
TRAILER
AIR SUPPLY
0
1
2
AIR BRAKE
Figure 11.
NOTE
If tire carrier latch is fully engaged, and SPARE TIRE LOOSE indicator light has gone out, skip to Step (15).
If tire carrier latch fails to fully engage tire carrier bar, or SPARE TIRE
LOOSE indicator fails to go out, perform Steps (12) through (14).
12. Move directional control lever (7) to LOWER.
0091-11
TM 9-2320-339-10
0091
Figure 12.
13. Pump hand pump handle (8) until tire carrier lowers approximately 1 ft. (30 cm).
14. Repeat Steps (7) through (11).
NOTE
If tire carrier latch is fully engaged, and SPARE TIRE LOOSE indicator
light has gone out, complete Steps (15) through (20).
15. Remove right lock rod (5) from stowage bracket (6) and pull down to end of groove (12)
until it stops. Turn right lock rod (5) CW until it is hand tight, with jointed end (13) across
tire carrier arm (14).
0091-12
TM 9-2320-339-10
15
0091
17
13
6
16
12
14
Figure 13.
16. Remove left lock rod (3) from stowage bracket (4), locate washer (15) and pull towards
left lock rod (3) until it stops. Pull both left lock rod (3) and washer (15) down to end of
groove (16). Turn left Lock rod (4) CW until it is hand tight, with jointed end (17) pointed
towards tire carrier arm (14).
17. Insert safety pin (18) through hole located on right lock rod jointed end (13).
0091-13
TM 9-2320-339-10
0091
18
13
Figure 14.
NOTE
Tire carrier directional control lever should always be in LOWER position
for vehicle operation.
18. Set directional control lever (7) to LOWER position.
0091-14
TM 9-2320-339-10
0091
Figure 15.
19. Shut off engine (WP 0056) or set ignition switch (1) to off position (as applicable).
0091-15
TM 9-2320-339-10
CHEM
ALARM
0091
INTER
AXLE
25
22
15
11
8
8X8
6.2
5.5
3.7
2.7
2.0
IN H20 kPa
FILTER MINDER
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
B.O
SELECT
GPFU
B.O
LIGHTS
PARKING
BRAKE
HIGH
IDLE
1
2
TRAILER
AIR SUPPLY
0
1
2
AIR BRAKE
Figure 16.
20. Stow access ladder. (WP 0037)
END OF TASK
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0091-16
TM 9-2320-339-10
0092
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
OPERATE TIRE CARRIER USING OUTSIDE AIR SOURCE
INITIAL SETUP:
Not Applicable
CAUTION
Ensure the passenger side of the vehicle has 6 ft. (1.83 m) of
clearance from the battery box forward to accommodate the tire
carrier lowering or damage to equipment may occur.
Do not dump (deflate) vehicle air suspension system (WP 0039)
when spare tire is attached to tire carrier and in contact with the
ground. Failure to comply may result in damage to equipment.
Do not add a significant amount of weight to the vehicle when spare
tire is attached to tire carrier and in contact with the ground. Failure
to comply may result in damage to equipment.
NOTE
This procedure is a two soldier task.
1. Remove access ladder from stowage and connect to passenger side front fender. (WP
0037)
2. Disconnect safety pin (1) from right lock rod (2). Leave safety pin (1) hang from its
lanyard (3).
0092-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
0092
Figure 1.
CAUTION
The tire carrier lock rods are a snag hazard to the movement of the tire
carrier and must be properly stowed in stowage brackets prior to lowering
the tire carrier. Failure to properly stow tire carrier lock rods prior to lowering operation may result in damage to equipment.
3. Turn left lock rod (4) CCW until enough slack is made to push left lock rod (4) up and
into its stowage bracket (5).
0092-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
0092
Figure 2.
4. Turn right lock rod (6) CCW until enough slack is made to push right lock rod (6) up and
into its stowage bracket (7).
Figure 3.
0092-3
TM 9-2320-339-10
0092
WARNING
If tire carrier is in any position other than full up and locked (tire carrier
latch engaged) or resting on ground, only tire carrier pump operator
should be within six feet (1.83 m) of passenger side of vehicle from battery
box forward. Failure to comply may result in personnel being struck by
tire carrier/spare tire, causing injury or death to personnel.
5. Ensure safety area is clear of personnel and equipment. Assistant will stand outside
the safety area and ensure no personnel wander into safety area while lowering
operation is taking place.
SAFETY
AREA
6 FT (1.83m)
SAFETY AREA
Figure 4.
6. Set directional control lever (8) to LOWER position.
0092-4
TM 9-2320-339-10
0092
11
10
Figure 5.
7. Remove cap from auxiliary air fitting (9).
8. Connect air hose (10) to auxiliary air fitting (9).
NOTE
It may be necessary to simultaneously hold lever on air hose with tire
carrier pump power control dependant on type air hose used.
The operator will notice a small amount of oil being expelled with the
air from the tire carrier pump each time it cycles, this is a normal
condition.
9. Press and hold power control (11). The tire carrier pump cyclic rate will be rapid at first,
and then slow noticeably. As cyclic rate slows, the operator should notice tire carrier
begin to move.
0092-5
TM 9-2320-339-10
0092
CAUTION
Once tire is in contact with the ground, do not press power control with
directional control lever in LOWER position. This could put undue stress
on tire carrier and may cause damage to equipment.
NOTE
The tire carrier can be stopped at any time during lowering operations by
releasing the power control and moving the directional control lever to
RAISE position.
10. Once tire carrier has passed vertical (approximately 6 in. [15.24 cm] of movement),
release power control (11) and allow tire carrier to lower on its own until tire contacts
ground.
11. Move directional control lever (8) to raise position.
RAISE TIRE CARRIER
CAUTION
Ensure the passenger side of the vehicle has 6 ft. (1.83 m) of clearance
from the battery box forward to accommodate the tire carrier lowering or
damage to equipment may occur.
NOTE
This procedure is a two soldier task.
1. If vehicle is not idling, set ignition switch (1) to on position , and check that SPARE TIRE
LOOSE indicator (2) is illuminated.
0092-6
TM 9-2320-339-10
0092
CHEM
ALARM
INTER
AXLE
25
22
15
11
8
8X8
6.2
5.5
3.7
2.7
2.0
IN H20 kPa
FILTER MINDER
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
B.O
SELECT
GPFU
B.O
LIGHTS
PARKING
BRAKE
HIGH
IDLE
1
2
0
1
2
TRAILER
AIR SUPPLY
AIR BRAKE
Figure 6.
2. Ensure spare tire is securely fastened to the tire carrier.
CAUTION
Ensure the passenger side top engine access cover is closed and secured prior to raising the tire carrier with spare tire installed. If access
cover is braced open, spare tire will contact it and cause damage to the
cover as well as prevent the tire carrier from locking in full up position.
NOTE
If passenger side top engine access cover is open and laying flat, the tire
(in the full up position) will not allow the access cover to be closed.
3. Ensure passenger side top engine access cover is secured closed.
CAUTION
The tire carrier lock rods are a snag hazard to the movement of the tire
carrier and must be properly stowed in stowage brackets prior to lowering
the tire carrier. Failure to properly stow tire carrier lock rods prior to lowering operation may result in damage to equipment.
4. Ensure left lock rod (3) is properly stowed in stowage bracket (4).
0092-7
TM 9-2320-339-10
0092
Figure 7.
5. Ensure right lock rod (5) is properly stowed in stowage bracket (6).
WARNING
If tire carrier is in any position other than full up and locked (tire carrier
latch engaged) or resting on ground, only tire carrier pump operator
should be within six feet (1.83 m) of passenger side of vehicle from battery
box forward. Failure to comply may result in personnel being struck by
tire carrier/spare tire, causing injury or death to personnel.
6. Ensure safety area is clear of personnel and equipment. Assistant will stand outside
the safety area and ensure no personnel wander into safety area while raising operation
is taking place.
0092-8
TM 9-2320-339-10
SAFETY
AREA
6 FT (1.83m)
SAFETY AREA
Figure 8.
7. Set directional control lever (7) to RAISE position.
0092-9
0092
TM 9-2320-339-10
0092
10
Figure 9.
8. Remove cap from auxiliary air fitting (8).
9. Connect air hose (9) to auxiliary air fitting (8).
NOTE
It may be necessary to simultaneously hold lever on air hose with tire
carrier pump power control dependant on type air hose used.
The operator will notice a small amount of oil being expelled with the
air from the tire carrier pump each time it cycles, this is a normal
condition.
When the power control is pressed, the tire carrier pump cyclic rate
will be rapid at first, and then slow noticeably. As cyclic rate slows,
the operator should notice the tire carrier begin to move.
10. Press and hold power control (10).
0092-10
TM 9-2320-339-10
0092
NOTE
The tire carrier can be stopped at any time during raising operations
by releasing power control.
As the tire carrier is raised, the tire carrier pump will begin to cycle at
an increased rate.
11. Continue to raise tire carrier until it is in the full up position. The operator will notice a
significant slow down in the tire carrier pump cyclic rate. Release power control (10).
WARNING
Always maintain a distance of six feet (1.83 m) until confirmation that tire
carrier latch is engaged. Failure to comply may result in personnel being
struck by tire carrier/spare tire causing severe injury or death to personnel.
12. Maintaining a safe distance of 6 ft. (1.83 m), the assistant will check the tire carrier latch
(11), ensuring it has fully engaged the tire carrier arm bar (12).
0092-11
TM 9-2320-339-10
12
0092
11
Figure 10.
13. With the assistant maintaining the safety area, the operator will proceed to the driver
side cabin and check to ensure the SPARE TIRE LOOSE indicator (2) has gone out.
2
CHEM
ALARM
INTER
AXLE
8X8
25
22
15
11
8
6.2
5.5
3.7
2.7
2.0
IN H20 kPa
FILTER MINDER
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
B.O
SELECT
GPFU
B.O
LIGHTS
PARKING
BRAKE
HIGH
IDLE
1
2
TRAILER
AIR SUPPLY
0
1
2
AIR BRAKE
Figure 11.
0092-12
TM 9-2320-339-10
0092
NOTE
If tire carrier latch is fully engaged, and SPARE TIRE LOOSE indicator light has gone out, skip to Step (17).
If tire carrier latch fails to fully engage tire carrier bar, or SPARE TIRE
LOOSE indicator fails to go out, perform Steps (14) through (16).
14. Move directional control lever (7) to LOWER.
10
Figure 12.
15. Press power control (10) until tire carrier lowers approximately 1 ft. (30 cm).
16. Repeat Steps (7) through (13).
NOTE
If tire carrier latch is fully engaged, and SPARE TIRE LOOSE indicator
light has gone out, complete Steps (17) through (22).
0092-13
TM 9-2320-339-10
0092
17. Remove right lock rod (5) from stowage bracket (6) and pull down to end of groove (13)
until it stops. Turn right lock rod (5) CW until it is hand tight, with jointed end (14) across
tire carrier arm (15).
16
18
14
6
17
13
15
Figure 13.
18. Remove left lock rod (3) from stowage bracket (4), locate washer (16) and pull towards
left lock rod (3) until it stops. Pull both left lock rod (3) and washer (16) down to end of
groove (17). Turn left lock rod (3) CW until it is hand tight, with jointed end (18) pointed
towards tire carrier arm (15).
19. Insert safety pin (19) through hole located on right lock rod jointed end (14).
0092-14
TM 9-2320-339-10
0092
19
14
Figure 14.
NOTE
Tire carrier directional control lever should always be in LOWER position
for vehicle operation.
20. Set directional control lever (7) to LOWER position.
0092-15
TM 9-2320-339-10
0092
Figure 15.
21. Shut off engine (WP 0056) or set ignition switch (1) to off position (as applicable).
0092-16
TM 9-2320-339-10
CHEM
ALARM
0092
INTER
AXLE
25
22
15
11
8
8X8
6.2
5.5
3.7
2.7
2.0
IN H20 kPa
FILTER MINDER
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
B.O
SELECT
GPFU
B.O
LIGHTS
PARKING
BRAKE
HIGH
IDLE
1
2
TRAILER
AIR SUPPLY
0
1
2
AIR BRAKE
Figure 16.
22. Stow access ladder. (WP 0037)
END OF TASK
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0092-17
TM 9-2320-339-10
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
SELF-RECOVER VEHICLE USING SELF-RECOVERY WINCH
INITIAL SETUP:
Not Applicable
NOTE
For additional information on vehicle self-recovery, refer to FM
4-30.31. (WP 0157)
Vehicle self-recovery is a two soldier task. Soldiers must
communicate by hand signals.
1. Shut off engine. (WP 0056)
2. Adjust mirror (1) so assistant can be clearly seen during procedure.
Figure 1.
3. Adjust mirror (1) so assistant can be clearly seen during procedure.
0093-1
0093
TM 9-2320-339-10
0093
Figure 2.
CAUTION
HYD ENABLE switch must be in off position before moving hydraulic selector valve control to prevent equipment damage.
4. Set HYD ENABLE switch (2) to off position. MAIN HYD ENABLE indicator (3) will go
out.
2
3
CHEM
ALARM
INTER
AXLE
8X8
25
22
15
11
8
6.2
5.5
3.7
2.7
2.0
IN H20 kPa
FILTER MINDER
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
B.O
SELECT
GPFU
B.O
LIGHTS
PARKING
BRAKE
HIGH
IDLE
1
2
TRAILER
AIR SUPPLY
0
1
2
AIR BRAKE
Figure 3.
5. Pull out hydraulic selector valve control.
0093-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
HYDRAULIC SELECTOR
VALVE CONTROL
Figure 4.
6. Pull out hydraulic selector valve control.
0093-3
0093
TM 9-2320-339-10
0093
HYDRAULIC SELECTOR
VALVE CONTROL
Figure 5.
7. Start engine. (WP 0043)
8. Set HYD ENABLE switch (2) to on position. MAIN HYD ENABLE indicator (3) will
illuminate.
0093-4
TM 9-2320-339-10
0093
3
2
INTERAXLE
8X8
B.O.
LIGHTS
PULL TO
FOR
NOT MIDLAN
EXHAUST
LER LY
TRAI SUPPKING
AIR PAR D
S U P PL
B.O.
SELECT
PU S H T O
CHEM
ALARM
GPPU
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
M
M
1
2
ASS
HIGH
IDLE
AlTranlissmisonsion
Figure 6.
9. Move winch shift lever (4) to OUT position to pay out small amount of cable.
10. Release winch shift lever (4) to center position.
11. Set PTO ENGAGE switch (2) to OFF position. Indicator light (3) will go out.
12. Set HYD ENABLE switch (2) to off position. MAIN HYD ENABLE indicator (3) will go
out.
13. Remove cotter pin (5) from pin (6).
Figure 7.
0093-5
TM 9-2320-339-10
0093
14. Remove pin (6) from clevis (7) and disconnect clevis (7) from tiedown ring (8).
WARNING
Always wear protective gloves when handling winch cable. Never let
cable run through hands. Frayed cables can cut severely. Failure to
comply may result in injury or death to personnel.
Never operate winch with less than five wraps of cable on winch
drum. Failure to comply may result in injury or death to personnel.
15. Route winch cable (9) around, and over top of winch (10) toward front of vehicle (as
shown).
7
9
10
M977 SHOWN
Figure 8.
16. Set HYD ENABLE switch (2) to on position. MAIN HYD ENABLE indicator (3) will
illuminate.
0093-6
TM 9-2320-339-10
0093
11
10
3
M984A4
INTERAXLE
8X8
B.O.
LIGHTS
PULL TO
EXHAUST
ER
TRAILSUPPLYING
AIR PARK
SU PP
FOR AND
NOT MIDL
LY
B.O.
SELECT
PUSH TO
CHEM
ALARM
GPPU
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
M
M
12
ASS
HIGH
IDLE
n
AllTransisomission
11
M977A4
10
Figure 9.
17. Move winch shift lever (4) to OUT and pay out winch cable (9), while assistant routes
cable (9) through notch in fender (11).
NOTE
Do not place cable between tensioning device pulleys at this time.
When pulling cable through tensioning device, push sheave towards
frame rail to allow clevis to pass through.
0093-7
TM 9-2320-339-10
0093
18. Pay out cable (9) while assistant pulls cable (9) until it is 6 in. to 1 ft. (15 cm to 30 cm)
past the front roller guide (12).
12
13
M977 SHOWN
13
15
14
Figure 10.
NOTE
Do not place cable between tensioning device pulleys at this time.
When pulling cable through tensioning device, push sheave towards
frame rail to allow clevis to pass through.
19. Pay out cable (9) while assistant pulls cable (9) until it is 6 in. to 1 ft. (15 cm to 30 cm)
past the front roller guide (12).
0093-8
TM 9-2320-339-10
0093
12
13
M977A4 SHOWN
13
15
14
Figure 11.
20. Stop paying out cable (9).
21. Assistant routes cable (9) through cable guide (13), over sheave (14), between roller
(15), and side of cable guide (13).
22. Pay out winch cable (9) as assistant routes cable over first axle and 1 ft. (30 cm) past
front roller guide assembly (12).
0093-9
TM 9-2320-339-10
0093
9
M977 SHOWN
12
Figure 12.
23. Pay out winch cable (10) as assistant routes cable over first axle and 1 ft. (30 cm) past
front roller guide assembly (12).
0093-10
TM 9-2320-339-10
0093
M977A4 SHOWN
9
12
Figure 13.
24. Release winch shift lever (4) to center position.
0093-11
TM 9-2320-339-10
0093
3
2
INTERAXLE
8X8
B.O.
LIGHTS
PULL TO
FOR
NOT MIDLAN
EXHAUST
LER LY
TRAI SUPPKING
AIR PAR D
S U P PL
B.O.
SELECT
PU S H T O
CHEM
ALARM
GPPU
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
M
M
1
2
ASS
HIGH
IDLE
AlTranlissmisonsion
10
M977A4 SHOWN
19
18
18
17
16
Figure 14.
25. Set PTO ENGAGE switch (2) to OFF position. Indicator light (3) will go out.
0093-12
TM 9-2320-339-10
0093
26. Set HYD ENABLE switch (2) to off position. MAIN HYD ENABLE indicator (3) will go
out.
27. Remove quick release pin (16) and guide bracket (17). Move cable guide brackets (18)
apart so cable (9) can be placed against bottom of sheave (19).
28. Move cable guide brackets (18) together and install guide bracket (17) and quick
release pin (16).
29. Set PTO ENGAGE switch (2) to ON position. Indicator light (3) will illuminate.
30. Set HYD ENABLE switch (2) to on position. MAIN HYD ENABLE indicator (3) will
illuminate.
31. Move winch shift lever (4) to OUT and pay out winch cable (9) while assistant pulls cable
to tree, another heavy vehicle (WP 0095), or another heavy object refer to FM 4-30.31.
(WP 0157)
32. When winch cable (9) is let out to heavy object, release winch shift lever (4) to center
position.
33. Set PTO ENGAGE switch (2) to OFF position. Indicator light (3) will go out.
34. Set HYD ENABLE switch (2) to off position. MAIN HYD ENABLE indicator (3) will go
out.
35. If snatch block must be used for self-recovery operation, attach self-recovery winch
cable (9) to snatch block (WP 0094) and connect end of self-recovery winch cable to
mired vehicle left front towing eye. (WP 0095) Attach snatch block to tree, another
vehicle, or heavy object refer to FM 4-30.31. (WP 0157)
CAUTION
There must always be at least five wraps of cable on winch. If load is
applied with less than five wraps of cable on winch, cable may come loose
on drum.
36. Check that there are at least five wraps of winch cable (9) left on winch (10). If there
are not at least five wraps of winch cable left on self-recovery winch, stop using selfrecovery winch and continue with Step (54) of this procedure.
CAUTION
Do not go over winch pull capacity or winch may be damaged.
37. Ensure weight of mired vehicle and amount of winch cable (9) left on self-recovery winch
(10) does not go over pull capacity (refer to FM 4-30.31 (WP 0157) and Self-Recovery
Winch Pull Capacity table below). If pull will go over capacity, stop using self-recovery
winch and continue with Step (54) of this procedure.
0093-13
TM 9-2320-339-10
0093
2nd layer
3rd layer
4th layer
5th layer
NOTE
If winch cable will be connected to another vehicle acting as a stationary
anchor, refer to FM 4-30.31 (WP 0157) or Connect/Disconnect Self-Recovery Winch Cable to Another Vehicle (WP 0095) for connecting procedures.
38. If it is determined using self-recovery winch (10) will not go over winch pull capacity,
connect winch cable (9) to heavy object.
39. Ensure winch shift lever (4) is at center position.
40. Ensure PTO ENGAGE switch (2) is set to OFF position. Indicator light (3) will go out.
41. Ensure HYD ENABLE switch (2) is set to off position. MAIN HYD ENABLE indicator (3)
will go out.
WARNING
Do not operate winch while personnel are working on or around tensioning device. Failure to comply may result in injury or death to personnel.
42. Pull back and hold tension pulley lever (20).
0093-14
TM 9-2320-339-10
0093
3
2
INTERAXLE
8X8
B.O.
LIGHTS
PULL TO
FOR
NOT MIDLAN
EXHAUST
LER LY
TRAI SUPPKING
AIR PAR D
S U P PL
B.O.
SELECT
PU S H T O
CHEM
ALARM
GPPU
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
M
M
1
2
ASS
HIGH
IDLE
AlTranlissmisonsion
10
M977A4 SHOWN
21
20
22
9
21
Figure 15.
43. Put winch cable (9) between tensioning device pulleys (21).
44. Release tension pulley lever (20).
45. Check that winch cable (9) rests inside grooves of both tensioning device pulleys (21)
and sheave (22).
0093-15
TM 9-2320-339-10
0093
46. Check that winch cable (9) is not caught on vehicle or any other objects.
WARNING
Keep all personnel clear of area near winch cable when tension is on
cable. Failure to comply may result in injury or death to personnel.
47. Ensure all personnel are clear of self-recovery winch (10) and winch cable (9).
48. Set PTO ENGAGE switch (2) to ON position. Indicator light (3) will illuminate.
49. Set HYD ENABLE switch (2) to on position. MAIN HYD ENABLE indicator (3) will
illuminate.
50. Move winch shift lever (4) to IN until slack is out of cable.
51. Release winch shift lever (4) to center position.
WARNING
Keep all personnel clear of area near winch cable when tension is on
cable. Failure to comply may result in injury or death to personnel.
CAUTION
Self-recovery winch is not designed to winch mired vehicle by itself.
Mired vehicle drive system power must always be used with winch to
self-recover vehicle, or damage to equipment may result.
If winch does not move mired vehicle, stop using winch, overheat
damage may result.
52. Ensure TRANSFER CASE shift lever (23) is set to LO.
0093-16
TM 9-2320-339-10
24
3
2
0093
INTERAXLE
8X8
B.O.
LIGHTS
S U P PL
PULL TO
EXHAUST
LER LY
TRAI SUPPKING
AINOTR FORMIDPARLAND
B.O.
SELECT
PU S H T O
CHEM
ALARM
23
GPPU
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
M
M
1
2
ASS
HIGH
IDLE
AlTranlissmisonsion
27
10
25
26
M977A4 SHOWN
Figure 16.
53. Ensure TRACTION CONTROL lever (24) is set to INTER-AXLE DIFF. LOCK.
54. Ensure traction control switch (24) is set to INTER AXLE.
55. Apply service brake pedal (25).
56. Set transmission range selector (26) to 1 (1st gear range).
57. Release service brake pedal (25).
58. Move winch shift lever (4) to IN and apply slight pressure to throttle pedal (27).
NOTE
Keep winch cable tight at all times so cable does not get tangled with
vehicle.
59. Adjust position of throttle pedal (27) to change engine speed as needed to keep winch
cable (9) tight and vehicle moving.
60. When mired vehicle is on solid ground, release winch shift lever (4) to center position.
61. Park vehicle. (WP 0055)
62. Set winch shift lever (4) to OUT and pay out winch cable (9) until all tension is off cable.
0093-17
TM 9-2320-339-10
0093
63. When all tension is off winch cable (9), release winch shift lever (4) to center position.
64. Set PTO ENGAGE switch (2) to OFF position. Indicator light (3) will go out.
65. Set HYD ENABLE switch (2) to off position. MAIN HYD ENABLE indicator (3) will go
out.
NOTE
If winch cable is connected to another vehicle, refer to Connect/Disconnect Self-Recovery Winch Cable to Another Vehicle (WP 0095) for disconnecting procedures.
66. Disconnect winch cable (9) from heavy object.
67. If snatch block was used, disconnect end of winch cable (10) from vehicle and remove
snatch block from winch cable and from tree, other vehicle, or heavy object refer to FM
4-30.31. (WP 0157)
CAUTION
Do not reel clevis end of winch cable through roller guides. Clevis may
catch on roller guide and cause cable or roller guide to break.
68. Set PTO ENGAGE switch (2) to ON position. Indicator light (3) will illuminate.
69. Set HYD ENABLE switch (2) to on position. MAIN HYD ENABLE indicator (3) will
illuminate.
70. Move winch shift lever (4) to IN.
WARNING
Always wear protective gloves when handling winch cable. Never let
cable run through hands. Frayed cables can cut severely. Failure to
comply may result in injury or death to personnel.
Never operate winch with less than five wraps of cable on winch
drum. Failure to comply may result in injury or death to personnel.
71. Reel in winch cable (9) while assistant uses tire iron extension handle to guide cable
(9) onto self-recovery winch (10) so cable wraps are level across face of self-recovery
winch (10).
72. When end of cable (9) is near front of vehicle, release winch shift lever (4) to center
position.
73. Set PTO ENGAGE switch (2) to OFF position. Indicator light (3) will go out.
0093-18
TM 9-2320-339-10
0093
74. Set HYD ENABLE switch (2) to off position. MAIN HYD ENABLE indicator (3) will go
out.
75. Remove quick release pin (16) and guide bracket (17). Move cable guide brackets (18)
apart so winch cable (9) can be removed from sheave (19).
M977 SHOWN
19
18
18
17
16
Figure 17.
76. Remove quick release pin (16) and guide bracket (17). Move cable guide brackets (18)
apart so winch cable (9) can be removed from sheave (19).
0093-19
TM 9-2320-339-10
0093
M977A4 SHOWN
19
18
18
16
17
Figure 18.
77. Move cable guide bracket (18) together. Install guide bracket (17) and quick release
pin (16).
78. Pull back and hold tension pulley lever (20).
0093-20
TM 9-2320-339-10
M977 SHOWN
0093
21
13
20
22
9
Figure 19.
79. Pull back and hold tension pulley lever (20).
0093-21
21
TM 9-2320-339-10
M977A4 SHOWN
0093
21
13
20
22
9
21
Figure 20.
80. Lift winch cable (9) out of tensioning device pulleys (21).
81. Release tension pulley lever (20).
82. Pull winch cable (9) back and out of cable guide (13).
83. Set HYD ENABLE switch (2) to on position. MAIN HYD ENABLE indicator (3) will
illuminate.
0093-22
TM 9-2320-339-10
0093
7
9
10
M977A4 SHOWN
3
2
INTERAXLE
8X8
B.O.
LIGHTS
S U P PL
PULL TO
EXHAUST
LER LY
TRAI SUPPKING
AINOTR FORMIDPARLAND
B.O.
SELECT
PU S H T O
CHEM
ALARM
GPPU
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
M
M
1
2
ASS
HIGH
IDLE
AlTranlissmisonsion
Figure 21.
84. While assistant guides winch cable (9), move winch shift lever (4) to IN.
85. When clevis (7) is approximately 2 ft. (61 cm) from winch (10), release winch shift lever
(4) to center position.
86. Set PTO ENGAGE switch (2) to OFF position. Indicator light (3) will go out.
87. Set HYD ENABLE switch (2) to off position. MAIN HYD ENABLE indicator (3) will go
out.
88. Assistant routes end of winch cable (9) down along front face of winch (10).
0093-23
TM 9-2320-339-10
0093
10
28
Figure 22.
89. Assistant routes end of winch cable (9) under winch (10) and out through hole in bottom
of rear winch frame (28).
90. Assistant connects clevis (7) at end of winch cable (9) to tiedown ring (8) with pin (6)
and cotter pin (5).
0093-24
TM 9-2320-339-10
0093
10
M977A4 SHOWN
9
6
3
INTERAXLE
8X8
B.O.
LIGHTS
PULL TO
NOT MID
EXHAUST
LER LY
TRAI SUPPKING
AIR FOR PARLAND
S U P PL
B.O.
SELECT
PU S H T O
CHEM
ALARM
GPPU
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
M
M
1
2
ASS
HIGH
IDLE
AlTranlissmisonsion
Figure 23.
91. Set PTO ENGAGE switch (2) to ON position. Indicator light (3) will illuminate.
92. Set HYD ENABLE switch (2) to on position. MAIN HYD ENABLE indicator (3) will
illuminate.
0093-25
TM 9-2320-339-10
0093
WARNING
Keep all personnel clear of area near winch cable when tension is on
cable. Failure to comply may result in injury or death to personnel.
93. Order all personnel to stand clear of area near winch (10).
CAUTION
Do not reel in winch cable too tightly. If too much tension is applied, cable
or tiedown ring can break, or winch may be damaged.
94. Once assistant and all other personnel are clear of area, move winch shift lever (4) to
IN and take all slack out of winch cable (9).
95. When winch cable (9) is tight, release winch shift lever (4) to center position.
96. Set PTO ENGAGE switch (2) to OFF position. Indicator light (3) will go out.
97. Set HYD ENABLE switch (2) to off position. MAIN HYD ENABLE indicator (3) will go
out.
98. Shut off engine. (WP 0056)
99. Push in hydraulic selector valve control.
0093-26
TM 9-2320-339-10
HYDRAULIC SELECTOR
VALVE CONTROL
Figure 24.
100.Push in hydraulic selector valve control.
0093-27
0093
TM 9-2320-339-10
HYDRAULIC SELECTOR
VALVE CONTROL
Figure 25.
101.Adjust mirror (1) for driving.
Figure 26.
102.Adjust mirror (1) for driving.
0093-28
0093
TM 9-2320-339-10
Figure 27.
WINCH MIRED VEHICLE TO THE REAR
NOTE
For additional information on vehicle self-recovery refer to FM
4-30.31. (WP 0157)
Vehicle self-recovery is a two soldier task. Soldiers must
communicate by hand signals.
1. Shut off engine. (WP 0056)
2. Adjust mirror (1) so assistant can be clearly seen during procedure.
Figure 28.
3. Adjust mirror (1) so assistant can be clearly seen during procedure.
0093-29
0093
TM 9-2320-339-10
0093
Figure 29.
CAUTION
HYD ENABLE switch must be in off position before moving hydraulic selector valve to prevent equipment damage.
4. Set HYD ENABLE switch (2) to off position. MAIN HYD ENABLE indicator (3) will go
out.
2
3
CHEM
ALARM
INTER
AXLE
8X8
25
22
15
11
8
6.2
5.5
3.7
2.7
2.0
IN H20 kPa
FILTER MINDER
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
B.O
SELECT
GPFU
B.O
LIGHTS
PARKING
BRAKE
HIGH
IDLE
1
2
TRAILER
AIR SUPPLY
0
1
2
AIR BRAKE
Figure 30.
5. Pull out hydraulic selector valve control.
0093-30
TM 9-2320-339-10
HYDRAULIC SELECTOR
VALVE CONTROL
Figure 31.
6. Pull out hydraulic selector valve control.
0093-31
0093
TM 9-2320-339-10
0093
HYDRAULIC SELECTOR
VALVE CONTROL
Figure 32.
7. Set HYD ENABLE switch (2) to on position. MAIN HYD ENABLE indicator (3) will
illuminate.
0093-32
TM 9-2320-339-10
0093
3
2
INTERAXLE
8X8
B.O.
LIGHTS
PULL TO
FOR
NOT MIDLAN
EXHAUST
LER LY
TRAI SUPPKING
AIR PAR D
S U P PL
B.O.
SELECT
PU S H T O
CHEM
ALARM
GPPU
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
M
M
1
2
ASS
HIGH
IDLE
AlTranlissmisonsion
Figure 33.
8. Move winch shift lever (4) to OUT position to pay out small amount of cable.
9. Release winch shift lever (4) to center position.
10. Set PTO ENGAGE switch (2) to OFF position. Indicator light (3) will go out.
11. Set HYD ENABLE switch (2) to off position. MAIN HYD ENABLE indicator (3) will go
out.
12. Remove cotter pin (5) from pin (6).
Figure 34.
0093-33
TM 9-2320-339-10
0093
13. Remove pin (6) from clevis (7) and disconnect clevis from tiedown ring (8).
14. Set HYD ENABLE switch (2) to on position. MAIN HYD ENABLE indicator (3) will
illuminate.
10
11
M977A4 SHOWN
9
3
2
INTERAXLE
8X8
B.O.
LIGHTS
PULL TO
FOR
NOT MIDLAN
EXHAUST
LER LY
TRAI SUPPKING
AIR PAR D
S U P PL
B.O.
SELECT
PU S H T O
CHEM
ALARM
GPPU
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
M
M
1
2
ASS
HIGH
IDLE
AlTranlissmisonsion
Figure 35.
0093-34
TM 9-2320-339-10
0093
WARNING
Always wear protective gloves when handling winch cable. Never let
cable run through hands. Frayed cables can cut severely. Failure to
comply may result in injury or death to personnel.
Never operate winch with less than five wraps of cable on winch
drum. Failure to comply may result in injury or death to personnel.
15. Move winch shift lever (4) to OUT while assistant pulls winch cable (9) from selfrecovery winch (10) toward rear of vehicle.
NOTE
Do not place cable between tensioning device pulleys at this time.
When pulling cable through tensioning device, push sheave towards
frame rail to allow clevis to pass through.
16. Continue to pay out winch cable (9) while assistant routes cable through cable guide
(11).
17. Continue to pay out winch cable (9) while assistant routes cable through roller guide
(12).
0093-35
TM 9-2320-339-10
0093
10
12
M983 SHOWN
Figure 36.
18. Continue to pay out winch cable (9) while assistant routes cable through hole (12) in
fender and through roller guide (13).
0093-36
TM 9-2320-339-10
0093
M977 SHOWN
12
13
Figure 37.
19. Continue to pay out winch cable (9) while assistant routes cable roller guide (13).
0093-37
TM 9-2320-339-10
0093
13
Figure 38.
20. Pay out winch cable (9) while assistant pulls cable to tree, another vehicle, or heavy
object refer to FM 4-30.31. (WP 0157)
21. When winch cable (9) is let out to tree, another vehicle, heavy object, release winch
shift lever (4) to center position.
22. Set HYD ENABLE switch (2) to off position. MAIN HYD ENABLE indicator (3) will go
out.
0093-38
TM 9-2320-339-10
0093
10
M977A4 SHOWN
3
INTERAXLE
8X8
B.O.
LIGHTS
PULL TO
EXHAUST
LER LY
TRAI SUPPKING
AIR FOR PARLAND
NOT MID
S U P PL
Y
B.O.
SELECT
PU S H T O
CHEM
ALARM
GPPU
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
M
M
1
2
ASS
HIGH
IDLE
AlTranlissmisonsion
Figure 39.
23. If snatch block must be used for self-recovery operation, attach self-recovery winch
cable (9) to snatch block (WP 0094) and connect end of self-recovery winch cable to
mired vehicle left rear towing eye. (WP 0095) Attach snatch block to a tree, another
vehicle, or heavy object refer to FM 4-30.31. (WP 0157)
CAUTION
There must be at least five wraps of cable on winch. If load is applied with
less than five wraps of cable on winch, cable may come loose on drum.
24. Check that there are at least five wraps of winch cable (9) left on winch (10). If there
are not at least five wraps of winch cable left on winch (10), stop using self-recovery
winch (10) and continue with Step (46) of this procedure.
CAUTION
Do not go over winch pull capacity or winch could be damaged.
0093-39
TM 9-2320-339-10
0093
25. Ensure weight of mired vehicle and amount of winch cable (9) left on winch (10) does
not go over pull capacity refer to FM 4-30.31 (WP 0157) and Self-Recovery Winch Pull
Capacity table below). If pull will go over capacity, stop using self-recovery winch and
continue with Step (46) of this procedure.
Table 2. Self-Recovery Winch Pull Capacity.
Cable Layer
2nd layer
3rd layer
4th layer
5th layer
NOTE
If winch cable will be connected to another vehicle acting as a stationary
anchor, refer to FM 4-30.31 (WP 0157) or Connect/Disconnect Self-Recovery Winch Cable to Another Vehicle (WP 0095) for connecting procedures.
26. If it is determined using self-recovery winch (10) will not go over winch pull capacity,
connect winch cable (9) to heavy object.
27. Ensure winch shift lever (4) is at center position.
28. Set PTO ENGAGE switch (2) to OFF position. Indicator light (3) will go out.
29. Set HYD ENABLE switch (2) to off position. MAIN HYD ENABLE indicator (3) will go
out.
WARNING
Do not operate winch while personnel are working on or around tensioning device. Failure to comply may result in injury or death to personnel.
30. Pull back and hold tension pulley lever (14).
0093-40
TM 9-2320-339-10
0093
11
15
9
14
M977 SHOWN
Figure 40.
31. Route winch cable (9) between pulleys (15).
32. Release tension pulley lever (14).
33. Ensure winch cable (9) rests inside grooves of both pulleys (15).
34. Ensure winch cable (9) is not caught on vehicle or any other objects.
35. Ensure all personnel are clear of winch (10) and winch cable (9).
0093-41
TM 9-2320-339-10
0093
10
M977A4 SHOWN
17
3
2
INTERAXLE
8X8
B.O.
LIGHTS
PULL TO
EXHAUST
LER LY
TRAI SUPPKING
AIR PAR D
FOR
NOT MIDLAN
S U P PL
Y
B.O.
SELECT
PU S H T O
CHEM
ALARM
16
GPPU
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
M
M
1
2
ASS
HIGH
IDLE
AlTranlissmisonsion
20
19
18
Figure 41.
36. Set PTO ENGAGE switch (2) to ON position. Indicator light (3) will illuminate.
37. Set HYD ENABLE switch (2) to on position. MAIN HYD ENABLE indicator (3) will
illuminate.
38. Move winch shift lever (4) to IN until slack is out of winch cable (9).
39. Release winch shift lever (4) to center position.
0093-42
TM 9-2320-339-10
0093
WARNING
Keep all personnel clear of area near winch cable when tension is on
cable. Failure to comply may result in injury or death to personnel.
CAUTION
Self-recovery winch is not designed to winch mired vehicle by itself.
Mired vehicle drive system power must always be used with winch to
self-recover vehicle, or damage to equipment can result.
If winch does not move mired vehicle, stop using winch, overheat
damage may result.
40. Ensure that TRANSFER CASE shift lever (16) is set to LO.
41. Ensure TRACTION CONTROL lever (17) is set to INTER-AXLE DIFF. LOCK.
42. Ensure traction control switch (17) is set to INTER AXLE.
43. Apply service brake pedal (18).
44. Set transmission range selector (19) to R (reverse).
45. Release service brake pedal (18).
46. Slightly press throttle pedal (20) and move winch shift lever (4) to IN.
NOTE
Keep winch cable tight at all times so cable does not get tangled with
vehicle.
47. Adjust position of throttle pedal (20) to change engine speed as needed to keep winch
cable (9) tight and mired vehicle moving.
48. When mired vehicle is on solid ground, release winch shift lever (4) to center position.
49. Park vehicle. (WP 0055)
50. Set winch shift lever (4) to OUT and pay out winch cable (9) until all tension is released.
51. When all tension is off winch cable (9), release winch shift lever (4) to center position.
52. Set PTO ENGAGE switch (2) to OFF position. Indicator light (3) will go out.
53. Set HYD ENABLE switch (2) to off position. MAIN HYD ENABLE indicator (3) will go
out.
0093-43
TM 9-2320-339-10
0093
NOTE
If winch cable is connected to another vehicle, refer to Connect/Disconnect Self-Recovery Winch Cable to Another Vehicle (WP 0095) for disconnecting procedures.
54. Disconnect winch cable (9) from heavy object.
55. If snatch block was used, disconnect end of winch cable (9) from vehicle. (WP 0095)
Remove snatch block from winch cable (WP 0094) and tree, another vehicle, or heavy
object refer to FM 4-30.31. (WP 0157)
CAUTION
Do not reel clevis end of winch cable through roller guides. Clevis may
catch on roller guide and cause cable or roller guide to break.
56. Set PTO ENGAGE switch (2) to ON position. Indicator light (3) will illuminate.
57. Set HYD ENABLE switch (2) to on position. MAIN HYD ENABLE indicator (3) will
illuminate.
58. Set winch shift lever (4) to IN.
59. When end of cable is near rear of vehicle, release winch shift lever (4) to center position.
60. Set PTO ENGAGE switch (2) to OFF position. Indicator light (3) will go out.
61. Set HYD ENABLE switch (2) to off position. MAIN HYD ENABLE indicator (3) will go
out.
WARNING
Always wear protective gloves when handling winch cable. Never let
cable run through hands. Frayed cables can cut severely. Failure to
comply may result in injury or death to personnel.
Never operate winch with less than five wraps of cable on winch
drum. Failure to comply may result in injury or death to personnel.
62. Pull clevis (7) end of winch cable (9) forward through roller guide (13) and hole (12) in
fender.
0093-44
TM 9-2320-339-10
0093
M977 SHOWN
12
13
9
Figure 42.
WARNING
Always wear protective gloves when handling winch cable. Never let
cable run through hands. Frayed cables can cut severely. Failure to
comply may result in injury or death to personnel.
Never operate winch with less than five wraps of cable on winch
drum. Failure to comply may result in injury or death to personnel.
63. Pull clevis (7) end of winch cable (9) forward through roller guide (13).
0093-45
TM 9-2320-339-10
0093
13
Figure 43.
64. Lift winch cable (9) out of roller guide (12).
0093-46
TM 9-2320-339-10
0093
10
12
M983 SHOWN
Figure 44.
65. Pull back and hold tension pulley lever (14).
0093-47
TM 9-2320-339-10
0093
11
15
9
14
M977 SHOWN
Figure 45.
66. Lift winch cable (9) out of pulleys (15).
67. Release tension pulley lever (14).
68. Pull winch cable (9) forward and out of cable guide (11).
69. Set HYD ENABLE switch (2) to on position. MAIN HYD ENABLE indicator (3) will
illuminate.
0093-48
TM 9-2320-339-10
0093
10
M977A4 SHOWN
9
6
3
INTERAXLE
8X8
B.O.
LIGHTS
PULL TO
NOT MID
EXHAUST
LER LY
TRAI SUPPKING
AIR FOR PARLAND
S U P PL
B.O.
SELECT
PU S H T O
CHEM
ALARM
GPPU
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
M
M
1
2
ASS
HIGH
IDLE
AlTranlissmisonsion
Figure 46.
70. Move winch shift lever (4) to IN position to reel in cable while assistant guides winch
cable (9) to tiedown ring (8).
71. When clevis (7) is approximately 2 ft. (61 cm) from winch (10), release winch shift lever
(4) to center position.
72. Assistant connects clevis (7) to tiedown ring (8) with pin (6) and cotter pin (5).
0093-49
TM 9-2320-339-10
0093
WARNING
Keep all personnel clear of area near winch cable when tension is on
cable. Failure to comply may result in injury or death to personnel.
73. Order all personnel to stand clear of area near winch (10).
CAUTION
Do not reel in winch cable too tightly. If too much tension is applied, cable
or tiedown ring can break, or winch may be damaged.
74. Once assistant and all other personnel are clear of area, move winch shift lever (4) to
IN and take all slack out of winch cable (9).
75. When cable is tight, release winch shift lever (4) to center position.
76. Set PTO ENGAGE switch (2) to OFF position. Indicator light (3) will go out.
77. Set HYD ENABLE switch (2) to off position. MAIN HYD ENABLE indicator (3) will go
out.
78. Shut off engine. (WP 0056)
79. Push in hydraulic selector valve control.
0093-50
TM 9-2320-339-10
HYDRAULIC SELECTOR
VALVE CONTROL
Figure 47.
80. Push in hydraulic selector valve control.
0093-51
0093
TM 9-2320-339-10
HYDRAULIC SELECTOR
VALVE CONTROL
Figure 48.
81. Adjust mirror (1) for driving.
Figure 49.
82. Adjust mirror (1) for driving.
0093-52
0093
TM 9-2320-339-10
Figure 50.
END OF TASK
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0093-53
0093
TM 9-2320-339-10
0094
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
SNATCH BLOCK INSTALLATION/REMOVAL
INITIAL SETUP:
Not Applicable
Figure 1.
2. Remove screw (2).
3. Move plate (3) to side to open snatch block (1).
4. Place winch cable (4) in snatch block (1).
5. Close plate (3) and align holes.
6. Install screw (2).
7. Ensure screw (2) is tight and winch cable (4) can be moved freely through snatch block
(1).
8. Continue with self-recovery operation (WP 0093).
0094-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
Figure 2.
2. Remove screw (2).
3. Move plate (3) to side to open snatch block (4).
4. Take winch cable (1) out of snatch block (4).
5. Close plate (3) and align holes.
6. Install screw (2).
7. Stow snatch block (4) in stowage box.
8. Continue with self-recovery operation (WP 0093).
END OF TASK
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0094-2
0094
TM 9-2320-339-10
0095
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
CONNECT/DISCONNECT SELF-RECOVERY WINCH CABLE TO ANOTHER VEHICLE
INITIAL SETUP:
Not Applicable
CAUTION
When attaching self-recovery winch cable to another vehicle, that vehicle
must be used only as an anchor point or damage to equipment can result.
NOTE
There are three tiedown rings on each side of vehicle.
1. Unscrew one tiedown ring (1) from mounting plate (2).
Figure 1.
2. Unscrew one tiedown ring (1) from mounting plate (2).
0095-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
Figure 2.
3. Remove lifting shackle (3) from stowage.
0095-2
0095
TM 9-2320-339-10
0095
Figure 3.
4. Insert lifting shackle (3) through tiedown ring (1).
5. Connect lifting shackle (3) to left front of left rear tow eye (4) with pin (5).
6. Install cotter pin (6).
7. Connect self-recovery winch cable (7) with clevis (8) to tiedown ring (1) with pin (9).
8. Install cotter pin (10).
9. Continue with self-recovery winch operation (WP 0093).
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM VEHICLE
1. Ensure there is enough slack in winch cable (1).
0095-3
TM 9-2320-339-10
4
1
Figure 4.
2. Remove cotter pin (2).
3. Remove pin (3) and disconnect clevis (4) from tiedown ring (5).
4. Remove cotter pin (6).
5. Remove pin (7) and disconnect lifting shackle (8) from tow eye (9).
6. Remove tiedown ring (5) from lifting shackle (8).
7. Stow lifting shackle (8).
NOTE
There are three tiedown rings on each side of vehicle.
8. Install tiedown ring (5) into mounting plate (10).
0095-4
0095
TM 9-2320-339-10
10
Figure 5.
NOTE
There are three tiedown rings on each side of vehicle.
9. Install tiedown ring (5) into mounting plate (10).
0095-5
0095
TM 9-2320-339-10
10
Figure 6.
10. Continue with self-recovery winch operation (WP 0093).
END OF TASK
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0095-6
0095
TM 9-2320-339-10
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
TOW DISABLED VEHICLE
INITIAL SETUP:
Not Applicable
CAUTION
When towing another vehicle, do not go over GCWR given in
equipment data (WP 0006). Failure to comply may result in damage
to equipment.
Propeller shaft must be removed by field level maintenance before
towing disabled vehicle or equipment may be damaged.
NOTE
Disabled vehicles must be prepared and moved in accordance with FM
21-305 . If instructed to do so, manually release spring brakes (WP
0107) as part of preparing disabled vehicle for towing.
1. Install and operate portable beacon lights. (WP 0070)
2. Set TRANSFER CASE shift lever (1) to NEUT (neutral) position.
3. Set traction control switch (2) to off (center) position.
0096-1
0096
TM 9-2320-339-10
0096
4
INTERAXLE
8X8
B.O.
LIGHTS
PULL TO
EXHAUST
LER
TRAI SUPPKINLYG
AIR PAR D
FOR
NOT MIDLAN
S UPPLY
B.O.
SELECT
PUS O
HT
CHEM
ALARM
1
GPPU
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
M
M
1
2
ASS
HIGH
IDLE
nn
smissio
ATranlliso
Figure 1.
4. Push in PARKING BRAKE control on disabled vehicle (refer to operator's manual).
5. Push in TRAILER AIR SUPPLY control (4) on recovery vehicle.
6. Transport disabled vehicle.
END OF TASK
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0096-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
CONNECT/DISCONNECT TOW BAR
INITIAL SETUP:
Not Applicable
WARNING
Do not use 10-ton tow bar with self-guided coupler (normally found on
some M1120 LHS and M1977 CBT models). Self-guided coupler is not
compatible with 10-ton tow bar. Failure to comply may result in injury or
death to personnel
WARNING
Tow bar is heavy. Do not attempt to lift or move tow bar without the aid
of two assistants and a lifting device. Failure to comply may result in injury
or death to personnel.
NOTE
This procedure is a three soldier task.
The 10-ton tow bar should always be used in conjunction with two 16
ft. (5 m) safety chains.
Allow ample distance between towing vehicle and disabled vehicle
to connect 10-ton tow bar.
1. Align rear of towing vehicle near front of disabled vehicle.
0097-1
0097
TM 9-2320-339-10
0097
WARNING
Tow bar is heavy. Do not attempt to lift or move tow bar without the aid
of two assistants and a lifting device. Failure to comply may result in injury
or death to personnel.
2. With aid of two assistants and a lifting device, remove tow bar (1) from stowage.
Figure 1.
3. Remove cotter hairpin (2) and pin (3) from tow bar (1).
4. Separate tow bar (1) at pivot point (4).
NOTE
Towing eyes on all models of HEMTT series vehicles are same in appearance, operation, and location. HEMTT M977 shown.
5. Position legs of tow bar (1) in front of disabled vehicle with spare pins (5) facing up.
0097-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
0097
M977 BASE/A2
1
3
1
9
Figure 2.
M977 A4
Figure 3.
6. Remove two cotter hairpins (6) and pins (7) from tow bar shackles (8).
0097-3
TM 9-2320-339-10
0097
WARNING
Tow bar is heavy. Do not attempt to lift or move tow bar without the aid
of two assistants and a lifting device. Failure to comply may result in injury
or death to personnel.
7. While two assistants hold one leg of tow bar (1) and align shackle (8) with towing eye
(9), install pin (7) and cotter hairpin (6).
8. Repeat Step (7) for other leg of tow bar (1).
9. Align legs of tow bar (1) at pivot point (4) and install pin (3) and cotter hairpin (2).
WARNING
Do not use 10-ton tow bar with self-guided coupler (normally found on
some M1120 LHS and M1977 CBT models). Self-guided coupler is not
compatible with 10-ton tow bar. Failure to comply may result in injury or
death to personnel
NOTE
Pintle hook on all models of HEMTT series vehicles are same in appearance, operation, and location. HEMTT M977 shown.
10. Position the towing vehicle so pintle hook is aligned with tow bar lunette eye.
11. Remove cotter pin (10) from pintle hook (11).
0097-4
TM 9-2320-339-10
12
0097
M977
11
13
1
10
Figure 4.
12. Pull latch (12) away from vehicle and hold.
13. Lift top of pintle hook (11) and let go of latch (12). Pintle hook (11) will be locked open.
WARNING
Tow bar is heavy. Do not attempt to lift or move tow bar without the aid
of two assistants and a lifting device. Failure to comply may result in injury
or death to personnel.
0097-5
TM 9-2320-339-10
0097
WARNING
Do not put hands near pintle hook while aligning lunette eye with pintle
hook. Failure to comply may result in injury or death to personnel.
14. While two assistants lift tow bar (1), slowly back up towing vehicle until tow bar lunette
eye (13) connects to pintle hook (11).
15. Pull latch (12) and close top half of pintle hook (11).
16. Install cotter pin (10) in pintle hook (11).
NOTE
If air system of disabled vehicle is damaged, manually release spring
brakes (WP 0107) and skip to Step (20).
17. Remove two inter-vehicular air lines (14) from stowage.
M977
M977
18
15
19
14
17
16
Figure 5.
NOTE
Gladhands on all models of HEMTT series vehicles are same in appearance, operation, and location. HEMTT M977 shown.
18. Connect first intervehicular air line (14) to driver side rear gladhand (15) of towing
vehicle and driver side front gladhand (16) of disabled vehicle.
19. Connect second intervehicular air line (17) to passenger side rear gladhand (18) of
towing vehicle and passenger side front gladhand (19) of disabled vehicle.
20. Remove two 16 ft. (5 m) safety chains (20) from stowage.
0097-6
TM 9-2320-339-10
0097
NOTE
Both driver side and passenger side walking beams are same. Driver
side shown.
If disabled vehicle is either a BASE or A2 model HEMTT series
vehicle (refer to data plate on inside of drivers door), complete Step
(21). If disabled vehicle is an A4 model HEMTT series vehicle (refer
to data plate on inside of drivers door), skip to Step (22).
21. Route one 16 ft. (5 m) safety chain (20) over walking beam (21) behind No. 1 axle (22)
on disabled vehicle, and hook 16 ft. (5 m) safety chain (20) back into itself under walking
beam (21) as shown.
22
20
21
BASE/A2 MODELS
Figure 6.
CAUTION
Special care should be taken when connecting 16 ft. (5 m) safety chain
to tiedown ring. The procedure listed below routes the 16 ft. (5 m) safety
chain in such a way as to minimize excessive contact with vehicle air
0097-7
TM 9-2320-339-10
0097
NOTE
Both driver side and passenger side tiedown rings are same. Driver side
shown.
22. Connect 16 ft. (5 m) safety chain (20) to disabled vehicle tiedown ring (23):
a. Route end (without safety shackle) of 16 ft. (5 m) safety chain (20) through tiedown
ring (23) from inboard to outboard until grab hook (24) hangs just below bottom of
air spring (25).
23
25
20
24
Figure 7.
b. Hook 16 ft. (5 m) safety chain (20) back to itself. Grab hook (24) should open
towards ground (shown) when tension is applied to 16 ft. (5 m) safety chain (20).
0097-8
TM 9-2320-339-10
0097
24
20
Figure 8.
23. Repeat Steps (21) or (22) for other side of disabled vehicle.
NOTE
16 ft. (5 m) safety chain may be attached to either safety chain loop
or towing shackles.
16 ft. (5 m) safety chain should be attached so they are just above,
but not in contact with the ground.
24. Route free ends of two 16 ft. (5 m) safety chain (20) through safety chain loop (26) on
towing vehicle and attach each 16 ft. (5 m) safety chain (20) back into itself as shown.
0097-9
TM 9-2320-339-10
26
0097
20
Figure 9.
25. Tow disabled vehicle. (WP 0096)
DISCONNECT TOW BAR
NOTE
This procedure is a three soldier task.
Vehicle should be parked and disconnected on level ground.
1. Park towing vehicle. (WP 0055)
2. Pull out TRAILER AIR SUPPLY control (1) on towing vehicle.
CHEM
ALARM
INTER
AXLE
25
22
15
11
8
8X8
6.2
5.5
3.7
2.7
2.0
IN H20 kPa
FILTER MINDER
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
B.O
SELECT
GPFU
B.O
LIGHTS
PARKING
BRAKE
HIGH
IDLE
1
2
TRAILER
AIR SUPPLY
0
1
2
AIR BRAKE
Figure 10.
0097-10
TM 9-2320-339-10
0097
NOTE
If disabled vehicle parking brake is inoperable and/or spring brakes on
disabled vehicle were manually released, install wheel chocks (refer to
operator's manual).
3. Engage parking brake on disabled vehicle (refer to operator's manual).
4. Disconnect two 16 ft. (5 m) safety chains (2) from towing vehicle and disabled vehicle.
Return 16 ft. (5 m) safety chains (2) to stowage.
M977
M977
4
Figure 11.
NOTE
If spring brakes on disabled vehicle were manually released before towing, skip to Step (6).
5. Disconnect two intervehicular air lines (3) from towing vehicle rear gladhands (4) and
from disabled vehicle front gladhands (5). Return intervehicular air lines (5) to stowage.
6. Remove cotter pin (6) from towing vehicle pintle hook (7).
0097-11
TM 9-2320-339-10
0097
11
10
Figure 12.
7. Pull latch (9) away from vehicle and hold.
8. Lift top of pintle hook (7) and let go of latch (9). Pintle hook (7) will be locked open.
9. As two assistants lift tow bar (10) until lunette eye (11) is clear of pintle hook (10), drive
towing vehicle forward approximately 15 ft. (4.6 m).
10. As assistants lower tow bar (10) to the ground, park towing vehicle.
11. Pull latch (9) to close towing vehicle pintle hook (7) and install cotter pin (6) in pintle
hook (7).
12. Remove cotter hairpin (12) and pin (13) and separate tow bar (10) at pivot point (14).
0097-12
TM 9-2320-339-10
0097
M977 BASE/A2
10
13
10
12
17
15
16
14
Figure 13.
M977 A4
1
10
13
12
9
15
17
14
Figure 14.
0097-13
16
TM 9-2320-339-10
0097
13. With aid of an assistant, hold one leg of tow bar (10) while another assistant removes
cotter hairpin (15) and pin (16) from shackle (17).
14. Repeat Step (13) for other leg of tow bar (10).
15. With aid of two assistants, lower tow bar (10) to the ground.
16. Install two pins (16) and cotter hairpins (15) is shackles (17).
17. Align legs of tow bar (10) at pivot point (14) and install pin (13) and cotter hairpin (12).
WARNING
Tow bar is heavy. Do not attempt to lift or move tow bar without the aid
of two assistants and a lifting device. Failure to comply may result in injury
or death to personnel.
18. With aid of two assistants and lifting device, return tow bar (10) to stowage.
END OF TASK
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0097-14
TM 9-2320-339-10
0098
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
OPERATE VEHICLE IN EXTREME HEAT
INITIAL SETUP:
Not Applicable
CAUTION
When operating vehicle in very hot temperatures of above 100F (38
C), extra care must be taken to prevent overheating engine
(temperatures over 230F (110C) and transmission (temperatures
over 300F, 149C). Watch water and transmission temperature
gauges closely. Failure to comply may result in damage to
equipment.
Check oil levels often and keep operating strain as low as possible.
Vehicle cooling and lubrication systems support each other. Failure
of one system will rapidly cause failure of other systems.
NOTE
Close heater valves to improve the efficiency of cabin air
conditioning.
Closing the heater valves disables cabin heat.
1. Keep operating temperatures as low as possible:
a. Set transmission range selector (1) to N (neutral) while engine is running and not
required to move.
b. Use low gear ranges only when necessary.
c.
Stop vehicle for cooling off periods, and idle engine as often as possible. Let engine
idle for approximately 3 minutes before shutting down. Idling will cool engine faster
than quick shutdown and may prevent damage from remaining engine heat.
d. Check oil levels often. Oil seals are more likely to leak in extreme hot weather.
e. Check air filter restriction indicator (2) frequently. If indicator shows red:
(1) Park vehicle. (WP 0055)
(2) Shut off engine. (WP 0056)
0098-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
0098
2
3
4
INTERAXLE
8X8
B.O.
LIGHTS
PULL TO
EXHAUST
ER
LY
TRAILSUPPKING
AIR PAR
FOR AND
NOT MIDL
SUPPLY
B.O.
SELECT
PU S H T O
CHEM
ALARM
GPPU
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
M
M
1
2
ASS
HIGH
IDLE
AlTranlissmisonsion
1
5
Figure 1.
2. If transmission temperature gauge (3) reads 300F (149C) or above, perform the
following steps:
a. Slow vehicle.
b. Set transmission range selector (1) to next lower gear range.
c.
Continue operation.
NOTE
Dashboard parking brake indicator will illuminate when PARKING
BRAKE control is applied.
(3) Pull out PARKING BRAKE control (4).
0098-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
0098
NOTE
Dashboard parking brake indicator will go out when PARKING
BRAKE control is released.
(2) Push in PARKING BRAKE control (4).
(3) Set transmission range selector (1) to normal gear range.
(4) Continue operation.
3. If water temperature gauge (6) indicates coolant temperature is near overheating,
perform the following steps:
a. Slow vehicle.
b. Set transmission range selector (1) to next lower gear range.
c.
Continue operation.
NOTE
Dashboard parking brake indicator will illuminate when PARKING
BRAKE control is applied.
(3) Pull out PARKING BRAKE control (4).
(4) Allow engine to cool.
f.
NOTE
Dashboard parking brake indicator will go out when PARKING
BRAKE control is released.
(2) Push in PARKING BRAKE control (4).
0098-3
TM 9-2320-339-10
0098
d. Radiator or charge air cooler fins/grill plugged with mud, debris, etc.
NOTE
Batteries do not hold charge well in extreme heat.
Battery will be tagged (white circle printed on top) for use in extreme
heat conditions as specific gravity must be changed to adjust for heat
(refer to TM 9-6140-200-14).
5. Keep batteries full, but do not overfill. Check battery electrolyte daily.
6. In hot, damp climates check body and chassis often and notify field level maintenance
if any of the following are found:
a. Signs of pitting or paint blistering on metal surfaces.
b. Signs of mildew, mold, or fungus on fabrics and rubber.
7. Adjust lubrication intervals as specified in applicable Lubrication Table.
8. Park vehicle (WP 0055) in sheltered area, out of wind if possible. If no shelter is
available, park so vehicle does not face into wind.
END OF TASK
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0098-4
TM 9-2320-339-10
0099
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
OPERATION IN EXTREME DUST
INITIAL SETUP:
Not Applicable
CAUTION
Clouds of dust can scratch glass surfaces. Keep glass surfaces covered
as much as possible in these conditions to prevent scratching.
1. Leave glass surfaces covered if not needed for operations. Take extra care when
cleaning glass to prevent scratching surfaces.
2. Keep close watch on air filter restriction indicator (1) located on top right side of drivers
instrument panel.
PARKING
BRAKE
TRAILER
AIR SUPPLY
AIR BRAKE
Figure 1.
3. Continuously scan gauges and indicators on drivers instrument panel (2) to be sure
dust does not affect equipment.
4. Allow as much distance as possible between vehicles and operate at low speeds.
0099-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
Figure 2.
6. When possible, park vehicle so it does not face into wind.
END OF TASK
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0099-2
0099
TM 9-2320-339-10
0100
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
OPERATE VEHICLE IN SAND OR MUD
INITIAL SETUP:
Not Applicable
CAUTION
Blowing sand may scratch glass surfaces. Glass surfaces should remain
covered as much as possible in these conditions to prevent scratching.
NOTE
Operating in mud can worsen vehicle braking and speed up brake wear.
If braking worsens while operating in mud, dry brakes by driving vehicle
approximately 500 ft. (153 m) with service brakes frequently applied. This
must be done with brake drums totally out of mud, so that drying action
can take place. If adequate braking is not restored by drying brakes, notify
field level maintenance.
1. Leave glass surfaces covered if not needed for operations. Extra care should be taken
when cleaning glass surfaces to prevent scratching surfaces.
NOTE
Principles of driving in sand can also be applied to driving in mud.
Best time to drive on sand is at night or early morning when sand is
damp. Damp sand gives better traction.
a. Check air filter restriction indicator (1) often.
2. Adjust tires to correct tire pressure for type tire and environment. (WP 0006)
3. Set TRANSFER CASE shift lever (2) to LO. 8X8 drive indicator (3) will illuminate.
0100-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
0100
1
4
INTERAXLE
8X8
B.O.
LIGHTS
EXHAUST
PULL TO
ER
AIL PLY
TR SUPAPRKING
AIR
OS
UPPLY
B.O.
CT
SELE
R ND
T FO LA
NO MID
PU
SH T
CHEM
ALARM
GPPU
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
1
2
ASS
HIGH
IDLE
soissnion
ATrallinsm
6
8
4
3
CHEM
ALARM
INTER
AXLE
8X8
25
22
15
11
8
6.2
5.5
3.7
2.7
2.0
IN H20 kPa
FILTER MINDER
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
B.O
SELECT
GPFU
B.O
LIGHTS
PARKING
BRAKE
HIGH
IDLE
1
2
TRAILER
AIR SUPPLY
0
1
2
AIR BRAKE
7
8
Figure 1.
0100-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
0100
CAUTION
Wheel hop condition should be avoided to prevent possible damage to
drivetrain. If wheel hop begins to occur, ease up on throttle to allow tires
to grip surface. If wheel hop continues, release throttle and apply brakes.
Apply throttle slowly as traction permits.
4. Start slowly. Do not spin wheels when starting to move vehicle.
5. Set traction control switch (4) to INTER AXLE for added traction. Indicator light (5) will
illuminate.
6. Set transmission range selector (6) to 2 (2nd) or 1 (1st), as needed for added traction.
7. Do not straddle sand mounds or drive on sides of two sand mounds. Loose sand will
not support vehicle on steep slopes.
8. Keep throttle pedal (7) steady after vehicle reaches desired speed.
9. Turn vehicle slowly when on loose sand or mud.
10. Steer vehicle straight up and down hills if possible.
11. To move vehicle forward and turn after vehicle is stopped in loose sand or mud, do the
following:
a. Set transmission range selector (6) to R (reverse).
b. Press throttle pedal (7) and move vehicle straight back about 20 ft. (6.1 m).
c.
Release throttle pedal (7) and press service brake pedal (8).
g. Set transmission range selector (6) to D (drive) when vehicle picks up speed and
is moving forward smoothly.
12. If vehicle starts to skid, do the following:
a. Release throttle pedal (7).
b. Steer in direction of skid until vehicle stops skidding.
c.
Press throttle pedal (7) slowly and steer vehicle on straight course.
PARK VEHICLE
1. Park vehicle as follows:
a. Vehicle should not face into wind.
b. Clean mud off vehicle as soon as possible.
0100-3
TM 9-2320-339-10
0100
CAUTION
Do not hit axle breathers when cleaning mud from axles.
Do not direct high pressure water stream at glass surfaces, seals, air
intake, axle breathers, exhaust outlet, or any other component of
vehicle that could be easily damaged by high pressure water stream.
2. Clean mud from wheels, brakes, axles, universal joints, steering mechanism, and
radiator as soon as possible.
3. Make sure axle breather vent caps move freely on breather body.
END OF TASK
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0100-4
TM 9-2320-339-10
0101
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
OPERATE VEHICLE IN DESERT ENVIRONMENT
INITIAL SETUP:
Not Applicable
NOTE
FM 90-3 contains detailed instructions for living and working in desert.
1. Principles for operating in extreme heat (WP 0098) and extreme dust (WP 0099), sand,
or mud (WP 0100) apply to desert environment.
NOTE
Close heater valves to improve the efficiency of cabin air
conditioning.
Closing the heater valves disables cabin heat.
2. Temperatures may change as much as 70F (21C) degrees between day and night.
These changes may damage equipment if vehicle is not properly prepared.
a. Due to expansion and contraction of all fluids and air, care should be taken when
filling fuel tank and fluid reservoirs to prevent overflow when temperatures change.
b. Precision instruments may be affected by temperature changes and may need
adjustment more often.
END OF TASK
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0101-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
OPERATE VEHICLE IN COLD ENVIRONMENT (32F [0C] TO -25F [-32C])
INITIAL SETUP:
Not Applicable
WARNING
Do not touch extremely cold metal (below -26F, -32C to -65F, -54C).
Bare skin may freeze to cold metal. Failure to comply may result in injury
or death to personnel.
CAUTION
Before operating vehicle in extreme cold environment, ensure engine
arctic kit is installed and vehicle has been prepared as described in
FM 9-207 . Refer to FM 31-70 , FM 31-71 , and FM 21-305 for
additional information on operations in extreme cold environment.
Watch instrument panel closely. If any unusual readings occur, stop
vehicle and shut off engine. Check engine immediately.
Park in shelter when possible. If shelter is not available, park so
vehicle does not face into wind. Place planks or brush under wheels
so vehicle will not freeze in place.
Fuel filter should be drained before topping off fuel tank. Keep fuel
tank as full as possible during cold operations. Water forms in empty
fuel tank as it cools. Water in fuel system could freeze and block
system.
All snow and ice should be removed from vehicle as soon as possible.
Snow and ice may slow or stop movement of critical parts if allowed
to pile up.
Special care must be used during operations in extreme cold
environment. In extreme cold, engine coolant and fluid in windshield
0102-1
0102
TM 9-2320-339-10
0102
washer can freeze. Batteries can freeze and crack. Oil and grease
may get thick and stiff. Rubber and metal parts may crack or become
brittle and break easily.
Proper component lubrication is a must for extreme cold operation.
1. Install tire chains (WP 0088) (as needed).
2. Start engine (WP 0043) and allow engine warm up thoroughly.
NOTE
Positioning TRANSFER CASE shift lever to LO automatically activates
8X8 drive.
3. Set TRANSFER CASE shift lever (1) to LO. 8X8 DRIVE indicator (2) will illuminate.
4
INTERAXLE
8X8
B.O.
LIGHTS
PULL TO
EXHAUST
ER
LY
TRAILSUPPKING
AIR PAR
FOR AND
NOT MIDL
SUPPLY
B.O.
SELECT
PU S H T O
CHEM
ALARM
GPPU
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
M
M
12
ASS
HIGH
IDLE
AlTranlissmisonsion
3
7
6
Figure 1.
4. Set transmission range selector (3) to 1 (1st gear range) and drive at lowest possible
speed to warm driveline components and tires.
5. Drive on mud, snow, ice, and slippery surfaces as follows:
NOTE
0102-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
0102
a. Set TRANSFER CASE shift lever (1) to LO for added traction. 8X8 DRIVE indicator
(2) will illuminate.
NOTE
Traction control switch should be set to INTER AXLE when transfer
case shift lever is set to LO range while driving on slippery surfaces.
b. Set traction control switch (4) in INTER AXLE (when LO range is used recommended) or 8X8 (if HI range is required), as needed, when driving on slippery
surfaces. INTER-AXLE LOCK indicator (5) and/or 8X8 DRIVE indicator (2) will
illuminate as applicable.
c.
d. Keep throttle pedal (6) steady after vehicle reaches desired speed.
e. Turn vehicle slowly when on slippery surfaces.
f.
j.
Drive at slower speeds and stay twice normal distance from vehicle ahead.
k.
Signal turns sooner than normal to give vehicles behind ample time to safely slow
down.
WARNING
NOTE
Pressing service brake pedal lightly will help keep vehicle from skidding.
l.
Apply brakes sooner, and press service brake pedal (7) lightly to give early warning
that vehicle will slow or stop.
0102-3
TM 9-2320-339-10
0102
s.
0102-4
TM 9-2320-339-10
0102
NOTE
If no shelter is available, park vehicle so it does not face into the wind.
Vehicle facing opposite of the direction of the wind is optimal.
a. Park vehicle in sheltered area, out of wind if possible.
NOTE
If no high, dry ground is available, spread out planks, brush, etc., to
create a raised area so that vehicle tires will not freeze in snow, water,
ice, or mud.
b. Park vehicle on high, dry ground if possible.
c.
NOTE
Do not hit axle breathers when cleaning mud, snow, and ice from axles.
7. Clean snow, ice, and mud off vehicle as soon as possible.
8. Clean mud, snow, and ice from wheels, brakes, axles, universal joints, mirrors, steering
mechanism, and radiator as soon as possible.
9. Ensure axle breather vent caps move freely on breather body.
END OF TASK
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0102-5
TM 9-2320-339-10
0103
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
OPERATION IN EXTREME COLD ENVIRONMENT
INITIAL SETUP:
Not Applicable
WARNING
Do not touch extremely cold metal (below -26F, -32C to -65F, -54C).
Bare skin may freeze to cold metal. Failure to comply may result in injury
or death to personnel.
CAUTION
Before operating vehicle in extreme cold environment, ensure engine
arctic kit is installed and vehicle has been prepared as described in
FM 9-207.
Refer to FM 31-70 , FM 31-71 , and FM 21-305 for additional
information on operations in extreme cold environment.
Watch instrument panel closely. If any unusual readings occur, stop
vehicle and shut off engine. Check immediately.
Park in shelter when possible. If shelter is not available, park so
vehicle does not face into wind. Place planks or brush under wheels
so vehicle will not freeze in place.
Fuel filter should be drained before topping off fuel tank. Keep fuel
tank as full as possible during cold operations. Water forms in empty
fuel tank as it cools. Water in fuel system could freeze and block
system.
All snow and ice should be removed from vehicle as soon as possible.
Snow and ice may slow or stop movement of critical parts if allowed
to pile up.
0103-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
0103
WARNING
Do not touch extremely cold metal (below -26F, -32C to -65F, -54C).
Bare skin may freeze to cold metal. Failure to comply may result in injury
or death to personnel.
NOTE
If additional air is put in tires for standby periods, lower tire pressure to
normal amounts before driving vehicle.
4. In areas where temperatures reach -50F (-46C) or colder, fill tires with air
approximately 10 psi above normal for long standby periods and overnight.
OPERATE TANKER MODULE IN EXTREME COLD ENVIRONMENT (-26F[-32C] to
-65F [-54C])
WARNING
Do not touch extremely cold metal (below -26F, -32C to -65F, -54C).
Bare skin may freeze to cold metal. Failure to comply may result in injury
or death to personnel.
1. Before performing fuel handling operations, perform warm-up as follows:
a. Prepare tanker for operations. (WP 0078)
0103-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
0103
d. Set PTO ENGAGE switch (1) to ON position. Indicator light (2) will illuminate.
2
1
INTERAXLE
8X8
B.O.
LIGHTS
PULL TO
EXHAUST
LER
TRAI SUPPKINLYG
AIR PAR D
FOR
NOT MIDLAN
S U P PL
Y
B.O.
SELECT
PU S H T O
CHEM
ALARM
GPPU
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
M
M
1
2
ASS
HIGH
IDLE
AlTranlissmionssion
Figure 1.
e. With engine at low idle, engage primary pump for at least 5 minutes.
f.
0103-3
TM 9-2320-339-10
0104
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
OPERATE VEHICLE IN FOREST OR ROCKY TERRAIN
INITIAL SETUP:
Not Applicable
WARNING
NOTE
When driving over very rocky terrain is part of the mission route, be sure
spare wheel and tire are on vehicle, in good repair, and at correct pressure for normal operations. There is greater chance of tire punctures
when operating in rocky terrain.
1. Fold vehicle side mirrors in far enough so area to rear of vehicle can still be seen, but
mirrors will not be damaged by rocks, trees, and other obstructions.
CAUTION
Before driving over ground obstructions such as stumps and large rocks,
ensure vehicle has adequate clearance. Stumps and rocks may damage
components underneath vehicle.
2. Avoid driving over obstructions if possible.
CAUTION
Ensure vehicle can clear overhanging tree limbs and other obstructions.
Low overhead obstructions may damage cargo, cargo cover, and other
parts on top of vehicle.
3. Avoid low overhanging obstructions if possible.
0104-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
0104
4. Check traction and braking. Rocks and fallen leaves can be very slick, especially when
wet.
END OF TASK
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0104-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
0105
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
OPERATE VEHICLE IN SALTWATER AREAS
INITIAL SETUP:
Not Applicable
OPERATION
1. Inspect vehicle and major components (crane, tanker module, LHS, etc.) frequently for
the buildup of salt deposits, rust, and corrosion.
NOTE
Do not direct high-pressure water hose nozzles, or steam cleaner nozzles
into hydraulic system seals and/or electrical junction boxes.
2. If salt deposits are located, clean the affected areas using authorized local procedures.
3. Frequently wash the vehicle and major components to prevent the buildup of salt
deposits.
4. If corrosion is present, notify your supervisor as these conditions need to be corrected
immediately.
END OF TASK
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0105-1
////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
SET UP/SECURE HIGHWAY EMERGENCY MARKER KIT
INITIAL SETUP:
Not Applicable
Figure 1.
3. Remove markers (3) from case.
0106-1
////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
TM 9-2320-339-10
0106
//////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
TM 9-2320-339-10
0106
Figure 2.
Figure 3.
Figure 4.
0106-2
//////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
TM 9-2320-339-10
0106
Figure 5.
PLACE MARKERS ON UNDIVIDED HIGHWAY
1. Place one marker (1) about 40 paces (100 ft. [30 m]) in front of vehicle, so marker faces
traffic approaching from front.
Figure 6.
2. Place another marker (1) directly behind vehicle, so marker faces traffic approaching
from rear.
3. Place third marker (1) approximately about 40 paces (100 ft. [30 m]) behind vehicle, so
marker faces traffic approaching from rear.
PLACE MARKERS ON DIVIDED HIGHWAY
1. Place one marker (1) directly behind vehicle, so marker faces traffic approaching from
rear.
0106-3
//////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
TM 9-2320-339-10
0106
Figure 7.
2. Place second marker (1) about 40 paces (100 ft. [30 m]) behind vehicle, so marker faces
traffic approaching from rear.
3. Place third marker (1) about 80 paces (200 ft. [60 m]) behind second marker, so marker
faces traffic approaching from rear.
SECURE MARKERS
1. Rotate marker (1) over base (2).
Figure 8.
0106-4
//////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
Figure 9.
3. Fold arms (3) down onto base (2).
Figure 10.
4. Put markers (1) in case.
5. Put emergency marker kit (4) in stowage brackets (5).
0106-5
////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
TM 9-2320-339-10
0106
//////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
TM 9-2320-339-10
0106
Figure 11.
0106-6
//////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
0107
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
MANUALLY RELEASE SPRING BRAKES
INITIAL SETUP:
Not Applicable
NOTE
This procedure should only be used when vehicle air system is totally
inoperative and vehicle cannot be towed with rear end raised by wrecker.
1. Remove wheel chocks (1) from stowage.
Figure 1.
2. Place wheel chocks (1) in front and back of one wheel on No. 3 (2) or No. 4 (3) axle.
0107-1
////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
TM 9-2320-339-10
//////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
TM 9-2320-339-10
0107
RELEASE BRAKES
WARNING
NOTE
Driver side brake chamber on No. 4 axle is shown. Steps are same for
No. 4 axle passenger side and No. 3 axle.
Figure 2.
2. Remove nut (3), washer (4), and release-bolt (5) from bracket (6).
0107-2
//////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4
3
Figure 3.
3. Insert release-bolt (5) into brake chamber (2).
0107-3
////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
TM 9-2320-339-10
0107
//////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
TM 9-2320-339-10
0107
Figure 4.
4. Turn release-bolt (5) 1/4 turn to engage inside brake chamber (2).
5. Install washer (4) and nut (3) on release-bolt (5).
6. Tighten nut (3) until clevis (7) is pulled to rear of brake chamber (2).
3
Figure 5.
7. Repeat Steps (1) through (6) to release three remaining spring brakes on No. 3 and
No. 4 axles.
END OF TASK
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0107-4
//////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
0108
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
SLAVE START VEHICLE
INITIAL SETUP:
Not Applicable
NOTE
This procedure is a two soldier task.
1. Start engine of assist vehicle. (WP 0043)
NOTE
Model of truck can be determined by information plate on inside of
driver side cabin door.
Base Model HEMTT - Slave receptacle may be located either on
battery box or driver side front fender.
A2 Model HEMTT - Slave receptacle is located on driver side front
fender.
A4 Model HEMTT - Slave receptacle is located on driver side front
fender.
2. Move assist vehicle into position beside disabled vehicle so slave receptacles (1) on
both vehicles are side by side.
0108-1
////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
TM 9-2320-339-10
//////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
TM 9-2320-339-10
0108
1
BASE HEMTT
Figure 1.
A2 HEMTT
Figure 2.
0108-2
//////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
0108
1
A4 HEMTT
Figure 3.
3. Shut off engine of assist vehicle. (WP 0056)
SLAVE START DISABLED VEHICLE
NOTE
Model of truck can be determined by information plate on inside of
driver side cabin door.
Base Model HEMTT - Slave receptacle may be located either on
battery box or driver side front fender.
A2 Model HEMTT - Slave receptacle is located on driver side front
fender.
A4 Model HEMTT - Slave receptacle is located on driver side front
fender.
1. Remove caps (2) from slave receptacles (1) on both vehicles.
0108-3
////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
TM 9-2320-339-10
//////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
TM 9-2320-339-10
0108
1
2
1
2
BASE HEMTT
Figure 4.
0108-4
//////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
0108
1
2
A2 HEMTT
Figure 5.
1
A4 HEMTT
Figure 6.
0108-5
////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
TM 9-2320-339-10
//////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
TM 9-2320-339-10
0108
WARNING
Hot transmission/oil can cause severe burns. Wear gloves and proper
eye protection while performing troubleshooting or maintenance. Failure
to comply may result in injury or death to personnel.
NOTE
Make sure connectors and receptacles are free from dirt, sand, and debris before use.
2. Remove NATO slave cable from stowage and plug into slave receptacles of both
vehicles.
3. Start engine of assist vehicle. (WP 0043)
4. Using the throttle pedal, increase assist vehicle engine speed to more than 1000 rpm,
while assistant starts engine of disabled vehicle. (WP 0043)
5. As soon as disabled vehicle engine is running smoothly, remove NATO slave cable
from slave receptacles (1) on both vehicles and return to stowage.
6. Install caps (2) on slave receptacles (1) of both vehicles.
7. Move assist vehicle. (WP 0049)
8. Shut off engine of assist vehicle. (WP 0056)
NOTE
Model of truck can be determined by information plate on inside of
driver side cabin door.
A4 Model HEMTT does not have an AMPERES gauge. Battery voltage readout is located in top right corner of Liquid Crystal Display
(LCD) on instrument panel.
Gauges are located in different places dependant on model HEMTT.
Select correct view below for model HEMTT being serviced.
9. Check BATTERY gauge (3) of disabled vehicle. If BATTERY gauge (3) shows less than
24 volts, notify field level maintenance. If BATTERY gauge (3) shows 24 volts or more,
continue with Step (11).
0108-6
//////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
0108
PARKING
BRAKE
EXEXEX
EXEX
TRAILER
AIR SUPPLY
EXEX
EXEXEX
ENGINE
OFF
ON
START
AIR BRAKE
BASE HEMTT
Figure 7.
PARKING
BRAKE
EXEXEX
EXEX
EXEX
TRAILER
AIR SUPPLY
EXEXEX
ENGINE
OFF
ON
START
AIR BRAKE
A2 HEMTT
Figure 8.
0108-7
////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
TM 9-2320-339-10
//////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
TM 9-2320-339-10
0108
CHEM
ALARM
INTER
AXLE
8X8
25
22
15
11
8
6.2
5.5
3.7
2.7
2.0
IN H20 kPa
FILTER MINDER
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
B.O
SELECT
GPFU
B.O
LIGHTS
PARKING
BRAKE
HIGH
IDLE
1
2
TRAILER
AIR SUPPLY
0
1
2
AIR BRAKE
A4 HEMTT
Figure 9.
10. Check AMPERES gauge (4) of disabled vehicle (as applicable). If AMPERES gauge
shows discharge condition, notify field level maintenance. If AMPERES gauge (4)
shows charging, continue operation of vehicle.
END OF TASK
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0108-8
//////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
PERFORM IMMEDIATE ACTION FOR LOSS OF HYDRAULIC SYSTEM
INITIAL SETUP:
Not Applicable
NOTE
Steering wheel will be harder to turn after failure of hydraulic system.
1. If failure occurs while driving, continue steering as before.
NOTE
Failure of hydraulic system will stop operation of any crane, winch, or
hydraulic motor on vehicle. All cranes and winches are equipped with
automatic locking mechanisms to hold cranes and winches in position
they were in before hydraulics failed.
2. Do not try to continue operation of any crane or winch.
3. Do not try to repair hydraulic system. Notify your supervisor.
4. Perform fuel servicing using auxiliary pump. (WP 0110)
5. Notify field level maintenance.
END OF TASK
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0109-1
////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
TM 9-2320-339-10
0109
//////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
TM 9-2320-339-10
0109
0109-2
//////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
0110
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
PERFORM FUEL SERVICING USING AUXILIARY PUMP
INITIAL SETUP:
Not Applicable
PREPARATION
WARNING
To prevent fire or explosion, do not allow smoking, flame, sparks, and hot
or glowing objects within 50 ft. (15 m) of vehicle. Read and follow all safety
precautions in FM 10-67-1. Failure to comply may result in injury or death
to personnel.
NOTE
This procedure should be used to perform fuel servicing of land
vehicles when tanker primary pump cannot be used. Whenever
possible, use tanker primary pump for fuel handling operations.
Refer to FM 10-67-1 for general operating instructions for tanker
vehicles.
If equipment malfunctions, check that all steps of procedure have
been performed in proper sequence. If equipment still malfunctions,
perform troubleshooting.
1. If primary pump is inoperative, notify field level maintenance as soon as possible.
2. Prepare tanker for operation. (WP 0078)
3. Connect SR1 and SR2 static cables (1) to grounding devices and vehicle being
serviced.
0110-1
////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
TM 9-2320-339-10
//////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
TM 9-2320-339-10
60
80
500
40
20
60
100
800
1000
80
500
600
300
100
40
120
20
140
100
600
800
300
100
1000
1100
120
140
1100
160
160
0110
MARSH
MARSH
D
E
F
U
E
L
F
U
E
L
OUT
IN
VALVE
L L O N S
FLOW METER
Figure 1.
FUEL SERVICING
NOTE
Driver side servicing hose is shown in this procedure. Procedure for using
passenger side servicing hose is same except where noted.
0110-2
//////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
0110
60
80
800
120
140
100
80
100
500
600
300
20
0
60
100
500
40
600
40
800
300
20
0
160
120
140
100
1000
1000
1100
1100
160
0
MARSH
MARSH
D
E
F
F
U
OUT
L
IN
VALVE
L L O N S
FLOW METER
60
80
100
500
600
40
800
300
20
0
120
140
100
1000
1100
160
0
MARSH
Figure 2.
2. Remove rubber tie down strap (2) to release fuel service nozzle (5) from stowage
position.
3. Pull servicing hose (3) completely out from reel (4).
4. Engage hose reel tension knob (1).
NOTE
Use fuel service nozzle for fueling land vehicles. Use over-wing
nozzle and reducer adapter for over-wing fueling of aircraft.
Reducer adapter is used with over-wing nozzle only. If not fueling an
aircraft and/or using the over-wing fueling nozzle, skip to Step (8).
5. Remove fuel service nozzle (5) from servicing hose (3).
0110-3
////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
TM 9-2320-339-10
//////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
TM 9-2320-339-10
0110
8
80
80
60
60
100
500
40
100
40
120
100
140
1100
160
160
120
1000
1100
600
800
300
20
140
1000
0
0
100
500
600
800
300
20
MARSH
MARSH
D
E
F
U
E
F
U
E
L
OUT
IN
VALVE
L L O N S
FLOW METER
5
7
Figure 3.
6. Stow fuel service nozzle (5). Remove over-wing nozzle (6) and reducer adapter (7) from
stowage.
7. Install reducer adapter (7) on servicing hose (3). Install over-wing nozzle (6) on reducer
adapter (7).
8. Push in V6 FUEL/DEFUEL VALVE control rod (8).
9. Pull back MC MANUAL CONTROL EM VALVE lever (9).
NOTE
V3 SUCTION LINE VALVE is located inside left frame rail above rear end
of air tank in front of No. 3 axle.
0110-4
//////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
0110
FLAMMABLE
NO SMOKING WITHIN 50 FEET
10
Figure 4.
NOTE
V8 REEL VALVE controls fuel flow rate when passenger side servicing
hose is used for fueling.
11. Adjust V7 REEL VALVE (11) to full open position.
0110-5
////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
TM 9-2320-339-10
//////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
TM 9-2320-339-10
0110
11
60
80
800
80
100
500
600
300
600
40
120
800
300
20
140
100
0
60
100
500
40
20
1000
1100
160
160
120
140
100
1000
1100
MARSH
MARSH
D
E
F
U
E
L
F
U
E
L
OUT IN
VALVE
L L O N S
FLOW METER
12
13
Figure 5.
0110-6
//////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
0110
11
80
80
60
60
100
500
40
100
40
120
100
140
1100
160
160
120
1000
1100
600
800
300
20
140
1000
0
0
100
500
600
800
300
20
MARSH
MARSH
D
E
F
U
E
F
U
E
L
OUT
IN
VALVE
L L O N S
FLOW METER
14
13
15
3
////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
TM 9-2320-339-10
16
Figure 6.
NOTE
HAV HAND ACTUATED CONTROL valve must be open for fuel to flow.
16. Squeeze and hold lever (14) to open HAV HAND ACTUATED CONTROL valve (13).
17. Squeeze and hold lever (15) on fuel service nozzle (5) or lever (16) on over-wing nozzle
(6) to start fuel flow.
18. When receiving vehicle or aircraft tank is filled to desired level, release lever (15 or 16)
and HAV HAND ACTUATED CONTROL valve lever (14).
19. Remove fuel service nozzle (5) or over-wing nozzle (6) from receiving vehicle or aircraft
fuel filler.
20. Install fuel filler cover on receiving vehicle or aircraft.
21. Close V7 REEL valve (11).
0110-7
//////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
TM 9-2320-339-10
0110
22. Drain fuel from servicing hose (3) by squeezing and holding lever (15) on fuel service
nozzle (5) or lever (16) on over-wing nozzle (6) and dispose of fuel in accordance with
unit SOP.
23. Set APC AUXILLARY PUMP CONTROL switch (12) to APC to shut off.
19
60
80
500
40
20
60
100
800
1000
80
500
600
300
100
40
120
20
140
100
600
800
300
100
1000
1100
120
140
1100
160
160
MARSH
MARSH
D
E
F
U
E
L
F
U
E
L
OUT
IN
VALVE
L L O N S
FLOW METER
18
9
17
12
Figure 7.
CAUTION
Carefully guide hoses back onto reel through access hole. Failure to do
so may result in damage to equipment.
25. Let HAV HAND ACTUATED CONTROL valve hoses (17) rewind onto reel (18) and
stow inside pump module (19).
NOTE
Reducer adapter is used with over-wing nozzle only. If over-wing nozzle
was not used, skip to Step (29).
0110-8
//////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
60
80
500
40
20
60
100
800
1000
80
500
600
300
100
40
120
20
140
100
800
1000
120
140
1100
160
160
0110
600
300
100
0
1100
MARSH
MARSH
D
E
F
U
E
L
F
U
E
L
OUT
IN
VALVE
L L O N S
FLOW METER
3
7
Figure 8.
27. Remove reducer adapter (7) from servicing hose (3).
28. Return over-wing nozzle (6) and reducer adapter (7) to stowage.
29. Remove hand crank handle (20) from stowage.
0110-9
////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
TM 9-2320-339-10
//////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
TM 9-2320-339-10
0110
23
60
80
500
40
20
60
100
800
1000
80
500
600
300
100
40
120
20
140
100
600
140
1000
1100
160
160
120
800
300
100
0
1100
MARSH
MARSH
D
E
F
U
E
L
F
U
E
L
OUT
IN
VALVE
L L O N S
FLOW METER
S
22
21
20
Figure 9.
NOTE
V3 SUCTION LINE VALVE is located inside left frame rail above rear end
of air tank in front of No. 3 axle.
0110-10
//////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
0110
FLAMMABLE
NO SMOKING WITHIN 50 FEET
10
Figure 10.
END OF TASK
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0110-11
////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
TM 9-2320-339-10
//////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
TM 9-2320-339-10
0110
0110-12
//////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
TM 9-2320-339-10
0111
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
LIMP HOME/TRANSMISSION FAULT
INITIAL SETUP:
Not Applicable
CAUTION
If transmission range selector flashes current range selection while operating vehicle (shift selection is inhibited), DO NOT SHUT OFF ENGINE or attempt to change range selection. Shutting off engine may result
in the inability of selecting a drive range at startup, and diagnostic data
may be lost. Move vehicle to safe place and notify field level maintenance
as soon as possible.
NOTE
When transmission oil is below 19F (-7C), the only gears available are
R (reverse), N (Neutral), and 3 (third gear range) when D (drive) is selected. The remaining gears in D (drive) will not be available until transmission oil in sump warms above 19F (-7C).
1. If check transmission indicator (1) illuminates when operating vehicle, apply service
brake pedal (2) and stop vehicle.
0111-1
//////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
TM 9-2320-339-10
0111
CHEM
ALARM
INTER
AXLE
25
22
15
11
8
8X8
6.2
5.5
3.7
2.7
2.0
IN H20 kPa
FILTER MINDER
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
B.O
SELECT
GPFU
B.O
LIGHTS
PARKING
BRAKE
TRAILER
AIR SUPPLY
0
1
2
B.O.
LIGHTS
PULL TO
4
AIR BRAKE
EXHAUST
LER LY
TRAI SUPPKING
AIR PAR D
FOR
NOT MIDLAN
HIGH
IDLE
1
2
S U P PL
PUSH T O
LOAD MU
L
HA TI
SYST NDLI LIFT
EM NG
UN
LOA
D
LOA
D
CR
AN
SW E
H.A
.
AN
OFF
AlTranlissmisonsion
MA
N
TRA
NS
////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
Figure 1.
NOTE
DO NOT shift transmission to N (neutral).
NOTE
The operator must be aware that once the engine is turned off,
the vehicle will not be operable until the problem is corrected.
(1) The transmission may be locked into specific gear, and may not come out of
that gear until the engine is turned off.
0111-2
//////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
TM 9-2320-339-10
0111
WARNING
NOTE
The operator should consider the following guidelines carefully
with regard to type of mission, environment, terrain, etc., when deciding on whether to continue the mission, deadline, or return
vehicle to field level maintenance.
(2) No additional damage to the transmission will occur. The operator can continue
to operate vehicle in the limp home mode and complete mission. However, the
operator must be aware of the following guidelines:
(a) DO NOT shut off engine until the decision is made to deadline vehicle.
Once the engine is shut off, the vehicle will not be operable until the problem
is corrected.
(b) As the engine cannot be turned off and the transmission is locked into gear,
the operator will not be able to leave the cab until vehicle is deadlined.
(c) The vehicle will not be able to operate in R (reverse).
(d) Depending on gear range the transmission is locked into, the operator may
not be able to drive vehicle up steep grades. (WP 0053)
(e) The service brake pedal (2) may need to be applied slightly earlier than
normal when stopping the vehicle.
(f) Depending upon gear range the transmission is locked into and the terrain
the vehicle is operating in, the engine and/or transmission may overheat.
The operator must closely monitor the engine coolant temperature gauge
(4) and the transmission oil temperature gauge (5).
CAUTION
If overheating occurs when operating in the transmission limp
home mode, the operator should stop the vehicle (do not shut
off engine), and allow the transmission and engine to cool down
to normal operating levels. If the engine and transmission do
not cool down, or overheating reoccurs, the operator should
0111-3
//////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
TM 9-2320-339-10
0111
END OF TASK
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0111-4
//////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
TM 9-2320-339-10
0112
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
STOWAGE AND SIGN GUIDE
SCOPE
This work package shows locations for data plates, decals, and stencils that are required
to be in place on the HEMTT series vehicles.
GENERAL
The following figures show the location of metal signs, decals, and stencils used on the
vehicle. Most of these signs and stencils contain cautions or information needed to operate
the vehicle safely. For stowage locations of Components Of End Item (COEI) and Basic
Issue Items (BII), refer to Components of End Item and Basic Issue Items tables. (WP
0158)
Table 1. Inside Driver Side Door.
1
10
2
CARC
8
4
INDEX
DECAL/PLATE/STENCIL
0112-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
0112
Parts Data
CARC Stencil
Rustproofing CAUTION
Rustproofing Data
Warranty Information
10
Shipping Data
Table 2. Front Exterior.
1
INDEX
PLACARD/STENCIL
0112-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
0112
TIEDOWN Stencil
3
INTERAXLE
8X8
B.O.
LIGHTS
PULL TO
EXHAUST
ER
LY
TRAILSUPPKING
AIR PAR
FOR AND
NOT MIDL
SUPPLY
B.O.
SELECT
PU S H T O
CHEM
ALARM
GPPU
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
M
M
12
ASS
HIGH
IDLE
AlTranlissmisonsion
INDEX
DECAL/PLATE
0112-3
TM 9-2320-339-10
0112
10
FLAMMABLE
NO SMOKING WITHIN 50 FEET
4
2
INDEX
4
DECAL/PLACARD/PLATE/STENCIL
24V Stencil
TIEDOWN Stencil
WARNING OPEN SLOWLY TO RELIEVE PRESSURE Stencil (on manhole cover latch)
Certification Plate
10
NO STEP Stencil
(multiple on exhaust and engine access panels)
0112-4
TM 9-2320-339-10
0112
FLAMMABLE
NO SMOKING WITHIN 50 FEET
1
1
INDEX
DECAL/PLACARD/PLATE/STENCIL
TIEDOWN Stencil
NO STEP Stencil
(multiple on exhaust and engine access panels)
0112-5
TM 9-2320-339-10
0112
10
FLAMMABLE
NO SMOKING
WITHIN
50 FEET
11
4
12
13
14
INDEX
14
PLACARD/PLATE/STENCIL
FLAMMABLE Stencil
10
0112-6
TM 9-2320-339-10
0112
12
13
14
NO STEP Stencil
LOCATION
Axle Housing
Carrier
Transfer Case
Engine
Transmission
Total
11
0112-7
TM 9-2320-339-10
CHAPTER 3
TROUBLESHOOTING
PROCEDURES
TM 9-2320-339-10
0113
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
BUZZER SOUNDS AND AIR INDICATOR IS LIT
INITIAL SETUP:
Equipment Condition
Engine OFF. (WP 0056)
TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURE
BUZZER SOUNDS AND AIR INDICATOR IS LIT
TEST 1 - Is air pressure greater than 75 psi (517 kPa)?
1. Start engine, (WP 0043)and allow air pressure to build.
2. Check air pressure.
0113-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
0113
INTERAXLE
8X8
B.O.
LIGHTS
PULL TO
EXHAUST
ER LY
TRAILSUPPKING
AIR PAR
OS
FOR AND
NOT MIDL
UPPLY
B.O.
SELECT
PUSH T
CHEM
ALARM
GPPU
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
M
M
12
ASS
HIGH
IDLE
AlTranlissmisonsion
REAR AIR
PRESSURE GAUGE
FRONT AIR
PRESSURE GAUGE
AIR
INDICATOR LIGHT
Figure 1.
3. Turn engine OFF. (WP 0056)
CONDITION/INDICATION
Is air pressure greater than 75 psi (517 kPa)?
DECISION
No - Test 2 - Are any petcock valves open?
Yes - Notify Supervisor.
TEST 2 - Are any petcock valves open?
1. Check if any air reservoir petcock/drain valves are open. If valve(s) open, close petcock
(s).
0113-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
0113
AIR RESERVOIR
DRAIN MANIFOLD
Figure 2.
CONDITION/INDICATION
Are any petcock valves open?
DECISION
Petcock(s) open - Test 6 - Does buzzer stop, and air indicator light extinguish?
Petcock's closed - Test 3 - Is trailer air supply control in correct position?
TEST 3 - Is trailer air supply control in correct position?
1. Check that trailer air supply control is pulled out (OFF position) if no trailer is coupled,
and pushed in (ON position) if trailer is coupled.
2. If trailer air control is found in an incorrect position, set to correct position.
0113-3
TM 9-2320-339-10
0113
25
22
15
11
8
6.2
5.5
3.7
2.7
2.0
IN H20 kPa
FILTER MINDER
INTERAXLE
8X8
EXHAUST
ER
TRAILSUPPLYING
AIR PARK
S U PP
FOR AND
NOT MIDL
LY
PULL TO
B.O.
LIGHTS
B.O.
SELECT
PU S H T O
CHEM
ALARM
GPPU
AUX
HYD
TRAILER
AIR SUPPLY
CONTROL
HYD
ENABLE
PARKING
BRAKE
TRAILER
AIR SUPPLY
M
M
12
ASS
HIGH
IDLE
n
AllTransisomission
Figure 3.
CONDITION/INDICATION
Is trailer air supply control in correct position?
DECISION
No - Test 6 - Does buzzer stop, and air indicator light extinguish?
Yes - Test 4 - Does air reservoir, hoses, lines, fittings, and/or connectors leak?
TEST 4 - Does air reservoir, hoses, lines, fittings, and/or connectors leak?
1. Check air reservoir, hoses, lines, fittings, and/or connectors for leaks. Tighten any leaks
found.
0113-4
TM 9-2320-339-10
0113
FRONT
AIR
COMPRESSOR
AIR
DRYER
AIR RESERVOIR
NO. 5
AIR RESERVOIR
NO. 2
AIR RESERVOIR
NO. 3
(ALL EXCEPT M1120 A4 LHS)
AIR RESERVOIR
NO. 1
AIR RESERVOIR
NO. 4
AIR RESERVOIR
NO. 3
(M1120 A4 LHS ONLY)
Figure 4.
CONDITION/INDICATION
Does air reservoir, hoses, lines, fittings, and/or connectors leak?
0113-5
TM 9-2320-339-10
0113
DECISION
Air reservoir, hoses, lines and/or connectors leak. - Notify Supervisor. Test 6 - Does
buzzer stop, and air indicator light extinguish?Notify Supervisor.
Air reservoir, hoses, lines, fittings, and/or connectors OK - Test 5 - Does buzzer sound,
and air indicator light illuminate when trailer is disconnected?
TEST 5 - Does buzzer sound, and air indicator light illuminate when trailer is
disconnected?
1. If trailer is coupled, disconnect trailer from vehicle.
INTERAXLE
8X8
B.O.
LIGHTS
PULL TO
EXHAUST
ER LY
TRAILSUPPKING
AIR PAR
OS
FOR AND
NOT MIDL
UPPLY
B.O.
SELECT
PUSH T
CHEM
ALARM
GPPU
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
M
M
12
ASS
HIGH
IDLE
AlTranlissmisonsion
REAR AIR
PRESSURE GAUGE
FRONT AIR
PRESSURE GAUGE
AIR
INDICATOR LIGHT
Figure 5.
2. Start engine, (WP 0043) and allow air pressure to build.
3. Check if buzzer continues to sound, and if air indicator light is illuminated.
4. Turn engine off. (WP 0056)
CONDITION/INDICATION
Does buzzer sound, and air indicator light illuminate when trailer is disconnected?
0113-6
TM 9-2320-339-10
0113
DECISION
No - Notify Supervisor.
Yes - Problem corrected.
TEST 6 - Does buzzer stop, and air indicator light extinguish?
1. Start engine, (WP 0043) and allow air pressure to build.
2. Check that buzzer does not sound, and air indicator light is off.
INTERAXLE
8X8
B.O.
LIGHTS
PULL TO
EXHAUST
ER LY
TRAILSUPPKING
AIR PAR
OS
FOR AND
NOT MIDL
UPPLY
B.O.
SELECT
PUSH T
CHEM
ALARM
GPPU
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
M
M
12
ASS
HIGH
IDLE
AlTranlissmisonsion
REAR AIR
PRESSURE GAUGE
FRONT AIR
PRESSURE GAUGE
AIR
INDICATOR LIGHT
Figure 6.
3. Turn engine off. (WP 0056)
CONDITION/INDICATION
Does buzzer stop, and air indicator light extinguish?
DECISION
No - Notify Supervisor.
Yes - Problem corrected.
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0113-7
TM 9-2320-339-10
0114
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
AIR SYSTEM LOSES PRESSURE DURING OPERATION
INITIAL SETUP:
Equipment Condition
Engine OFF. (WP 0056)
TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURE
AIR SYSTEM LOSES PRESSURE DURING OPERATION
TEST 1 - Are any petcock valves open?
WARNING
0114-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
0114
AIR RESERVOIR
DRAIN MANIFOLD
Figure 1.
CONDITION/INDICATION
Are any petcock valves open?
DECISION
Petcock(s) open - Test 5 - Does air system lose pressure during operation?
Petcocks closed - Test 2 - Is trailer air supply control in correct position?
TEST 2 - Is trailer air supply control in correct position?
1. Check if trailer air supply control is pulled out (OFF position) if no trailer is coupled, and
pushed in (ON position) if trailer is coupled.
2. If trailer air supply control is found in an incorrect position, set to correct position.
0114-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
0114
25
22
15
11
8
6.2
5.5
3.7
2.7
2.0
IN H20 kPa
FILTER MINDER
INTERAXLE
8X8
EXHAUST
ER
TRAILSUPPLYING
AIR PARK
S U PP
FOR AND
NOT MIDL
LY
PULL TO
B.O.
LIGHTS
B.O.
SELECT
PU S H T O
CHEM
ALARM
GPPU
AUX
HYD
TRAILER
AIR SUPPLY
CONTROL
HYD
ENABLE
PARKING
BRAKE
TRAILER
AIR SUPPLY
M
M
12
ASS
HIGH
IDLE
n
AllTransisomission
Figure 2.
CONDITION/INDICATION
Is trailer air supply control in correct position?
DECISION
No - Test 5 - Does air system lose pressure during operation?
Yes - Test 3 - Does air pressure reach 120 psi (827 kPa) with engine accelerated?
TEST 3 - Does air pressure reach 120 psi (827 kPa) with engine accelerated?
1. Start engine. (WP 0043)
2. Accelerate engine and check if air pressure reaches 120 psi (827 kPa).
0114-3
TM 9-2320-339-10
0114
INTERAXLE
8X8
B.O.
LIGHTS
PULL TO
EXHAUST
ER LY
TRAILSUPPKING
AIR PAR
OS
FOR AND
NOT MIDL
UPPLY
B.O.
SELECT
PUSH T
CHEM
ALARM
GPPU
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
M
M
12
ASS
HIGH
IDLE
AlTranlissmisonsion
REAR AIR
PRESSURE GAUGE
FRONT AIR
PRESSURE GAUGE
AIR
INDICATOR LIGHT
Figure 3.
CONDITION/INDICATION
Does air pressure reach 120 psi (827 kPa) with engine accelerated?
DECISION
No - Notify Supervisor.
Yes - Test 4 - Are air leaks present?
TEST 4 - Are air leaks present?
1. Turn engine off. (WP 0056)
2. Press service brake treadle completely down, and have crew member check for air
leaks.
0114-4
TM 9-2320-339-10
0114
FRONT
AIR
COMPRESSOR
AIR
DRYER
AIR RESERVOIR
NO. 5
AIR RESERVOIR
NO. 2
AIR RESERVOIR
NO. 3
(ALL EXCEPT M1120 A4 LHS)
AIR RESERVOIR
NO. 1
AIR RESERVOIR
NO. 4
AIR RESERVOIR
NO. 3
(M1120 A4 LHS ONLY)
Figure 4.
3. If leaky fitting(s) found, tighten fittings.
CONDITION/INDICATION
Are air leaks present?
DECISION
Air leaks found - Notify Supervisor.
No air leaks found - Test 5 - Does air system lose pressure during operation?
0114-5
TM 9-2320-339-10
0114-6
0114
TM 9-2320-339-10
0115
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
TRAILER BRAKE DOES NOT APPLY WHEN SERVICE BRAKE TREADLE OR
PARKING BRAKE IS USED
INITIAL SETUP:
Equipment Condition
Engine OFF. (WP 0056)
TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURE
TRAILER BRAKE DOES NOT APPLY WHEN SERVICE BRAKE TREADLE OR
PARKING BRAKE IS USED
TEST 1 - Are intervehicular air hoses securely and correctly connected?
1. Check that intervehicular air hoses are secure and correctly connected. If not, reconnect
correctly.
0115-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
0115
Figure 1.
CONDITION/INDICATION
Are intervehicular air hoses securely and correctly connected?
DECISION
No - Test 3 - Do trailer brakes apply when service brake treadle or parking brake is
used?
Yes - Test 2 - Is trailer air supply control pushed in (ON position)?
TEST 2 - Is trailer air supply control pushed in (ON position)?
1. Check if trailer air supply control is pushed in (ON position).
0115-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
0115
25
22
15
11
8
6.2
5.5
3.7
2.7
2.0
IN H20 kPa
FILTER MINDER
INTERAXLE
8X8
EXHAUST
ER
TRAILSUPPLYING
AIR PARK
S U PP
FOR AND
NOT MIDL
LY
PULL TO
B.O.
LIGHTS
B.O.
SELECT
PU S H T O
CHEM
ALARM
GPPU
AUX
HYD
TRAILER
AIR SUPPLY
CONTROL
HYD
ENABLE
PARKING
BRAKE
TRAILER
AIR SUPPLY
M
M
12
ASS
HIGH
IDLE
n
AllTransisomission
Figure 2.
2. If trailer air supply control is found pulled out (OFF position), push in.
CONDITION/INDICATION
Is trailer air supply control pushed in (ON position)?
DECISION
No - Test 3 - Do trailer brakes apply when service brake treadle or parking brake is
used?
Yes - Notify Supervisor.
TEST 3 - Do trailer brakes apply when service brake treadle or parking brake is used?
1. Start engine. (WP 0043)
2. Test drive vehicle.
3. Note trailer brake operations.
CONDITION/INDICATION
Do trailer brakes apply when service brake treadle or parking brake is used?
DECISION
No - Notify Supervisor.
Yes - Problem corrected.
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0115-3
TM 9-2320-339-10
0116
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
WINDSHIELD WASHER WILL NOT OPERATE
INITIAL SETUP:
Equipment Condition
Engine OFF. (WP 0056)
TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURE
WINDSHIELD WASHER WILL NOT OPERATE
TEST 1 - Is washer fluid reservoir free from damage or cracks?
1. Check washer fluid reservoir for cracks and/or damage.
WINDSHIELD WASHER
RESERVOIR
Figure 1.
CONDITION/INDICATION
Is washer fluid reservoir free from damage or cracks?
DECISION
No - Notify Supervisor.
Yes - Test 2 - Is washer fluid present in washer fluid reservoir?
0116-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
0116
CAUTION
Do not fill windshield washer reservoir with water when temperatures are
likely to be 32F (0C) or less. If water freezes, reservoir can crack or
break.
1. Check washer fluid level in reservoir. if low, fill windshield washer reservoir.
WINDSHIELD WASHER
RESERVOIR
Figure 2.
CONDITION/INDICATION
Is washer fluid present in washer fluid reservoir?
DECISION
No - Test 6 - Does the windshield washer operate?
Yes - Test 3 - Are all hoses securely attached to reservoir?
TEST 3 - Are all hoses securely attached to reservoir?
1. Check that all hoses are securely attached to reservoir. If loose hoses are found, attach
to reservoir.
0116-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
AIR HOSE
0116
FLUID HOSE
WINDSHIELD WASHER
RESERVOIR
Figure 3.
CONDITION/INDICATION
Are all hoses securely attached to reservoir?
DECISION
No - Test 6 - Does the windshield washer operate?
Yes - Test 4 - Are hoses free of cracks or damage?
TEST 4 - Are hoses free of cracks or damage?
1. Check if hoses are cracked or damaged.
0116-3
TM 9-2320-339-10
AIR HOSE
0116
FLUID HOSE
WINDSHIELD WASHER
RESERVOIR
Figure 4.
CONDITION/INDICATION
Are hoses free of cracks or damage?
DECISION
No - Notify Supervisor.
Yes - Test 5 - Are washer spray openings free of debris?
TEST 5 - Are washer spray openings free of debris?
1. Check washer spray openings on wipers for clogs.
WINDSHIELD
WASHER NOZZLE
FLUID HOSE
Figure 5.
2. If openings are clogged, clear washer spray opening using pin, wire, or similar item.
0116-4
TM 9-2320-339-10
0116
CONDITION/INDICATION
Are washer spray openings free of debris?
DECISION
No - Test 6 - Does the windshield washer operate?
Yes - Notify Supervisor.
TEST 6 - Does the windshield washer operate?
1. Start engine, (WP 0043)and allow air pressure to build.
2. Check windshield washer for proper operation.
INTERAXLE
8X8
EXHAUST
ER
LY
TRAILSUPPKING
AIR PAR
OS
FOR AND
NOT MIDL
UPPLY
PULL TO
B.O.
LIGHTS
B.O.
SELECT
P U SH T
CHEM
ALARM
GPPU
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
M
M
12
ASS
HIGH
IDLE
AlTranlissmisonsion
WINDSHIELD
WASHER SWITCH
Figure 6.
CONDITION/INDICATION
Does the windshield washer operate?
DECISION
No - Notify Supervisor.
Yes - Problem corrected.
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0116-5
TM 9-2320-339-10
0117
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
AIR HORN WILL NOT OPERATE
INITIAL SETUP:
Equipment Condition
Engine OFF. (WP 0056)
TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURE
AIR HORN WILL NOT OPERATE
TEST 1 - Are air hoses tight?
WARNING
0117-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
AIR HORN
AIR HORN
VALVE LEVER
Figure 1.
CONDITION/INDICATION
Are air hoses tight?
DECISION
Connections loose - Test 3 - Does air horn operate?
Connections OK - Test 2 - Does horn valve lever move freely?
TEST 2 - Does horn valve lever move freely?
1. Check horn valve lever for freedom of movement.
0117-2
0117
TM 9-2320-339-10
AIR HORN
AIR HORN
VALVE LEVER
Figure 2.
CONDITION/INDICATION
Does horn valve lever move freely?
DECISION
No - Notify Supervisor.
Yes - Test 3 - Does air horn operate?
TEST 3 - Does air horn operate?
1. Start engine, (WP 0043) and allow air pressure to build.
2. Check air horn for proper operation.
0117-3
0117
TM 9-2320-339-10
AIR HORN
Figure 3.
3. Turn engine off. (WP 0056)
CONDITION/INDICATION
Does air horn operate?
DECISION
No - Notify Supervisor.
Yes - Problem corrected.
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0117-4
AIR HORN
VALVE LEVER
0117
TM 9-2320-339-10
0118
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
ARCTIC ENGINE HEATER FAILS TO OPERATE
INITIAL SETUP:
Equipment Condition
Engine OFF. (WP 0056)
TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURE
ARCTIC ENGINE HEATER FAILS TO OPERATE
TEST 1 - Is fuel present in fuel tank?
1. Turn engine start switch ON. (WP 0020)
2. Turn engine start switch OFF.
3. Add fuel to fuel tank if no fuel present.
CONDITION/INDICATION
Is fuel present in fuel tank?
DECISION
No - Test 3 - Does arctic heater operate?
Yes - Test 2 - Are arctic heater intake port and exhaust tube free from blockage?
TEST 2 - Are arctic heater intake port and exhaust tube free from blockage?
1. Inspect arctic heater inlet port and exhaust tube for foreign objects and obstructions.
Remove any items found.
0118-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
Figure 1.
CONDITION/INDICATION
Are arctic heater intake port and exhaust tube free from blockage?
0118-2
0118
TM 9-2320-339-10
DECISION
Continue - Test 3 - Does arctic heater operate?
TEST 3 - Does arctic heater operate?
CAUTION
Do not attempt to operate arctic heater if arctic heater fails to start, or
shutdown occurs during normal operation. System shutdown may indicate an arctic heater system fault. Failure to comply may cause system
lockout.
CAUTION
Do not operate arctic heater if arctic heater indicator light flashes during
normal operation. Arctic heater indicator light flashing indicates an arctic
heater system fault. Failure to comply may cause system lockout.
NOTE
If arctic heater does not operate, arctic heater may be in lockout mode
due to, either too many overheat occurrences (code 15), or too many start
attempts (code 50). Arctic heater lockout mode (code 50) is activated if
arctic heater fails to start after 20 successive start attempts (10 start cycles in succession).
NOTE
The arctic heater will attempt to start two times per start cycle. After the
second failed start attempt, the arctic heater will not operate until the arctic heater on/off switch is turned off, then back on.
NOTE
Audible clicking from the arctic heater fuel metering pump may indicate
that the arctic heater fuel system isnt primed. If audible clicking is heard
from the arctic heater fuel metering pump, repeat steps (1) through (4)
four times, or until arctic heater starts. Do not attempt to start arctic heater
more than five times. The arctic heater should prime itself within nine start
attempts.
1.
2.
3.
4.
0118-3
0118
TM 9-2320-339-10
Figure 2.
CONDITION/INDICATION
Does arctic heater operate?
DECISION
No - Notify Supervisor.
Yes - Problem corrected.
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0118-4
0118
TM 9-2320-339-10
0119
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
ONE OR MORE LIGHTING CIRCUITS NOT OPERATING
INITIAL SETUP:
Equipment Condition
Engine OFF. (WP 0056)
TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURE
ONE OR MORE LIGHTING CIRCUITS NOT OPERATING
TEST 1 - Is the lighting system control in the ON or OPERATING position?
1. Check if lighting system control is ON or in OPERATING position.
0119-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
MASTER LIGHTS
SWITCH
INTERAXLE
8X8
EXHAUST
ER
LY
TRAILSUPPKING
AIR PAR
OS
FOR AND
NOT MIDL
U P P LY
PULL TO
B.O.
LIGHTS
B.O.
SELECT
P USH T
CHEM
ALARM
GPPU
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
M
M
12
ASS
HIGH
IDLE
AlTranlissmisonsion
Figure 1.
CONDITION/INDICATION
Is the lighting system control in the ON or OPERATING position?
DECISION
No - Test 3 - Do all lighting circuits operate properly?
Yes - Notify Supervisor.
TEST 2 - Is intervehicular connection secure and/or connected correctly?
1. If trailer lights are the problem, make sure cable is securely connected.
0119-2
0119
TM 9-2320-339-10
Figure 2.
CONDITION/INDICATION
Is intervehicular connection secure and/or connected correctly?
0119-3
0119
TM 9-2320-339-10
0119
DECISION
Intervehicular cable loose. - Test 3 - Do all lighting circuits operate properly?Notify
Supervisor.
Intervehicular connection OK. - Notify Supervisor.
TEST 3 - Do all lighting circuits operate properly?
1. Check for proper operation of dome lights. (WP 0060)
2. Check for proper operation of panel lights. (WP 0061)
3. Check for proper operation of service drive lights. (WP 0063)
4. Check for proper operation of parking lights. (WP 0062)
5. Check for proper operation of clearance lights. (WP 0065)
6. Check for proper operation of stoplight. (WP 0064)
7. Check for proper operation of tanker module lights. (WP 0069)
8. Check for proper operation of blackout drive lights. (WP 0066)
9. Check for proper operation of blackout marker lights. (WP 0067)
10. Check for proper operation of turn signal lights. (WP 0071)
CONDITION/INDICATION
Do all lighting circuits operate properly?
DECISION
No - Notify Supervisor.
Yes - Problem corrected.
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0119-4
TM 9-2320-339-10
0120
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
FAILS TO CRANK WHEN ENGINE START SWITCH IS TURNED TO START POSITION
INITIAL SETUP:
Equipment Condition
Engine OFF. (WP 0056)
TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURE
FAILS TO CRANK WHEN ENGINE START SWITCH IS TURNED TO START POSITION
TEST 1 - Is transmission range selector in neutral (N)?
1. Verify range selector is in neutral (N) position. If not in neutral (N), shift it to neutral (N).
INTERAXLE
8X8
B.O.
LIGHTS
PULL TO
EXHAUST
LER
TRAI SUPPKINLYG
AIR PAR D
FOR
NOT MIDLAN
S U P P LY
B.O.
SELECT
PUS O
HT
CHEM
ALARM
TRANSMISSION
RANGE
SELECTOR
GPPU
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
M
M
1
2
ASS
HIGH
IDLE
nn
smissio
ATranlliso
Figure 1.
CONDITION/INDICATION
Is transmission range selector in neutral (N)?
DECISION
No - Test 3 - Does engine crank when engine start switch is turned to start position?
Yes - Test 2 - Are battery cable connections clean, tight, and free from damage?
0120-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
0120
TEST 2 - Are battery cable connections clean, tight, and free from damage?
1. Remove battery box cover. (WP 0153)
2. Check battery cable connections for dirt, corrosion and/or looseness.
Figure 2.
3. Check battery cables for damage.
CONDITION/INDICATION
Are battery cable connections clean, tight, and free from damage?
DECISION
No - Notify Supervisor.
Yes - Test 3 - Does engine crank when engine start switch is turned to start position?
TEST 3 - Does engine crank when engine start switch is turned to start position?
1. Install battery box cover. (WP 0153)
2. Attempt to start engine. (WP 0043)
0120-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
CONDITION/INDICATION
Does engine crank when engine start switch is turned to start position?
DECISION
No - Notify Supervisor.
Yes - Problem corrected.
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0120-3
0120
TM 9-2320-339-10
0121
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
CRANKS BUT FAILS TO START
INITIAL SETUP:
Equipment Condition
Engine OFF. (WP 0056)
TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURE
CRANKS BUT FAILS TO START
TEST 1 - Does fuel gauge indicate the presence of fuel?
1. Turn engine start switch ON. (WP 0020)
2. Check fuel gauge for indication of fuel presence.
FUEL
GAUGE
RINTE E
AXL
LOW FUEL
INDICATOR
8X8
EXHAU
S
PULL TO
B.O.
TS
LIGH
T
R
LE LY G
AI PP IN
TR SU RK
PA D
R
AI R AN
FO
T MIDL
PUS
NO
HT
O SUP
B.O.
ECT
SEL
M
CHERM
ALA
GPP
AUX
HYD
HYD
BLE
ENA
M
1
M 2
ASS
HIGH
IDLE
ion
on
iss
Allis
sm
Tran
Figure 1.
3. Turn engine start switch OFF. (WP 0020)
CONDITION/INDICATION
Does fuel gauge indicate the presence of fuel?
0121-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
DECISION
No - Test 4 - Does engine start?
Yes - Test 2 - Is there fuel present in fuel tank?
TEST 2 - Is there fuel present in fuel tank?
1. Remove fuel tank cap and filter screen from fuel tank.
Figure 2.
2. Check fuel tank for presence of fuel.
3. Add fuel to fuel tank if no fuel was present.
4. Replace filter screen and fuel tank cap on fuel tank.
0121-2
0121
TM 9-2320-339-10
0121
CONDITION/INDICATION
Is there fuel present in fuel tank?
DECISION
No - Test 4 - Does engine start?
Yes - Test 3 - Is air filter restricted?
TEST 3 - Is air filter restricted?
1. Attempt to start engine and note indication on air filter restriction indicator.
AIR FILTER
RESTRICTION
INDICATOR
RINTE E
AXL
8X8
B.O.
TS
LIGH
R
LE LY
G
AI PP
IN
TR SU
RK
R
PA D
AI
R AN
FO
T MIDL
PU
SH T
SUPPLY
PULL TO
A
EXH UST
NO
B.O.
ECT
SEL
M
CHERM
ALA
GPP
AUX
HYD
HYD
BLE
ENA
M
1
M 2
ASS
HIGH
IDLE
son
Alli ission
sm
Tran
Figure 3.
CONDITION/INDICATION
Is air filter restricted?
DECISION
Restricted - Service air filter. (WP 0151)
Not Restricted - Test 4 - Does engine start?
TEST 4 - Does engine start?
1. Attempt to start engine. (WP 0043)
CONDITION/INDICATION
Does engine start?
0121-3
TM 9-2320-339-10
0121
DECISION
Air filter indicator shows red after cleaning filter. - Notify Supervisor. Notify Supervisor.
Engine starts. - Problem corrected.
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0121-4
TM 9-2320-339-10
0122
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
STARTS OR RUNS ROUGHLY AFTER PROPER WARM-UP, DOES NOT MAKE FULL
POWER, OR MAKES EXCESSIVE EXHAUST SMOKE
INITIAL SETUP:
Equipment Condition
Engine OFF. (WP 0056)
TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURE
STARTS OR RUNS ROUGHLY AFTER PROPER WARM-UP, DOES NOT MAKE FULL
POWER, OR MAKES EXCESSIVE EXHAUST SMOKE
TEST 1 - Is PTO engaged?
1. Start engine and allow engine to reach normal operating temperature. (WP 0043)
2. Check HYD Enable switch and Main HYD Enable indicator to make sure that PTO is
disengaged. Light should be off.
0122-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
0122
INTERAXLE
8X8
B.O.
LIGHTS
S U PP
PULL TO
EXHAUST
ER
TRAILSUPPLYING
AIRNOT FORMIDLPARKAND
LY
B.O.
SELECT
PU S H T O
CHEM
ALARM
GPPU
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
M
M
12
ASS
HIGH
IDLE
AlTranslismissonion
MAIN HYD
ENABLE
INDICATOR
HYD
ENABLE
SWITCH
CHEM
ALARM
INTER
AXLE
8X8
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
HIGH
IDLE
1
2
B.O
SELECT
GPFU
B.O
LIGHTS
0
1
2
Figure 1.
CONDITION/INDICATION
Is PTO engaged?
DECISION
PTO engaged. - Test 4 - Does engine start or run roughly after proper warm-up, and/
or does not make full power or makes excessive exhaust smoke?
PTO disengaged. - Test 2 - Does air filter restriction indicator show red and/or VACUUM
INCHES H2O window show 18 or more after being reset?
TEST 2 - Does air filter restriction indicator show red and/or VACUUM INCHES H2O
window show 18 or more after being reset?
1. Reset air filter restriction indicator.
2. Start engine. (WP 0043)
3. Check if air filter restriction indicator is red and/or VACUUM INCHES/kPa H2O window
shows 18 or more.
0122-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
0122
AIR FILTER
RESTRICTION
INDICATOR
RINTE E
AXL
8X8
B.O.
TS
LIGH
R
LE LY
G
AI PP
IN
TR SU
RK
R
PA D
AI
R AN
FO
T MIDL
PU
SH T
SUPPLY
PULL TO
A
EXH UST
NO
B.O.
ECT
SEL
M
CHERM
ALA
GPP
AUX
HYD
HYD
BLE
ENA
M
1
M 2
ASS
HIGH
IDLE
son
Alli ission
sm
Tran
Figure 2.
CONDITION/INDICATION
Does air filter restriction indicator show red and/or VACUUM INCHES H2O window
show 18 or more after being reset?
DECISION
Restricted. - Test 3 - Does air filter restriction indicator show red and/or VACUUM
INCHES H2O window show 18 or more after being cleaned?
Not restricted. - Test 4 - Does engine start or run roughly after proper warm-up, and/or
does not make full power or makes excessive exhaust smoke?
TEST 3 - Does air filter restriction indicator show red and/or VACUUM INCHES H2O
window show 18 or more after being cleaned?
1. Turn engine OFF. (WP 0056)
2. Clean air filter. (WP 0151)
3. Start engine. (WP 0043)
4. Check if air filter restriction indicator is red and/or VACUUM INCHES/kPa H2O window
shows 18 or more.
0122-3
TM 9-2320-339-10
0122
AIR FILTER
RESTRICTION
INDICATOR
RINTE E
AXL
8X8
B.O.
TS
LIGH
R
LE LY
G
AI PP
IN
TR SU
RK
R
PA D
AI
R AN
FO
T MIDL
PU
SH T
SUPPLY
PULL TO
A
EXH UST
NO
B.O.
ECT
SEL
M
CHERM
ALA
GPP
AUX
HYD
HYD
BLE
ENA
M
1
M 2
ASS
HIGH
IDLE
son
Alli ission
sm
Tran
Figure 3.
CONDITION/INDICATION
Does air filter restriction indicator show red and/or VACUUM INCHES H2O window
show 18 or more after being cleaned?
DECISION
Restricted. - Notify Supervisor.
Not restricted. - Test 4 - Does engine start or run roughly after proper warm-up, and/or
does not make full power or makes excessive exhaust smoke?
TEST 4 - Does engine start or run roughly after proper warm-up, and/or does not make
full power or makes excessive exhaust smoke?
1. Test drive vehicle.
CONDITION/INDICATION
Does engine start or run roughly after proper warm-up, and/or does not make full power
or makes excessive exhaust smoke?
DECISION
Runs rough. - Notify Supervisor.
Runs normal. - Problem corrected.
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0122-4
TM 9-2320-339-10
0123
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
ENGINE OVERHEATS
INITIAL SETUP:
Equipment Condition
Engine OFF. (WP 0056)
TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURE
ENGINE OVERHEATS
TEST 1 - Are right-side radiator hoses and housing free from leaks?
WARNING
Radiator coolant hoses are very hot and pressurized during vehicle operation. Allow radiator to cool prior to checking hoses. Failure to comply
may result in injury or death to personnel.
1. Open driver and passenger side engine covers. (WP 0154)
2. Check upper and lower radiator hoses and housing for leaks.
3. Check that all clamps are tight and secure.
0123-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
0123
UPPER
RADIATOR HOSE
HOUSING
THERMOSTAT
HOSE
WATER PUMP
HOSE
HOUSING
LOWER
RADIATOR
HOSE
Figure 1.
CONDITION/INDICATION
Are right-side radiator hoses and housing free from leaks?
DECISION
Radiator hoses and/or housing damaged. - Notify Supervisor. Test 2 - Does engine
overheat?Notify Supervisor.
Radiator hoses and/or housing free from damage and/or leaks. - Notify Supervisor.
TEST 2 - Does engine overheat?
1. Close driver and passenger side engine covers. (WP 0154)
2. Start engine. (WP 0043)
0123-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
UPPER
RADIATOR HOSE
HOUSING
THERMOSTAT
HOSE
WATER PUMP
HOSE
HOUSING
LOWER
RADIATOR
HOSE
Figure 2.
3. Test drive vehicle.
CONDITION/INDICATION
Does engine overheat?
DECISION
Engine overheats - Notify Supervisor.
Engine OK - Problem corrected.
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0123-3
0123
TM 9-2320-339-10
0124
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
LOW OIL PRESSURE GAUGE INDICATION
INITIAL SETUP:
Equipment Condition
Engine OFF. (WP 0056)
TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURE
LOW OIL PRESSURE GAUGE INDICATION
TEST 1 - Is engine oil level low?
1. Check engine oil level. (WP 0141)
ENGINE
DIPSTICK
Figure 1.
2. If oil level is low, fill oil to proper level. (WP 0141)
CONDITION/INDICATION
Is engine oil level low?
DECISION
Continue - Test 2 - Is engine oil pressure still low?
TEST 2 - Is engine oil pressure still low?
1. Start engine and allow engine to reach operating temperature. (WP 0043)
2. Check OIL PRESS gauge. Gauge should read as follows:
0124-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
0124
CONDITION/INDICATION
Is engine oil pressure still low?
DECISION
Oil pressure low. - Notify Supervisor.
Oil pressure OK. - Problem corrected.
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0124-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
0125
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
EXCESSIVE OIL CONSUMPTION
INITIAL SETUP:
Equipment Condition
Engine OFF. (WP 0056)
TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURE
EXCESSIVE OIL CONSUMPTION
TEST 1 - Are engine oil lines loose?
WARNING
Caution the oil lines could be under pressure be sure to wear the proper
eye protection to avoid personal injury.
1. Open driver and passenger side engine covers. (WP 0154)
0125-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
Figure 1.
2. Check for loose engine oil lines or damaged components.
CONDITION/INDICATION
Are engine oil lines loose?
DECISION
Lines Loose - Notify Supervisor.
Lines OK - Test 2 - Are any engine oil leaks present?
TEST 2 - Are any engine oil leaks present?
1. Tighten any loose fittings/components if found.
2. Visually check for engine oil leaks.
CONDITION/INDICATION
Are any engine oil leaks present?
0125-2
0125
TM 9-2320-339-10
DECISION
Leaks found. - Notify Supervisor.
No leaks found. - Notify Supervisor.
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0125-3
0125
TM 9-2320-339-10
0126
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
HYDRAULIC SYSTEM OPERATES TOO SLOW, TOO FAST, WITH JERKY
MOVEMENTS; OR ONE OR MORE HYDRAULICS CIRCUITS WILL NOT OPERATE
INITIAL SETUP:
Equipment Condition
Engine OFF. (WP 0056)
TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURE
HYDRAULIC SYSTEM OPERATES TOO SLOW, TOO FAST, WITH JERKY
MOVEMENTS; OR ONE OR MORE HYDRAULICS CIRCUITS WILL NOT OPERATE
TEST 1 - Is hydraulic fluid level within normal operating range?
1. Check hydraulic fluid level. If low, add hydraulic fluid. (WP 0141)
0126-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
0126
Figure 1.
CONDITION/INDICATION
Is hydraulic fluid level within normal operating range?
DECISION
No - Test 3 - Do all hydraulic systems operate properly?
Yes - Test 2 - Are hydraulic hoses and connections free from leaks and/or damage?
0126-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
0126
TEST 2 - Are hydraulic hoses and connections free from leaks and/or damage?
WARNING
Caution the hydraulic system maybe under pressure be sure to wear the
proper eye protection to avoid personal injury.
1. Check hydraulic hoses and connections for leaks and/or damage.
0126-3
TM 9-2320-339-10
0126
(PTO) DRIVEN
HYDRAULIC PUMP
HYDRAULIC
RESERVOIR
PTO DRIVE
SELF-RECOVERY
WINCH
SELECTOR
VALVE
Figure 2.
0126-4
TM 9-2320-339-10
0126
0126-5
TM 9-2320-339-10
0127
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
SELF-RECOVERY WINCH DOES NOT WORK
INITIAL SETUP:
Equipment Condition
Engine OFF. (WP 0056)
TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURE
SELF-RECOVERY WINCH DOES NOT WORK
TEST 1 - Is hydraulic fluid level within normal operating range?
1. Check hydraulic fluid level. If low, add hydraulic fluid. (WP 0141)
0127-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
0127
Figure 1.
CONDITION/INDICATION
Is hydraulic fluid level within normal operating range?
DECISION
No - Test 3 - Does self-recovery winch operate properly?
Yes - Test 2 - Is self-recovery winch shift linkage free from debris and damage?
TEST 2 - Is self-recovery winch shift linkage free from debris and damage?
1. Check self-recovery winch shift linkage for debris and damage. If debris found, clean
shift linkage. (WP 0148)
0127-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
0127
Figure 2.
2. Check self-recovery winch shift linkage for debris and damage. If debris found, clean
shift linkage. (WP 0148)
0127-3
TM 9-2320-339-10
0127
SELF-RECOVERY WINCH
SHIFT LINKAGE
Figure 3.
CONDITION/INDICATION
Is self-recovery winch shift linkage free from debris and damage?
DECISION
Linkage damaged. - Notify Supervisor. Test 3 - Does self-recovery winch operate
properly?Notify Supervisor.
Linkage OK. - Notify Supervisor.
0127-4
TM 9-2320-339-10
0127-5
0127
TM 9-2320-339-10
0128
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
UNUSUALLY NOISY WHEN OPERATING
INITIAL SETUP:
Equipment Condition
Engine OFF. (WP 0056)
TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURE
UNUSUALLY NOISY WHEN OPERATING
TEST 1 - Is self-recovery winch cable free of twists, tangles, or binding?
1. Check if self-recovery winch cable is twisted, tangled, or causing drum to bind. If cable
is tangled, pay out or take up cable as necessary to straighten.
Figure 1.
0128-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
CONDITION/INDICATION
Is self-recovery winch cable free of twists, tangles, or binding?
DECISION
No - Notify supervisor.
Yes - Test 2 - Is self-recovery winch free of unusual noise when operating?
TEST 2 - Is self-recovery winch free of unusual noise when operating?
1. Start engine. (WP 0043)
2. Operate self-recovery winch, and listen for unusual noise. (WP 0093)
Figure 2.
CONDITION/INDICATION
Is self-recovery winch free of unusual noise when operating?
DECISION
No - Notify supervisor.
Yes - Problem corrected.
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0128-2
0128
TM 9-2320-339-10
0129
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
VEHICLE IS HARD TO STEER, SHIMMIES, WANDERS, OR PULLS TO ONE SIDE
INITIAL SETUP:
Equipment Condition
Engine OFF. (WP 0056)
TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURE
VEHICLE IS HARD TO STEER, SHIMMIES, WANDERS, OR PULLS TO ONE SIDE
TEST 1 - Are tires inflated to proper pressure for road condition?
WARNING
NOTE
Inflate tires only when they are cool. Inflate to proper pressure for
road condition.
Tire tread is non-directional. Vehicle operation is not affected by direction of traction bars.
1. Check tires for proper inflation. (WP 0139)
0129-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
0129
Figure 1.
2. If tires are improperly inflated, inflate or deflate tires to proper pressure.
CONDITION/INDICATION
Are tires inflated to proper pressure for road condition?
DECISION
Improperly inflated - Test 3 - Is vehicle hard to steer; or does it shimmy, wander, or pull
to one side?
Inflation OK - Test 2 - Are wheels free of loose, missing, or broken lugnuts?
TEST 2 - Are wheels free of loose, missing, or broken lugnuts?
1. Check for loose, missing, or broken lugnuts.
0129-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
0129
Figure 2.
CONDITION/INDICATION
Are wheels free of loose, missing, or broken lugnuts?
DECISION
No - Tighten and/or replace loose, missing, or damaged lugnut(s). (WP 0149)
Yes - Notify Supervisor.
TEST 3 - Is vehicle hard to steer; or does it shimmy, wander, or pull to one side?
1. Start engine. (WP 0043)
2. Test drive vehicle.
CONDITION/INDICATION
Is vehicle hard to steer; or does it shimmy, wander, or pull to one side?
0129-3
TM 9-2320-339-10
DECISION
No - Notify Supervisor.
Yes - Problem corrected.
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0129-4
0129
TM 9-2320-339-10
0130
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
VEHICLE STEERING SLOW TO RESPOND OR INTERMITTENT
INITIAL SETUP:
Equipment Condition
Engine OFF. (WP 0056)
TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURE
VEHICLE STEERING SLOW TO RESPOND OR INTERMITTENT
TEST 1 - Is hydraulic fluid low?
1. Check for low hydraulic fluid. (WP 0141)
2. If fluid level is low,add hydraulic fluid. (WP 0141)
0130-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
0130
Figure 1.
CONDITION/INDICATION
Is hydraulic fluid low?
DECISION
Fluid level low - Test 3 - Is steering slow to respond or intermittent?
Fluid level OK - Test 2 - Are there any leaking or damaged hydraulic fittings or lines?
0130-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
WARNING
Caution the hydraulic system maybe under pressure be sure to wear the
proper eye protection to avoid personal injury.
1. Check for leaking or damaged hydraulic lines and/or fittings.
0130-3
0130
TM 9-2320-339-10
0130
HYDRAULIC
CONNECTION
HYDRAULIC
CONNECTION
HYDRAULIC
LINE
HYDRAULIC
LINES
HYDRAULIC
LINE
HYDRAULIC
CONNECTION
HYDRAULIC
LINE
HYDRAULIC
CONNECTION
HYDRAULIC
CONNECTION
HYDRAULIC
CONNECTION
HYDRAULIC
LINE
HYDRAULIC
LINE
HYDRAULIC
CONNECTION
HYDRAULIC
CONNECTION
Figure 2.
2. If loose hydraulic fluid fittings are found, tighten fittings.
0130-4
HYDRAULIC
LINE
TM 9-2320-339-10
0130
CONDITION/INDICATION
Are there any leaking or damaged hydraulic fittings or lines?
DECISION
Hydraulic lines damaged or leaking. - Ensure fittings are tightened and notify supervisor
of faulty hydraulic lines. Tighten loose fittings. (Test 3 - Is steering slow to respond or
intermittent?)Notify Supervisor.
No leaks, damaged lines or loose fittings found. - Notify Supervisor.
TEST 3 - Is steering slow to respond or intermittent?
1. Start engine. (WP 0043)
2. Test drive vehicle.
CONDITION/INDICATION
Is steering slow to respond or intermittent?
DECISION
Steering faulty - Notify Supervisor.
Steering OK - Problem corrected.
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0130-5
TM 9-2320-339-10
0131
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
WATER IS DISPENSED WITH FUEL
INITIAL SETUP:
Equipment Condition
Engine OFF. (WP 0056)
TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURE
WATER IS DISPENSED WITH FUEL
TEST 1 - Is fuel free from contamination?
NOTE
Drain fuel from filter separator tank into suitable, non-spark producing
container.
1. Drain fuel from filter separator by opening V15 DRAIN VALVE on filter-separator.
Figure 1.
2. Check fuel for water contamination. If fuel is cloudy, drain fuel until clean fuel is
discharged.
CONDITION/INDICATION
Is fuel free from contamination?
0131-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
DECISION
No - Notify Supervisor.
Yes - Problem corrected.
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0131-2
0131
TM 9-2320-339-10
0132
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
UNUSUALLY NOISY WHEN OPERATING
INITIAL SETUP:
Equipment Condition
Engine OFF. (WP 0056)
TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURE
UNUSUALLY NOISY WHEN OPERATING
TEST 1 - Is transmission/transfer case free from unusual noise while operating?
1. Start engine. (WP 0043)
2. Test drive vehicle.
Figure 1.
CONDITION/INDICATION
Is transmission/transfer case free from unusual noise while operating?
DECISION
No - Notify supervisor.
Yes - Problem corrected.
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0132-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
0133
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
SLOW OR DIFFICULT ENGAGEMENT
INITIAL SETUP:
Equipment Condition
Engine OFF. (WP 0056)
TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURE
SLOW OR DIFFICULT ENGAGEMENT
TEST 1 - Does transmission and/or transfer case engage normally?
1. Start engine. (WP 0043)
2. Test drive vehicle.
Figure 1.
CONDITION/INDICATION
Does transmission and/or transfer case engage normally?
DECISION
No - Notify Supervisor.
Yes - Problem corrected.
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0133-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
0134
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
TRANSFER CASE SHIFT LEVER WILL NOT SHIFT
INITIAL SETUP:
Equipment Condition
Engine OFF. (WP 0056)
TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURE
TRANSFER CASE SHIFT LEVER WILL NOT SHIFT
TEST 1 - Does transfer case shift lever shift when transmission is shifted from Neutral
(N) to Drive (D)?
1. Start engine (WP 0043)
2. Move transmission range selector from Neutral (N) to Drive (D). Apply throttle to roll
vehicle slightly, and shift transmission from (D) to (N). As vehicle stops, shift
TRANSFER CASE shift lever.
TRANSMISSION
RANGE
SELECTOR
INTERAXLE
8X8
B.O.
LIGHTS
PULL TO
EXHAUST
LER
TRAI SUPPKINLYG
AIR PAR D
FOR
NOT MIDLAN
S U P P LY
B.O.
SELECT
PUS O
HT
CHEM
ALARM
GPPU
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
M
M
1
2
ASS
HIGH
IDLE
nn
smissio
ATranlliso
Figure 1.
0134-1
TRANSFER
CASE
SHIFT LEVER
TM 9-2320-339-10
0134
CONDITION/INDICATION
Does transfer case shift lever shift when transmission is shifted from Neutral (N) to Drive
(D)?
DECISION
No - Test 2 - Does transfer case shift lever shift when transmission is shifted from
Neutral (N) to Reverse (R)?
Yes - Problem corrected.
TEST 2 - Does transfer case shift lever shift when transmission is shifted from Neutral
(N) to Reverse (R)?
1. Move transmission range selector from Neutral (N) to Reverse (R). Apply throttle to roll
vehicle slightly and shift transmission from R to N. As vehicle stops, shift TRANSFER
CASE shift lever.
TRANSMISSION
RANGE
SELECTOR
INTERAXLE
8X8
B.O.
LIGHTS
PULL TO
EXHAUST
LER
TRAI SUPPKINLYG
AIR PAR D
FOR
NOT MIDLAN
S U P P LY
B.O.
SELECT
PUS O
HT
CHEM
ALARM
GPPU
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
TRANSFER
CASE
SHIFT LEVER
M
M
1
2
ASS
HIGH
IDLE
nn
smissio
ATranlliso
Figure 2.
CONDITION/INDICATION
Does transfer case shift lever shift when transmission is shifted from Neutral (N) to
Reverse (R)?
DECISION
No - Test 3 - Is shift cable free of mud and debris?
Yes - Problem corrected.
TEST 3 - Is shift cable free of mud and debris?
1. Turn engine OFF. (WP 0056)
0134-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
Figure 3.
3. If needed, clean shift cable. (WP 0148)
CONDITION/INDICATION
Is shift cable free of mud and debris?
DECISION
Dirty - Test 4 - Does transfer case shift lever shift normally?
Clean - Notify Supervisor.
TEST 4 - Does transfer case shift lever shift normally?
1. Start engine. (WP 0043)
a. Test drive vehicle.
2. Attempt to shift transfer case. (WP 0047)
0134-3
0134
TM 9-2320-339-10
0134
TRANSMISSION
RANGE
SELECTOR
INTERAXLE
8X8
B.O.
LIGHTS
PULL TO
EXHAUST
LER
TRAI SUPPKINLYG
AIR PAR D
FOR
NOT MIDLAN
S U P P LY
B.O.
SELECT
PUS O
HT
CHEM
ALARM
GPPU
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
M
M
1
2
ASS
HIGH
IDLE
nn
smissio
ATranlliso
Figure 4.
3. Turn engine OFF. (WP 0056)
CONDITION/INDICATION
Does transfer case shift lever shift normally?
DECISION
No - Notify Supervisor.
Yes - Problem corrected.
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0134-4
TRANSFER
CASE
SHIFT LEVER
TM 9-2320-339-10
0135
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
TRANS TEMP GAUGE INDICATES OVERHEATING DURING NORMAL OPERATION
INITIAL SETUP:
Equipment Condition
Engine OFF. (WP 0056)
TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURE
TRANS TEMP GAUGE INDICATES OVERHEATING DURING NORMAL OPERATION
TEST 1 - Is transmission fluid at proper operating level?
1. Check transmission fluid level. (WP 0141)
TRANSMISSION
DIPSTICK
Figure 1.
2. If transmission fluid is low, add transmission fluid. (WP 0141)
CONDITION/INDICATION
Is transmission fluid at proper operating level?
DECISION
Transmission fluid was high. - Notify Supervisor. Test 2 - Does TRANS TEMP gauge
indicate overheating during normal operation?
Transmission fluid was at proper level. - Notify Supervisor.
TEST 2 - Does TRANS TEMP gauge indicate overheating during normal operation?
1. Start engine. (WP 0043)
2. Test drive vehicle.
0135-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
0135
TRANSMISSION
TEMP GAUGE
INTERAXLE
8X8
PULL TO
B.O.
LIGHTS
B.O.
SELECT
EXHAUST
ER LY
TRAILSUPPKING
AIR PAR
SUPPLY
FOR AND
NOT MIDL
PU S H T O
CHEM
ALARM
TRANSMISSION
OVER TEMP
INDICATOR
GPPU
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
M
M
12
ASS
HIGH
IDLE
AlTranlissmisonsion
Figure 2.
CONDITION/INDICATION
Does TRANS TEMP gauge indicate overheating during normal operation?
DECISION
Overheating - Notify Supervisor.
Correct temperature - Problem corrected.
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0135-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
0136
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
WHEEL WOBBLES
INITIAL SETUP:
Equipment Condition
Engine OFF. (WP 0056)
TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURE
WHEEL WOBBLES
TEST 1 - Are any lugnuts loose, missing or broken?
1. Check wheels for loose, missing or broken lugnuts.
0136-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
Figure 1.
CONDITION/INDICATION
Are any lugnuts loose, missing or broken?
DECISION
No - Tighten or replace lugnut(s). (WP 0149)
Yes - Test 2 - Are any of the wheels bent?
TEST 2 - Are any of the wheels bent?
1. Check to see if any of the wheels are bent.
0136-2
0136
TM 9-2320-339-10
Figure 2.
CONDITION/INDICATION
Are any of the wheels bent?
DECISION
Wheel bent - Replace damaged wheel(s). (WP 0149)
Wheels OK - Notify Supervisor.
TEST 3 - Do any of the wheels wobble?
1. Start engine. (WP 0043)
2. Test drive vehicle.
CONDITION/INDICATION
Do any of the wheels wobble?
0136-3
0136
TM 9-2320-339-10
DECISION
Wheel wobbles - Notify Supervisor.
Wheel OK - Notify Supervisor.
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0136-4
0136
TM 9-2320-339-10
0137
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
TIRES WORN UNEVENLY OR EXCESSIVELY
INITIAL SETUP:
Equipment Condition
Engine OFF. (WP 0056)
TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURE
TIRES WORN UNEVENLY OR EXCESSIVELY
TEST 1 - Are tires inflated to proper pressure for road condition?
WARNING
Tire air pressure must be checked properly. Failure to comply may result
in injury or death to personnel.
NOTE
Inflate tires only when they are cool. Inflate to proper pressure for
road condition.
Tire tread is non-directional. Vehicle operation is not affected by direction of traction bars.
1. Check tires for proper inflation. (WP 0142)
0137-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
Figure 1.
2. If tires are improperly inflated, inflate or deflate to proper pressure.
CONDITION/INDICATION
Are tires inflated to proper pressure for road condition?
DECISION
Improperly inflated - Notify Supervisor.
Inflation OK - Notify Supervisor.
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0137-2
0137
TM 9-2320-339-10
CHAPTER 4
PREVENTIVE
MAINTENANCE
CHECKS AND
SERVICES (PMCS)
TM 9-2320-339-10
TM 9-2320-339-10
0138
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
INTRODUCTION - PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE
PMCS INTRODUCTION
This section contains PMCS requirements for HEMTT series vehicles. The PMCS tables
contain checks and services necessary to ensure that the vehicle is ready for operation.
Using PMCS tables, perform maintenance at specified intervals.
MAINTENANCE FORMS AND RECORDS
Every mission begins and ends with paperwork. There is not much of it, but it must be kept
up. The filled out forms and records have several uses. They are a permanent record of
services, repairs, and modifications made on the vehicle; they are reports to unit
maintenance and to your Commander; and they serve as a checklist to find out what is
wrong with the vehicle after its last use, and whether those faults have been fixed. For the
information needed on forms and records, refer to DA PAM 750-8. (WP 0157)
PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE CHECKS AND SERVICES
0138-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
0138
Cleanliness: Dirt, grease, oil, and debris only get in the way and may cover up a
serious problem. Use solvent cleaning compound (WP 0160, Table 1, Item 6, 7,
8, 9, 10, 11) on all metal surfaces and soapy water on rubber.
Bolts, Nuts, and Screws: Check bolts, nuts, and screws for obvious looseness,
missing, bent, or broken condition and tighten or replace as necessary. They
cannot all be checked with a tool, of course, but look for chipped paint, bare metal,
or rust around bolt heads.
Welds: Look for loose or chipped paint, rust, or gaps where parts are welded
together. If a bad weld is found, have it repaired.
Electric Wires and Connectors: Look for cracked or broken insulation, bare
wires, and loose or broken connectors. Tighten loose connectors and make sure
wires are in good shape.
Hydraulic Lines and Fittings: Look for wear, damage, and leaks, and make sure
clamps and fittings are tight. Wet spots show leaks, of course, but a stain around
a fitting or connector can indicate a leak. If a connector or fitting is loose, tighten
it. If something is broken or worn out, repair or replace per applicable procedure.
Damage is defined as: Any conditions that affect safety or would render the
vehicle unserviceable for mission requirements.
FLUID LEAKAGE
It is necessary to know how fluid leakage affects the status of fuel, oil, coolant, and the
hydraulic systems. The following are definitions of types/classes of leakage necessary to
know in order to determine the status of the vehicle.
NOTE
Equipment operation is allowable with minor leakage (Class I or II). Consideration must be given to the fluid capacity in the item/system being
checked/inspected. When in doubt, notify the supervisor. When operating
with Class I or II leaks, continue to check fluid levels as required in the
PMCS. Class III leaks should be repaired per applicable procedure.
Class I :Seepage of fluid (as indicated by wetness or discoloration) not great enough to
form drops.
Class II: Leakage of fluid great enough to form drops but not enough to cause drops to
drip from item being checked/inspected.
Class III: Leakage of fluid great enough to form drops that fall from the item being checked/
inspected.
PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE CHECKS AND SERVICES (PMCS)
Prior to performing your PMCS, check with your PLL clerk to verify that the latest
publications are being used by the operator and organizational unit.
0138-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
0138
Listed below are links to each section of the PMCS. Just click on desired PMCS.
PMCS - BEFORE (WP 0139)
PMCS - DURING (WP 0140)
PMCS - AFTER (WP 0141)
PMCS - WEEKLY (WP 0142)
PMCS - MONTHLY (WP 0144)
PMCS - SEMIANNUAL (WP 0143)
Vehicles designated or dispatched to transport Class A or B ammunition, explosives,
poisons, or radioactive yellow III materials over public highways require more stringent
inspections.
Daily Walk Around PMCS Diagram. This routing diagram will be of help to complete the B,
D, or A PMCS. It shows the vehicle PMCS routing track, which matches the sequence of
PMCS to be performed.
START
Figure 1.
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0138-3
TM 9-2320-339-10
0139
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
BEFORE - PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE
INITIAL SETUP:
Tools and Special Tools
Gloves, Welders
None
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
WARNING
WARNING
0139-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
0139
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
NOTE
Perform Operator's Before,
After, and Weekly PMCS
checks if:
You are the assigned
driver but have not
operated the vehicle
since the last weekly
inspection.
You are operating the
vehicle for the first time.
NOTE
Clean all lubrication
points with cleaning
compound, solvent and
allow to dry prior to
servicing.
When using a grease
gun, apply lubricant to the
fitting until clean lubricant
squeezes out of the part
being lubricated.
Always refer to lubrication
instructions (WP 0145) to
ensure equipment has
correct lubricants
appropriate to operating
environment (expected
continuous
temperatures). If not,
remove/drain and
reapply/refill equipment
with appropriate
lubricants for operating
environment as
0139-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
0139
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
prescribed in lubrication
instructions. (WP 0145)
NOTE
If leakage is detected, further
investigation is needed to determine the location and
cause of the leak. If there is
any doubt, contact your supervisor or field level maintenance.
1
Before
Driver
Side Exterior
Any fuel,
Class III
leak, or air
lines/fittings
leaking or
damaged.
Fire extinguisher
missing or
damaged.
0139-3
TM 9-2320-339-10
0139
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Procedure
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
SEAL
GAUGE
FIRE
EXTINGUISHER
Figure 1.
a. Check gauge for proper
pressure.
0139-4
Pressure
gauge needle in RECHARGE
area.
TM 9-2320-339-10
0139
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
c.
Seal broken
or missing.
NOTE
Ball valve is in ON position
when handle is in line with ball
valve body (shown below).
2
Before
Driver
Side Air
Springs
1. Ensure two driver side air suspension ball valves are in ON position. (WP 0042)
0139-5
Ball valves
have damage that
would prevent normal
operation.
TM 9-2320-339-10
0139
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
HANDLE LOCK
HANDLE
BALL VALVE SHOWN IN ON POSITION
Figure 2.
2. Check each air spring for inflation
and obvious damage.
0139-6
Air springs
will not inflate or have
damage
that would
TM 9-2320-339-10
0139
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
AIR SPRING
AIR SPRING SHOWN IS ON THE
PASSENGER SIDE OF VEHICLE. EACH AXLE
HAS AN AIR SPRING THAT IS SIMILAR.
Figure 3.
WARNING
0139-7
TM 9-2320-339-10
0139
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
NOTE
A tire is bad or in need of
repair if the bead,
sidewall, and tread areas
show signs of damage.
Remember that this
process requires you to
make judgement calls
and the goal is to safely
maintain equipment in top
quality conditions.
3
Before
Driver
Side
Tires
WARNING
0139-8
TM 9-2320-339-10
0139
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
signs that read NO SMOKING
WITHIN 50 FEET OF VEHICLE. Failure to comply may
result in injury or death to personnel.
NOTE
Drain fuel into suitable
container.
Operation of vehicle with
malfunctioning fuel/water
separator may violate AR
385-55. (WP 0157)
4
Before
Fuel/Water Separator
0139-9
TM 9-2320-339-10
0139
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Procedure
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
FUEL/WATER
SEPARATOR
THUMB NUT
Figure 4.
2. Check fuel/water separator for
leaks and damage.
5
Before
Engine
0139-10
Any fuel
leak.
TM 9-2320-339-10
0139
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
ADD
FULL
ENGINE OIL
DIPSTICK
Figure 5.
NOTE
Engine oil level should be between ADD and FULL mark
on dipstick.
a. Add engine oil as required.
(WP 0145, Table 1)
b. Drain excess engine oil as
required, or notify field level
maintenance.
6
Before
0139-11
24V battery
disconnect
switch inoperative.
TM 9-2320-339-10
0139
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
24V BATTERY
DISCONNECT SWITCH
Figure 6.
7
Before
Rear of
Vehicle
Visually check rear of vehicle for obvious damage that would impair operation.
Before
Fuel
Tank
Module
Fuel tank
leaks.
0139-12
TM 9-2320-339-10
0139
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
MANHOLE
COVER
SEAL
FILL COVER
Figure 7.
WARNING
0139-13
Manhole
cover is unserviceable.
TM 9-2320-339-10
0139
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
Fill cover is
unserviceable.
Any fuel
leak.
WARNING
0139-14
TM 9-2320-339-10
0139
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
when engine is hot. When
working with fuel, post
signs that read NO
SMOKING WITHIN 50
FEET OF VEHICLE.
Failure to comply may
result in injury or death to
personnel.
Discharge from filterseparator tank shall be
drained into non-spark
producing container to
prevent fire or explosion.
Failure to comply may
result in injury or death to
personnel.
NOTE
Drain fuel and water into a
suitable container.
9
Before
Fuel
Tank
Module
0139-15
TM 9-2320-339-10
0139
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
80
60
500600
40
20
80
60
100
500600
40
800 120
300
100
0
20
140
1000
1100
160
100
800 120
300
100
0
140
1000
1100
160
MARSH
MARSH
L L
FLOW METER
0139-16
Hose or
hose reel is
damaged
and is needed for intended mission.
TM 9-2320-339-10
0139
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
HOSE
REEL
VNPG
GAUGE
DLPG
GAUGE
60 80 100
500
600
40 300
800120
20 100
140
1000
0
1100
160
0
MARSH
HOSE
REEL
60 80 100
500
600
40 300
800120
20 100
140
1000
0
1100
160
0
MARSH
F
F
VALVE
OUTIN
L L O N S
FLAMMABLE
NO SMOKING WITHIN 50 FEET
U
U
E
E
L
L
FLOW METER
HOSES
STATIC REELS
AND CABLES
Figure 9.
3. Check nozzles and adapters for
obvious damage.
Nozzle or
reducer
adapter is
damaged
and is needed for intended mission.
Either/both
of the two
static reels
or cables
are missing
or unserviceable.
Glass bezel
is missing or
0139-17
TM 9-2320-339-10
0139
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
that they are firmly attached to
gauge bodies.
6. Check fuel suction hose and storage tube for obvious damage and
missing parts.
broken and
is required
for intended
mission.
Fuel suction
hose and/or
storage
tube is damaged or
missing
parts.
FLAMMABLE
NO SMOKING WITHIN 50 FEET
STOWAGE TUBE
FUEL
SUCTION HOSE
Figure 10.
10
Before
Self-Recovery
Winch
(SRW)
0139-18
Self-recovery winch
unserviceable.
TM 9-2320-339-10
0139
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Procedure
REAR
TENSIONER
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
SELF-RECOVERY
WINCH
FRONT
TENSIONER
Figure 11.
2. Inspect front cable guide for any
loose or missing parts and any
obvious damage.
0139-19
Front cable
guide has
loose or
missing
parts, or is
TM 9-2320-339-10
0139
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
unserviceable.
11
Before
Wheel
Chocks
Rear cable
guide has
loose or
missing
parts, or is
unserviceable.
Vehicle is
equipped
with less
than four
wheel
chocks.
NOTE
If leakage is detected, further
investigation is needed to de-
0139-20
TM 9-2320-339-10
0139
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Procedure
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Before
Passenger Side
Exterior
Any fuel,
Class III
leak, or air
lines/fittings
leaking or
damaged.
Fire extinguisher
missing or
damaged.
0139-21
TM 9-2320-339-10
0139
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Procedure
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
SEAL
GAUGE
FIRE
EXTINGUISHER
Figure 12.
a. Check gauge for proper
pressure.
0139-22
Pressure
gauge needle in RECHARGE
area.
TM 9-2320-339-10
0139
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Procedure
c.
13
Before
Passenger Side
Air
Springs
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Seal broken
or missing.
Ball valve
damaged/
will not
move to ON
position.
AIR SPRING
AIR SPRING SHOWN IS ON THE
PASSENGER SIDE OF VEHICLE. EACH AXLE
HAS AN AIR SPRING THAT IS SIMILAR.
Figure 13.
2. Check each air spring for inflation
and obvious damage.
0139-23
Air springs
will not inflate or have
damage
that would
prevent normal operation.
TM 9-2320-339-10
0139
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
WARNING
NOTE
Remember that a tire in
storage (spare) can be
flat but not look like it. The
HEMTT tire sidewalls can
support the wheel. Don't
be fooled.
A tire is bad or in need of
repair if the bead,
sidewall, and tread areas
show signs of damage.
Remember that this
process requires you to
make judgement calls
and the goal is to safely
maintain equipment in top
quality conditions.
14
Before
Passenger Side
Tires (in-
0139-24
TM 9-2320-339-10
0139
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
cluding
spare
tire)
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
ing spare tire) and service tire
(WP 0152) as required.
WARNING
0139-25
ted, or unserviceable.
TM 9-2320-339-10
0139
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
be burned. Failure to
comply may result in
injury to personnel.
NOTE
Coolant should
completely fill lower sight
glass at any engine
temperature.
Coolant should
completely fill upper sight
glass if engine is hot.
Coolant should partially
fill upper sight glass if
engine is cold.
15
Before
Radiator
0139-26
Coolant is
low.
TM 9-2320-339-10
0139
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
SIGHT GLASS
RADIATOR
Figure 14.
WARNING
NOTE
Vehicle operation with inoperative seat belts may violate
AR 385-55. (WP 0157)
0139-27
TM 9-2320-339-10
0139
Item
No.
Interval
16
Before
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Procedure
Seat
Belts
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Webbing is
cut, frayed
or excessively worn.
STRAP
STRAPS
BUTTON
RETRACTOR
BUCKLE
LATCH
STRAPS
RETRACTORS
Figure 15.
0139-28
TM 9-2320-339-10
0139
Item
No.
17
Interval
Before
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Seats
Procedure
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Buckle/latch
does not engage with a
solidsounding
click and/
or does not
release
freely when
button is
pushed.
Molded
plastic
around
buckle/latch
is deformed,
cracked, or
broken.
Retractor(s)
do not operate properly, or retractor cover(s)
are
cracked/
broken.
Hardware is
loose, missing, rusted,
corroded, or
damaged.
0139-29
TM 9-2320-339-10
0139
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Procedure
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
anism broken or missing.
ADJ.
HT
HEIG
HEIGHT
ADJUSTMENT
CONTROL
FORWARD/BACKWARD
ADJUSTMENT CONTROL
Figure 16.
18
Before
0139-30
Fire extinguisher
missing or
damaged.
TM 9-2320-339-10
0139
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Procedure
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
SEAL
GAUGE
FIRE
EXTINGUISHER
Figure 17.
2. Check gauge for proper pressure
of about 150 psi (1034 kPa).
0139-31
Pressure
gauge needle in RECHARGE
area.
TM 9-2320-339-10
0139
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
Seal broken
or missing.
NOTE
Complete all start engine
(WP 0043) procedures,
and comply with all notes,
cautions, and warnings
within that procedure
before completing the
PMCS checks below.
Once all start engine (WP
0043) procedures are
completed, engine
should be kept running for
the remaining PMCS
checks.
19
Before
Engine
Engine fails
to start.
NOTE
Check the instruments listed
below for damage, operation,
and condition.
20
Before
Instruments
0139-32
Engine oil
pressure
gauge is inoperative.
TM 9-2320-339-10
0139
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
TACHOMETER
BATTERY
VOLTAGE
CHEM
ALARM
INTER
AXLE
8X8
25
22
15
11
8
6.2
5.5
3.7
2.7
2.0
IN H20 kPa
FILTER MINDER
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
B.O
SELECT
GPFU
B.O
LIGHTS
PARKING
BRAKE
HIGH
IDLE
1
2
3
TRAILER
AIR SUPPLY
0
1
2
ENGINE
OIL PRESSURE
GAUGE
AIR BRAKE
FRONT AIR
PRESSURE
GAUGE
REAR AIR
PRESSURE
GAUGE
Figure 18.
2. Tachometer.
0139-33
Tachometer
is inoperative or indicates less
than 625
rpm or more
than 725
rpm at idle
after engine
has been
properly
warmed up
(start engine (WP
TM 9-2320-339-10
0139
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
0043) procedure
completed).
3. Battery voltage readout.
NOTE
Air pressure buzzer will sound
anytime low air indicator is illuminated. Ensure low air indicator and buzzer activate
when air pressure falls below
60 to 70 psi (4.83 bar) in
FRONT air system.
4. FRONT air pressure gauge.
0139-34
FRONT air
pressure
gauge is inoperative or
indicates
FRONT air
system is
below 70 psi
(4.83 bar)
after engine
has been
properly
TM 9-2320-339-10
0139
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
warmed up
(start engine (WP
0043) procedure
completed).
Low air
pressure indicator and/
or buzzer
remain on,
or do not operate.
NOTE
Air pressure buzzer will sound
anytime low air indicator is illuminated. Ensure low air indicator and buzzer activate
when air pressure falls below
60 to 70 psi (4.83 bar) in
REAR air system.
5. REAR air pressure gauge.
0139-35
REAR air
pressure
gauge is inoperative or
indicates
REAR air
system is
below 70 psi
(4.83 bar)
after engine
has been
properly
warmed up
(start en-
TM 9-2320-339-10
0139
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Procedure
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
gine (WP
0043) procedure
completed).
Low air
pressure indicator and/
or buzzer
remain on,
or do not operate.
0139-36
TM 9-2320-339-10
0139
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
FUEL
GAUGE
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
TRANSMISSION
OIL TEMPERATURE
GAUGE
CHEM
ALARM
INTER
AXLE
AIR FILTER
RESTRICTION
INDICATOR
25
22
15
11
8
8X8
6.2
5.5
3.7
2.7
2.0
IN H20 kPa
FILTER MINDER
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
B.O
SELECT
GPFU
B.O
LIGHTS
PARKING
BRAKE
HIGH
IDLE
1
2
3
TRAILER
AIR SUPPLY
0
1
2
AIR BRAKE
ENGINE COOLANT
TEMPERATURE
Figure 19.
NOTE
Several minutes are required
for engine to warm up so an
accurate reading can be taken.
7. Engine coolant temperature
gauge.
0139-37
Engine
coolant
temperature
gauge is in-
TM 9-2320-339-10
0139
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
operative,
or indicates
less than
180F (82
C) or more
than 219F
(104C) after engine
has been
properly
warmed up
(start engine (WP
0043) procedure
completed).
NOTE
Transmission may not reach
160F (71C) oil temperature
at idle for several minutes.
8. Transmission oil temperature
gauge.
9. Fuel gauge.
FUEL
gauge is inoperative,
or indicates
less than
the required
amount of
0139-38
TM 9-2320-339-10
0139
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
fuel needed
to complete
the mission.
CAUTION
Vehicle must be parked when
making this check. Failure to
comply may result in damage
to equipment. Transfer case
will be damaged if shifted
while vehicle is moving.
NOTE
Engine must be running to
perform this check.
21
Before
TRANSFER
CASE
Shift Lever and
Traction
Control
Switch
0139-39
TM 9-2320-339-10
0139
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
INTER-AXLE
INDICATOR
TRACTION
CONTROL
SWITCH
8X8
INDICATOR
INTERAXLE
8X8
B.O.
LIGHTS
P U LL T O
EXHAUST
LER
TRAI SUPPKINLYG
AIR PAR D
FOR
NOT MIDLAN
SUPPLY
B.O.
SELECT
PUSH TO
CHEM
ALARM
GPPU
AUX
HYD
TRANSFER
CASE SHIFT
LEVER
HYD
ENABLE
M
M
1
2
3
ASS
HIGH
IDLE
nn
smissio
ATranlliso
Figure 20.
a. With transmission in N (neutral), shift transfer lever
through all range positions.
Lever should move freely
through all range positions.
0139-40
TRANSFER
CASE shift
lever inoperable or
binds between
range detents.
TM 9-2320-339-10
0139
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
NOTE
Engine must be running to
perform this check.
22
Before
Engine
Brake
0139-41
Traction
control
switch or indicators inoperable.
TM 9-2320-339-10
0139
Interval
ENGINE BRAKE
HIGH/MEDIUM/LOW
SWITCH
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
ENGINE BRAKE
ENABLE INDICATOR
INTERAXLE
8X8
B.O.
LIGHTS
P U LL T O
B.O.
SELECT
EXHAUST
LER
TRAI SUPPKINLYG
AIR PAR D
FOR
NOT MIDLAN
SUPPLY
Item
No.
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
PUSH TO
CHEM
ALARM
GPPU
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
M
M
1
2
3
ASS
HIGH
IDLE
nn
smissio
ATranlliso
TRANSMISSION
RANGE SELECTOR
THROTTLE
PEDAL
ENGINE BRAKE
ON/OFF SWITCH
Figure 21.
b. Push in throttle pedal and increase engine speed to between 1900 and 2100 rpm.
c.
0139-42
TM 9-2320-339-10
0139
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
Engine retarder/brake
does not engage.
NOTE
Engine must be running to
perform this check.
23
Before
Steering
Steering inoperable or
binds.
NOTE
Engine must be running to
perform this check.
24
Before
HYD ENABLE
Switch
0139-43
TM 9-2320-339-10
0139
Item
No.
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Interval
HYD ENABLE
SWITCH
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
CHEM
ALARM
INTER
AXLE
8X8
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
HIGH
IDLE
1
2
B.O
SELECT
GPFU
0
1
2
Figure 22.
NOTE
Operation of vehicle with malfunctioning windshield wiper
may violate AR 385-55. (WP
0157)
25
Before
Windshield
Wiper/
Washer
Switches
0139-44
B.O
LIGHTS
TM 9-2320-339-10
0139
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
CHEM
ALARM
INTER
AXLE
8X8
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
HIGH
IDLE
1
2
B.O
SELECT
GPFU
0
1
2
WINDSHIELD
WIPER CONTROL
Figure 23.
2. Check windshield washer switch
for proper operation. (WP 0034)
NOTE
Engine must be running
to perform this check.
Operation of vehicle with
malfunctioning
windshield wiper may
violate AR 385-55. (WP
0157)
26
Before
Parking
Brake
Control
0139-45
B.O
LIGHTS
TM 9-2320-339-10
0139
Item
No.
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Interval
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
PARKING BRAKE
CONTROL
CHEM
ALARM
INTER
AXLE
8X8
25
22
15
11
8
6.2
5.5
3.7
2.7
2.0
IN H20 kPa
FILTER MINDER
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
B.O
SELECT
GPFU
B.O
LIGHTS
PARKING
BRAKE
HIGH
IDLE
1
2
3
TRAILER
AIR SUPPLY
0
1
2
AIR BRAKE
Figure 24.
a. With vehicle at idle and service brake pedal engaged,
(WP 0045)set transmission
range selector to D (drive).
(WP 0047)
NOTE
Dashboard parking brake indicator will illuminate when
PARKING BRAKE control is
applied.
b. Pull out PARKING BRAKE
control. (WP 0044)
0139-46
TM 9-2320-339-10
0139
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
c.
NOTE
Operator may continue on
with mission if vehicle requires no servicing.
27
Before
Engine
0139-47
Vehicle
moves with
PARKING
BRAKE
control applied (pulled
out).
TM 9-2320-339-10
0140
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
DURING - PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE
INITIAL SETUP:
Tools and Special Tools
Gloves, Welders
None
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
WARNING
During
Engine
NOTE
Check trailer handbrake control lever only if a trailer is
hooked up to vehicle.
0140-1
Engine has
excessive
smoke, unusual noise,
runs rough,
or misfires.
TM 9-2320-339-10
0140
Item
No.
Interval
During
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Trailer
Handbrake
Control
Lever
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
TRAILER HANDBRAKE
CONTROL LEVER
Figure 1.
Listen for actuation. If none, refer to
applicable trailer operator's manual.
NOTE
During operation, all gauges
should maintain the proper
readings listed in the PMCS
BEFORE checks. (WP 0139)
0140-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
0140
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Item
No.
Interval
During
Instruments
Gauges, indicators,
and warning
lights do not
read/operate properly.
During
Transmission
Transmission slips or
will not shift.
During
Steering
Be alert for any unusual noise, binding, or difficulty in steering during operation.
Steering
binds or is
unresponsive.
During
Service
Brakes
Service
brakes do
not operate
properly.
Procedure
NOTE
TANK FUEL LEVEL
INDICATOR must be at
least 1/8 of a tank to
perform this procedure.
Engine must be running
to perform this check.
7
During
Fuel
Tank
Module
1. Check that main fuel pump operates using the following procedure:
0140-3
Main fuel
pump inoperable.
TM 9-2320-339-10
0140
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
CAUTION
Do not move hydraulic selector valve control while PTO is
engaged or vehicle hydraulic
equipment may be damaged.
a. Push hydraulic selector
valve in.
HYDRAULIC
SELECTOR
VALVE
Figure 2.
b. Start engine. (WP 0043)
c.
0140-4
TM 9-2320-339-10
0140
Item
No.
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Interval
HYD ENABLE
SWITCH
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
CHEM
ALARM
INTER
AXLE
8X8
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
HIGH
IDLE
1
2
B.O
SELECT
GPFU
0
1
2
Figure 3.
d. Pull back on MC MANUAL
CONTROL EM VALVE lever.
0140-5
B.O
LIGHTS
TM 9-2320-339-10
0140
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
DLPG DISCHARGE
LINE PRESSURE GAUGE
80
60
100
500600
40 300
800120
80
60
100
500600
40 300
800120
20 100
140
1000
0
1100
160
0
MARSH
20 100
140
1000
0
1100
160
0
MARSH
F
F
VALVE
OUTIN
U
U
L L O N S
E
E
L
L
FLOW METER
MC MANUAL
CONTROL
EM VALVE LEVER
PUMP
ENGAGEMENT
LEVER
Figure 4.
e. Push forward on PUMP ENGAGEMENT lever.
NOTE
Make following check at engine idle.
f.
0140-6
TM 9-2320-339-10
0140
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
However, it is necessary to
verify system operating pressure described in next check.
NOTE
Make following check with engine at high idle.
g. Check discharge line pressure gauge (DLPG) for proper operation (WP 0029) and
pressure indication.
0140-7
TM 9-2320-339-10
0140
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
60
40
20
80
500 600
60
100
800
300
40
120
20
140
1000
1100
160
100
0
0
80
500 600
100
800
300
120
140
1000
1100
160
100
0
0
MARSH
MARSH
D
E
F
U
E
L
OUT
60
40
20
0
80
500 600
300
F
U
E
L
IN
100
800 120
140
1000
1100
160
100
0
MARSH
VALVE
L L O N S
FLOW METER
Figure 5.
3. Check flowmeter (FM) for damage and proper operation. (WP
0029)
0140-8
TM 9-2320-339-10
0140
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
60
40
20
80
500 600
60
100
800
300
40
120
20
140
1000
1100
160
100
0
0
80
500 600
100
800
300
120
140
1000
1100
160
100
0
0
MARSH
MARSH
D
E
F
U
E
L
OUT
60
40
20
0
80
500 600
300
F
U
E
L
IN
100
800 120
140
1000
1100
160
100
0
MARSH
VALVE
L L O N S
FLOW METER
FLOWMETER
L L O N S
Figure 6.
4. While dispensing fuel, check
venturi-nozzle pressure gauge
(VNPG) for proper operation (WP
0029) and any obvious damage.
The gauge pressure should read
a few psi less than the discharge
line pressure gauge (DLPG).
0140-9
Gauge does
not register
or pressure
is not similar
to discharge
line pressure gauge
(DLPG).
TM 9-2320-339-10
0140
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
VNPG VEN/NOZZLE
PRESSURE GAUGE
60
40
20
80
500 600
60
100
800
300
40
120
20
140
1000
1100
160
100
0
0
80
500 600
100
800
300
120
140
1000
1100
160
100
0
0
MARSH
MARSH
D
E
F
U
E
L
OUT
60
40
20
0
80
500 600
300
F
U
E
L
IN
100
800 120
140
1000
1100
160
100
0
MARSH
VALVE
L L O N S
FLOW METER
Figure 7.
5. Check HAV hand actuated control for proper operation (WP
0028) and any obvious damage.
Air should be exhausted when
HAV handle is released.
0140-10
HAV control
does not operate properly.
TM 9-2320-339-10
0140
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
80
60
100
500
600
40 300
800120
80
60
100
500600
40 300
800120
20 100
140
1000
0
1100
160
0
MARSH
20 100
140
1000
0
1100
160
0
MARSH
F
F
VALVE
OUTIN
U
U
L L O N S
E
E
L
L
FLOW METER
HAV CONTROL
Figure 8.
6. Check HAV air lines, fuel delivery
hoses, valves, fittings, connectors and piping for leaks, defects,
and obvious damage.
0140-11
Any fuel
leak is
present
and/or no
other fuel
hoses are
available.
TM 9-2320-339-10
0140
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
60
40
20
80
500 600
60
100
800
300
40
120
20
140
1000
1100
160
100
0
0
80
500 600
100
800
300
120
140
1000
1100
160
100
0
0
MARSH
MARSH
D
E
F
U
E
L
OUT
60
40
20
0
80
500 600
300
F
U
E
L
IN
100
800 120
140
1000
1100
160
100
0
MARSH
VALVE
L L O N S
FLOW METER
0140-12
TM 9-2320-339-10
0140
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
DLPG DISCHARGE
LINE PRESSURE GAUGE
80
60
100
500600
40 300
800120
80
60
100
500600
40 300
800120
20 100
140
1000
0
1100
160
0
MARSH
20 100
140
1000
0
1100
160
0
MARSH
F
F
VALVE
OUTIN
U
U
L L O N S
E
E
L
L
FLOW METER
MC MANUAL
CONTROL
EM VALVE LEVER
PUMP
ENGAGEMENT
LEVER
Figure 10.
a. Pull back on PUMP ENGAGEMENT LEVER until it
contacts latch.
b. Push forward on MC MANUAL CONTROL EM VALVE
lever.
c.
0140-13
TM 9-2320-339-10
0140-14
0140
TM 9-2320-339-10
0141
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
AFTER - PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE
INITIAL SETUP:
Tools and Special Tools
Gloves, Welders
None
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
WARNING
WARNING
0141-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
0141
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
NOTE
Perform Operator's Before,
After, and Weekly PMCS
checks if:
You are the assigned
driver but have not
operated the vehicle
since the last weekly
inspection.
You are operating the
vehicle for the first time.
NOTE
Clean all lubrication
points with cleaning
compound, solvent and
allow to dry prior to
servicing.
When using a grease
gun, apply lubricant to the
fitting until clean lubricant
squeezes out of the part
being lubricated.
Always refer to lubrication
instructions (WP 0145) to
ensure equipment has
correct lubricants
appropriate to operating
environment (expected
continuous
temperatures). If not,
remove/drain and
reapply/refill equipment
with appropriate
lubricants for operating
environment as
0141-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
0141
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
prescribed in lubrication
instructions. (WP 0145)
After
Underneath Vehicle
Any fuel,
Class III
leak, or air
lines/fittings
leaking or
damaged.
Any fuel
leak. Class
III leak of
any other
fluid.
WARNING
CAUTION
Do not fill hydraulic reservoir
past FULL COLD mark. Fail-
0141-3
TM 9-2320-339-10
0141
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
ure to comply may result in
damage to equipment.
NOTE
Hydraulic oil expands
when heated, which may
give the operator false
(high) fluid level readings
if the vehicle has been
recently operated.
If possible, wait until
hydraulic reservoir is
completely cooled down
(minimum of 2 hours)
prior to adding hydraulic
oil, otherwise fill reservoir
to FULL COLD mark.
2
After
Hydraulic
Fluid
Reservoir
0141-4
TM 9-2320-339-10
0141
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Procedure
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
'FULL
COLD'
LEVEL
SIGHT
GLASS
HYDRAULIC
RESERVOIR
Figure 1.
a. Remove cap from hydraulic
reservoir.
b. Fill hydraulic reservoir with
lubricating oil (WP 0145, Table 4) until sight glass reads
at FULL COLD mark.
c.
0141-5
TM 9-2320-339-10
0141
Item
No.
Interval
After
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Driver
Side
Wheels
Procedure
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Wheel is
broken,
cracked, or
bent.
Two or
more lugnuts or
studs on the
same wheel
are missing,
broken, or
bent.
After
Driver
Side
Shock
Absorbers
Damaged
or Class III
leak
present.
After
Rear Exterior
After
Towing
Gladhands
After
Passenger side
Wheels
Wheel is
broken,
cracked, or
bent.
Two or
more lug-
0141-6
TM 9-2320-339-10
0141
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
age. If loose, tighten and report to
maintenance as soon as practical.
After
Passenger Side
Shock
Absorbers
WARNING
Vehicles air system is pressurized, be sure to wear proper eye protection and keep
face away from drain valves
while draining air reservoirs.
Open air drain valves slowly
to prevent sudden blast of air.
Failure to comply may result
in injury to personnel.
9
After
Air Reservoirs
0141-7
nuts or
studs on the
same wheel
are missing,
broken, or
bent.
TM 9-2320-339-10
0141
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
AIR RESERVOIR
DRAIN VALVES
Figure 2.
2. Once all air is exhausted from air
reservoirs, close air reservoir
drain valves on air system drain
manifold.
CAUTION
Clean around end of fill tube
prior to removing dipstick.
This will aid in preventing dirt
or foreign matter from entering the transmission and
causing damage.
0141-8
TM 9-2320-339-10
0141
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
NOTE
Vehicle is parked (WP 0055)
on a flat, level surface.
Engine is at idle.
Transmission is at normal
operating temperature,
160-200F (71-93C).
10
After
Transmission
HOT
FULL
HOT
ADD
TRANSMISSION
FLUID
DIPSTICK
COLD
FULL
ADD
COLD
Figure 3.
0141-9
TM 9-2320-339-10
0141
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
NOTE
Fluid level should be between
HOT FULL and HOT ADD
marks.
11
After
Spare
Tire/
Wheel
Overfull.
Notify field
level maintenance.
Tire has
cuts, gouges, or
cracks that
could result
in tire failure. Tire is
missing or
unserviceable.
Wheel is
broken,
cracked, or
bent.
Two or
more lugnuts or
studs are
missing,
broken, or
bent.
0141-10
TM 9-2320-339-10
0141
Item
No.
Interval
12
After
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Procedure
Exterior
of Cab
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
NOTE
Operation of vehicle with broken/missing mirrors may violate AR 385-55. (WP 0157)
13
After
Mirrors
Figure 4.
0141-11
TM 9-2320-339-10
0141
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
NOTE
Operation of vehicle with
damaged or missing windshield may violate AR 385-55.
(WP 0157)
14
After
Windshield
and Wiper Arms/
Blades
WINDSHIELD
WINDSHIELD WIPER
ARMS/BLADES
Figure 5.
0141-12
TM 9-2320-339-10
0141
Item
No.
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Interval
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
NOTE
Operation of vehicle with
damaged wiper arms/blades
may violate AR 385-55. (WP
0157)
2. Check condition of wiper arms
and blades.
After
Fan
Switch
R-
INTE
8X8
AXL
B.O.
EXHAUS
AI
TR
T
TS
NO
LIGH
R
G
LE
IN
RK
PA
R
FO
PUS H
T
PULL TO
B.O.
TO SUPP
15
ECT
LY
SEL
PP
CHE
SU
AI
AN
DL
MI
RM
ALA
GPP
AUX
HYD
BLE
ENA
HYD
ASS
HIGH
son ion
Alli iss
nsm
Tra
IDLE
FAN CONTROL
SWITCH
Figure 6.
NOTE
Operation of vehicle with malfunctioning windshield wash-
0141-13
TM 9-2320-339-10
0141
Item
No.
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Interval
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
er may violate AR 385-55.
(WP 0157)
16
After
Washer
Control
CHEM
ALARM
INTER
AXLE
8X8
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
HIGH
IDLE
1
2
B.O
SELECT
GPFU
0
1
2
WINDSHIELD
WASHER CONTROL
Figure 7.
NOTE
Operation of vehicle with malfunctioning windshield wiper
may violate AR 385-55. (WP
0157)
17
After
Wiper
Control
0141-14
B.O
LIGHTS
TM 9-2320-339-10
0141
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
CHEM
ALARM
INTER
AXLE
8X8
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
HIGH
IDLE
1
2
B.O
SELECT
GPFU
0
1
2
WINDSHIELD
WIPER CONTROL
Figure 8.
NOTE
Operation of vehicle with malfunctioning horn may violate
AR AR 385-55. (WP 0157)
18
After
Horns
NOTE
Light checks will require
assistance.
Operation of vehicle with
malfunctioning turn signal
0141-15
B.O
LIGHTS
TM 9-2320-339-10
0141
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Procedure
control may violate AR
385-55. (WP 0157)
19
After
TURN SIGNAL
CONTROL LEVER
Figure 9.
20
After
0141-16
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
TM 9-2320-339-10
0141
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
LEFT TURN
SIGNAL INDICATOR
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
RIGHT TURN
SIGNAL INDICATOR
CHEM
ALARM
INTER
AXLE
8X8
25
22
15
11
8
6.2
5.5
3.7
2.7
2.0
IN H20 kPa
FILTER MINDER
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
B.O
SELECT
GPFU
B.O
LIGHTS
PARKING
BRAKE
HIGH
IDLE
1
2
0
1
2
TRAILER
AIR SUPPLY
Figure 10.
NOTE
Light checks will require
assistance.
Operation of vehicle with
malfunctioning
emergency flasher
control may violate AR
385-55. (WP 0157)
21
After
Emergency
Flasher
Control
0141-17
TM 9-2320-339-10
0141
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
EMERGENCY
FLASHER
CONTROL
Figure 11.
NOTE
Light checks will require
assistance.
Operation of vehicle with
malfunctioning service
lights may violate AR
385-55. (WP 0157)
22
After
Lights
NOTE
Operation of vehicle with malfunctioning beacon light may
0141-18
TM 9-2320-339-10
0141
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Procedure
violate AR 385-55. (WP
0157)
23
After
Portable
Beacon
Light (If
equipped)
0141-19
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
TM 9-2320-339-10
0142
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
WEEKLY - PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE
INITIAL SETUP:
Tools and Special Tools
Gloves, Welders
None
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
WARNING
WARNING
0142-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
0142
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
NOTE
Perform Operator's Before,
After, and Weekly PMCS
checks if:
You are the assigned
driver but have not
operated the vehicle
since the last weekly
inspection.
You are operating the
vehicle for the first time.
NOTE
Lubrication intervals are
for normal operating
conditions. Intervals may
be shortened as required
for severe operating
conditions.
Clean all lubrication
points with cleaning
compound, solvent and
allow to dry prior to
servicing.
When using a grease
gun, apply lubricant to the
fitting until clean lubricant
squeezes out of the part
being lubricated.
Always refer to lubrication
instructions (WP 0145) to
ensure equipment has
correct lubricants
appropriate to operating
environment (expected
continuous
0142-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
0142
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
temperatures). If not,
remove/drain and
reapply/refill equipment
with appropriate
lubricants for operating
environment as
prescribed in lubrication
instructions. (WP 0145)
WARNING
Weekly
Driver
Side
Tires
Weekly
Propeller
Shafts
and UJoints
0142-3
Propeller
shaft or UJoint has
excessive
movement,
obvious
damage, or
one or more
nuts or
screws are
loose, miss-
TM 9-2320-339-10
0142
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
ing, or damaged.
PROPELLER
SHAFTS
Figure 1.
NOTE
When vehicle is operating
under severe conditions,
lubricate propeller shafts
and universal joints every
50 hours of vehicle
operation.
Complete Step 2 only if
vehicle is operating under
severe conditions.
2. Lubricate all propeller shafts,
transmission to transfer case
0142-4
TM 9-2320-339-10
0142
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Procedure
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Weekly
Axle
Breathers
Check four axle breathers for damage and free movement of vent caps
on breather body.
0142-5
Any axle
breather
caps are
damaged or
vent caps
do not move
freely on
breather
body.
TM 9-2320-339-10
0142
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
FRONT OF
VEHICLE
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
AXLE
BREATHER
VENT
CAP
BREATHER
BODY
Figure 2.
NOTE
Operation of vehicle with
damaged/malfunctioning air
compressor may violate AR
385-55. (WP 0157)
0142-6
TM 9-2320-339-10
0142
Item
No.
Interval
Weekly
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Air Compressor
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
Screws
missing,
mounting
flange broken, air hoses damaged or fittings/connections
loose.
AIR
COMPRESSOR
Figure 3.
5
Weekly
Secondary Fuel
Filter
0142-7
Any fuel
leak.
TM 9-2320-339-10
0142
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
SECONDARY
FUEL FILTER
Figure 4.
NOTE
Operation of vehicle with any
exhaust leaks may violate AR
385-55. (WP 0157)
6
Weekly
Exhaust
System
0142-8
Exhaust
pipe between turbocharger
and exhaust
manifold
leaks. Any
exhaust
pipe miss-
TM 9-2320-339-10
0142
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
ing or damaged.
MUFFLER
HEATSHIELD
RAINCAP
TAILPIPE
CLAMPS
Figure 5.
7
Weekly
Fuel
Tank
0142-9
Any fuel
leak.
TM 9-2320-339-10
0142
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
FUEL LINES
CONNECTIONS
STRAPS
CONNECTIONS
FUEL TANK
PIPE PLUG
Figure 6.
8
Weekly
Fuel
Tank
Strainer
0142-10
TM 9-2320-339-10
0142
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Procedure
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
FUEL TANK
STRAINER
Figure 7.
9
Weekly
Hydraulic
Pump
0142-11
Any Class
III leak
present or
any mounting screw is
loose or
missing.
TM 9-2320-339-10
0142
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
HYDRAULIC
PUMP
Figure 8.
10
Weekly
Hydraulic
Hoses
NOTE
It is possible for properly
tightened rear mounting
screws to turn by hand in
the mount. Properly
tightened front mounting
0142-12
Class III
leak
present.
Chaffing or
obvious
damage to
hydraulic
hose
present.
TM 9-2320-339-10
0142
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
screws can be tilted
slightly in mounts.
Mounting screws have
specific torque
requirements and at
times may appear to be
loose. Do not attempt to
tighten. If in doubt, notify
your supervisor.
11
Weekly
Fuel
Tank
Mounting
Screws
Check that fuel tank module mounting screws (both driver and passenger side) are not loose, broken, or
missing.
One or
more fuel
tank module
mounting
screws are
broken or
missing.
MOUNTING
SCREWS
MOUNTING
SCREWS
Figure 9.
0142-13
TM 9-2320-339-10
0142
Item
No.
Interval
12
Weekly
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Stowage
Boxes
Procedure
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
13
Weekly
Rear
Spring/
Parking
Brake
Chambers
14
Weekly
Towing
Shackles
15
Weekly
Pintle
Hook
0142-14
Pintle hook
loose or
locking
mechanism
damaged/
unserviceable.
TM 9-2320-339-10
0142
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Procedure
PINTLE
HOOK
Figure 10.
2. Clean pintle hook and coat with
GAA. (WP 0145, Table 9)
16
Weekly
Rear Lifting
Shackles
17
Weekly
Inter-vehicle
Connector
0142-15
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
TM 9-2320-339-10
0142
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
INTER-VEHICLE
ELECTRICAL
CONNECTOR
Figure 11.
WARNING
0142-16
TM 9-2320-339-10
0142
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
to comply may result in injury
or death to personnel and
damage to equipment.
NOTE
Inspection of passenger side
tires includes spare tire.
18
Weekly
Passenger Side
Tires
WARNING
0142-17
TM 9-2320-339-10
0142
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
WARNING
Weekly
Batteries
Cracks or
holes in battery box.
BATTERY BOX
Figure 12.
2. Check battery cables for presence, frays, splits, and looseness.
0142-18
TM 9-2320-339-10
0142
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
split, or
loose.
3. Check for loose, missing, or damaged batteries and corroded or
burnt battery terminals.
One or
more batteries missing,
cracked, or
unserviceable. Any
battery terminal corroded or
burnt. Any
hold down
not secure.
NOTE
The tire carrier pump will normally vent a small amount of
oil as a mist when in use. This
results in a coating of oil on
the pump and the immediate
surrounding area. This is normal and is not to be considered as a leak.
20
Weekly
Tire Carrier
0142-19
Tire carrier
pump has
obvious
damage or
Class III
leak is
present.
TM 9-2320-339-10
0142
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
RAISE/LOWER
LEVER
POWER
BUTTON
STOWAGE
BRACKETS
TIRE CARRIER
PUMP
TIRE
TIRE CARRIER LOCK RODS CARRIER
LATCH
Figure 13.
2. Check tire carrier latch for obvious damage and leaks.
0142-20
Tire carrier
latch has
obvious
TM 9-2320-339-10
0142
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
damage or
Class III
leak is
present.
3. Check operation/lower tire carrier: (WP 0040)
a. Remove both lock rods from
tire carrier and place on
stowage brackets.
WARNING
CAUTION
Ensure passenger side of
vehicle has six ft. (1.8 m)
of clearance from battery
box forward to
0142-21
TM 9-2320-339-10
0142
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
accommodate lowering
of tire carrier or damage
to equipment may result.
Do not dump air
suspension system with
tire carrier in down
position. Damage to tire
carrier arm may result.
NOTE
Once tire carrier has
passed vertical
(approximately 6 in.
[15.24 cm] of movement),
release power control (9)
and allow the tire carrier
to lower on its own until
tire contacts ground.
The tire carrier can be
stopped at any time
during lowering
operations by releasing
the power control and
moving the directional
control lever to RAISE
(pointing inboard)
position.
b. Set directional control lever
to LOWER (pointing outboard) position. Push and
hold power control on tire
carrier pump to lower tire to
ground.
0142-22
Tire carrier
does not
lower to
ground.
TM 9-2320-339-10
0142
Item
No.
Interval
21
Weekly
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Procedure
Air Intake
System
CLAMP
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
1. Check air intake system for damaged air intake tube and loose
clamps. Tighten clamps as needed.
AIR INTAKE
TUBE
HAND
KNOB
AIR CLEANER
HOUSING
Figure 14.
2. Check air cleaner housing for
loose hand knobs. Tighten as
needed.
22
Weekly
Air Dryer
0142-23
Air intake
system has
damaged
air intake
tube or unserviceable
clamps.
TM 9-2320-339-10
0142
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
AIR
DRYER
Figure 15.
NOTE
Pressurize air system prior to
performing this check.
23
Weekly
Air Lines
and Hoses
Any leaks or
damage to
air lines, hoses, or fittings are
found.
24
Weekly
Radiator
and Hoses
Any Class
III leak.
0142-24
TM 9-2320-339-10
0142
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
SIGHT GLASS
RADIATOR
Figure 16.
CAUTION
Ensure lock rods are secured
on stowage brackets before
raising tire carrier. Damage to
tire carrier may result.
NOTE
Raising the tire carrier
requires approximately
70 psi (5 bar) of air from
the vehicle rear air
system. If possible, the
operator should start
engine (WP 0043) and let
idle during raise
operation to ensure
adequate supply of air.
0142-25
TM 9-2320-339-10
0142
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Procedure
Ensure engine covers are
closed before raising tire
carrier.
25
Weekly
Raise
Tire Carrier
0142-26
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
TM 9-2320-339-10
0142
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
RAISE/LOWER
LEVER
POWER
BUTTON
STOWAGE
BRACKETS
TIRE CARRIER
PUMP
TIRE
TIRE CARRIER LOCK RODS CARRIER
LATCH
Figure 17.
0142-27
TM 9-2320-339-10
0142
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
Tire carrier
does not
raise or
does not engage carrier
latch.
NOTE
Operation of vehicle with
damaged doors or windows
may violate AR 385-55. (WP
0157)
26
Weekly
Doors,
Handles,
and Windows
27
Weekly
Drive
Belts and
Pulleys
0142-28
Any drive
belt is broken,
cracked to
the belt fiber, has
more than
TM 9-2320-339-10
0142
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Procedure
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
one crack
(1/8 in. in
depth or
50% of belt
thickness),
has frays
more than 2
in. long or
excessive
play.
DRIVE
BELTS
PULLEYS
Figure 18.
2. Check for bent or damaged pulley.
0142-29
TM 9-2320-339-10
0142
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
NOTE
Start Engine. (WP 0043) Engine must be running for remaining PMCS checks.
Weekly
Cab
Temperature Controls
VENT
CONTROL
CABIN AIR
DIRECTIONAL
CONTROL
R-
INTE
8X8
AXL
B.O.
EXHAUS
R
LE
AI
IN
TR
RK
TS
LIGH
NO
ECT
SEL
PULL TO
B.O.
O SUPPLY
28
FO
PA
PU
SH T
LY
PP
CHE
SU
AI
AN
DL
MI
RM
ALA
GPP
AUX
HYD
HEATER
TEMPERATURE
CONTROL
BLE
ENA
HYD
M
M
ASS
HIGH
son
Alli iss
nsm
Tra
ion
IDLE
AIR CONDITIONING
CONTROL
FAN
CONTROL
VENT
CONTROL
Figure 19.
a. Check two vent controls.
0142-30
TM 9-2320-339-10
0142
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Procedure
Weekly
Emergency
Fuel Shut
Off System
0142-31
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
TM 9-2320-339-10
0142
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
80
100
500600
60
40
20
140
1000
1100
160
80
100
500600
60
40
800 120
300
100
0
20
800 120
300
100
0
140
1000
1100
160
MARSH
MARSH
F
F
OUT IN
U
VALVE
E
L L O N S
L
L
FLOW METER
MC MANUAL
CONTROL EM
VALVE LEVER
FLAMMABLE
EMERGENCY
FUEL SHUTOFF
Figure 20.
b. Pull out Emergency Fuel
Shut-Off.
0142-32
TM 9-2320-339-10
0142
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Procedure
c.
Determine if MC MANUAL
CONTROL EM VALVE lever
has been set in closed (forward) position.
0142-33
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
MC MANUAL CONTROL EM
VALVE
does not return to the
closed (forward) position when
the EMERGENCY
FUEL
SHUT OFF
is pulled
out.
TM 9-2320-339-10
0143
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
SEMIANNUAL - PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE
INITIAL SETUP:
Tools and Special Tools
Gloves, Welders
None
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
WARNING
WARNING
0143-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
0143
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
NOTE
Lubrication intervals are
for normal operating
conditions. Intervals may
be shortened as required
for severe operating
conditions.
Clean all lubrication
points with cleaning
compound, solvent and
allow to dry prior to
servicing.
When using a grease
gun, apply lubricant to the
fitting until clean lubricant
squeezes out of the part
being lubricated.
Always refer to lubrication
instructions (WP 0145) to
ensure equipment has
correct lubricants
appropriate to operating
environment (expected
continuous
temperatures). If not,
remove/drain and
reapply/refill equipment
with appropriate
lubricants for operating
environment as
prescribed in lubrication
instructions. (WP 0145)
1
Semiannual
Brake
System
0143-2
Fitting will
not purge
old lubricant
TM 9-2320-339-10
0143
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
adjusters (four fittings per axle) with
GAA. (WP 0145, Table 9)
SLACK ADJUSTER
LUBE FITTING
BRAKE CAMSHAFT
LUBE FITTING
Figure 1.
NOTE
When vehicle is operating
under severe conditions,
lubricate propeller shafts
and universal joints every
50 hours of vehicle
operation.
0143-3
out of component.
TM 9-2320-339-10
0143
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Procedure
Use the proper lubricant
to purge all four bearing
seals of each universal
joint. This flushes
abrasive contaminants
from each bearing and
assures all four bearings
are filled properly. Pop
the seals, these seals are
made to be popped.
If any seals fail to purge,
move propeller shaft from
side-to-side while
applying gun pressure.
This allows greater
clearance on thrust end of
bearing that is not
purging. If seals still do
not purge, rock vehicle by
releasing the parking
brake, start engine, put
transmission in D (drive)
or R (reverse), and allow
vehicle to roll. This
removes the windup in
the drive line and allows
for a greater clearance on
the thrust end of the
universal joint.
Because of the design of
the universal joint seal,
there will occasionally be
one or more bearing
seals of a joint that may
not purge. If this occurs,
notify field level
maintenance.
0143-4
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
TM 9-2320-339-10
0143
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Procedure
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Semiannual
Propeller
Shafts
and UJoints
0143-5
Fitting will
not purge
old lubricant
out of component.
TM 9-2320-339-10
0143
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
U-JOINT
CROSS
FITTING
SPLINE
FITTING
SPLINE
FITTING
U-JOINT
CROSS
FITTING
TRANSMISSION/TRANSFER
CASE PROPELLER SHAFT
AND U-JOINTS
Figure 2.
a. Complete the following when
lubricating the spline end of
the propeller shafts:
0143-6
Fitting will
not purge
old lubricant
out of component.
TM 9-2320-339-10
0143
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
until lubricant appears at
pressure relief hole.
(2) Cover pressure relief
hole with finger and continue adding grease until
it appears at sleeve yoke
seal.
Semiannual
Steering
System
0143-7
Damage or
wear
present. Fitting will not
purge old lubricant out
of component.
TM 9-2320-339-10
0143
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
STEERING
GEAR BOX
STEERING SHAFT
UNIVERSAL JOINTS
STEERING
GEAR BOX
STEERING
COLUMN
LINKAGE
STEERING SHAFT
BEARING
Figure 3.
2. Lubricate steering shaft bearing
(four fittings) with GAA. (WP
0145, Table 9)
Fitting will
not purge
old lubricant
out of component.
Fitting will
not purge
old lubricant
out of component.
0143-8
TM 9-2320-339-10
0143
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
FRONT SUSPENSION
HANGER NOT SHOWN
FOR CLARITY
MASTER STEERING
GEAR LUBE FITTING
Figure 4.
NOTE
The top trunnion bearing
should be given 10 to 12
strokes with a grease gun
through existing fitting.
The plug below the
bottom should
temporarily be removed
and a grease fitting
installed. The lower
trunnion bearing should
be lubricated with 10 to
12 strokes from a grease
0143-9
TM 9-2320-339-10
0143
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
gun. The grease fitting
should then be removed
and the plug reinstalled.
4. Lubricate axles No. 1 and No. 2
trunnion bearings with GAA. (WP
0145, Table 9)
AXLE NO. 1
LUBE
FITTINGS
TRUNNION BEARINGS
(DRIVER SIDE)
Figure 5.
0143-10
Fitting will
not purge
old lubricant
out of component.
TM 9-2320-339-10
0143
Item
No.
Interval
Semiannual
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Battery
Electrical
System
Procedure
SLAVE
RECEPTACLE
Figure 6.
5
Semiannual
Mirror Assembly
LUBE 4
LOCATIONS
Figure 7.
0143-11
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
TM 9-2320-339-10
0143
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
NOTE
Pintle hook plate lubrication
fitting can be on any side.
6
Semiannual
Pintle
Hook
Fitting will
not purge
old lubricant
out of component.
Figure 8.
7
Semiannual
Self-Recovery
Winch
1. Unreel, (WP 0093) clean, and lubricate cable with OE/HDO. (WP
0145, Table 7)
2. Lubricate front and rear cable
tensioner rollers (three fittings
per tensioner) with GAA. (WP
0145, Table 9)
0143-12
Fitting will
not purge
old lubricant
out of component.
TM 9-2320-339-10
0143
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Procedure
Figure 9.
3. Lubricate pivot points and pressure rollers with OE/HDO. (WP
0145, Table 8)
0143-13
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
TM 9-2320-339-10
0143
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
Fitting will
not purge
old lubricant
out of component.
LUBE
FITTING
Figure 10.
5. Lubricate front cable guide (four
fittings) with GAA. (WP 0145, Table 9)
0143-14
Fitting will
not purge
old lubricant
TM 9-2320-339-10
0143
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
out of component.
LUBE
FITTINGS
FRONT CABLE
GUIDE
LUBE
FITTINGS
Figure 11.
0143-15
TM 9-2320-339-10
0144
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
MONTHLY - PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE
INITIAL SETUP:
Tools and Special Tools
Gloves, Welders
None
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
WARNING
WARNING
0144-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
0144
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
NOTE
Lubrication intervals are
for normal operating
conditions. Intervals may
be shortened as required
for severe operating
conditions.
Clean all lubrication
points with cleaning
compound, solvent and
allow to dry prior to
servicing.
When using a grease
gun, apply lubricant to the
fitting until clean lubricant
squeezes out of the part
being lubricated.
Always refer to lubrication
instructions (WP 0145) to
ensure equipment has
correct lubricants
appropriate to operating
environment (expected
continuous
temperatures). If not,
remove/drain and
reapply/refill equipment
with appropriate
lubricants for operating
environment as
prescribed in lubrication
instructions. (WP 0145)
1
Monthly
Damage
And Cor-
0144-2
Any broken,
cracked,
bent frame
TM 9-2320-339-10
0144
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
rosion
Check
Monthly
Lubricate
Oilcan
Points
rails, crossmembers,
or screws
are found.
1. Lubricate cabin door latching
mechanisms and hinges with
OE/HDO. (WP 0145)
2. Lubricate all side panel and engine cover hinges, locks, and
latches with OE/HDO. (WP
0145)
NOTE
Steady illumination of the arctic engine heater indicator
light indicates proper operation.
3
Monthly
Arctic Engine
Heater
0144-3
TM 9-2320-339-10
0144
Procedure
INTERAXLE
8X8
B.O.
LIGHTS
EXHAUST
LER LY
TRAI SUPPKING
AINOTR FORMIDPARLAND
SUPPLY
PULL TO
B.O.
SELECT
P U SH T O
INDICATOR
LIGHT
AlTranlissmisonsion
er
ARCTIC
HEATER
ON/OFF
SWITCH
Prehe
at
Interval
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Engin
e
Item
No.
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Figure 1.
2. Visually check all fuel lines for
leaks, cuts, loose clamps, and
other obvious damage.
0144-4
Any Class
III leak.
TM 9-2320-339-10
0144
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
ARCTIC
ENGINE
HEATER
CLAMP
EXHAUST
PIPE
INTAKE
PORT
FUEL PICK
UP PIPE
FUEL
LINE
HOSE
CLAMPS
FUEL
METERING
PUMP
CLAMP
Figure 2.
3. Visually check intake port and exhaust pipe for blockage.
4. Check water pump for unusual
noise.
0144-5
TM 9-2320-339-10
0144
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
HOSE
ARCTIC ENGINE
HEATER
CLAMP
HOSE
CLAMP
WATER PUMP
Figure 3.
5. Check coolant hoses at arctic engine heater for leaks, cuts, loose
hose clamps, and other obvious
damage.
Any Class
III leak.
Any Class
III leak.
0144-6
TM 9-2320-339-10
0144
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
ARTIC ENGINE
HEATER COOLANT
FITTINGS
Figure 4.
7. Run arctic engine heater for a
minimum of 15 minutes at least
once a month.
CAUTION
DO NOT lubricate B GRAVITY receptacle. Fuel contamination may occur. Failure to
comply may result in damage
to equipment.
4
Monthly
Fuel
Tank
Module
0144-7
TM 9-2320-339-10
0144
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Procedure
HAV HAND
ACTUATED CONTROL
REEL
CRANK
HANDLE BEARINGS
PUMP
ENGAGMENT
LEVER
HOSE GUIDE
ROLLER
AXLES
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
REWIND
GEARS
B GRAVITY
RECEPTACLE
(SEE CAUTION)
STATIC DISCHARGE
LINE REELS
MC MANUAL
CONTROL EM
VALVE LEVER
Figure 5.
a. Lubricate HAV Hand actuated control reel ratchet
mechanism with OE/HDO.
(WP 0145, Table 8)
0144-8
TM 9-2320-339-10
0144
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Procedure
HAV HAND
ACTIVATED
CONTROL REEL
RATCHET
MECHANISM
Figure 6.
b. Lubricate pump engagement
lever lubrication points with
OE/HDO. (WP 0145, Table
8)
0144-9
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
TM 9-2320-339-10
0144
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Procedure
OILCAN
LUBE
POINTS
PUMP
ENGAGEMENT
LEVER
Figure 7.
c.
0144-10
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
TM 9-2320-339-10
0144
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Procedure
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
REWIND GEARS
CRANK HANDLE
BEARING
LUBE LIFTING
HOSE
GUIDE
ROLLERS
V15 DRAIN VALVE
(FILTER SEPARATOR)
Figure 8.
d. Lubricate V15 drain valve (filter separator) handle with
OE/HDO. (WP 0145)
e. Lubricate driver side and
passenger side fuel hose
reel crank handle bearings
(one fitting one each reel)
with GAA. (WP 0145)
f.
0144-11
Fitting will
not purge
old lubricant
out of component.
TM 9-2320-339-10
0144
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
with light coating of GAA.
(WP 0145)
g. Lubricate static discharge
line reels (two total) pawl and
ratchet mechanism with OE/
HDO. (WP 0145)
RATCHET
MECHANISM
PAWL
Figure 9.
h. Lubricate MC manual control
EM valve lever:
0144-12
TM 9-2320-339-10
0144
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
MC MANUAL CONTROL EM
VALVE LEVER
OILCAN POINTS
Figure 10.
(1) Lubricate pivot points
with OE/HDO. (WP
0145)
(2) Lubricate sliding points
of lever and linkage with
OE/HDO. (WP 0145)
0144-13
TM 9-2320-339-10
0144
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
WARNING
Monthly
Self-Recovery
Winch
(SRW)
0144-14
TM 9-2320-339-10
0144
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Procedure
REAR
TENSIONER
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
SELF-RECOVERY
WINCH
FRONT
TENSIONER
Figure 11.
3. Inspect front cable guide for any
loose or missing parts and any
obvious damage.
0144-15
Front cable
guide has
loose/missing parts or
TM 9-2320-339-10
0144
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
is unserviceable.
4. Inspect front tensioner for loose
or missing parts and any obvious
damage.
Rear cable
guide has
loose/missing parts or
is unserviceable.
NOTE
Gas particulate filter unit must
be in operation to perform the
following checks.
6
Monthly
Gas Particulate
Filter Unit
(GPFU)
0144-16
Heater does
not operate/
operates
abnormally
and GPFU
is required
for mission.
TM 9-2320-339-10
0144
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
HOSE CLAMP
HOSE
CLAMP
HOSES
Figure 12.
2. Disconnect two air duct breakaway sockets from mount and
feel for airflow.
No airflow
or not
enough airflow and
GPFU is required for
mission.
Heater is inoperative
and GPFU
is required
for mission.
Hoses cut,
torn, or
damaged
and GPFU
0144-17
TM 9-2320-339-10
0144
Item
No.
Interval
Item to
be
Checked
or
Serviced
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
Procedure
is required
for mission.
5. Make sure hose clamps are secure.
Monthly
Rifle
Stowage
Mount
TOP
MOUNT
HANDLE
LOWER
MOUNT
Figure 13.
2. Check handle for excessive
looseness or binding.
0144-18
Clamps
loose and
GPFU is required for
mission.
TM 9-2320-339-10
0144
Item
No.
Interval
Monthly
Machine
Gun Operator's
Platform
Support
Monthly
Machine
Gun Operator's
Platform
Check machine gun operator's platform for cracks, loose or broken leg,
missing or broken tie down strap.
10
Monthly
Ring
Mount
11
Monthly
M-13 Decontamination
Unit
12
Monthly
M-8
Chemical
Alarm
13
Monthly
Radio
Procedure
0144-19
Equipment
Not Ready/
Available If:
TM 9-2320-339-10
CHAPTER 5
MAINTENANCE
INSTRUCTIONS
TM 9-2320-339-10
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
LUBRICATION INSTRUCTIONS
INITIAL SETUP:
Not Applicable
WARNING
Adhesives, solvents, and sealing compounds can burn easily, can give
off harmful vapors, and are harmful to skin and clothing. Keep away from
open fire and use in well-ventilated area. If adhesive, solvent, or sealing
compound gets on skin or clothing, wash immediately with soap and water. Failure to comply may result in injury or death to personnel.
NOTE
The lowest level of maintenance authorized to lubricate a specific
point is indicated by where that lubrication point falls within the PMCS
tables. Operator/crew are only authorized to lubricate those points
within the operator PMCS tables. Field level maintenance personnel
are authorized to lubricate all points regardless of which tables
(operator or field level) those lubrication points are listed.
Refer to PMCS tables for specific lubrication points and localized
views.
Lubrication intervals are for normal operating conditions. Intervals
may be shortened as required for severe operating conditions.
Clean all lubrication points with cleaning compound, solvent and
allow to dry prior to servicing.
When using a grease gun, apply lubricant to the fitting until clean
lubricant squeezes out of the part being lubricated.
After a thorough high pressure washing, lubricate all grease fittings
and oil can points outside and underneath vehicle.
0145-1
0145
TM 9-2320-339-10
0145
Item
Engine Oil
(with filter
change)
Capacitie
s
Expected
Temperat
ures
Above
+15F (-9
C)
Expected
Temperat
ures
+40 to -15
F
(+4 to -26
C)
Expected
Temperat
ures
Desert
+40 to -50 Condition
F
s
(+4 to -46
C)
Interval
42 qt.
(39.73 L)
OE/
HDO-15W
/40
MILPRF-2104
OE/
HDO-15W/
40
MILPRF-2104
or
OEA
MILPRF-4616
7
(Notes 1
and 2)
OE/
HDO-15W/
40
MILPRF-2104
or
OEA
MILPRF-4616
7
(Notes 1
and 2)
OE/
HDO-40
MILPRF-2104
A-Annual
(1 year)
OE/
HDO-15W
/40
MILPRF-2104
OE/
HDO-15W/
40
MILPRF-2104
or
OEA
MILPRF-4616
7
(Notes 1
and 2)
OE/
HDO-15W/
40
MILPRF-2104
or
OEA
MILPRF-4616
7
(Notes 1
and 2)
OE/
HDO-40
MILPRF-2104
A-Annual
(1 year)
0145-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
0145
Item
Capacitie
s
Expected
Temperat
ures
Above
+15F (-9
C)
Expected
Temperat
ures
+40 to -15
F
(+4 to -26
C)
Expected
Temperat
ures
Desert
+40 to -50 Condition
F
s
(+4 to -46
C)
Interval
NOTE
1. OEA must be used when temperatures are consistently below 0F (-18C).
2. OE/HDO-15W/40 must be used when temperatures are consistently above 0F
(-18C).
Item
Capacities
Transmission Oil
(with filter
change)
40 qt. (37.84
L)
OE/
HDO-15W/
40
MILPRF-2104
OE/
HDO-15W/
40
MILPRF-2104
(Note 2)
OE/
HDO-15W/
40
MILPRF-2104
(Note 2)
A-Annual
(1 year)
OE/
HDO-15W/
40
MILPRF-2104
OE/
HDO-15W/
40
MILPRF-2104
(Note 2)
OE/
HDO-15W/
40
MILPRF-2104
(Note 2)
A-Annual
(1 year)
OE/
HDO-15W/
40
MILPRF-2104
OE/
HDO-15W/
40
MILPRF-2104
or
OE/
HDO-15W/
40
MILPRF-2104
or
A-Annual
(1 year)
Transfer
Case
0145-3
Interval
TM 9-2320-339-10
0145
Item
Capacities
Expected
Expected
Expected
Temperatur
Temperatur Temperatur
es
es
es
+40 to -50F
Above +15 +40 to -15F
(+4 to -46
F (-9C)
(+4 to -26C )
C)
Interval
OEA
OEA
MILMILPRF-46167
PRF-46167
(Notes 1 and (Notes 1 and
2)
2)
All Other
Transmission
and Transfer
Case
Lubrication
Points
As Required
GAA
MILPRF-10924
GAA
MILPRF-10924
(Note 2)
GAA
MILPRF-10924
(Note 2)
As Required
(Note 3)
NOTE
1. OE/HDO-15W/40 must be used when temperatures are consistently above 0F
(-18C).
2. Refer to FM 9-207 (WP 0157) for arctic operation.
3. Refer to PMCS tables for specific lubrication intervals.
Item
Capacities
Axle 1
17.5 qt.
(16.56 L)
Expected
Expected
Expected
Temperatur Temperatur
Temperatur
es
es
es
+40 to -15F +40 to -50F
Above +15
(+4 to -26
(+4 to -46
F (-9C)
C)
C)
GO-85W/
140
MILPRF-2105
GO-85W/
140
MILPRF-2105
or
GO-80W/90
0145-4
GO-80W/90
MILPRF-2105
or
GO-75
Interval
B-Bienniel
(2 Years)
(Note 4)
TM 9-2320-339-10
0145
Item
Capacities
Expected
Expected
Expected
Temperatur Temperatur
Temperatur
es
es
es
+40 to -15F +40 to -50F
Above +15
(+4 to -26
(+4 to -46
F (-9C)
C)
C)
Interval
MILMILPRF-2105
PRF-2105
(Notes 1 and (Notes 2 and
3)
3)
Axle 2
(and Power
Divider)
21.5 qt.
(20.34 L)
GO-85W/
140
MILPRF-2105
GO-85W/
GO-80W/90
140
MILMILPRF-2105
PRF-2105
or
or
GO-75
GO-80W/90
MILMILPRF-2105
PRF-2105 (Notes 2 and
(Notes 1 and
3)
3)
B-Bienniel
(2 Years)
(Note 4)
Axle 3
(and Power
Divider)
21 qt. (19.87
L)
GO-85W/
140
MILPRF-2105
GO-85W/
GO-80W/90
140
MILMILPRF-2105
PRF-2105
or
or
GO-75
GO-80W/90
MILMILPRF-2105
PRF-2105 (Notes 2 and
(Notes 1 and
3)
3)
B-Bienniel
(2 Years)
(Note 4)
Axle 4
16.5 qt.
(15.61 L)
GO-85W/
140
MILPRF-2105
GO-85W/
GO-80W/90
140
MILMILPRF-2105
PRF-2105
or
or
GO-75
GO-80W/90
MILMILPRF-2105
PRF-2105 (Notes 2 and
(Notes 1 and
3)
3)
B-Bienniel
(2 Years)
(Note 4)
0145-5
TM 9-2320-339-10
0145
Item
Capacities
Oil Lubed
Wheel
Bearings
N/A
GO-85W/
140
MILPRF-2105
All Other
Axle
Lubrication
Points
As Required
GAA
MILPRF-10924
GO-85W/
GO-80W/90
140
MILMILPRF-2105
PRF-2105
or
or
GO-75
GO-80W/90
MILMILPRF-2105
PRF-2105 (Notes 2 and
(Notes 1 and
3)
3)
GAA
MILPRF-10924
(Note 3)
GAA
MILPRF-10924
(Note 3)
Interval
B-Bienniel
(2 Years)
As Required
(Note 5)
NOTE
1. GO-85W/140 must be used when temperatures are consistently above 30F (-1
C).
2. GO-85W/90 must be used when temperatures are consistently above -15F (-26
C).
3. Refer to FM 9-207 (WP 0157) for arctic operation.
4. An initial lubrication change on new or rebuilt axles should occur between 500
mi. (805 km) and 1,000 miles (1 609 km). Refer to Field Level Annual PMCS for
more information.
5. Refer to PMCS tables for specific lubrication intervals.
0145-6
TM 9-2320-339-10
0145
Item
Capacities
Hydraulic
Reservoir
153.5 qt.
(145.21 L)
Expected
Expected
Expected
Temperatur Temperatur
Temperatur
es
es
es
+40 to -15F +40 to -50F
Above +15
(+4 to -26
(+4 to -46
F (-9C)
C)
C)
OE/HDO-10
MILPRF-2104
or
OE/HDO-30
MILPRF-2104
(Note 1)
OE/HDO-10
MILPRF-2104
(Note 2)
OEA
MILPRF-46167
(Notes 2 and
3)
Interval
A-Annual
(1 year)
NOTE
1. OE/HDO-30 must be used only when temperatures are consistently above 60F
(16C).
2. Refer to FM 9-207 (WP 0157) for arctic operation.
3. OEA must be used when temperatures are consistently below 0F (-18C).
Item
Capacities
Antifreeze
(CID AA-52624)
(Note 1)
58.5 qt.
(55.34 L)
Expected
Expected
Expected
Temperatur Temperatur
Temperatur
es
es
es
+40 to -15F +40 to -50F
Above +15
(+4 to -26
(+4 to -46
F (-9C)
C)
C)
58.5 qt.
58.5 qt.
(55.34 L)
(55.34 L)
50% Ethyl50% Ethylene Glycol
ene Glycol
Type IC (Re- Type IC (Recycled)
cycled)
(Notes 1 and (Notes 1 and
2)
2)
0145-7
58.5 qt.
(55.34 L)
60% Ethylene Glycol
Arctic Type
IB (Recycled)
(Notes 1, 2,
and 3)
Interval
A-Annual
(1 year)
(Note 4)
TM 9-2320-339-10
0145
Item
Capacities
Antifreeze
(CID AA-52624)
(Note 1)
58.5 qt.
(55.34 L)
29.5 qt.
(27.91 L)
100% Ethylene Glycol
Type IA (Recycled)
plus
29 qt. (27.43
L) water
(Notes 1 and
5)
29.5 qt.
35.1 qt. (33.2
(27.91 L)
L)
100% Ethyl- 100% Ethylene Glycol
ene Glycol
Type IA (Re- Type IA (Recycled)
cycled)
plus
plus
29 qt. (27.43
23.4 qt.
L) water
(22.14 L) wa(Notes 1 and
ter
5)
(Notes 1, 3,
and 6)
A-Annual
(1 year)
(Note 4)
Antifreeze
(CID AA-52624)
(Note 1)
58.5 qt.
(55.34 L)
29.5 qt.
(27.91 L)
100%
100% Propylene Glycol
Type IIA (virgin)
plus
29 qt. (27.43
L) water
(Notes 1 and
7)
29.5 qt.
(27.91 L)
100% Propylene Glycol
Type IIA (virgin)
plus
29 qt. (27.43
L) water
(Notes 1 and
7)
A-Annual
(1 year)
(Note 4)
(Note 1)
(Note 1)
Interval
NOTE
1. Refer to TB 750-651 (WP 0157) for more information on antifreeze and additives
used in the HEMTT series vehicle engine cooling system, and TM 750-254 (WP
0157) for detailed instructions for draining, cleaning, and flushing cooling systems
of tactical vehicles.
0145-8
TM 9-2320-339-10
0145
Item
Capacities
Expected
Expected
Expected
Temperatur Temperatur
Temperatur
es
es
es
+40 to -15F +40 to -50F
Above +15
(+4 to -26
(+4 to -46
F (-9C)
C)
C)
Interval
2. Type 1C (normal) and Type 1B (arctic) antifreeze is premixed, and DOES NOT
REQUIRE the addition of water. Never add water or inhibitor to Type IB antifreeze.
3. Refer to FM 9-207 (WP 0157) for arctic operation.
4. Engine coolant contaminant level is checked annually. Engine coolant does not
need to be changed until it fails check.
5. A mixture of 50% Ethylene Glycol (EG) antifreeze to 50% water will provide freeze
protection down to -34F (-37C).
6. A mixture of 50% Propylene Glycol (PG) antifreeze to 50% water will provide
freeze protection down to -27F (-33C).
7. A mixture of 60% Ethylene Glycol (EG) antifreeze to 40% water will provide freeze
protection down to -62F (-52C).
8. A mixture of 60% Propylene Glycol (PG) antifreeze to 40% water will provide
freeze protection down to -56F (-49C).
Item
Capacities
Tire Carrier
Pump
(Note 1)
Expected
Expected
Expected
Temperatur Temperatur
Temperatur
es
es
es
+40 to -15F +40 to -50F
Above +15
(+4 to -26
(+4 to -46
F (-9C)
C)
C)
OE/HDO-10
MILPRF-2104
OE/HDO-10
MILPRF-2104
(Note 2)
OEA
MILPRF-46167
(Note 2)
Interval
S-Semiannual (WP
0143)
(6 Months)
(Note 3)
NOTE
1. Refer to tire carrier hydraulic system fill for information on servicing tire carrier
pump.
2. Refer to FM 9-207 (WP 0157) for arctic operation.
0145-9
TM 9-2320-339-10
0145
Item
Capacities
Expected
Expected
Expected
Temperatur Temperatur
Temperatur
es
es
es
+40 to -15F +40 to -50F
Above +15
(+4 to -26
(+4 to -46
F (-9C)
C)
C)
Interval
Item
Capacities
Self-Recovery Winch
Gearbox
(Note 1)
2 qt. (1.89 L)
GO-85W/
140
MILPRF-2105
GO-75
MILPRF-2105
or
GO-80W/90
MILPRF-2105
(Note 2)
GO-75
MILPRF-2105
(Note 2)
A-Annual
(1 year)
Winch Cable
As Required
OE/HDO-30
MILPRF-2104
OE/HDO-10
MILPRF-2104
(Note 1)
OEA
MILPRF-46167
(Note 1)
S-Semiannual (WP
0143)
(6 Months)
All Other
Self-Recovery Winch
Lubrication
Points
As Required
GAA
MILPRF-10924
GAA
MILPRF-10924
(Note 2)
GAA
MILPRF-10924
(Note 2)
As Required
(Note 3)
NOTE
1. Pre-lubricated from manufacturer.
2. Refer to FM 9-207 (WP 0157) for arctic operation.
0145-10
Interval
TM 9-2320-339-10
0145
Item
Capacities
Expected
Expected
Expected
Temperatur Temperatur
Temperatur
es
es
es
+40 to -15F +40 to -50F
Above +15
(+4 to -26
(+4 to -46
F (-9C)
C)
C)
Interval
Capacities
As Required
Expected
Temperatures
Above +15F
(-9C)
Expected
Temperatures
+40 to -15F
(+4 to -26C )
Expected
Temperatures
+40 to -50F
(+4 to -46C )
OE/HDO-30
MIL-PRF-2104
OE/HDO-10
MIL-PRF-2104
(Note 1)
OEA
MIL-PRF-46167
(Note 1)
Intervals
As Required
(Note 2)
NOTE
1. Refer to FM 9-207 (WP 0157) for arctic operation.
2. Refer to PMCS tables for specific oilcan lubrication intervals.
Item
Capacities
Brake Cam
Slack Adjusters
As Required
GAA
MILPRF-10924
GAA
MILPRF-10924
(Note 1)
GAA
MILPRF-10924
(Note 1)
S-Semiannual (WP
0143)
(6 Months)
Fuel Service
Module
As Required
GAA
GAA
MILPRF-10924
GAA
MILPRF-10924
As Required
(Note 3)
0145-11
Interval
TM 9-2320-339-10
0145
Item
Capacities
Components
Expected
Expected
Expected
Temperatur
Temperatur
Temperatur
es
es
es
+40 to -15F
Above +15
+40 to -50F
(+4 to -26
F (-9C)
(+4 to -46C )
C)
Interval
MILPRF-10924
(Note 1)
(Note 1)
As Required
GAA
MILPRF-10924
GAA
MILPRF-10924
(Note 1)
GAA
MILPRF-10924
(Note 1)
W-Weekly
(WP 0142)
S-Semiannual (WP
0143)
(6 Months)
(service fittings)
Propeller
As Required
Driver
Shafts
and U-Joints
GAA
MILPRF-10924
GAA
MILPRF-10924
(Note 1)
GAA
MILPRF-10924
(Note 1)
S-Semiannual (WP
0143)
(6 Months)
(Note 2)
GAA
MILPRF-10924
GAA
MILPRF-10924
(Note 1)
GAA
MILPRF-10924
(Note 1)
S-Semiannual (WP
0143)
(6 Months)
Pintle Hook
Steering
System
As Required
NOTE
1. Refer to FM 9-207 (WP 0157) for arctic operation.
2. When vehicle is operating under severe conditions, lubricate propeller shafts and
universal joints every 50 hours of vehicle operation.
3. Refer to PMCS tables for specific lubrication intervals.
0145-12
TM 9-2320-339-10
0145
Capacities
As Required
Expected
Temperature
SD All Temperatures
(Note 2)
Intervals
As Required
NOTE
1. After a thorough high pressure washing, lubricate all grease fittings and oil can
points outside and underneath vehicle.
2. Refer to FM 9-207 (WP 0157) for arctic operation.
0145-13
TM 9-2320-339-10
0146
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
CLOSE/OPEN HEATER VALVES
INITIAL SETUP:
Equipment Condition
Engine OFF. (WP 0056)
NOTE
Closing two heater valves will improve the efficiency of the cabin air
conditioning.
Closing two heater valves will disable cabin heat.
Heater valve knob is located on rear passenger side of engine.
1. Turn heater valve knob (1) counterclockwise to close.
Figure 1.
NOTE
Heater valve knob is located towards bottom of front passenger side of
engine.
0146-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
0146
Figure 2.
END OF TASK
OPEN HEATER VALVES
NOTE
Opening two heater valves will diminish efficiency of air conditioning
kit.
Opening two heater valves will enable cabin heat.
Heater valve knob is located on rear passenger side of engine.
1. Turn heater valve knob (1) clockwise to close.
0146-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
0146
Figure 3.
NOTE
Heater valve knob is located towards bottom of front passenger side of
engine.
2. Turn heater valve knob (2) clockwise to close.
Figure 4.
END OF TASK
0146-3
TM 9-2320-339-10
FOLLOW-ON MAINTENANCE
1. Close passenger side engine cover. (WP 0154)
2. Remove wheel chocks.
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0146-4
0146
TM 9-2320-339-10
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
PRE/POST TOWING PROCEDURE (FRONT LIFT ONLY)
INITIAL SETUP:
Tools and Special Tools
Chain, 8 ft. (supplied by wrecker)
Chain, 7 ft. (supplied by wrecker) (WP
0158, Table 3, Item 6)
Equipment Condition
Engine OFF. (WP 0056)
CAUTION
When installing axle restraint chains, route chains so hoses or lines are
not between frame and chain or axle and chain. Failure to comply may
result in damage to equipment.
NOTE
This procedure is applicable to preparation for towing a HEMTT
series vehicle from the front ONLY (refer to tow HEMTT-front lift for
further information).
If disabled vehicle is either a BASE or A2 model HEMTT series
vehicle (refer to data plate on inside of driver side door), complete
Step (1).
If disabled vehicle is an A4 model HEMTT series vehicle (refer to data
plate on inside of driver side door), skip to Step (2).
1. Perform the following on disabled vehicle:
a. Remove propeller shaft between transfer case and No. 3 axle.
b. Install axle restraint chains (1):
0147-1
0147
TM 9-2320-339-10
0147
4
Figure 1.
NOTE
Axle restraint chains are installed the same way, driver side
shown.
(1) Route axle restraint chain (1) over frame rail (2) and around axle (3) beside
walking beam (4).
(2) Hook axle restraint chain (1) back into itself.
(3) Repeat Steps (1) and (2) for opposite side of No. 2 axle (3).
CAUTION
When installing axle restraint chains, route chain around frame rail and
axle only. Do not wrap chain around lateral torque rod, shock absorber,
shift cables, etc. as they could be crushed. Route chains so hoses or lines
are not between frame and chain or axle and chain. Failure to comply
may result in damage to equipment.
NOTE
This procedure is applicable to preparation for towing a HEMTT
series vehicle from the front ONLY (refer to tow HEMTT-front lift for
further information).
If disabled vehicle is an A4 model HEMTT series vehicle (refer to data
plate on inside of driver side door), complete Step (2).
2. Perform the following on disabled vehicle:
0147-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
0147
Figure 2.
NOTE
Axle restraint chains are installed the same way, driver side
shown.
(1) Route axle restraint chain (1) under engine shroud (2), over frame rail (3), and
around axle (4).
(2) Hook axle restraint chain (1) back into itself as shown.
(3) Repeat Steps (1) and (2) for opposite side of No. 2 axle (3).
END OF TASK
0147-3
TM 9-2320-339-10
0147
NOTE
This post towing procedure is applicable to a HEMTT series vehicle
that has been towed from the front ONLY (refer to tow HEMTT-front
lift for further information).
If disabled vehicle is either a BASE or A2 model HEMTT series
vehicle (refer to data plate on inside of driver side door), complete
Step (1).
If disabled vehicle is an A4 model HEMTT series vehicle (refer to data
plate on inside of driver side door), skip to Step (2).
1. Perform the following to disabled vehicle:
a. Remove two axle restraint chains (1) from around frame rails (2) and No. 2 axle (3).
2
Figure 3.
b. Return two axle restraint chains (1) to wrecker stowage.
c.
NOTE
This post towing procedure is applicable to a HEMTT series vehicle
that has been towed from the front ONLY (refer to tow HEMTT-front
lift for further information).
If disabled vehicle is an A4 model HEMTT series vehicle (refer to data
plate on inside of driver side door), complete Step (2).
2. Perform the following to disabled vehicle:
a. Remove two axle restraint chains (1) from under engine shroud (2), around frame
rail (3), and No. 2 axle (4).
0147-4
TM 9-2320-339-10
2
3
Figure 4.
b. Return two axle restraint chains (1) to wrecker stowage.
c.
END OF TASK
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0147-5
0147
TM 9-2320-339-10
0148
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
CLEAN VEHICLE
INITIAL SETUP:
Materials/Parts
Rag, Wiping (WP 0160, Table 1, Item
50)
Equipment Condition
Engine OFF. (WP 0056)
Wheels chocked. (WP 0073)
CLEAN EXTERIOR
CAUTION
Do not wipe dirt off vehicle when vehicle is dry. Dirt, stones, or debris may
scratch and damage vehicle.
NOTE
After a thorough high pressure washing, lubricate all grease fittings and
oil can points outside and underneath vehicle (refer to lubrication instructions (WP 0145) for more information).
1. Wash vehicle often with cool or warm water. Do not use strong detergent or abrasives.
Figure 1.
2. While cleaning vehicle, look closely for rust, corrosion, bare metal, or other damage.
Report any damage to Field Level Maintenance.
END OF TASK
CLEAN INTERIOR
1. Remove loose dirt and dust from cab interior components (1).
0148-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
0148
1
3
2
Figure 2.
2. Clean seat cushions (2) and seatbelts (3) with warm soapy water. Do not use abrasives
or solvents.
3. Wipe seat cushions (2) and seatbelts (3) dry.
END OF TASK
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0148-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
0149
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
CHANGE WHEEL AND TIRE ASSEMBLY
INITIAL SETUP:
Tools and Special Tools
Chocks, Wheel (4) (WP 0158, Table 3,
Item 8)
Extension, Handle (WP 0158, Table 3,
Item 15)
Handle, Wrench (WP 0158, Table 3,
Item 18)
Jack, 12-ton, With Handle (WP 0158,
Table 3, Item 21)
Jack, Base Plate (WP 0158, Table 3,
Item 26)
PREPARE VEHICLE
1. Shut off engine. (WP 0056)
WARNING
Park vehicle in safe area, out of traffic, where there is no danger to personnel changing tire assembly. Park vehicle on hard level ground. Failure
to comply may result in injury or death to personnel.
2. Turn on emergency flashers. (WP 0072)
3. Set up emergency marker kit, as necessary. (WP 0106)
END OF TASK
REMOVE SPARE WHEEL AND TIRE ASSEMBLY FROM TIRE CARRIER
NOTE
This procedure is a two soldier task.
0149-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
0149
Figure 1.
3. While assistant steadies spare wheel and tire assembly, lower tire carrier (WP 0040)
until completely clear of spare wheel and tire assembly.
4. With aid of an assistant, roll spare wheel and tire assembly to vehicle near flat wheel
and tire assembly, and lean spare wheel and tire assembly against vehicle.
5. Check spare wheel and tire assembly air pressure.
6. Service spare wheel and tire assembly as required. (WP 0152)
END OF TASK
0149-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
0149
CAUTION
Jack placement is critical to avoid damaging vehicle suspension components. Follow jack placement notes and procedures carefully. Failure to
comply may result in damage to equipment.
NOTE
If wheel and tire assembly to be removed is on No. 3 or No. 4 axle,
refer to remove wheel and tire assembly from No. 3 or No. 4 axle.
All wheel and tire assemblies on No. 1 and No. 2 axles are removed
the same. Passenger side No. 1 axle wheel and tire assembly shown.
Jack ram should be fully screwed down (making jack as short as
possible) for Step (3).
3. Check if jack base plate (1) and jack (2) will fit under apex of equalizing beam (3):
Figure 2.
0149-3
TM 9-2320-339-10
0149
3
FORWARD
Figure 3.
NOTE
Position jack 12 in. (30 cm) from end of equalizing beam. The jack
should be centered on apex as shown.
a. If jack base plate (1) and jack (2) fit under apex of equalizing beam (3), skip to Step
(5).
b. If jack base plate (1) and jack (2) DO NOT fit under apex of equalizing beam (3),
continue with Step (4).
4. Drive flat/shredded wheel and tire assembly onto two wheel chocks (4).
0149-4
TM 9-2320-339-10
0149
4
Figure 4.
5. Install two wheel chocks (WP 0073) (4) in front of and behind tire across (on same axle)
from tire and wheel assembly which is being removed.
CAUTION
Jack placement is critical to avoid damaging vehicle suspension components. Follow jack placement notes and procedures carefully. Failure to
comply may result in damage to equipment.
NOTE
Jack ram should be fully screwed down (making jack as short as
possible) for Step (6).
Center jack on apex, 12 in. (30 cm) from end of equalizing beam.
6. Position jack base plate (1) and jack (2) under apex of equalizing beam (3).
0149-5
TM 9-2320-339-10
0149
Figure 5.
3
FORWARD
Figure 6.
NOTE
If possible, unscrew jack ram until it contacts jacking point on equalizing
beam prior to completing Step (7).
7. Raise jack (2) until firm contact is established with apex of equalizing beam (3).
NOTE
Studs and lugnuts on driver side of vehicle have left-hand threads.
Rotate lugnuts clockwise to loosen, counterclockwise to tighten.
Studs and lugnuts on passenger side of vehicle have right-hand
0149-6
TM 9-2320-339-10
0149
5
Figure 7.
NOTE
If wheel chocks were used under flat/shredded wheel and tire assembly
to aid in jack placement, wheel and tire assembly does not have to be
clear of wheel chocks.
9. Raise vehicle until wheel and tire assembly can be removed.
10. Assistant removes and sets 10 lugnuts (5) aside.
NOTE
If wheel chocks were used under flat/shredded wheel and tire assembly
to aid in jack placement, remove them and return to vehicle stowage.
11. Lower vehicle until wheel and tire assembly is just touching ground.
12. Raise vehicle slightly while assistant tilts top of wheel and tire assembly forward. Flat
wheel and tire assembly should move forward.
13. Repeat Steps (11) and (12) to walk wheel and tire assembly off axle studs (6).
0149-7
TM 9-2320-339-10
0149
Figure 8.
14. With aid of an assistant, remove wheel and tire assembly and lean wheel and tire
assembly against vehicle.
END OF TASK
REMOVE WHEEL AND TIRE ASSEMBLY FROM NO. 3 OR NO. 4 AXLE
NOTE
If wheel and tire assembly to be removed is on No. 1 or No. 2 axle,
refer to remove wheel and tire assembly from No. 1 or No. 2 axle.
All wheel and tire assemblies on No. 3 and No. 4 axles are removed
the same. Passenger side No. 4 axle wheel and tire assembly shown.
It may be necessary to drive flat/shredded wheel and tire assembly
onto two wheel chocks in order to fit jack base plate and jack under
transverse beam casting.
1. Service (inflate) vehicle air suspension needs to be serviced (inflated) to perform jacking
procedure.
2. Turn No. 4 axle ball valves OFF to perform jacking procedure.
3. Install two wheel chocks (WP 0073) in front of and behind tire across (on same axle)
from tire and wheel assembly which is being removed.
CAUTION
Jack placement is critical to avoid damaging vehicle suspension components. Follow jack placement notes and procedures carefully. Failure to
comply may result in damage to equipment.
0149-8
TM 9-2320-339-10
0149
NOTE
Position jack directly under flat spot in center of transverse beam casting.
4. Place jack base plate (1) and jack (2) under transverse beam casting (3):
3
4
1
Figure 9.
5. Unscrew jack ram (4) until it is at full extension or contacts transverse beam end casting
(3).
6. Raise jack (2) until firm contact is established with jacking point on transverse beam
end casting (3).
NOTE
Studs and lugnuts on driver side of vehicle have left-hand threads.
Rotate lugnuts clockwise to loosen.
Studs and lugnuts on passenger side of vehicle have right-hand
threads. Rotate lugnuts counterclockwise to loosen.
Loosen lugnuts enough so they can be easily removed once weight
is off wheel and tire assembly, but do not remove them.
7. Assistant loosens 10 lugnuts (5) until they turn easily.
0149-9
TM 9-2320-339-10
0149
5
Figure 10.
NOTE
If wheel chocks were used under flat/shredded wheel and tire assembly
to aid in jack placement, wheel and tire assembly does not have to be
clear of wheel chocks.
8. Raise vehicle until wheel and tire assembly can be removed.
9. Assistant removes and sets 10 lugnuts (5) aside.
NOTE
If wheel chocks were used under flat/shredded wheel and tire assembly
to aid in jack placement, remove them and return to vehicle stowage.
10. Lower vehicle until wheel and tire assembly is just touching ground.
11. Raise vehicle slightly while assistant tilts top of wheel and tire assembly forward. Tire
should move forward.
12. Repeat Steps (10) and (11) to walk wheel and tire assembly off studs (6).
0149-10
TM 9-2320-339-10
0149
Figure 11.
13. With aid of an assistant, remove wheel and tire assembly and lean wheel and tire
assembly against vehicle.
END OF TASK
INSTALL WHEEL AND TIRE ASSEMBLY
NOTE
Tire tread is non-directional. Vehicle operation is not affected by direction
of traction bars.
1. With aid of an assistant, roll wheel and tire assembly (1) up to axle (2).
Figure 12.
0149-11
TM 9-2320-339-10
0149
NOTE
Check that spare wheel and tire assembly wheel dish is in same position
as flat wheel and tire assembly wheel dish. Deep side of wheel dish will
face toward vehicle on four front wheels. Deep side of wheel dish will face
away from vehicle on four rear wheels except M984A4. All eight wheels
on M984A4 are installed with deep side of wheel dish facing toward vehicle.
2. Make sure deep side of spare wheel and tire assembly wheel dish (3) is in same position
as flat/shredded wheel and tire assembly wheel dish when flat/shredded wheel and tire
assembly was removed.
NOTE
Tire valve stem extension must be removed to reposition wheel and
tire assembly valve stem extension.
It may be necessary to reposition valve stem to accomplish
installation of valve stem extension.
3. Make sure wheel and tire assembly valve stem (4) is pointing out, away from vehicle.
0149-12
TM 9-2320-339-10
0149
Figure 13.
4. Line up holes in rim (5) of wheel and tire assembly (1) with studs (6) on axle (2).
5
1
7
6
Figure 14.
0149-13
TM 9-2320-339-10
0149
WARNING
Wheel/tire assembly weighs 540 lbs (245 kg). Do not attempt to lift or
move wheel/tire assembly without the aid of an assistant and a lifting
device. Failure to comply may result in injury or death to personnel.
5. Lean top of wheel and tire assembly (1) against studs (6) and axle (2).
NOTE
Install a lugnut on top stud, and hand-tighten to hold wheel and tire assembly in place.
6. Using handle extension (7), slide spare wheel and tire assembly onto studs (6) while
assistant raises vehicle with jack. Bottom of wheel and tire assembly (1) should swing
toward axle (2).
7. Assistant lowers vehicle until wheel and tire assembly (1) just touches ground.
8. Repeat Steps (5) through (7) until wheel and tire assembly (1) is seated on axle (2) and
studs (6).
NOTE
Studs and lugnuts on driver side of vehicle have left-hand threads.
Rotate lugnuts counterclockwise to tighten.
Studs and lugnuts on passenger side of vehicle have right-hand
threads. Rotate lugnuts clockwise to tighten.
9. Install and tighten 10 lugnuts (8) in order shown using wheel lugnut wrench.
0149-14
TM 9-2320-339-10
0149
START
FINISH
Figure 15.
10. Assistant lowers jack (9) until vehicle weight is fully supported by suspension system.
11. Remove jack (9) and jack base plate (10) from under vehicle.
10
Figure 16.
12. Tighten 10 lugnuts (8) in order shown until they no longer tighten.
0149-15
TM 9-2320-339-10
0149
START
FINISH
Figure 17.
13. Return all tools and equipment to proper stowage boxes.
14. Turn No. 1 or No. 4 axle ball valves ON (WP 0042) (as applicable).
15. Return vehicle to field level maintenance and have lugnuts (8) tightened to torque
requirements as soon as possible.
END OF TASK
STOW FLAT/SHREDDED WHEEL AND TIRE ASSEMBLY
1. With aid of an assistant, roll flat/shredded wheel and tire assembly into position in front
of wheel and tire assembly carrier.
2. While assistant maneuvers flat/shredded wheel and tire assembly, raise and lower
wheel and tire assembly carrier (WP 0040) until wheel and tire assembly carrier
mounting bracket tooth (1) catches rim (2) of spare wheel and tire assembly.
0149-16
TM 9-2320-339-10
0149
Figure 18.
3. Raise tire carrier slightly so weight of flat wheel and tire assembly pulls itself closer to
tire carrier mounting bracket (3) and onto carrier mounting bracket alignment ridges (4).
4. Install and hand-tighten four spare wheel and tire assembly retention screws (5) into
holes provided in tire carrier mounting bracket (3).
5. Securely tighten four spare wheel and tire assembly retention screws (5).
6. Raise tire carrier.
7. Pick up and stow emergency marker kit (as necessary).
END OF TASK
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0149-17
TM 9-2320-339-10
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
CLEAN FUEL TANK STRAINER
INITIAL SETUP:
Materials/Parts
Rag, Wiping (WP 0160, Table 1, Item
50)
Equipment Condition
Engine OFF. (WP 0056)
Wheels chocked. (WP 0073)
WARNING
Fuel is very flammable and can explode easily. Keep fuel away from open
fire and keep fire extinguisher within easy reach when working with fuel.
Do not work on fuel system when engine is hot. Fuel can be ignited when
engine is hot. When working with fuel, post signs that read NO SMOKING
WITHIN 50 FEET OF VEHICLE. Failure to comply may result in injury or
death to personnel.
1. Wipe off dirt from fuel filler cap (1).
Figure 1.
2. Remove fuel filler cap (1).
0150-1
0150
TM 9-2320-339-10
Figure 2.
2. Install and tighten fuel filler cap (1).
END OF TASK
FOLLOW-ON MAINTENANCE
1. Remove wheel chocks.
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0150-2
0150
TM 9-2320-339-10
0151
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
SERVICE AIR CLEANER ELEMENT
INITIAL SETUP:
Tools and Special Tools
Ladder (WP 0158, Table 2, Item 3)
Equipment Condition
Engine OFF. (WP 0056)
Wheels chocked. (WP 0073)
Materials/Parts
Rag, Wiping (WP 0160, Table 1, Item
50)
Figure 1.
2. Remove retaining ring (2) from canister (3).
3. Remove air cleaner element (4) from canister (3).
0151-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
Figure 2.
END OF TASK
CLEAN AIR CLEANER ELEMENT
NOTE
Notify field level maintenance if air cleaner element is damaged or cannot
be cleaned by tapping.
1. Tap side of air cleaner element (4) lightly against hand.
0151-2
0151
TM 9-2320-339-10
Figure 3.
2. Dump out dirt and dust from primary element (4).
3. Wipe air cleaner element (4) with clean rag.
END OF TASK
INSTALL AIR CLEANER ELEMENT
1. Install air cleaner element (4) in canister (3).
0151-3
0151
TM 9-2320-339-10
0151
Figure 4.
2. Position retaining ring (2) over canister (3).
Figure 5.
3. Tighten four knobs (1) to secure retaining ring (2).
4. Start engine. (WP 0043)
5. Push button (5) to reset air cleaner restriction indicator (6). If indicator window (7) shows
VACUUM INCHES H20 below 20, continue with vehicle operation. If indicator window
0151-4
TM 9-2320-339-10
0151
shows VACUUM INCHES H20 above 20, notify Field Level Maintenance as soon as
possible.
CHEM
ALARM
INTER
AXLE
8X8
25
22
15
11
8
6.2
5.5
3.7
2.7
2.0
IN H20 kPa
FILTER MINDER
AUX
HYD
HYD
ENABLE
B.O
SELECT
GPFU
B.O
LIGHTS
PARKING
BRAKE
HIGH
IDLE
1
2
TRAILER
AIR SUPPLY
0
1
2
AIR BRAKE
5
Figure 6.
6. Shut OFF engine. (WP 0056)
END OF TASK
FOLLOW-ON MAINTENANCE
1. Remove wheel chocks.
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0151-5
TM 9-2320-339-10
0152
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
SERVICE TIRES
INITIAL SETUP:
Tools and Special Tools
Gauge, Tire Pressure (WP 0158, Table
3, Item 13)
WARNING
NOTE
There are two types of air pressure gauges. One is a separate handheld
gauge. The other is a combined pressure gauge/inflation hose.
Both may be used to check air pressure in tire.
ALWAYS use combined pressure gauge/inflation hose to inflate tire.
1. Check tire air pressure with tire pressure gauge.
2. Ensure tires have correct air pressure for road conditions and driving speed .
END OF TASK
0152-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
INFLATE TIRE
1. Remove air hose (1) from stowage and connect air hose (1) to quick-disconnect
coupling (2) by pushing back sleeve (3).
0152-2
0152
TM 9-2320-339-10
0152
DRIVER SIDE
(ALL VEHICLES
EXCEPT
M983 AND M984)
PASSENGER SIDE
(ALL VEHICLES
EXCEPT M984)
2
2
DRIVER SIDE
(M983)
PASSENGER SIDE
(M984)
3
1
2
DRIVER SIDE
(M984)
Figure 1.
2. Connect combined pressure gauge/inflation hose (4) to air hose (1).
3. Start engine. (WP 0043)
0152-3
TM 9-2320-339-10
Figure 2.
WARNING
NOTE
Trajectory area as shown applies to all wheel/tire assemblies.
Air chuck must clamp securely with no leaks or air pressure gauge
readings will be inaccurate.
0152-4
0152
TM 9-2320-339-10
0152
There are two types of air pressure gauges. One model is a separate
handheld gauge . The other is a combined pressure gauge/inflation
hose.
Both may be used to check air pressure in tire.
ALWAYS use combined pressure gauge/inflation hose to inflate tire.
5. Push latch handle (7) inward, while pushing air chuck (8) onto valve stem (6). Release
latch handle (7) and immediately step out of the trajectory area and read tire air pressure
gauge.
TRAJECTORY
TRAJECTORY
TRAJECTORY
TRAJECTORY
Figure 3.
WARNING
0152-5
TM 9-2320-339-10
0152
NOTE
Trajectory area as shown applies to all wheel/tire assemblies.
6. Inflate or deflate until proper pressure is attained. Press latch handle (7) and pull air
chuck (8) from valve stem extension (6). Install valve cap (5).
TRAJECTORY
TRAJECTORY
5
TRAJECTORY
TRAJECTORY
Figure 4.
7. Shut OFF engine. (WP 0056)
WARNING
0152-6
TM 9-2320-339-10
0152
DRIVER SIDE
(ALL VEHICLES
EXCEPT
M983 AND M984)
PASSENGER SIDE
(ALL VEHICLES
EXCEPT M984)
2
2
DRIVER SIDE
(M983)
PASSENGER SIDE
(M984)
3
1
2
DRIVER SIDE
(M984)
Figure 5.
9. Hold end of air hose (1) and push sleeve (3) back and remove air hose (1) from quickdisconnect coupling (2).
0152-7
TM 9-2320-339-10
10. Stow air hose (1) and combined pressure gauge/inflation hose (4).
END OF TASK
FOLLOW-ON MAINTENANCE
1. Remove wheel chocks.
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0152-8
0152
TM 9-2320-339-10
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
OPEN/CLOSE BATTERY BOX
INITIAL SETUP:
Equipment Condition
Engine OFF. (WP 0056)
Wheels chocked. (WP 0073)
WARNING
WARNING
Batteries produce explosive gases. Do not smoke or use open flame near
batteries. Do not allow hot, sparking, or glowing objects near batteries. If
batteries are giving off gases, presence of a heat, flame, or spark may
cause fire and/or explosion. Failure to comply may result in injury or death
to personnel.
WARNING
Use extreme care not to short out battery terminals. Remove all jewelry
such as rings, ID tags, bracelets, etc. prior to working on or around vehicle. Jewelry and tools can catch on equipment, contact positive elec-
0153-1
0153
TM 9-2320-339-10
trical circuits, and cause a direct short, severe burns, or electrical shock.
Failure to comply may result in injury or death to personnel.
WARNING
0153-2
0153
TM 9-2320-339-10
0153
2
3
1
Figure 1.
2. Slide cover (2) up and out.
3. Hold cover (2) in place or remove cover.
END OF TASK
CLOSE BATTERY BOX
WARNING
WARNING
Batteries produce explosive gases. Do not smoke or use open flame near
batteries. Do not allow hot, sparking, or glowing objects near batteries. If
batteries are giving off gases, presence of a heat, flame, or spark may
cause fire and/or explosion. Failure to comply may result in injury or death
to personnel.
0153-3
TM 9-2320-339-10
WARNING
Use extreme care not to short out battery terminals. Remove all jewelry
such as rings, ID tags, bracelets, etc. prior to working on or around vehicle. Jewelry and tools can catch on equipment, contact positive electrical circuits, and cause a direct short, severe burns, or electrical shock.
Failure to comply may result in injury or death to personnel.
WARNING
0153-4
0153
TM 9-2320-339-10
0153
2
3
1
Figure 2.
2. Align rubber hooks (1) and brackets (4).
3. Connect rubber hooks (1).
END OF TASK
FOLLOW-ON MAINTENANCE
1. None.
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0153-5
TM 9-2320-339-10
0154
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
OPEN/CLOSE ENGINE COVERS AND ENGINE SIDE PANEL REMOVAL/
INSTALLATION
INITIAL SETUP:
Equipment Condition
Engine OFF. (WP 0056)
NOTE
Driver side and passenger side engine covers are opened the same way.
Driver side shown.
1. Lift handle (1) and turn clockwise.
Figure 1.
2. Lift engine cover (2).
3. Release hood prop rod (3) from holding bracket (4).
0154-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
Figure 2.
4. Insert hood prop end (5) into support bracket (6).
0154-2
0154
TM 9-2320-339-10
Figure 3.
END OF TASK
CLOSE ENGINE COVERS
NOTE
Driver side and passenger side engine covers are closed the same way.
Driver side shown.
1. Remove hood prop rod end (5) from support bracket (6).
0154-3
0154
TM 9-2320-339-10
Figure 4.
2. Insert hood prop rod (3) into holding bracket (4).
0154-4
0154
TM 9-2320-339-10
Figure 5.
3. Close engine cover (2).
Figure 6.
4. Turn handle (1) counterclockwise and fold down handle (1).
END OF TASK
DRIVER SIDE ENGINE ACCESS PANEL REMOVAL
1. Unlatch two rubber latches (1) from brackets (2).
0154-5
0154
TM 9-2320-339-10
0154
Figure 7.
2. Open access panel (3).
3. Lift access panel (3) straight up and remove from two hinge pins (4).
END OF TASK
DRIVER SIDE ENGINE ACCESS PANEL INSTALLATION
1. Install access panel (3) on two hinge pins (4).
0154-6
TM 9-2320-339-10
0154
Figure 8.
2. Close access panel (3).
3. Latch two rubber latches (1) on brackets (2).
END OF TASK
FOLLOW-ON MAINTENANCE
1. Raise tire carrier (if passenger side engine cover was opened). (WP 0040)
2. Remove wheel chocks.
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0154-7
TM 9-2320-339-10
0155
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
PRIMING FUEL SYSTEM
INITIAL SETUP:
Materials/Parts
Rag, Wiping (WP 0160, Table 1, Item
50)
Equipment Condition
Driver side engine cover opened. (WP
0154)
Driver side engine access panel
opened. (WP 0154)
PRIMING
WARNING
Fuel and oil are slippery and can cause falls. To avoid injury, wipe up
spilled oil with a clean cloth. Failure to comply may result in injury or death
to personnel.
WARNING
Fuel is very flammable and can explode easily. Keep fuel away from open
fire and keep fire extinguisher within easy reach when working with fuel.
Do not work on fuel system when engine is hot. Fuel can be ignited when
engine is hot. When working with fuel, post signs that read NO SMOKING
WITHIN 50 FEET OF VEHICLE. Failure to comply may result in injury or
death to personnel.
1. Loosen air bleed plug (1) three full turns. Do not remove air bleed plug.
0155-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
0155
Figure 1.
2. Turn knob (2) counterclockwise until knob (2) can be pulled out.
3. Push and pull knob (2) on priming pump (3) until fuel appears at air bleed plug (1).
4. Tighten air bleed plug (1).
5. Push and pull knob (2) until strong resistance is felt.
CAUTION
Fuel priming pump knob must be in locked position prior to starting engine. Failure to comply may result in damage to equipment.
6. Push knob (2) in and turn clockwise until locked.
CAUTION
If engine fails to start within 30 seconds, turn ignition switch to OFF and
allow starter motor to cool at least two minutes before trying again. Failure
to comply may result in damage to equipment.
NOTE
If vehicle does not start after three attempts, contact field level maintenance.
0155-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
0155
7. Attempt to start engine. (WP 0043) If engine fails to start or does not operate smoothly
for more than 30 seconds, repeat Steps (1) through (6).
END OF TASK
FOLLOW-ON MAINTENANCE
1. Close driver side engine access panel. (WP 0154)
2. Close driver side engine cover. (WP 0154)
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0155-3
TM 9-2320-339-10
0156
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
OPEN/CLOSE CIRCUIT BREAKER ACCESS PANEL
INITIAL SETUP:
Equipment Condition
Engine OFF. (WP 0056)
Wheels chocked. (WP 0073)
OPEN
1. Push in two screws (1) and turn counterclockwise to release screws (1) and open circuit
breaker access panel (2).
Figure 1.
END OF TASK
CLOSE
1. Close circuit breaker access panel (2) and turn two screws (1) clockwise to lock.
0156-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
0156
Figure 2.
END OF TASK
FOLLOW-ON MAINTENANCE
1. None.
END OF WORK PACKAGE
0156-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
CHAPTER 6
SUPPORTING
INFORMATION
TM 9-2320-339-10
0157
FIELD MAINTENANCE
REFERENCES
SCOPE
This work package lists all pamphlets, forms, field manuals, technical manuals, and other
publications referenced in this manual. Also, those publications that should be consulted
for additional information about vehicle operations are listed.
DEPARTMENT OF ARMY PAMPHLETS
The following indexes should be consulted frequently for latest changes or revisions and
for new publications relating to material covered in this technical manual.
DA PAM 25-30
DA PAM 25-33
DA PAM 710-2-1
DA PAM 750-8
FORMS
DA FORM 2028
DA FORM 2401
DA FORM 2402
Maintenance Tag
DA FORM 2404
DA FORM 2407
Maintenance Request
DA FORM 2407-1
DA FORM 2408
DA FORM 2408-9
DA FORM 5988-E
DD FORM 250
DD FORM 314
DD FORM 1149
DD FORM 1348-1
DD FORM 1397
0157-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
0157
FORMS - Continued
DD FORM 2282
STANDARD FORM 91
FM 4-25.11
FM 4-30.31
FM 5-100-15
FM 5-125
FM 9-207
FM 10-16
FM 10-67-1
FM 20-3
FM 21-10
FM 21-305
FM 31-70
FM 31-71
Northern Operations
FM 55-21
FM 3-11.3
FM 3-11.4
FM 3-11.5
0157-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
0157
FM 90-3
Desert Operations
FM 90-13
TECHNICAL BULLETINS
TB ORD 1030
TB 5-5420-234-15
TB 9-2300-281-35
TB 9-2300-422-20
TB 43-0001-62-SERIES
TB 43-0142
TB 43-0209
TB 43-0212
TB 43-0216
TB 750-651
TB 9-289
TECHNICAL MANUALS
TM 3-4230-214-12&P
TM 3-4240-280-10
TM 3-6665-225-12
TM 5-1940-277-10
TM 5-2090-202-12&P
0157-3
TM 9-2320-339-10
0157
TM 9-214
TM 9-243
TM 9-1005-245-13&P
TM 5-5420-209-12
TM 5-5420-277-14&P
TM 9-1440-600-10
TM 9-2320-326-10HR
TM 9-2330-357-14&P
TM 9-2330-385-14
TM 9-2330-385-24P
TM 9-2610-200-14
TM 9-3990-206-14&P
TM 9-3990-260-14&P
0157-4
TM 9-2320-339-10
0157
TM 9-4910-571-12&P
TM 9-4910-78313&P
TM 9-4940-468-13
TM 9-4940-568-10
TM 9-6115-465-24P
TM 9-6140-200-14
TM 9-8000
TM 11-5820-498-12
TM 38-250
TM 43-0139
TM 55-2200-001-12
TM 11-5820-498-35
TM 55-2320-279-14
TM 750-244-3
TM 750-244-6
TM 750-254
TM 5-2330-378-14&P
0157-5
TM 9-2320-339-10
0157
TM 9-2330-213-14&P
TM 9-2330-231-14&P
TM 9-2330-368-14&P
MISCELLANEOUS PUBLICATIONS
AR 70-1
AR 200-1
AR 385-55
AR 700-138
AR 700-139
AR 702-7
AR 750-1
AR 750-10
CTA 8-100
CTA 50-970
GPM 94-02
SB 725-92-1
TC 9-237
0157-6
TM 9-2320-339-10
0157
TO 00-25-234
0157-7
TM 9-2320-339-10
0158
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
COMPONENTS OF END ITEM AND BASIC ISSUE ITEMS LISTS
INTRODUCTION
Scope
This work package lists COEI and BII for the HEMTT series vehicles to help you inventory
items required for safe and efficient operation.
General
The Components of End Item and Basic Issue Items Lists are divided into the following lists:
Components of End Item (COEI) This listing is for informational purposes only and is not
authority for requisition replacements. These items are part of the HEMTT series vehicle.
As part of the end item, these items must be with the end item whenever it is issued or
transferred between property accounts. Items of COEI are removed and separately
packaged for transportation or shipment only when necessary. Illustrations are furnished to
help you find and identify the items.
Basic Issue Items (BII) These are the minimum essential items required to place the
HEMTT series vehicle in operation, to operate it, and to perform emergency repairs.
Although shipped separately packaged, BII must be with the vehicle during operation and
when it is transferred between property accounts. Listing these items is your authority to
request/requisition them for replacement based on your authorization of the end item by the
TOE/MTOE. Illustrations are furnished to help you find and identify the items.
Explanation of Entries in the COEI List and BII List
The following provides an explanation of columns found in the tabular listings:
Item Number. Gives you the reference number of the item listed.
National Stock Number (NSN) and Illustration. Identifies the stock number of the item to
be used for requisitioning purposes and provides an illustration of the item.
Description, Part Number/(CAGEC). Identifies the Federal item name (in all capital letters)
followed by a minimum description when needed. The stowage location of COEI and BII is
also included in this entry. The last line below the description is the part number and the
Commercial and Government Entity Code (CAGEC) (in parentheses).
Usable On Code. When applicable, gives you a code if the item you need is not the same
for different models of equipment. These codes are identified below:
0158-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
0158
Used On
LH3
LH4
Column (5) - U/I Unit of Issue (U/I) U/I. Unit of Issue (U/I) indicates the physical
measurement or count of the item as issued per the National Stock Number shown in
column (2).
Column (6) - Qty. Indicates the quantity required.
COMPONENTS OF END ITEM
Table 2. Components of End Item
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
(6)
Illus
No.
Description, Part
Number/(CAGEC)
Usable
On
Code
U/I
Qty
Rqr
6680-01-208-4495
LH3
LH4
EA
4720-01-185-6067
HOSE ASSEMBLY,
NONMETALLIC: Fuel
15 ft. (Located in tube
along passenger side of
tanker module)
1378080(45152)
LH3
LH4
EA
0158-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
0158
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
(6)
Illus
No.
Description, Part
Number/(CAGEC)
Usable
On
Code
U/I
Qty
Rqr
2540-01-166-1384
LADDER, VEHICLE
BOARDING (Located
over battery box on
passenger side of
vehicle)
1766590W(45152)
LH3
LH4
EA
4930-01-318-6091
LH3
LH4
EA
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
(6)
Illus
No.
Description, Part
Number/(CAGEC)
Usable
On
Code
U/I
Qty
Rqr
0158-3
TM 9-2320-339-10
0158
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
(6)
Illus
No.
Description, Part
Number/(CAGEC)
Usable
On
Code
U/I
Qty
Rqr
5110-00-293-2336
LH3
LH4
EA
8105-01-353-2497
BAG, TEXTILE:
Pamphlet (Located in
cabin in glove box
forward of passenger/
crew seat)
1362710(45152)
LH3
LH4
EA
7510-00-889-3494
BINDER, LOOSE-LEAF
(Located on passenger
side of cab in glove box)
11677003(19207)
LH3
LH4
EA
3940-01-163-2319
BLOCK, TACKLE: 20
Ton (Located in driver
side tool box)
168400(75535)
LH3
LH4
EA
0158-4
TM 9-2320-339-10
0158
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
(6)
Illus
No.
Description, Part
Number/(CAGEC)
Usable
On
Code
U/I
Qty
Rqr
2540-00-409-8891
BRACKET ASSEMBLY,
TOOL: Pioneer
(Located to the left of
fuel can stowage box)
MS53053-1(96906)
LH3
LH4
EA
4010-01-200-1506
CHAIN ASSEMBLY,
SINGLE LEG: 7 ft. Limp
Home (Located in driver
side tool box)
1452490(45152)
LH3
LH4
EA
4010-01-249-0548
CHAIN ASSEMBLY,
SINGLE LEG: 14 ft.
Utility (Located in driver
side tool box)
00044-9973(96508)
LH3
LH4
EA
0158-5
TM 9-2320-339-10
0158
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
(6)
Illus
No.
Description, Part
Number/(CAGEC)
Usable
On
Code
U/I
Qty
Rqr
2540-01-165-6136
LH3
LH4
EA
4730-01-222-6705
COUPLING HALF,
QUICK DISCONNECT:
Reducer Adapter (to
connect fuel nozzles)
25CX20A(33813)
LH3
LH4
EA
10
4210-01-460-9083
EXTINGUISHER, FIRE
(Located: One each
mounted on driver side
stowage box, and
passenger side battery
box)
36250(99539)
LH3
LH4
EA
0158-6
TM 9-2320-339-10
0158
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
(6)
Illus
No.
Description, Part
Number/(CAGEC)
Usable
On
Code
U/I
Qty
Rqr
11
4210-01-133-9053
EXTINGUISHER, FIRE:
2.7 lbs, 10 BC (Located:
mounted to rear cabin
wall, left of crew/
passenger seat)
429101(03670)
LH3
LH4
EA
12
6545-00-922-1200
LH3
LH4
EA
13
4910-01-003-9599
GAUGE, TIRE
PRESSURE, SELFCONTAINED (Located
in cabin in glove box
forward of passenger/
crew seat)
61-J2-1506(94894)
LH3
LH4
EA
0158-7
TM 9-2320-339-10
0158
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
(6)
Illus
No.
Description, Part
Number/(CAGEC)
Usable
On
Code
U/I
Qty
Rqr
14
5120-01-526-1378
LH3
LH4
EA
15
5340-01-209-7841
HANDLE, EXTENSION
(for lug wrench)
(Located in driver side
tool box)
1347720(45152)
LH3
LH4
EA
16
5120-00-288-6574
LH3
LH4
EA
0158-8
TM 9-2320-339-10
0158
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
(6)
Illus
No.
Description, Part
Number/(CAGEC)
Usable
On
Code
U/I
Qty
Rqr
17
5340-01-558-6515
LH3
LH4
EA
18
5120-01-233-9508
HANDLE, SOCKET
WRENCH: Wheel
Lugnut (Located in
driver side toolbox)
ORR301(66784)
LH3
LH4
EA
19
4720-01-558-6415
HOSE ASSEMBLY,
NONMETALLIC: Air 50
ft.
2155210U(45152)
LH3
LH4
EA
0158-9
TM 9-2320-339-10
0158
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
(6)
Illus
No.
Description, Part
Number/(CAGEC)
Usable
On
Code
U/I
Qty
Rqr
20
4910-01-386-4300
INFLATOR-GAUGE,
PNEUMATIC TIRE
(Located in cabin in
glove box forward of
passenger/crew seat)
I-405M(63900)
LH3
LH4
EA
21
5120-01-146-8096
JACK, HYDRAULIC,
HAND: 12 Ton with
Handle (Located in
driver side tool box)
EBJ-12GC(26952)
LH3
LH4
EA
22
5120-00-243-2395
MATTOCK: Pick
(Located in driver side
tool box)
11677022(19207)
LH3
LH4
EA
23
4930-00-051-3194
LH3
LH4
EA
0158-10
TM 9-2320-339-10
0158
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
(6)
Illus
No.
Description, Part
Number/(CAGEC)
Usable
On
Code
U/I
Qty
Rqr
24
5340-00-158-3807
LH3
LH4
EA
25
5340-00-158-3805
PADLOCK: Without
Chain (Located in
stowage box)
AA59487-2S(58536)
LH3
LH4
EA
26
2540-01-165-5987
LH3
LH4
EA
27
5120-01-480-0640
LH3
LH4
EA
0158-11
TM 9-2320-339-10
0158
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
(6)
Illus
No.
Description, Part
Number/(CAGEC)
Usable
On
Code
U/I
Qty
Rqr
28
9905-01-480-0644
REFLECTOR SET,
HIGHWAY WARNING,
TRIANGULAR (Located
in cabin mounted under
glove box forward of
passenger/crew seat)
6432GBX(45152)
LH3
LH4
SE
29
5975-00-878-3791
LH3
LH4
EA
30
5140-01-167-1541
LH3
LH4
EA
0158-12
TM 9-2320-339-10
0158
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
(6)
Illus
No.
Description, Part
Number/(CAGEC)
Usable
On
Code
U/I
Qty
Rqr
31
5120-01-398-8053
SCREWDRIVER,
CROSS TIP: Phillips No.
3 (Located in driver side
toolbox - part of tool roll)
SDFP56(96508)
LH3
LH4
EA
32
5120-00-293-3309
SCREWDRIVER, FLAT
TIP: No. 6 (Located in
driver side toolbox - part
of tool roll)
66-110(03914)
LH3
LH4
EA
33
4030-00-377-1397
SHACKLE: Anchor,
Limp Home (Located in
driver side toolbox)
RR-C-271
TY4AGRBCL2SZ
1.000(81348)
LH3
LH4
EA
34
4030-01-197-2334
SHACKLE: Slinging
(Located on rear towing
eyes)
1451750(45152)
LH3
LH4
EA
0158-13
TM 9-2320-339-10
0158
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
(6)
Illus
No.
Description, Part
Number/(CAGEC)
Usable
On
Code
U/I
Qty
Rqr
35
4030-01-316-1552
SHACKLE: Towing:
(Located on front towing
eyes)
RR-C-271D
TYIVAGRACL1 3/8 IN
(81348)
LH3
LH4
EA
36
5120-01-515-7117
SHOVEL, HAND
(Located on pioneer tool
bracket)
3453866(45152)
LH3
LH4
EA
37
5120-01-436-2924
WRENCH,
ADJUSTABLE: 8 in.
(Located in driver side
toolbox - part of tool roll)
AC18(96508)
LH3
LH4
EA
0158-14
TM 9-2320-339-10
0158
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
(6)
Illus
No.
Description, Part
Number/(CAGEC)
Usable
On
Code
U/I
Qty
Rqr
38
5120-00-264-3796
WRENCH,
ADJUSTABLE: 12 in.
(Located in driver side
toolbox - part of tool roll)
120405A(45152)
LH3
LH4
EA
39
5120-01-070-8386
WRENCH, SOCKET:
Wheel Nut (Located in
driver side tool box)
1048-TR(45152)
LH3
LH4
EA
0158-15
TM 9-2320-339-10
0159
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
ADDITIONAL AUTHORIZATION LIST (AAL)
INTRODUCTION
Scope
This work package lists additional authorization items that are needed to operate and
maintain the HEMTT Series Vehicles.
General
This list identifies items that do not have to accompany the HEMTT Series Vehicles and
that do not have to be turned in with it. These items are all authorized to you by CTA, MTOE,
TDA, or JTA.
Explanation of Columns in the AAL
Column (1) - National Stock Number (NSN). Identifies the stock number of the item to be
used for requisitioning purposes.
Column (2) - Description, Part Number/(CAGEC). Identifies the Federal item name (in all
capital letters) followed by a minimum description when needed. The last line below the
description is the part number and the Commercial and Government Entity Code (CAGEC)
(in parentheses).
Column (3) - Usable On Code. When applicable, gives you a code if the item you need is
not the same for different models of equipment.
Table 1. List of Usable On Codes
Code
Used On
LH3
LH4
Column (4) - U/I. Unit of Issue (U/I) indicates the physical measurement or count of the item
as issued per the National Stock Number.
Column (5) - Qty Recm. Indicates the quantity recommended.
0159-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
0159
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
National
Stock Number
(NSN)
Usable
On Code
U/I
Qty
Recom
4910-00-347-9
703
LH3 LH4
EA
6150-01-022-6
004
LH3 LH4
EA
2540-01-152-7
813
LH3 LH4
PR
4730-00-951-3
294
LH3 LH4
EA
4230-01-220-3
221
DECONTAMINATION KIT,
INDIVIDUAL EQUIPMENT
5705588(19207)
LH3 LH4
EA
5130-01-400-0
129
EXTENSION, SOCKET
WRENCH: IMPACT 3/4 in.
DRIVE, 13 in. LONG
07569(1CV05)
LH3 LH4
EA
4210-00-965-1
108
LH3 LH4
EA
4240-01-220-6
373
LH3 LH4
KT
8415-00-634-4
658
GLOVES, LEATHER
37G2940(90142)
LH3 LH4
PR
2990-01-509-1
935
LH3 LH4
EA
0159-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
0159
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
National
Stock Number
(NSN)
Usable
On Code
U/I
Qty
Recom
4720-01-341-4
912
HOSE ASSEMBLY
1759750U(45152)
LH3 LH4
EA
N/A-NONE
FOUND
LH3 LH4
EA
4720-01-254-0
189
HOSE ASSEMBLY,
NONMETALLIC: INTERVEHICULAR
MS39325-9-140-8(96906)
LH3 LH4
EA
4720-00-083-0
048
LH3 LH4
EA
N/A-NONE
FOUND
LH3 LH4
EA
5895-01-506-4
503
INSTALLATION KIT,
ELECTRONIC EQUIPMENT:
C4ISR
3418900(45152)
LH3 LH4
EA
1005-01-519-2
126
INSTALLATION KIT:
MOUNTING, MACHINE GUN
1301740UW/OR45152
LH3 LH4
KT
6665-01-220-3
220
LH3 LH4
KT
6220-01-250-5
190
LH3 LH4
EA
0159-3
TM 9-2320-339-10
0159
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
National
Stock Number
(NSN)
Usable
On Code
U/I
Qty
Recom
5120-00-892-5
709
MIRROR, INSPECTION
UH1487(11676)
LH3 LH4
EA
1005-01-266-1
233
LH3 LH4
EA
4930-00-516-0
839
LH3 LH4
EA
4930-00-117-4
726
LH3 LH4
EA
4930-00-051-3
194
LH3 LH4
EA
2910-01-388-6
870
LH3 LH4
EA
2910-01-428-3
166
LH3 LH4
KT
PLATE, TRANSPORT,
WELDMENT (used for air
transportability)No NSN assigned
at date of publish.
2248330W
LH3 LH4
EA
LH3 LH4
EA
4910-00-402-9
623
0159-4
TM 9-2320-339-10
0159
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
National
Stock Number
(NSN)
Usable
On Code
U/I
Qty
Recom
5120-00-197-9
473
LH3 LH4
EA
5975-01-050-5
707
ROD, GROUND
13219E0462(97403)
LH3 LH4
EA
4030-01-316-1
552
LH3 LH4
EA
3940-01-270-3
389
LH3 LH4
EA
5130-01-400-0
164
LH3 LH4
EA
2540-00-378-2
012
LH3 LH4
EA
5130-01-428-3
751
WRENCH, IMPACT,
PNEUMATIC
1789100U(45152)
LH3 LH4
EA
0159-5
TM 9-2320-339-10
0159
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
National
Stock Number
(NSN)
Usable
On Code
U/I
Qty
Recom
LH3 LH4
EA
4730-01-068-5
070
WYE ASSEMBLY
13219E0477(97403)
0159-6
TM 9-2320-339-10
0160
OPERATOR MAINTENANCE
EXPENDABLE AND DURABLE ITEMS LIST
INTRODUCTION
Scope
This work package lists expendable supplies and materials that are needed to operate and
maintain the HEMTT Series Vehicles. This list is for information only and is not authority to
requisition the listed items. These items are authorized to you by CTA 50-970, Expendable/
Durable Items (Except Medical, Class V Repair Parts, and Heraldic Items), CTA 50-909,
Field and Garrison Furnishings and Equipment or CTA 8-100, Army Medical Department
Expendable/Durable Items.
Explanation of Entries in the Expendable/Durable Items List
Item No. This number is assigned to the entry in the list and is referenced in the narrative
instructions to identify the item (e.g., Use brake fluid (Expendable/Durable Items List)).
Level. This column identifies the lowest level of maintenance that requires the listed item.
C -- Operator/Crew
O -- Unit/AMC
F -- Direct Support/ASB
H -- General Support
D -- Depot
National Stock Number (NSN). This is the NSN assigned to the item which you can use
to requisition it.
Item Name, Description, Part Number/(CAGEC). This column provides the other
information you need to identify the item. The last line below the description is the part
number and the Commercial and Government Entity Code (CAGEC) (in parentheses).
(U/I). Unit of Issue (U/I) code shows the physical measurement or count of an item, such
as gallon, dozen, gross, etc.
Table 1. Expendable and Durable Items List
(1)
Item
No.
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
Level
National
Stock Number
(NSN)
U/I
0160-1
TM 9-2320-339-10
0160
Item
No.
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
Level
National
Stock Number
(NSN)
U/I
6850-01-441-3
248
DR
6850-01-464-9
125
GL
6850-00-181-7
933
CO
6850-01-464-9
152
DR
Cleaner, Lubricant
5
9150-01-079-6
124
BT
6850-01-474-2
319
GL
6850-01-474-2
317
CO
0160-2
TM 9-2320-339-10
0160
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
Item
No.
Level
National
Stock Number
(NSN)
U/I
6850-01-474-2
316
DR
6850-01-474-2
318
GL
10
6850-01-474-2
320
BX
11
6850-01-474-2
321
DR
6850-00-926-2
275
BX
9140-01-413-7
511
GL
14
9140-00-286-5
286
GL
15
9140-00-286-5
287
CN
16
9140-00-286-5
288
DR
17
9140-00-286-5
289
DR
0160-3
TM 9-2320-339-10
0160
Item
No.
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
Level
National
Stock Number
(NSN)
U/I
Fuel
18
9130-01-031-5
816
GL
19
9140-01-412-1
311
GL
20
9140-00-286-5
294
GL
21
9140-00-286-5
295
CN
22
9140-00-286-5
296
DR
23
9140-00-286-5
297
DR
9150-01-197-7
688
TU
25
9150-01-197-7
693
CA
26
9150-01-197-7
690
CN
0160-4
TM 9-2320-339-10
0160
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
Item
No.
Level
National
Stock Number
(NSN)
U/I
27
9150-01-197-7
689
CN
28
9150-01-197-7
692
CN
9150-01-035-5
390
QT
30
9150-01-048-4
593
GL
31
9150-01-035-5
391
CN
9150-01-035-5
393
CN
9150-00-402-4
478
QT
34
9150-00-402-2
372
CN
0160-5
TM 9-2320-339-10
0160
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
Item
No.
Level
National
Stock Number
(NSN)
U/I
35
9150-00-491-7
197
DR
9150-00-189-6
727
QT
37
9150-00-186-6
668
CN
38
9150-00-191-2
772
DR
39
9150-01-496-1
939
DR
9150-00-183-7
808
GL
41
9150-00-186-6
681
QT
42
9150-00-188-9
858
CN
43
9150-01-433-7
978
DR
0160-6
TM 9-2320-339-10
0160
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
Item
No.
Level
National
Stock Number
(NSN)
U/I
44
9150-00-189-6
729
DR
9150-00-188-9
865
CN
9150-01-035-5
396
DR
9150-01-352-2
962
CO
48
9150-01-152-4
119
DR
9150-01-467-8
161
DR
Rag, Wiping
50
7920-00-205-1
711
0160-7
BE
TM 9-2320-339-10
0160
Item
No.
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
Level
National
Stock Number
(NSN)
U/I
Rope
51
4020-00-968-1
357
Rope, Fibrous
MIL-R-17343 (81349)
0160-8
RL
TM 9-2320-339-10
TM 9-2320-339-10
TM 9-2320-339-10
084811-000